Home

AMOS System Commands Reference Manual

image

Contents

1. File Name Mask LIT 001 004 Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 01 53 21 PM Files have been restored Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 01 55 17 PM Restored 106 Files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 01 55 17 PM Files have been restored Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 01 55 17 PM Restored 0 Files File Name Mask LTT 001 004 Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 01 55 19 PM Files have been restored Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 00 47 PM Restored 35 Files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 00 48 PM Files have been restored Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 00 52 PM ENTERED DBD62 19200 150 Mb gt UPD1 19200 150 Mb ENTERED DBD63 19200 150 Mb gt UPD2 19200 150 Mb ENTERED DBD64 19200 150 Mb gt UPD3 19200 150 Mb ENTERED DBD65 19200 150 Mb gt UPD4 19200 150 Mb ENTERED DBD66 19200 150 Mb gt UPD5 19200 150 Mb Restored 14 Files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 00 52 PM Files have been restored Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 01 01 PM Restored 8 Files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 Date amp Time Thu 5 Ju
2. DEL filespec filespec s filespec s is one or more valid file specifications selecting the modules you want to erase from your memory partition DEL assumes a file extension of any extension OPERATION Enter DEL followed by one or more file specifications For example DEL CREATE CREATE LIT DEL erases from your memory partition the modules selected by your specifications then it displays them to let you know they have been deleted You can use standard wildcard symbols in your file specifications For example DEL NEWPR NEWPR1 SBR NEWPRT LIT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DEL Page 2 MESSAGES Cannot DELETE filename file may not be deleted DEL cannot delete modules which have been locked in memory by setting the LOK bit flag in the module s flags word System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DEVTBL FUNCTION Displays data about the devices defined on your system CHARACTERISTICS DEVTBL is re entrant and re usable In order for your system monitor to know about and have access to physical devices on your system such as disk drives and backup devices those devices must be defined to the monitor in your system initialization command file See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for more information about how devices are defined OPERATION Enter DEVTBL at AMOS command level DEVTBL the display you see tells you
3. AMPC 7 1 Release June 2007 d Soft Release February 2007 AMOS 8 1 February 2007 Release AlphaTCP 1 5A February 2007 Release AlphaNET 2 4 January 2006 Release AlphaFAX 2 1 February 2007 Release MULTI 2 1B January 2006 Release AlphaWRITE 1 2A PRO6 2000 AlphaWRITE 2 2 PRO6 2000 0 AlphaCALC 2 0 April 2004 Release BSP 82 2s PRIENT 99 gt sien cock RE AEA CARERE RSA AlphaMAIL 1 2B PRO4 05 cece eee eee eee AM 8000 configuration files INIs Eagle 800 configuration files INIs AlphaC vol 1 of 2 PR12 97 AlphaC 2 0 vol 2 of 2 PRI2Z 97 secre cas XAdmin for AM 8000 Only Release 1 0 AlphaODBC 1 4A February 2007 Release VersiCOMM Plus V3 1 and ZARC OCT2004 Unsupported Software January 2006 AMPC 7 0 Release February 2007 d Soft Release February 2007 AMOS 8 1 January 31 2006 Release AlphaTCP 1 5A January 31 2006 Release AlphaNET 2 4 January 31 2006 Release AlphaFAX 2 1 March 1 2005 Release MULTI 2 1B January 31 2006 Release 4 AlphaWRITE 1 2A PR06 2000 AlphaWRITE 2 2 PROG 2000 cal scdeee nee 4 AlphaCALC 2 0 April 22 2004 Release BSP 22 PRA 99 svg cub thi ten dct cea Os ETENA ce AlphaMAIL 1 2B PRO4 05 eee ee eee eens AM 8000 configuration files INIs Eagle 800 configuration files INIs AlphaC vol 1 of 2 PR12 97 A
4. Privileged program must be logged into OPR Log into DSKO 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CRT420 Page 4 S100 data transfer error An error occurred with the AM 420 controller A number of these errors can indicate hardware problems Track 0 Head 0 did not verify First track must verify CRT420 could not verify track 0 head 0 which MUST verify Get technical help to determine what is wrong with the drive Track n Head n Sector n did not verify CRT420 marked track n head n as a bad track in the BADBLK SYS file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CRT520 FUNCTION Formats and incorporates defect list for disks controlled by the AM 520 Intelligent Disk Controllers The AM 522 controller is a variant of the AM 520 and works in the same way The information in this sheet also applies to the AM 522 CHARACTERISTICS CRT520 is re entrant and re usable Because of the high data density of the disks that run under the control of the AM 520 media flaws are likely and must be compensated for All drives that run under control of the AM 520 must be formatted using CRT520 I All drives purchased from Alpha Micro to be used with the AM 520 are formatted before Ss leaving the factory You do not need to run CRT520 again on these drives You do need to run CRT520 if you are upgrading an existing drive to use with the AM 520 instead of an AM 4
5. AMOS format is for compatibility with older floppy disk systems To navigate the menus use J O A and W To invoke a highlighted function press RETURN To abort menu functions and return to the AMOS prompt press or C To return to menu functions from submenus press ESC You can do any of the following Select Drive Selects drive to use in the operations listed below Reassign Blocks The AM 212 20 does not support this function Rewrite Hidden Sector Re initializes the media s hidden sector If the hidden sector becomes corrupted you may use this command to restore it without destroying any user data assuming the hidden sector is initialized as it was before it became corrupted Me Whenever the hidden sector is written the diagnostic cylinder is also re initialized This is necessary since the diagnostic cylinder always begins right after the last logical drive defined on the media This is ignored for AMOS compatible diskettes which do not have a hidden sector Format Formats and initializes the media in the selected drive You can select the media format directory type and either set the bitmap size and number of logicals or have FMSFLP optimize the logical configuration Here are the settings for some common configurations System Commands Reference Manual Rev 09 Page 3 T S FMSFLP For traditional directories using the entire drive with the largest possible bitmaps set Directory Type to T
6. Cannot open filespec invalid filename Check the syntax of your file specification and try again Cannot open filespec file not found Check your file specification or use DIR to find the file and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 SUBMIT Not enough free queue records for request The queue file is full No more SUBMIT jobs can be put in the queue until either a non recurring job finishes or the queue file is expanded Queue file not BATCH compatible The queue file you specified is not a Task Manager batch queue file Select another filename and try again Specified entry not found in queue Make sure you have the right queue file Task not found in queue The task you specified was not in the batch file queue Use SUBMIT to view the current entries and try again with a different task sequence number System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SYMLIT FUNCTION Creates a symbol table file for machine language object files to let you reference user defined symbols when you use the AlphaFIX symbolic debugging program Also lets you generate a program or load map file CHARACTERISTICS SYMLIT is re entrant and re usable The object files M68 the assembler creates contain complete information about the symbols used in your program as well as the actual generated code To make this list of symbols available to the debugging program AlphaFIX you must use the SYMLIT program to g
7. Unrecognized error code n returned by SPAWN See your system operator for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 RENAME FUNCTION Changes the names of files CHARACTERISTICS RENAME is re entrant re usable a wildcard file command and recognizes ersatz names FORMAT RENAME newfilespec filespec filespec s switch filespec s select the files you want to rename newfilespec s is the new name s and switch is an option request or RENAME filespec PROTECTION value for PROTECTION operation only See Chapter 6 of Monitor Calls Manual for more information on value DEFAULTS The default device and account are where you are logged The default switches are NOD and NOQ Defaults for unspecified filenames and extensions are OPTIONS The switches are file switches and may be abbreviated to any unique characters QUERY Confirm each renaming NOQUERY Rename without confirmation DELETE Delete existing file before renaming NODELETE If the new name is in use don t rename PROTECTION n Update the file protection code System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 RENAME Page 2 OPERATION Enter RENAME followed by a new name an equal sign and one or more files you want renamed For example RENAME ACCNT TXT AC TXT or RENAME TTY DVR DVRI2 LIT to TTYI2 LILIT DVRAA TXT to TTYAA TXT The PROTECTION switch allows you
8. Verif dir date changed entry if the entry is less severe than the original entry Can be further modified by error accumulation Error Accumulation and Modification As you review the MTUSAV log file some incidents may be reported with a severity other than you expect As described below four procedures can modify the severity of a particular incident two can boost the severity and two can reduce it A Boost Error Accumulation The total effect of a number of incidents of low severity may be larger then any one of them Therefore MTUSAV counts certain types of incidents and triggers an incident with a severity of error if the total reaches a certain number Any component incident that occurs after the triggering of error will report another error The following MTUSAV OPT settings control error accumulation The Components are the incidents which are counted in that category System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 20 MTUSAV OPT Setting Components Notes Max seq file in use count Bkup seq file in use Max contig file in use count Bkup contig file in use Bkup contig file hijacked Max rec in use count Bkup record in use Max tape dir block not found count Tape dir block not found Max read errors Bkup seq file read error Bkup contig file read error Verif seq file read error Verif contig file read error Max bum block count count Bkup seq file padded Bkup seq file truncated Max warnings
9. ADD2ND Add secondary key directory DELETE Delete existing secondary key directory DUMP Dump ISAM Plus file STAT Display statistical information ADDIDX Add index block DESCRP Change key description REBUILD Rebuild an index file EXIT Exit to AMOS You may enter a ISMUTL command from the list above in any combination of upper or lower case You may abbreviate if there is no conflict between command names MESSAGES Attempt to add duplicate key Duplicate keys aren t allowed for this file Cannot add record not enough free index blocks Use the ADDIDX utility to add extra index blocks or delete some records Cannot change key The ISAM Plus file was created in such a way that the keys in this file can t be modified Cannot create existing ISAM Plus file An ISAM Plus file by the same name already exists This message only appears if you interface your assembly language program to ISMUTL Cannot delete primary key You may not delete a primary key for any reason Data file full System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 ISMUTL You are trying to add more records than you allowed room for when you created the file Data file smashed This message appears if the IDA free list chain is smashed See your System Operator or Alpha Micro representative for help Incompatible ISAM Plus file Your file is in an older ISAM format see your SAM Plus User s Guide for help converting an old ISAM fil
10. Device not found mounted device name Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system If the device is not mounted MOUNT it Device or p pn specifications on output are illegal Your newfilespec and filespec s must be in the same device and account Maximum input exceeded You put more characters on the command line than RENAME could handle Break your command into smaller commands and try again 2MEM or RES specified on network You cannot access MEM or RES over a network Missing Output specification You must give a new file name so RENAME knows what to call your new file More than one output specification Try again using only one new file name No files renamed RENAME couldn t find any files matching your filespecs or wasn t able to carry out the renaming procedure because of an error Make sure you used the correct filespec and try again Specification error The symbol points to the error Check your syntax and try again Wildcard device or unit specified on network You can t use wildcard symbols over a network System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 RESTOR FUNCTION Writes files from a specified backup device to a hard disk RESTOR is a file oriented program that transfers files previously saved by the BACKUP command The BACKUP BAKDIR and RESTOR commands are included only for compatibility with earlier operating system versions Do NOT use these commands unless absolu
11. FORMAT STRRES switch outfilespec filespec filespec switch switch specifies a STRRES option outfilespec specifies the files to be created on the disk and the filespecs specify the files to be transferred from the tape with device and account specifications of the files when they were backed up System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 STRRES Page 2 DEFAULTS The output specification defaults to the input specification If you are logged into 1 2 the default output account specification is The input specification defaults to and the account and device you are logged into The defaults are NOQ D NOH OPTIONS Switches are all file switches and may be abbreviated to any unique letters DELETE Copy over existing file s NODELETE Don t copy over existing file s HASH Restore only files with different hash totals on the disk if files were saved using STRSAV H NOHASH Don t check hash totals QUERY Confirm before selecting files NOQUERY Don t confirm before selecting files OPERATION Load the desired cartridge into the streamer unit and enter STRRES and the files you need For example to copy from a cartridge all BAS files originally backed up from account 110 2 on DSK2 over to your current account DSK3 110 5 STRRES DSK3 110 5 DSK2 BAS 110 2 STRRES rewinds the tape and starts searching for the specified files It reads the directory from the beginning of
12. Illegal password must be alphanumeric Check your syntax and try again Invalid command type H for help Use the H option to see a summary of all of the commands and try again MFD forms an endless loop Add some accounts to the device before using the L option again No initialization performed This message assures you the initialization did not take place Out of memory See your System Operator for help with increasing your memory partition size Warning You may lose data if this logical is fully used This logical is greater than 32MB You have initialized this disk to a traditional format directory structure but the logical disk size is larger than the largest traditional format drive 32MB This can cause problems if data is loaded onto the disk Check the disk size and your choice of format type before proceeding or aborting Please enter a number Enter a number and press RETURN Privileged program must be logged into 1 2 Log into an operator s account 1 2 and try again PPN 377 377 is reserved and may not be used Under AMOS 2 x you cannot assign a PPN of 377 377 Choose another PPN System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SYSLOG FUNCTION Produces a system error list CHARACTERISTICS SYSLOG is the formatting program of the event logging system SYSLOG reads the log file SYSLOG SYS and produces a listing in the file SYSLOG LST This is a chronological listing of all events logged si
13. System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIXLOG Page 4 7 SAVE the driver to the disk For example SAVE WIN DVR RETURN If you do not specify an extension SAVE saves the file under the DVR extension indicating a device driver program Now that FIXLOG has defined a driver for you you must revise your system initialization command file to include the new information about the device For information on changing this file see your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File MESSAGES device name contains invalid disk controller information The device you tried to run FIXLOG on is not a self configuring drive You cannot use FIXLOG on that device See your System Operator s Guide for information on changing the number of logical devices devn is not the 1st logical unit The device you entered is not the first logical device of its physical unit Only that device name can be specified to FIXLOG Use DEVTBL to locate the correct device name and redo the FIXLOG command dev0 does not exist You either misspelled the device name or are trying to change the number of logical devices on a device that is not currently defined on the system The number of logical drives requested is invalid The maximum number of logical drives allowed is n You asked for an invalid number of logical drives Try again with a proper number Cannot find driver name The driver for your drive was not found Yo
14. Used with a control file to execute jobs on the Task Manager system For information on the Task Manager see your Task Manager User s Manual FORMAT SUBMIT queue filespec control filespec switch queue filespec is the specification of the Task Manager queue you want to use control filespec is the control file to submit or edit and switch is an option request DEFAULTS Default queue is DSKO BATQUE SYS 1 4 Default control file extension is CTL The default queue file extension is SYS Default switches are NOR NOP and NOLO OPTIONS All switches can be abbreviated to any unique name AFTER mm dd yy hh mm AM PM Task is run after specified absolute or relative time DEADLINE mm dd yy hh mm Task must run before specified time or it will be AM PM killed ERROR NONE FATAL ALL FATAL WARNING or ALL will abort task if a WARNING system error occurs FATAL kills on fatal system errors WARNING on warning messages KILL Removes file from the queue LIMIT mm dd yy hh mm AM PM Task must be completed in specified time period or it will be removed from the queue LIST Lists queue file contents Default if no filespec specified LOGTIME Puts run date time in log file NOLOGTIME Negates LOGTIME MEMORY n Task needs nK to run Default is 32K System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SUBMIT NEXT mm dd yy hh mm OUTPUT filespec PERMANENT NOPERMANENT PRIORI
15. VCRO DSK3 B32 BAS 10 4 to DSK2 B32 O0LD 10 4 Y VCRO DSK3 SCRTCH BAS 10 6 to DSK2 SCRTICH OLD 10 6 N You may use CTRLYC at any time to stop the file transfer But remember if you are restoring files with the same specification as other files already on the disk any of those files that were already selected will be erased Once the restore is finished rewind and remove the cassette and return it to its storage location If a disk error is encountered during the restore all files prior to the error are restored properly You will see an error message the restore stops and you are returned to AMOS Run DSKANA on your disk to be sure no problems occur When you use S VCRRES reads the file s position in the tape table of contents in the normal manner and then guides you to locating the file on the tape Once you get close to the file press PLAY on the VCR and the restore process proceeds as usual System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VCRRES Page 4 MESSAGES Backup media is not file structured The tape you are trying to read was not written by VCRSAV Make sure you have mounted the correct tape cassette Backup media not compatible with current software The tape was saved by a version of VCRSAV which is not compatible with the current version of VCRRES Check with your System Operator to see what can be done Cannot allocate record on filespec Device full This indicates a disk
16. CHARACTERISTICS BADBLK is re entrant and re usable It reads the list of disk defects created by a disk certification program Depending on the type of disk this list is either in the file BADBLK SYS 1 2 or handled by the drive internally on a portion of the disk reserved for that purpose In either case the list is created when the disk is certified Certifying a disk is a serious procedure which you should do only if you have a situation where the data on the disk is not recoverable In cases where you need to modify the list of disk defects we strongly recommend you use BADBLK rather than re certifying the disk For disks which use BADBLK SYS 1 2 BADBLK also verifies the file s hash total a value based on the file s contents that checks the validity of the data in the file While AM 520 and AM 522 controlled disks do have BADBLK SYS 1 2 files these files are not used by the operating system Defects are handled internally by the disk controller You can still use BADBLK to update the defect list To use BADBLK on a SCSI disk the disk must be connected to the SCSI bus You cannot use BADBLK on a SCSI disk connected to an AM 515 disk controller For a discussion of when to use BADBLK to create or modify the BADBLK SYS file see your System Operator s Guide FORMAT BADBLK devn OPERATION When used from an account other than OPR Enter BADBLK and the logical device you want a bad block list for For example BADBL
17. CRT410 also computes and stores a hash total for BADBLK SYS within the file Other programs can check this hash total against the contents of the file to make sure BADBLK SYS contains undamaged data You must mount a logical device before certifying it FORMAT CRT410 devn devn is the specification of the device you want to certify System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CRT410 Page 2 OPERATION Enter CRT410 and the specification of the device For example CRT410 SMD5 Make sure you have backed up any data on the disk you may need CRT410 destroys all data on the disk You can interrupt the program at this point by pressing TRL C CRT410 now creates a file named BADBLK SYS in account 1 2 of the disk you are certifying This file will hold a list of all bad disk blocks CRT410 finds It then asks you several questions 1 Enter maximum acceptable number of bad tracks Give the number of bad tracks you will accept on the disk You may specify up to 15 tracks When CRT410 finds more than this number it tells you so and returns you to AMOS command level 2 Enter number of accounts to preallocate This information allows CRT410 to pre initialize blocks in the Master File Directory MFD There is no practical limit to the number of accounts you may specify and the number you enter here in no way restricts the number of accounts you can add to the disk in the future The only limiting factors are the size of the logical
18. Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of valid devices Cannot READ device name device is not mounted Mount the device and try again Device is full Please insert another disk then type RETURN to continue or type Control C to abort copy Follow the instructions to continue or abort Did not copy filespec Informs you the copy was aborted DSK is not a valid backup device Try again using a floppy device name No file oriented device corresponding to device name is mounted You specified a device but left off the unit number Try again No room to perform append device full Try again with a floppy disk with room left on it System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 WRDCNT FUNCTION Counts and displays the number of words in a file Can optionally adjust the word count prior to display CHARACTERISTICS WRDCNT is re entrant and re usable WRDCNT considers a word to be any collection of characters separated by one or more spaces tabs returns linefeeds or formfeeds WRDCNT is designed to work with text files Using it on binary data files will not yield useful results FORMAT WRDCNT filespec adjustment filespec is the file specification and adjustment is a factor applied to the result number OPERATION Enter WRDCNT followed the file specification for the file in which you wish to count words For example WRDCNT
19. IDA freecount Number of records free in data file 5 6 7 IDX freelist pointer Logical block number of next free block in index 8 IDX freecount Number of free logical index blocks 9 Records allocated Number of data records used 10 Top dir blk pointer Block pointer to beginning of top index block The rest of the display contains debugging information about the structure of the index file This information is mostly of use to the experienced programmer who understands the internal workings of ISAM System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 ISMDMP MESSAGES Cannot rename filespec file not found Check your device and account specifications and your spelling and try again No records dumped You tried to dump data from an empty ISAM data file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 ISMUTL FUNCTION ISMUTL performs a variety of operations on an ISAM Plus file including creating the ISAM Plus file loading records into it reformatting displaying and adjusting it ISMUTL may be used interactively or may be accessed through your assembly language AlphaBASIC or AlphaC programs CHARACTERISTICS ISAM Indexed Sequential Access Method is a method of organizing and accessing data An ISAM Plus file is a data file index file combination The index file contains pointers to records in the data file ISAM Plus quickly finds data records by search
20. Rx Interrupts All is the count of all Rx interrupts Tx Interrupts All is the count of all Tx interrupts Both Rx amp Tx Int is the count of all interrupts with Rx amp Tx bits set RDA Last amp First is the count of Rx packets with the last amp first segment bit set Tx Collision count is the total Tx collision counts returned from the chip Unregistered Type is the total count of unidentifiable packets Total Send Packets is the total number of packets sent Total Rx Stop is the total number of times the Rx process has stopped Total No Rx Buffers is the total number of times an Rx buffer was not available CINV is total count of referenced packets not on the receive queue CDISC is total count of discarded request NOFSD is the total number of Rx packets with no first segment flag set NOLSD is the total number of Rx packets with no last segment flag set ARDA FCNT is the total number of free Rx descriptors PRDA UCNT is the total number of used Rx descriptors ATDA FCNT is the total number of free Tx descriptors PTDA UCNT is the total number of used Tx descriptors TX QU CNT is the Tx queue count FLAGS is processing flags used by PCI programs RDES0O is the latest Rx descriptor processed NTRI is the total count of interrupts without a Tx or Rx request present CTDAPFP is the current TDA pointer for processing Missed Frames is the total number of missed frames Master Abort is the total number of Master Aborts encountered TLLCNT is th
21. System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 CRT620 FUNCTION Checks and verifies the quality of 1 2 mag tape 1 4 streaming tape 8mm tape or DAT tape for use as disk file backup media Also re tensions streamer cartridges and builds a warm boot streamer cartridge from a warm boot monitor file created by WRMGEN CHARACTERISTICS CRT620 is re entrant and re usable A warm boot is a procedure you can use to restore your system when your System Disk is erased or written over accidentally A warm boot from the streamer tape requires a special monitor file generated using WRMGEN with enough information to get your system up and running on one terminal and in one memory partition Then you can restore the damaged files to your System Disk from other backups previously created with MTUSAV CRT620 performs a CRC check to make sure it can read each block of data on the tape It o does not check the file structure of the tape It is possible for a tape to show no errors after CRT620 and still be unreadable To properly check a backup use MTUDIR to display a directory of the entire tape since the directory process reads the structure of the entire tape FORMAT CRT620 filespec size switch filespec is the specification of the warm boot monitor file you want to copy onto the streamer tape if you are using the BOOT switch Used with VERIFY size is the number of megabytes to write to the tape if you omit it VERIFY writes until t
22. System Commands Reference Manual Rev 10 SET FF FFF FF FF 2222 2 eae 2S 505 a gt Z Z Z Z A v Z SC SE SV UF UM UX VB VD Page 4 Current device and drive number Sends TCRT 2 Ersatz name of current account If none same as P Name of current language Same as NI NP NB Baud rate Terminal driver name Interface driver name Job name Modem driver name Interface driver port number in decimal Operating system name User name Account number in brackets AlphaNET cpu ID Ersatz name for AlphaNET cpu ID If none same as SC Monitor version Free memory in user partition in KB Total memory in user partition in KB Radix H for hexadecimal O for octal Set to bright display Set to dim display These codes result in an interpreted prompt which changes depending on the user account etc When using an interpreted prompt keep the following in mind e PROMPT SYS must be loaded into system memory and initialized for interpreted prompts to work e If you use SET PROMPT in a DO file you must double the dollar sign before any interpreted prompt code for example use P for the current account not SP e While the maximum length of the prompt string you enter is 19 characters interpreted prompts may result in a displayed prompt much longer than this e Calculating the prompt length in a program is more difficult you cannot do so by counting the cha
23. Tape full multi reel backup is not supported Backup is being aborted All the files you specified cannot fit onto a single tape A multi reel backup cannot be done with the hardware and software combination being used The backup is aborted without a verification phase Not all files are backed up Tape full running under Task Manager Cannot change tape backup aborting All the files you specified cannot fit on a single tape A new tape cannot be loaded as the backup is running under control of the Task Manager The backup aborts without any verification phase and the Task Manager control file continues to execute Tape is file protected please insert a write ring or mount a different tape then press RETURN when ready Make sure you have the correct tape then install a write ring to continue System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 26 Tape is full please mount another tape then press C to continue Pressing Control C will abort the backup and leave the tape with partially copied files Remove the tape label it and mount another reel to continue the backup If you want to stop the backup you can use ETRLYC at this point but be aware the tape you just created may not be restorable Tape is not from the same save set Please correct then press RETURN when ready or press control C to abort The tape you mounted is not from the correct save set Replace it with the correct reel from t
24. megabytes 11432 000 2170 569 9261 431 gigabytes 11 1641 2211 97 9 0444 DBD media contains 178 logical units DBD61 Which DBD Logical s would you like to restore Each DBD Logical entered may have one MASK following it A space must separate the DBD Logical and the MASK MASK characters are amp e g DBDO DIR 1 2 DBD5 A LIT 1 or DBD16 FLP Enter list of disk Logicals to be transferred Disk Logicals may be entered as a range e g DBDO 20 for DBDO thru DBD20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line With Wildcarding 76 LIT 1 4 hich Disk Logical s would you like to restore to Enter list of disk Logicals to be transferred Disk Logicals may be entered as a range e g DBDO 20 for DBDO thru DBD20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line 15 Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 01 45 12 PM File Name Mask LIT 001 004 ENTERED LIT 1 4 DBD61 19200 150 Mb gt UPDO 19200 150 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 01 45 15 PM System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 BDRES Page 9 Files have been restored Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 01 53 18 PM Restored 204 files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 01 53 20 PM Files have been restored Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 01 53 20 PM Restored 0 Files
25. switches from the AMOS prompt DBD DBD will attempt to find a DVD RAM or Blu ray drive The DBD driver must be in system memory DBD will find the DVD RAM drive either using the command line switch ID or by defaulting to DBD If more than one DVD or Blu ray device is found when scanning the SCSI bus you will be asked to choose the device you wish to use Found the following possible DBD Recorders ID Description 1 nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX 2 nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 DBD Page 2 Select one of the above devices Additional information about the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive is then displayed DVD RAM or Blu ray Recorder located at SCSI id 3 The option is performed If you want to remove the DVD or Blu ray media or switch to another DVD media use the U switch DBD U REQUIREMENTS AND SETUP DBD requires the following e AM 8000 Eagle 800 or AMPC 7 X based system e AMOS 8 1 or later e A supported DVD RAM or Blu ray drive The DBD package contains the following required files DBD LIT The device driver DBD DVR for the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive in system memory The SSD overlay file DVD000 OVR MAKBD LIT DIRBD LIT BDRES LIT MESSAGES DVD RAM or Blu ray drive found at SCSI id lt gt DBD is confirming the SCSI ID of the DVD drive it is about to use Error Device specified is not a DVD RAM or Blu ray Recorder Error DVDram driver must be
26. usually octal If you want MAP to display these memory addresses as hexadecimal numbers make sure the HEX option is in effect before using MAP For information on changing the number base the system uses for your numeric displays see the SET reference sheet FORMAT MAP filespec switch s filespec selects the memory module about which you want information A switch selects various options DEFAULTS If you do not specify a filespec MAP assumes you want information on all of the memory modules in your partition If you do not specify any switches MAP assumes you want full information on the memory module s you specified Specifying any one switch cancels all the defaults OPTIONS MAP assumes each character after the slash is a separate switch The switches are B F H M R IS U Display octal base memory address for each module Display number of free memory bytes available in decimal Use with S Display hash totals for each memory module Display information about modules Display information about modules in RES Display number of bytes in decimal of each module Display information about modules in MEM System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MAP Page 2 OPERATION To see what modules are in your memory partition enter MAP You see a list of the memory modules currently in your partition Here is a sample line CHECK LIT 1016 35022 513 543 124 555 Hash total Base addres
27. 03 97 06 97 12 97 6 98 4 99 10 99 2 00 8 00 1 01 3 01 2 02 5 04 10 06 09 07 Page 2 Description PLAYCD RADMON RUNP RUNX SCSI SCZCSH SCZPIC SETPEN SI STAT1 TAPLOG TMODE and 640INI Updated Chapters 5 and 6 ASCDMP BACKUP CACHE CBEN CBDS COPY CRT610 CRT620 DATE DIRSEQ DSKANA DUMP ERSATZ FIXLOG FIXFLP FMTFLP FMTSCZ JOBPRI LABEL MK MONTST MOUNT MTURES MTUSAV MUSER PPN PRINT PUSH REDIR SET SETJOB SMEM STAT STRDIR STRRES STRSAV SYSLOG UTC VCRRES VDKUTL VERIFY WRMGEN and XY Added FMTS2 Added note about FMTS2 to FMTSCZ sheet Updated DSKANA MONGEN MONTST SET WRMGEN Added SCZERR Reformatted manual General update and corrections as necessary to all commands Updated Appendix A Rewrote MTUSAV updated FMTS2 maximum logical size and RADMON new switches Added FMSFLP updated SYSLOG andWRMGEN Updated SET and added MAKACD Updated MAKACD and added ESTAT Updated SI Updated SCSI and RADMON Added ESLSI and ESNIC deleted ESTAT Added ISOCD DVD MAKDVD and FMTDVD Added XMOUNT Added DVDRES Added MAKBD DIRBD DBD and BDRES System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18
28. 07 Page 5 COPY You are not logged in under 1 2 can t create p pn You tried to copy one or more files to an account that does not exist You must be logged into 1 2 to create such an account System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CPMCPY FUNCTION Transfers a copy of a file from a floppy diskette created under the CP M operating system to an AMOS file structured device CHARACTERISTICS CPMCPY is not re entrant or re usable CPMCPY assumes the data in the CP M file is in ASCII or binary form it does no translation of the data CPMCPY assumes the CPMCPY diskette is mounted on CP M device A CP M device A is AMOS device IMGO You must have the IMG DVR floppy driver in account DSKO 1 6 For information on configuring floppy disk drivers see your System Operator s Guide You must have the IMG device defined in your system device table see your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File The extension in your CP M file specification must be three characters This means if the CP M extension is only two characters you must enter a space as the third character If the extension is a null extension you must enter three spaces 4l CP M is a registered trademark of Digital Research In order to use CP M on an AMOS S system you must purchase the Alpha Micro implementation of CP M and your computer must be equipped with the proper Communications Controller For information on using AMOS CP M see y
29. 09 Page 3 WRMGEN After you have entered this basic information you will see a message asking you to enter the names of Secondary Devices to be defined into system memory These are devices on your system you want to be operational after the warm boot you may have noted them in step 1 above If you enter a device name you must enter the name of the device one device name per line for example VCRO Note there is no colon after VCRO If a device is non sharable put a slash in front of the device name Printers 1 4 streaming tape drives and video cassette recorders are non sharable Bitmaps etc are automatically set up as needed When defining secondary devices you must define all sharable devices such as disks before any non sharable devices For self configuring disks WRMGEN asks for the bitmap size if the disk driver was not created with FIXLOG it also asks for the number of logical units This only defines the device into system memory it does not load the actual device driver programs such as VCR DVR WRMGEN then asks you to enter the names of the programs to be pre loaded into System memory If you have an intelligent controller such as an AM 515 you must enter the microcode file such as AM515 MIC along with the driver program If the microcode file is not in system memory the device will not function This applies to any device with a microcode file such as an AM 350 The drivers for any ta
30. 2 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 VCRSAV You can save space on a cassette by selecting all the sequential files or all the random files you want to save at once VCRSAV begins by asking for information it will place in the cassette label Warm boot file name if you are creating one Volume name maximum of 40 characters Volume ID 10 characters Installation 30 characters System 30 characters and Creator 30 characters You then see a message that all other users will be suspended while VCRSAV is running If you are using T you get a prompt reminding you it could affect your ability to restore files later If you continue VCRSAV then tells you what files it is selecting for transfer and begins the copy process If you do not have a computer controlled Videotrax VCR VCRSAV gives you instructions on operating your VCR You may press CTRLYC at any point to halt the transfers If you do use DSKANA to make sure your bitmap was not affected When CTRLYC is entered VCRSAV writes an end of tape marker to the tape and stops with a message The files already on the tape can be restored though the table of contents lists all files originally selected A similar thing occurs if a disk error or a file block count discrepancy happens during the restore a message appears and files to that point can be restored When VCRSAV is finished you should use the CRT610 command with the CHECK option to check the casse
31. 6B7F4 6B893 6BB8 6C242 6C380 6C537 6C69D 6C742 6C7E8 6D3E1 6E66E 6E6A8 6EF5A 6F15E 6F31A N N FPROOWWNOWROCFONFONWNNDONWNWONEFWWOONKHFWNHNNFOONNDTDONDWWWOWFRWOWONONKFWWONWO TOVTCTCTCTCTFOOOCTOOOOOOoOOoO OOOO OOOO oO UO S e e e UO UOUO UO UO UO UO CUO UO UO UO Ta a aaa aaa a a a ae oo ae e e tr a iit Ac cr Te Te Tr re oT AT oT AT AT OT aT oT a a A A aD A a a A a aD a A oT aT oT A ar oT oT Tr i oT Te i AT Te oT Te ATs i An oT aT oT Ts A AT An An ACC035 ACC036 ACC037 ACC038 ACC039 REX000 REXO01 REX002 REX003 REXO004 REX005 REX006 REX007 REXO008 REXO009 REX010 REX01 REX012 REX013 REX014 REX015 TSS000 AMO000 AMO00 AMO002 AMO003 AMOO04 AMOOOS AMO006 AMO007 AMO008 AMO009 AMO010 AMOO AMOO AMOO AMOO AMOO AMOO AMOO AMOO AMOO019 AMNOOO AMNOO1 AMNOO2 AMNO03 AMNOO4 AMNOO5 AMNOO6 AMNOO7 AMNOO8 AMNOO9 AMNO10 AMNO AMNO AMNO AMNO AMNO AMNO AMNO AMNO AMNO19 AMM000 AMM001 AMM002 AMM003 AMM004 AMM005 AMM006 AMM007 AMM008 AMM009 AMM010 AMM011 AMM012 AMM013 AMM014 AMM015 AMM016 AMM017 AMM018 AIYHDUBWNE AIYHUABWNE FRPP APP PPP PP Peete PPP PPP Pee eee eee eee eee eee eee eee eee eee BDRES AMUS Network Library 1 of 3 AMUS Network Library 2 of 3 AMUS Network Library 3 of 3 Miscellaneous Software Products SuperVUE 31H
32. After you finish using the DSKDDT commands enter E to exit DSKDDT then rewrites the block and returns you to AMOS command level COMMAND SUMMARY nnn nnn is the relative position of the disk location from the front of the block For example 6 displays the contents of bytes six and seven the seventh and eighth bytes in the block nnn is the relative disk location you want to see enter in octal and NNN is the octal data two bytes to replace contents of nnn LINE FEED Display the next two bytes of data in the block You may also use WW Display the previous location Display location zero first two bytes RETURN No operation T Cancel current command line Displays XXX and a TAB Re write the modified block and exit Write the current memory contents to block n when E is entered This allows copying from one block to another Set the entire block to minus ones 177777 octal or FFFF hex The data on the disk will not be changed until E is entered Z Set the entire block to zeros The data on the disk won t be changed until E is entered CTRLYC Exit without updating the block MESSAGES R DSKDDT didn t understand your command Enter a valid command Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of valid devices and try again Cannot READ device name disk is not mounted MOUNT the disk and try again Cannot rewrite disk block insufficient privileges
33. Check your syntax and try again Language not supported assuming M68 If the source file does not have a recognizable extension the file is processed as if the file were an M68 file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 GLOBAL FUNCTION Produces an alphabetic cross reference of all global symbols in one or more object OBJ files Also shows which files define which symbols and which are externally defined symbols CHARACTERISTICS GLOBAL is re entrant and re usable The Alpha Micro macro assembler M68 allows you to segment assembly language programs You can assemble these segments separately and then link them together with LNKLIT the linkage editor Each segment is able to refer to symbols occurring in other segments using INTERN and EXTERN statements M68 also allows you to overlay a portion of a program with a program from the disk the OVRLAY statement does this For each OVRLAY statement an INTERN statement must exist in another segment which identifies the start of the overlay in that segment GLOBAL produces a listing file containing a cross reference of all symbols that have been referenced in an INTERN EXTERN or OVRLAY statement so you can see in which segments those references occur For more information on INTERN EXTERN OVRLAY and M68 see your Assembly Language Programmer s Manual GLOBAL produces the listing file in the account and device you are logged into The list file has
34. Copy over existing files Operation switch Restore only files with different hash totals Operation Overrides the default backup device if one exists You are prompted for the name of the device to use Confirm files to restore File switch Suppress display of files during the restore Operation Restore from VCR without locking users out Operation fr With AFTER and BEFORE you must specify a date and or time in this format switch month day year hour minute AM PM A time without a date defaults to the current date while a date without a time defaults to zero time midnight System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 RESTOR OPERATION Enter RESTOR and the desired switches and file specifications For example to restore from the backup medium all the files with BAS extensions backed up from account 110 2 on DSK2 enter RESTOR DSK2 BAS 110 2 RESTOR responds with a menu of the available backup devices Select the backup device you want RESTOR asks you to confirm the specification of the device you selected If the backup device specification shown is correct just press RETURN otherwise enter the correct specification RESTOR prompts you to ready your backup device in an appropriate way follow the instructions RESTOR displays a list of the file on the backup medium that fit the file specifications you gave you won t see this list if you used SUPPRESS It also displays a dot for each
35. Danish Dutch English Faeroese Finnish French Galician German Icelandic Irish Italian Norwegian Portuguese Spanish and Swedish It cannot support Welsh due to two missing characters Latin Letter W with circumflex and Latin Letter Y with circumflex It is the preferred encoding for the Internet AMOS follows this lead and expects 8 bit aware software to use these ISO standards In passing the ISO 8859 1 standard is a subset of the Unicode 1 x and 2 0 standards which use 16 bit character sets to encode most of the world s alphabets Unicode has aligned itself with a further ISO standard for 32 bit character sets ISO 10646 1 1993 There are several mappings available such as UTF 8 which can map Unicode characters to a variable length 8 bit based encoding Char acter NULL SOH STX ETX EOT ENQ ACK BEL BS HT LF VT FF CR SO SI DLE DC1 DC2 DC3 DC4 NAK SYN ETB CAN EM SUB ESC FS GS RS US SP Also Octal Decimal Hex ISO IEC 10646 1 1993 E Also Known As Type See Called Value Value Value and Unicode 2 0 Name Note 0 0 0 Null Cc 1 1 1 Start of Heading Cc 2 2 2 Start of Text Cc 3 3 3 End of Text Cc 4 4 4 End of Transmission Cc 5 5 5 Enquiry Cc 6 6 6 Acknowledge Cc 7 7 7 Bell Cc 10 8 8 Backspace Cc 11 9 9 Character Tabulation Tab Cc 12 10 A Line Feed Cc 13 11 B Line Tabulation Vertical Cc Tab 14 12 C Form Feed Cc 15 13 D Carriage Return Cc 16 14 E Shift Out Cc 17 15 F Shift In Cc 20 16 10
36. Device does not exist The system does not recognize the device specification you entered Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system and try again Device has exceeded maximum number of bad blocks CRT415 found more bad blocks than the value you specified as the maximum number of bad blocks you will accept You may wish to re run CRT415 and accept a higher number of bad blocks System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CRT415 Page 4 Devn is not at the standard port address Make sure you are using the correct format program Do you wish to continue Y or N The physical device you specified is not attached to the AM 415 controller at the expected T O port Make sure you are using the correct certification program for the device type you wish to certify Also check the cable connecting the disk to the AM 415 controller board and check your system INI file to make sure your DEVTBL statements are correct You can either continue the certification by entering Y or cancel CRT415 by entering N Drive defective CRT415 could not verify track 0 head 0 Because the first track MUST verify for the certification to continue CRT415 stops the certification Get technical help to resolve the problem with the drive Insufficient memory to perform certification The System Operator s job does not have a large enough memory partition to run CRT415 Use the MEMORY command to increase the amount of
37. If no switch is provided a usage prompt is displayed OPTIONS IS Retrieves PCI static page PAGE D IC Retrieves PCI Rx and Tx status page PAGE ID IE Clears accumulated totals and a new accumulation summary starts PAGE IM OPERATION ESLSI returns the following information from the PCI hardware PAGE I Static Page BASE 10 24 is PCI base address amp memory requirements RDA is Rx descriptor starting amp ending address TDA is Tx descriptor starting amp ending address RBA is Rx buffer area TBA is TX buffer area MBADDR is the next available PCI memory address MEMEND is the system end of memory address CBMAR is the starting address for the PCI port 0 card System Commands Reference Manual Rev 14 ESLSI Page 2 PCIPBR BUF is the address of the PCI informational memory module PCI IMPURE is the address of the PCI impure area PCI FLAGS is the general flags PCI P0 FLAGS is the Port 0 flags PCI P1 FLAGS is the Port 1 flags FLAGS is PCI Ethernet flags RDA count is the number of Rx descriptors TDA count is the number of Tx descriptors HTDA is the currently held TDA index ETDA is the end or last TDA FREE RX QUEUE is the next Rx queue index FREE TX QUEUE is the next Tx queue index CTDAPFP is current TDA index PAGE Il Rx amp Tx Status Page No RDA to Process is the number of RDAs to process No TDA to Process is the number of TDAs to process Interrupts Total is the count of all interrupts
38. MESSAGES Account does not exist x x You specified an account that does not exist Check your typing find the correct account or create the account you need Attempt to copy file to self You specified or wildcard processing yielded the same name for the output file as the input file You cannot copy a file onto itself Bypassing BADBLK SYS 1 2 BADBLK SYS exists to prevent bad blocks on a device from being allocated and should never be directly accessed You cannot copy BADBLK SYS 1 2 Cannot find DSKO CMDLIN SYS 1 4 The COPY program needs this file to be able to process wildcard symbols Check to see if CMDLIN SYS exists in DSKO 1 4 if so you did not have enough memory to load it into your partition try to increase your memory by erasing unnecessary files See your System Operator for further help Cannot load filename contiguous files may not be loaded You may only COPY sequential files into your memory partition Device Error You specified a peripheral device in a filespec and the device driver for that device is not loaded into system memory so AMOS can t access it See your System Operator about defining the device to the system and try again when it is ready for access Device full There is not enough room on your disk to do the COPY you requested See what you can do to free up memory space System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 COPY Page 4 Files may not be transferred to R
39. MONTST FUNCTION Tests a new monitor and or system initialization command file by bringing up the system under the control of a new monitor and or command file CHARACTERISTICS MONTST first looks in your memory partition for the monitor you want to test then it looks on the disk MONTST always looks directly on the disk for the system initialization command file you want to test You must be logged into the system operator s account DSKO 1 2 to use MONTST Make sure everyone is off the system when you use MONTST You can also use MONTST with MONGEN to boot up on a device other than your regular System Disk For example say your system has more than one Winchester disk Although you normally boot from your main Winchester disk you could boot from the other To do so use MONGEN to create a test monitor TEST MON containing the driver for the second Winchester disk place this monitor on the first logical device of your Winchester System Device Then use MONTST to boot using that special monitor with a special system initialization command file TEST INI in which the second disk has been defined as the System Device and the main Winchester device has been defined as a peripheral Jq If your computer uses CMOS boot settings and your system disk is not at SCSI ID 0 the S monitor file you use to MONTST must contain a disk driver created with FIXLOG for the correct SCSI ID If the monitor file uses an embedded generic SCSI driver MON
40. SCSI id 3 No device or unable to report 2 1 0 SCSI id 2 No device or unable to report SCSI id 1 No device or unable to report SCSI id 0 SCSI 2 disk MAXTOR MXT 1240S H6F AAA CMDQUE wide synchronous 20 00 MB 16 MESSAGES You must install a SCSI dispatcher prior to using this program This program requires the correct SCSI dispatcher to be installed via the system s initialization file Change the file and reboot the system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 13 SCZCSH FUNCTION Displays a continuously updated bar display showing write buffer usage and effectiveness CHARACTERISTICS SCZCSH is reentrant and reusable It works only on systems which use the SCSI dispatcher FORMAT SCZCSH dev dey is the three letter name of the device you want to see write buffer use for OPERATION Enter SCZCSH and the name of the device you want to see write buffer use for For example SCZCSH DSK The top bar of the screen display generated by SCZCSH shows the approximate percentage of write cells in use This bar should move around constantly while writes are occurring usually hovering around 50 percent The next bar shows the approximate percentage of writes which were placed in a cell but were overwritten by another write before actually being sent to the disk This is the same as disk writes occurring over previous writes however the seek and write overhead of previous writes was avoided Th
41. The CDIR command can be used to list the type size and name of a file that has been compressed FORMAT CMP filespec If no file extension is specified CMP assumes an extension of TXT OPTIONS No switches are currently defined OPERATION Type CMP followed by the specification of the file you want to compress then press RETURN For example CMP TRANS TXT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CMP Page 2 CMP now displays a message indicating compression of the file is in progress Compress ig TRANS TX Te sea tens ene lene dee ene dne Ane iia Na dees Each dot represents a block of the uncompressed file When compression is done a message is output indicating the name of the compressed file and the amount of compression achieved For example TRANS CMP compressed 37 7 When a file such as NAME EXT is processed the compressed file is named NAME CMP unless NAME CMP already exists In this case the file is named NAME CO0 or NAME CO1 etc depending on how many such files already exist If the file processed has already been compressed the resulting compressed file will likely be larger than the original file In this case the compression percentage is negative MESSAGES FILE EXT not found Check your syntax or your directory and try again More than 101 files with this file name Rename and recompress Erase or rename older compressed files and try again System Command
42. The streaming tape drive is full BACKUP then tells you how many of the files you requested were actually backed up Unable to run device handler task The device handler failed to communicate with the main task after it was spawned See your System Operator or Alpha Micro dealer for help Unspecified error received The main task received an error it did not understand from the device handler Try again if the problem persists see your Alpha Micro dealer for help VCR failed to respond to command The problem could be in the VCR remote control the remote control cable or the computer Make sure the cable is properly connected f it is try to determine if it s the VCR or computer so you can get it fixed WAIT switch format error detected The amount of time specified with the WAIT switch must be relative For example WAIT 2 30 would cause the VCR backup to start two and a half hours after you enter the BACKUP command System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BACKUP Page 6 Warm Boot Monitor monitor name not found Make sure you specified the monitor correctly or use DIR to locate the file WARNING Device handler task failed to respond Reboot system Reboot your system There should be no damage to your data System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BADBLK FUNCTION Lets you view the list of defects bad blocks for a disk device For most disks you can add or delete bad blocks from the list
43. and then edit your system initialization command file to correct the problem It is a good idea to run the DSKANA program after this to verify everything is correct with your disk TO DEFINE A SUBSYSTEM DRIVER PROGRAM 1 Log into DVR and enter FIXLOG LOG DSKO 1 6 FIXLOG 2 Type 2 on the FIXLOG menu FIXLOG asks for the name of the generic driver to be used The file extension default is DVR 3 FIXLOG next asks for the number of logical drives per physical device Then it asks for either the subsystem number 0 3 or the SCSI ID number 0 6 for the narrow SCSI bus 0 6 or 8 15 for the Wide SCSI bus If you are not sure what the subsystem number should be see the documentation for your type of system and for your drive unit the subsystem number depends on many hardware factors If you have trouble see your System Operator or Alpha Micro representative for help 4 If you have a SCSI controller and driver which support it FIXXLOG then asks for the number of read ahead blocks 5 If you have an intelligent disk controller you are next asked for the controller board number FIXLOG needs to know which controller the disk for which you are defining a driver is connected to See your Installation Guide to find out a board s number 6 Finally FIXLOG asks you for the new driver name Enter a unique three letter name for your driver program FIXLOG then builds the driver program and tells you the driver is in memory
44. and try again filename is not compatible with this version of FIX420 Your driver program was created under an earlier version of AMOS and will not work with the current version Re create the driver on your system see your Alpha Micro representative for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 FLPDIR FUNCTION Allows you to display a list of the files on a floppy disk Also allows you to create a disk file containing the floppy disk directory CHARACTERISTICS This program is provided for compatibility You normally should use BAKDIR FLPDIR does not work with extended format disks FLPDIR is re entrant and re usable Used in combination with WINFLP to write Winchester disk files to a floppy disk and FLPWIN to copy files from a floppy disk to a Winchester disk The floppy disk you read with FLPDIR must previously have been written by the WINFLP program FLPDIR is a wildcard command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on wildcard file specifications FORMAT FLPDIR switch listfilespec filespec s switch is an option request The optional listfilespec specifies a disk file to contain the floppy disk directory display The filespec s specify the files on the floppy disk you want listed DEFAULTS The default listfilespec is DIRECT LST in the account and device you are logged into The default filespec is and the account and device you are logged into The default floppy driv
45. because they execute and clear immediately For information about using SMEM in your system initialization command file to set up the shared memory pool see the System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File FORMAT SMEM switch switch is an option OPTIONS IS Display a summary report D address or name From OPR only removes specified memory block OPERATION Enter SMEM at AMOS command level For example SMEM You then see an information display about the memory pool The display shows Range Address range in memory of the shared memory block Size Size in bytes Name Name of the block if any FREE means unallocated Owner First job that allocated the block Count Number of jobs currently using the block Flags 2 indicates a named block 4 a permanent block 6 means both System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SMEM Page 2 A summary of total blocks and bytes used follows The total bytes displays are in decimal the others display in octal or hex depending on how your job is set If you use S you see only the summary display if used incorrectly could damage memory be sure you know what you are doing and be n The System Operator may use D to free a memory block from DSKO 1 2 This function sure you are removing the block you want to remove For example LOG OPR SMEM D pooll In the example above pooll is the name of the stuck block you want to remove You
46. file was allocated to a file Block reserved for system use only A link in the file where this message appears points to a block that can t be allocated to a file such as the label block MFD or bitmap area Block used in previous file The last block in the file also exists in a previous file Device error description Errors beginning with Device error tell you DSKANA found a block containing a hard error the system could not recover from The description tells you the specific file or device and block number where the error occurred Device not mounted Informative message indicating the device in question was bypassed by DSKANA System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 7 DSKANA Illegal block link A link in the file points to an invalid block address This file has a bum active count See your System Operator about using DSKDDT to correct the situation This file has a bum block count See your System Operator about using DSKDDT to correct the situation unable to locate BITMAP for rewrite DSKANA couldn t find the bitmap area for the device in memory This means the bitmap in memory may be invalid System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKCPY FUNCTION Creates a backup disk by making a literal image of one disk onto another Optionally generates a hash total for the backup disk CHARACTERISTICS DSKCPY is re entrant and re usable DSKCPY makes a LITERAL image of one disk onto another This m
47. for 3 5 disks or BMIN DVR for 5 25 disks as the system driver in order to create a bootable floppy diskette On AM 219 drives use FIX219 to generate a system driver for diskettes DEFAULTS The default monitor file is DSKO AMOSL MON 1 4 This means you must enter the monitor name AMOS32 MON on AMOS 32 systems The default device and account specification for the disk driver is DSKO 1 6 The default disk driver file extension is DVR OPERATION Enter MONGEN at AMOS command level MONGEN MONGEN asks for the specification of the system monitor you want to modify Enter the file specification of the monitor program you are going to use If you want to use the default monitor AMOSL MON I 4 just press RETURN MONGEN locates the specified monitor and loads it into your memory partition Be sure you have enough memory to accommodate the monitor and disk drivers as well as the MONGEN program itself usually at least 128K of memory System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MONGEN Page 2 Now MONGEN asks for the specification of the disk driver you want to insert into the monitor Enter the file specification of the correct disk driver program You may NOT just press RETURN MONGEN looks first in system memory for the driver then in your memory partition then on the disk If you have just updated a driver to use with MONGEN be sure there isn t an older version in memory ol On systems which use CMOS boot settings if
48. in this case in hexadecimal MESSAGES End of file 2 offset in file 1 The second file is shorter than the first End of file 1 offset in file 2 The first file is shorter than the second Equal expected Try again using an equal sign See the format Extraneous file name You can only compare two files at one time File specification error Check your syntax and try again Files are identical from offsets numbers From this point to the end of the files they are the same filespec not found FILCOM couldn t find one or both of the files you specified Check your syntax or use DIR to find the file s System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 FILCOM filespec file type mismatch At least one of the files you selected is a random file or other illegal type Number expected Try again using a number See the format Starting address addr for file fspec not within file size size You specified a starting point past the end of the file Re enter with a smaller number termination by error count offsets offsets The error count exceeded the number you specified termination for max mismatch length of size exceeded The size of the string mismatch is greater than the size you specified or the default You may want to change the size with S System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 FILDMP FUNCTION Displays the contents of a sequential fil
49. on the screen and put in MTUSAV LOG 4 MTUSAV LIT has defaults for all optional control values If a line in MTUSAV OPT is invalid it is ignored and the default value used If the rest of MTUSAV OPT cannot be read defaults are used for all subsequent options The control of this setting by MTUSAV OPT assumes the control line is processed without error Incident Invalid tape unit details Tape driver not loaded into RES Old version of tape driver used Using old version of TAPSER Cannot ASSIGN DEASGN tape drive Write protected tape Write protected tape Drive not ready or off line Drive not ready or off line Tape read or write errors Notes Mode Abort Where JOBERR C T Yes T L S JE MSC All Yes T L JE MSC All No T L All Yes T L JE MSC All Yes T L JE MSC C T Yes T L JE MSC No S C T Yes T L JE MSC No S All Yes T L S JE MSC Tape Drive Interaction Incidents OPT Text Note UNON 1 If the driver cannot report on the tape spanning ability of the selected drive MTUSAV will prevent multi reel operation even if the drive itself supports it System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 12 2 MTUSAV will wait under control of TIMEOUT until the time out period has expired 3 The incident is displayed on the screen and the user resolves it manually Incident Mode Abort Where JOBERR OPT Text Acc Note Error reading or writing All No TL Error reading TOC TOC file Error writing TOC
50. or add the B switch to an ERSATZ command in the system initialization command file to create blank entries when the system boots Ersatz device specification is not formatted properly The definition of the ersatz name is not valid Retype the line System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 ERSATZ Illegal Switch You have entered an illegal switch not A D O or W ERSATZ ignores the switch and continues No ersatz devices have been defined No ERSATZ statement was executed in the system INI file See your System Operator s Guide for more information You must define ersatz names from a file prior to the first SYSTEM command You entered something after ERSATZ which was not recognized If you want to add an ersatz name use the A switch System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 ESLSI FUNCTION Displays Ethernet statistical information accumulated by the PCI LAN driver LDV for use only with the AM 7000 computer system LDVs are similar to NDVs The most notable difference is that LDVs are hardware S drivers only They do not perform any network protocol specific functions Use this command only on the AM 7000 CHARACTERISTICS ESLSI is re entrant and re usable It displays Ethernet statistical information retrieved from a central depository The LDV updates the central depository continuously You can press CTRL C at any time to exit the program FORMAT ESLSI S C E
51. or see your Alpha Micro representative to get the proper patch version Illegal assembler pseudo op appears in patch file Only certain assembler pseudo op codes are allowed within patch files Make sure your patch file doesn t contain the following conditional assembly pseudo ops ASECT DSECT PSECT SYM NOSYM or INTERN Incompatible object file version The versions of M68 LIT and PTCH LIT on your system are not compatible See your Alpha Micro representative for help Patched file has wrong hash total Inserting the patch into the existing program file did not give the proper results Make sure you are using the proper versions of both the program and patch files and check your patch file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PLAYCD FUNCTION PLAYCD lets you play music or other audio CDs using the CD ROM drive attached to your AMOS computer CHARACTERISTICS PLAYCD is reentrant and reusable While it may work with any SCSI 2 compatible CD ROM drive it has been tested only with the Toshiba Model TXM3401E1 portable CD ROM drive OPERATION Place the CD you want to listen to in the CD ROM drive and from AMOS command level type PLAYCD A menu which allows you to control the CD ROM drive appears on your screen You can make the CDROM drive play stop eject jump to the next track return to a previous track pause or exit by pressing the key indicated in the menu The PLAYCD menu is shown below CURRENT TR
52. there is not an empty SCSI address for the CD ROM player PLAYCD cannot work Free up a SCSI address and try again This CD ROM drive is not SCSI 2 compliant and therefore cannot be used PLAYCD requires a SCSI 2 CD ROM player The player reported that it is not a SCSI 2 device You must install a SCSI dispatcher prior to using this program You must add the appropriate SCSI dispatcher to your system s initialization file and reboot the system before using PLAYCD System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 POP FUNCTION POP works with PUSH to return you to a previously recorded account CHARACTERISTICS POP is re entrant and re usable If you do not include an option POP returns you to the last account you were in You must have SMEM defined in your system initialization command file for this feature to work FORMAT POP option OPTIONS A Clear all recorded accounts S Swap with last logged account OPERATION Enter POP and perhaps an option POP Moves back one account POP S Swaps with previous account POP then returns you to the proper account as defined by the PUSH you used MESSAGES Account number invalid Make sure you gave the correct device and the account number is in the proper form and try again All POPped out There is no account currently PUSHed to go to Already logged in under account You tried to log to where you are currently logged System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PO
53. 1 Error reading disk directory All Yes T L S JE MSC 2 structure Unable to open sequential All No T L Bkup seq file in use Yes 3 11 file file in use Unable to open sequential All No TLS Bkup error seq file 3 file other open Unable to open contiguous All No TL Bkup contig file in use Yes 4 11 file file in use Unable to open contiguous All No TLS Bkup error contig file 3 file other open Contiguous file hijacked by All No T L Bkup contig file Yes 5 11 another job hijacked Unable to read all blocks in All No TLS Bkup seq file read Yes 6 sequential file error Unable to read all blocks in All No TLS Bkup contig file read Yes 7 contiguous file error One or more contiguous file All No TLS Bkup record in use Yes 8 11 blocks are locked with LOKSER Sequential file bum block All No TLS Bkup seq file padded Yes 9 count pad file Sequential file bum block All No TES Bkup seq file Yes 9 count truncate file truncated Tape spanning needed but All Yes T L S D EFUL not supported Tape spanning allowed and T Yes T L S D EFUL needed Tape spanning allowed and 1 C No T 10 needed Unable to update Last All No TL Dir date update failed 1 Backup date Backup Incidents Notes 1 Only files in extended directory format whose details are successfully written to MTUSAV TOC have their date of last backup updated 2 This error stops all further file processing and MTUSAV aborts under contro
54. 3A Colon Po G 73 59 3B Semicolon Po lt 74 60 3C Less Than Sign Sm 75 61 3D Equals Sign Sm gt 76 62 3E Greater Than Sign Sm IT 63 3F Question Mark Po 100 64 40 Commercial At Po 1 A 101 65 41 Latin Capital Letter A Lu B 102 66 42 Latin Capital Letter B Lu C 103 67 43 Latin Capital Letter C Lu D 104 68 44 Latin Capital Letter D Lu E 105 69 45 Latin Capital Letter E Lu F 106 70 46 Latin Capital Letter F Lu G 107 71 47 Latin Capital Letter G Lu H 110 72 48 Latin Capital Letter H Lu I 111 73 49 Latin Capital Letter I Lu J 112 74 4A Latin Capital Letter J Lu K 113 75 4B Latin Capital Letter K Lu L 114 76 4C Latin Capital Letter L Lu M 115 77 4D Latin Capital Letter M Lu N 116 78 4E Latin Capital Letter N Lu O 117 79 4F Latin Capital Letter O Lu P 120 80 50 Latin Capital Letter P Lu Q 121 81 51 Latin Capital Letter Q Lu R 122 82 52 Latin Capital Letter R Lu S 123 83 53 Latin Capital Letter S Lu T 124 84 54 Latin Capital Letter T Lu U 125 85 55 Latin Capital Letter U Lu V 126 86 56 Latin Capital Letter V Lu WwW 127 87 57 Latin Capital Letter W Lu X 130 88 58 Latin Capital Letter X Lu Y 131 89 59 Latin Capital Letter Y Lu Z 132 90 5A Latin Capital Letter Z Lu 133 91 5B Left Square Bracket Opening Square Bracket Ps 1 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 4 Char Also acter Called Value 134 135 a 136 137 140 a 141 b 142 c 143 d 144 e 145 f 146 g 147 h 150 i 151 j 152 k
55. 4 91 Page 3 SYMLIT Fatal error DSIZE must not appear in an overlay Check the instructions for use of the DSIZE pseudo opcode and try again Fatal error Expression stack error An error occurred when SYMLIT evaluated some expressions in your files Contact your Alpha Micro service division Fatal error Expression stack overflow You exceeded the number of nested expressions that SYMLIT can handle Find the overly complex expression in your source file and simplify it Fatal error First file must not be a library To let SYMLIT correctly resolve external references to a library you must specify the program that references that library before you specify the library file itself Fatal error First file must not be an overlay To let SYMLIT correctly resolve external references to an overlay you must specify the program that references that overlay before you specify the overlay file itself Fatal error Insufficient memory There wasn t enough memory for what you specified Increase the memory in your partition if you can See your System Operator for help Fatal error Overlays of code are not permitted Next expected address is address Overlay code address is address Your program is trying to overlay previous code Check your M68 programs to make sure your overlay references are correct Fatal error Overlay symbol symbol in segment segment was not defined in a previous input segment SYMLIT
56. AM IRESCO LIE 350i dss ee aeae e aE Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 44 40 AM Elapsed Time 00 00 42 761 571 Kbytes per second DBDS 19200 150 Mb gt UPDS 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 7085 Total 347685 169 768 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 44 43 AM RESTONS anere et desea eee Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 44 48 AM Elapsed Time 00 00 05 708 500 Kbytes per second DBD6 19200 150 Mb gt UPD 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 57016 Total 404701 197 608 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 44 52 AM RESONS cii ss eccee sieht aa A Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 45 29 AM Elapsed Time 00 00 37 770 486 Kbytes per second DBD7 19200 150 Mb gt UPD7 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 17996 Total 422697 206 395 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 45 33 AM IREStOTING Ail Gite octet seee i oe A Hen eA eee Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 45 45 AM Elapsed Time 00 00 12 749 833 Kbytes per second DBD8 19200 150 Mb gt UPD8 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 40664 Total 463361 226 250 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 45 48 AM Rest ting merses iene in len ina Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 46 15 AM Elapsed Time 00 00
57. BUF not found in system memory The PCI bus was not properly initialized System Commands Reference Manual Rev 14 EXP FUNCTION Expands a file compressed by the CMP command CHARACTERISTICS EXP is an OS Exec program that may be used as an AMOS command Multiple files may be expanded using the Expand function of OS Exec Only files compressed by the CMP program may be expanded using EXP The CTYPE command can be used to display the contents of a compressed sequential file The CDIR command can be used to list the type size and name of a compressed file FORMAT EXP filespec EXP assumes an extension of CMP OPERATION Enter EXP and the specification of the file For example EXP TRANS EXP now displays Expanding TRANS CMP Each dot represents a block of the uncompressed file that has been expanded If the original file already exists on the system a message such as this appears STRANS TXT already exists expanding to TRANS EXP When a file such as NAME CMP is processed the expanded file is given the original name and extension of the file unless it already exists In this case the file is named TRANS EXP or TRANS EO1 etc depending on how many such files already exist MESSAGES Bad input file The file can t be expanded due to a problem in the compressed file s content Recover your backup file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 EXP Page 2
58. Bitmap size Cylinders heads and sectors per track These are calculated values they don t reflect the physical structure of the drive System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 Page 5 FMTS2 List Defects Displays one or both defect lists maintained by the drive You can display the primary defect list grown defect list or both The drive displays the list in one of these three formats e Cyl Hd Sector defect location specified by cylinder head and sector e Cyl Hd Offset defect location specified by cylinder head and the number of bytes from the beginning of the track e Block defect location specified by 32 bit decimal block number You may scroll the list output by using T and WJ To return to the above defect list options press ESC Because of the different implementations this information cannot be compared to AMOS block numbers Initialize Drive Same as the format option described above except that it doesn t format the drive before writing the logical drive information fr If the drive s formatting is OK use this option instead of format This will save you time Mode Sense Retrieves mode sense information from the drive You can view these values e Current Values control the current operation of the drive e Changeable Values indicate which bytes bits are changeable e Saved Values control the current operation of the drive unless they are changed by a Mode Selected command
59. CONTROL Files to search BP F As shown you can use wildcards in the files to search Each line containing the search string is displayed on the screen If there are more than 24 occurrences AGREP displays one screen at a time unless you use N If the display pages press any character to continue to the next page You may use CTRLI C at any time to stop the search You may specify a file that contains the files to be searched by using an at sign For example AGREP String to search for INVENTORY CONTROL Files to search FILES TXT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 06 AGREP Page 2 In this case AGREP would search for the string in the files listed in the file FILES TXT If just an is entered AGREP looks for a file called SEARCH DIR to use as a list of files MESSAGES Besides standard AMOS file messages you may see File open error error code code See the code explanation in the Monitor Calls Manual Invalid switch You entered an invalid command line switch Use one of the valid options only Output specification not allowed You cannot enter an output file specification in the line defining the files to be searched Use the D or L option instead System Commands Reference Manual Rev 06 FUNCTION AMSCFG Analyzes and reports on the configuration of a running system CHARACTERISTICS AMSCFG is re entrant and re usable It scans system memory locations and system tables set up by AMOS at bo
60. CTRLY C or some other event interrupted the certification CRT420 intentionally writes a bad hash total to the BADBLK SYS file so other programs know the data in the file is incomplete and not to be trusted Re run CRT420 to provide a good BADBLK SYS file Control C abort The program was interrupted before certification The data on your disk is still complete Cylinder zero did not verify Cylinder 0 must contain no errors Get technical help to determine what is wrong with the drive Device has exceeded maximum number of errors CRT420 found more bad tracks than the value you specified as the maximum number of bad tracks you will accept You may want to re run CRT420 and allow more bad tracks Error during initialization An error on the AM 1000 Winchester Controller has been detected This may indicate a hardware problem See your Alpha Micro representative for help Error during recalibrate An error on the AM 1000 Winchester Controller has been detected This may indicate a hardware problem See your Alpha Micro representative for help Format drive error An error on the AM 1000 Winchester Controller has been detected This may indicate a hardware problem See your Alpha Micro representative for help n bad tracks is maximum Try again with a number less than or equal to n Nonexistent device Your device specification was invalid Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices for your system and try again
61. Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 RESTOR Page 6 File sequence error detected The file sequence number of the next file was not the expected number This could indicate a tape problem It can also occur if you fast forward during a restore and the tape has gone past the end of the data if so just try again File size mismatch on split file detected The second media of a split media backup didn t match the first Make sure you have the correct media If so see your System Operator for help Filename or PPN name not found while updating directory The Filename or PPN specified was not found while updating the directory of a disk formatted with extended directories See your Alpha Micro dealer for help Label date and time mismatch on BACKUP media detected The second media of a split media backup did not match the first Make sure you have the correct media If so see your System Operator or your Alpha Micro dealer for help No record ID detected The files on the tape were recorded with an early BACKUP version and your RESTOR program is a later version See your Alpha Micro dealer for help No supported backup devices found Your system does is not set up for any of the 3 supported backup devices so you can t specify a default device Output specification not found Even if the default specifications are what you want you MUST enter an equal sign to let RESTOR know which is the output specification Progr
62. DA Latin Capital Letter U With Lu Acute U 333 219 DB Latin Capital Letter U With Lu Circumflex 334 220 DC Latin Capital Letter U With Lu Diaeresis 335 221 DD Latin Capital Letter Y With Lu Acute P 336 222 DE Latin Capital Letter Thorn Lu B 337 223 DF Latin Small Letter Sharp S LI 340 224 EO Latin Small Letter A With Ll Grave 341 225 El Latin Small Letter A With Ll Acute a 342 226 E2 Latin Small Letter A With Ll Circumflex a 343 227 E3 Latin Small Letter A With LI Tilde System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Character Sets Page 7 Char Also Octal Decimal Hex ISO IEC 10646 1 1993 E Also Known As Type See acter Called Value Value Value and Unicode 2 0 Name Note a 344 228 E4 Latin Small Letter A With LI Diaeresis 345 229 E5 Latin Small Letter A With LI Ring Above 346 230 E6 Latin Small Ligature AE LI 2 347 231 E7 Latin Small Letter C With Ll Cedilla 350 232 E8 Latin Small Letter E With LI Grave 351 233 E9 Latin Small Letter E With LI Acute 352 234 EA Latin Small Letter E With Ll Circumflex 353 235 EB Latin Small Letter E With LI Diaeresis i 354 236 EC Latin Small Letter I With Ll Grave 355 237 ED Latin Small Letter I With Ll Acute 356 238 EE Latin Small Letter I With LI Circumflex 357 239 EF Latin Small Letter I With LI Diaeresis 6 360 240 FO Latin Small Letter Eth LI 361 241 F1 Latin Small Letter N With LI Tilde 362 242 F2 Latin Small Letter O With
63. DEVO thru DEV20 or may be comma separated The list is Enter the logical drives to be copied and then just a return when all desired drives have been entered REXO 15 L B L O C Ka S BITMAP ITE T Total Used Fr words 1 REX00 E 307200 20928 286272 19200 2 REXOL 307200 216928 90272 19200 3 REXO2 307200 2617 304583 19200 4 REX03 E 307200 36155 271045 19200 5 REX04 E 307200 63972 243228 19200 6 REXO5 E 307200 7085 300115 19200 7 REXO6 307200 57016 250184 19200 8 REXO7 307200 17996 289204 19200 9 REXO8 307200 40664 266536 19200 10 REX09 E 307200 8072 299128 19200 11 REX10 E 307200 32551 274649 19200 12 REX11 E 307200 3804 303396 19200 13 REX12 E 307200 84153 223047 19200 14 REX13 E 307200 19063 288137 19200 15 REX14 E 307200 52946 254254 19200 16 REX15 E 307200 241467 65733 19200 TOTAL 4915200 905417 4009783 megabytes 2400 000 442 098 1957 901 gigabytes 2 3438 0 4317 1 9120 MAKBBD then displays information about how much space is required on the media and where recording will start System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 MAKBD Calculating space requirements AMOS partition requires 226354 sectors Media sectors available 2236605 unused sectors remain MAKBBD then gives you the opportunity to abort or to
64. Disk but can identify a streaming tape drive e g STRO or a special device such as system memory RES Several commands also recognize a different type of device called an ersatz device Ersatz devices identify specific accounts on the System Disk For example the ersatz device BAS identifies the System AlphaBASIC Language Library account DSKO 7 6 You may also define your own Ersatz names For more information on ersatz devices see your System Operator s Guide A one to six character file name AMOS usually considers upper and lower case letters in a filename to be the same but some programs require that you enter filenames as all upper case If you enter more than six characters AMOS may not depending on the command you are using process any extension or PPN that follows the name Zero to three characters that follow the filename and give information to the command about the contents of the file The filename and extension are separated by a dot Identifies the account in which the file resides When it is part of a file specification always enclose the account number within square brackets An example of a typical file specification DSK2 PROJCT TXT 100 2 the device specification DSK2 tells AMOS the file is on logical unit DSK2 of the physical device DSK the filename PROJCT identifies the file the extension TXT further identifies the file and tells AMOS it contains text data and the account number 100 2
65. E 20480 19205 1275 280 2306 1 blk ACC028 E 20480 4280 6200 280 35C8 1 blk ACC029 E 20480 17606 2874 280 39E7 0 blk ACC030 E 20480 18673 1807 280 4B29 1 blk ACC031 E 20480 12208 8272 280 5D66 1 blk ACC032 E 20480 570 9910 280 6953 0 blk ACC033 E 20480 1773 8707 280 69E2 1b ACC034 E DBD055 pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical Logical pen Mogreal tives TST seed as ck cate ds Ea pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen Logical pen MoGrea Ls cP STA Oe aiea dea lee dy EAA ve pen Logical NEWO0 5200 General Information 2 cece cece aA AMOS 14E PROGC 2000 Is crire tekae EEA AMOS 23A PROB 2002 A a eta a a aN Eagle 100TX Terminal Server Flash Rel Eagle 100MX Fax Server Flash Release Eagle 100MX Fax Server Disk Release Eagle 450 TX Terminal Server Flash Rel Al phaPAxe 2 0 PRIO IO awed a kaa ale Ss foe pho ICP 13 50 PROS 2002 gue stp gue a aa Sees AlphaWRITE 1 2A PRO8 2000 phaWRITE 2 2 PROG 2000 04 AIphaCALG 230 PR4A 99 ssc aise wits suaeier ee a6 ESP 22 222 RREOLD I gutar r Goi alone oo tiene es BER AlphaNET 23 4 PRIO 99 boos tse bees poutan OS PERE CWO 5 scales Wiotcit ed telisied etal eat ve LA Yo We VersiCOMM Plus 3 1 PRO8 2002 Appoint
66. E AlphaODBC 1 0 100 Rel amp Src DBD009 307200 8072 299128 9200 10487 0 blk REX009 E AlphaMAIL 1 2B PRO9 05 200 DBDO10 307200 32551 274649 9200 1cc69 3 blk REX010 E Xadmin Release amp INIS 4 DBDO11 307200 3804 303396 9200 1EC34 1 blk REXO011 E Command amp Do Files 020020006 DBDO12 307200 84153 223047 9200 1EFEC 0 blk REX012 E Open Logical REX12 2 02004 DBDO13 307200 19063 288137 9200 2421B QO blk REX013 E AMPO 7 0 Release 2 2 ccc cece ees e teens DBDO14 307200 52946 254254 9200 254B9 2 blk REX014 E AlphaODBC 1 0 100 Rel amp Src ver 1 4Y DBDO15 307200 241467 65733 9200 2886E 3 blk REX015 E Open Logical REX15 0 0 e eens Sr Sm eee E B Sl 0 C SK 6 Sess S S gt BITMAP SECTOR ORESET S DEV Ly SsSosraoss Sarco SSS Sea o Stee SSeS SS eaaS SITEMS gt S3 gt Total Used Free words SOL SOL neS REGE DL SSSasSSorsesss D A B BSL Aas ssrHnsS snes TOTAL 4915200 905417 4009783 Media Label NIGHTLY BACKUP megabytes 2400 000 442 098 1957 901 gigabytes 2 3438 0 4317 1 9120 DBD media contains 16 logical units System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 3 BDRES BDRES then asks for the DBD logical s that you wish to copy from the backup media Which DBD Logical s would you like to restore Each DBD Logical entered may have one MASK following it A space must separate the DBD Logical
67. FMTDVD calculates both bitmap size and number of logical devices e For extended directories using the entire drive set Directory Type to Extended and Optimize to Yes Enter the number of logical devices you want FMTDVD calculates the best bitmap size System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 Page 3 FMTDVD For any other drive configuration you can set Optimize to No and enter the Directory Type Bitmap Size and Number of Logicals you want To figure the best traditional bitmap size for a given number of logical devices set Directory type to Extended and Optimize to Yes Enter the number of logical devices you want FMTDVD calculates the bitmap size Then first turn off optimization and then change Directory Type to Traditional After choosing a configuration press to continue Then to begin formatting the drive select Vendor Default Format If you decide you don t want to format the drive select Cancel and press RETURN Otherwise the drive begins formatting when you make your selection Drive Info Displays the following information about the currently selected drive List Defects Usable capacity Block size Format status Formatted capacity amount of space being used for logical drives Number of logicals Size of each logical drive Bitmap size Cylinders heads and sectors per track These are calculated values they don t reflect the physical structure of the drive The AM 403 does n
68. FUNCTION Formats SCSI Small Computer Systems Interface disk drives displays the drive status lists drive s defects reassigns defective blocks initializes a drive or rewrites the hidden sector CHARACTERISTICS FMTS2 is re entrant and re usable To run FMTS2 you must be logged into the System Operator s Account To run FMTS2 your computer must use an MC68020 or later processor To use it with a SCSI interface you must have a SCSI dispatcher installed Since FMTS2 lets you change the logical drive configuration you can use any drive of equal or greater capacity as a replacement for a failed drive FMTS2 also lets you create maximum size 32 MB traditional logical drives The maximum size of a logical device is 4 2GB which has a bitmap size of 524 288 words FMTS2 will not let you create a logical device larger than this CMD or DO files can control the format process through the command line interface FMTS2 sets JOBERR if it detects an error in the command line or a failed drive operation FMTS2 supports narrow and wide SCSI interfaces It supports both SCSI and SASI interfaces when both are present and lets you specify the one you prefer FORMAT FMTS2 ID number switch es number is the SCSI ID of the drive you are interested in and switch es is one or more option requests devices on the specified physical disk Be sure you have a complete backup of the o If you use the format or initialize option FMT
69. File is not an OS Exec compressed file You can t expand this file filename not found The file could not be located as specified Insufficient space to allocate this file There isn t enough space on the disk Erase unneeded files or see your System Operator for help More than 101 files with this file name Rename and reexpand Too many expanded copies exist Rename the file and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 FILCOM FUNCTION Lets you compare the memory contents of two sequential files Displays the data differences between the two files CHARACTERISTICS FILCOM is re entrant and re usable All numeric displays are in the number base set for your job see the SET reference sheet You may press to stop and re start the display or press CTRLYS and CTRLVQ Press CTRLIC to halt FILCOM FILCOM reads through the specified files comparing them byte by byte reporting mismatches as encountered and or indicating file matches mismatches A mismatch or error is reported as a pair of lines which display a mismatch count the contents of the files at the point of the mismatch in hex octal the length s of the mismatching sequences and the byte offsets of the sequences within the files If a mismatch is longer than the output device width the output is truncated FILCOM doesn t compare multi part files like ISAM and USAM files Files with the same data content but different in directory sto
70. If there is no media in the drive the program displays 7There is no media installed in the DVD RAM drive and exits If you want to remove the DVD media or switch to another DVD media use the U switch DVD U REQUIREMENTS AND SETUP DVD requires the following A 68030 or faster processor A full interrupt enabled SCSI dispatcher AMOS 2 3A or later A supported DVD RAM drive Enough SMEM to hold DEVTBL and BITMAP entries The DVD package contains the following required files e DVD LIT e The device driver for the DVD RAM drive in system memory e The SSD overlay file DVD000 OVR e FMTDVD LIT MESSAGES DVD RAM device already exists The DVD is already installed on the AMOS system Either DVD has already been run to define the DVD device for random I O or MAKDVD is currently using the DVD recorder System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 Page 3 DVD DVD RAM drive found at SCSI id lt gt DVD is confirming the SCSI ID of the DVD drive it is about to use Error Device specified is not a DVD RAM Recorder Error DVDram driver must be in system memory The DVD driver must be loaded into system memory during the AMOS boot process Impossible error can t find DVDn entries in DEVTBL DVD detected a system problem when unmounting the DVD Reboot the system Media is not AMOS format insert an AlphaDVD and try again DVD cannot read AMOS device information from the DVD media Remove the media from the drive and make
71. In either case the file is corrupt File size on tape does not match disk file During verification the size of the file on tape does not match the file on disk Verification continues from the start of the next tape file File verification phase aborted not all files have been verified You aborted verification by pressing C Not all the files on the tape have been checked against the same files on disk Insufficient memory to run MTUSAV See your System Operator for help in increasing your memory partition Multi reel backup tape spanning is available if needed This informational message confirms that the hardware and software combination in use supports multi reel backup if needed Multi reel backup tape spanning is not supported by this tape device The selected tape device does not support multi reel backups If the backup overflows the tape it will be aborted without any verification phase and not all files will be backed up Not all files have been updated with correct backup date Either you aborted the backup date update phase with a C there was an error in reading the MTUSAV TOC file or the TOC file was prematurely closed by an earlier error Only those files on a disk with an extended directory structure whose details were successfully recorded and read back from the TOC file will have their last backup date updated Please mount first reel in save set and press RETURN to continue or control C t
72. LST instead of to a terminal display The main purpose of the F switch is to allow you to force the CRT610 F command to a job attached to a pseudo terminal allowing you to check a cassette without tying up a real terminal To force the CRT610 F command to another job make sure 1 there is an unused job 2 that job is attached to a pseudo terminal 3 the job is logged into a disk account and 4 the job has memory allocate at least 10K For example ATTACH PSEUDO EXTRA FORCE EXTRA MEMORY 10K FORCE EXTRA LOG DSK2 100 1 FORCE EXTRA CRT610 F After the job is forced CRT610 begins If you have a manual VCR do not start the VCR before the job is forced You may run CRT610 F without forcing it to another job if you don t mind having your terminal tied up during the certification System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 CRT610 Page 4 TO CALIBRATE A REMOTE CONTROL VCR Load a cassette in your VCR and rewind it Make sure the tape does not contain data you need Log into an operator s account and enter the command For example LOG 1 2 CRT610 V CA CRT610 verifies the tape see above The CA option sets the cassette size to a minimum of two hours if your VCR is set for SP mode you must use a two hour or longer VCR tape The number of copies defaults to five If your VCR is set for EP mode use a six hour tape The calibration process takes approximately one hour A remote VCR table file DSK0 REMVCR TBL 1 4 is crea
73. Latin Small Letter W Latin Small Letter X Latin Small Letter Y Latin Small Letter Z Left Curly Bracket Vertical Line Right Curly Bracket Tilde System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Also Known As Backslash Closing Square Bracket Spacing Circumflex Caret Spacing Underscore Underscore Spacing Grave Opening Curly Bracket Vertical Bar Closing Curly Bracket Delete Padding Character High Octet Preset Break Permitted Here No Break Here Index Next Line Start of Selected Area End of Selected Area Character Tabulation Set Character Tabulation with Justification Line Tabulation Set Partial Line Forward Partial Line Backward Reverse Line Feed Single Shift Two Single Shift Three Device Control String Private Use One Private Use Two Set Transmit State Appendix A Type Po Pe Lm So Lm Ll Ll Ll Ll Ll LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI LI Ll Ll LI Ps So Pe So Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Cc Note 1 1 1 1 See ee Character Sets Page 5 Char Also Octal Decimal Hex ISO IEC 10646 1 1993 E Also Known As Type See acter Called Value Value Value and Unicode 2 0 Name Note CCH 224 148 94 Cancel Character Cc MW 225 149 95 Message Waiting Cc SPA 226 150 96 Start of Guarded Area Cc EPA 227 151 97 End of Guarded Area Cc SOS 230 152 98 Start of String Cc SGCI 231 153 99 Single Graphic Character Cc Introd
74. Logicals to be transferred Disk Logicals may be entered as a range ex devO 20 for devO thru dev20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line TSTO 8 all Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 08 47 14 A DVDO 56320 440 Mb gt TSTO 56320 440 Mb no Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 08 47 14 AM RESTOLING o aaa Mee ane a Sed Bathe EE E TENS o aa a aie a tod see a e 30 Logical has been restored amp remounted SSS Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 09 00 38 AM Elapse Time 00 13 24 DVD1 56320 440 Mb gt TST1 56320 440 Mb SHA Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 09 00 38 A RESTOPING mesada aa N Ser Eray tas Nel tee a ol Bee ele Bra See te area aie eles Boa Logical has been restored amp remounted ae Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 09 14 07 AM Elapse Time 00 13 29 DVD2 56320 440 Mb gt TST2 56320 440 Mb ae Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 09 14 07 A RESCOLING eai Sane AE PEE E r a E Ea A Bids cierto N ANE Logical has been restored amp remounted Soz Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 09 27 36 AM Elapse Time 00 13 29 DVD3 56320 440 Mb gt TST3 56320 440 Mb sos Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 09 27 36 AM RES EO RANG 5 spees E EE R EE I EE A a RE e E Waveney EE E i Logical has been restored amp remounted aan Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 09 41 00 AM Elapse Time 00 13 24 DVD4 56320 440 Mb gt TST4 56320
75. MEMORY command may not be used within a spawned job You cannot use MEMORY within a job created spawned by another program for example within a window created by MULTI You will have to get your terminal out of the spawned job situation before you can use MEMORY System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MENU FUNCTION Works on AlphaMENU menu definition files to produce executable menus CHARACTERISTICS MENU is re entrant and re usable You must have at least 32K of memory in your memory partition to use MENU Compiles only the MNU file does not compile or include query or help files These are searched for separately when needed by the CMN file Don t use MENU on already compiled files Compiled menus have a CMN extension See your AlphaMENU User s Manual for more information FORMAT MENU filespec filespec is the file containing the menu definition code The default file extension is MNU The default device and account specifications are where you are logged OPERATION Enter MENU and the file containing the menu definition for the menu you wish to compile For example MENU MYMENU When MENU finishes compiling the Menu file a message tells you if any errors were detected and whether the menu file was completed If your file compiled without errors a menu file is created in the account you are logged into with the filename of your menu and the extension CMN To call the menu use the SHELL command For e
76. MONTST AMOSL MON NEWSYS INI If you want to test with the standard AMOS monitor and the standard system initialization command file enter MONTST AMOSL 1 4 MESSAGES Cannot test filespec file not found Either the monitor or the initialization file cannot be found Check your syntax and try again File specification error Check your syntax and try again Filespec not found Check your syntax or use DIR to find the file it may be in another account This message can also appear if you don t have enough memory in your partition to load the monitor file if so ran MONTST from another job or increase the memory in your partition System Commands Reference Manual Rev 06 MOUNT FUNCTION Mounts or unmounts a disk and displays a list of all mounted disks on the system Can mount all logical devices on a physical drive with one command CHARACTERISTICS MOUNT is re entrant and re usable The system has no way of knowing when you change disks in your disk drives When you change disk cartridges in your hard disk system or change floppy disks in your floppy disk drives you must tell the system you have done so Floppy disk drives defined to use buffered I O see your System Operator s Guide must be mounted immediately after a new diskette is inserted and unmounted before it is removed Failure to do so may result in lost or corrupted data Your system INI file can be set up to initially mount your disks for you eve
77. Manual Rev 07 Page 5 VCRRES End of tape detected The tape you are restoring was interrupted for some reason and VCRRES has come to the end of tape marker All the restorable files from this tape have been restored File too fragmented for recording current filespace The software is unable to keep a record of all the disk space used by the file currently being created because the file contains more than 511 fragments See your System Operator about compressing disk space before trying again Files may not be transferred to RES You may only add programs to system memory by using the SYSTEM command within your system initialization command file Fragments Table out of sequence An error occurred during the search of the Fragments Table Rerun VCRRES If it still does not work see your System Operator FRGTBL blocks not found The end of the fragments table was reached before all of the files have been processed Rerun VCRRES If you see this again see your System Operator Job aborted You pressed CTRLYC to stop the restore No files are restored and no damage is done to any bitmaps Memory buffer unavailable No memory was available for the I O buffers during a critical process so VCRRES aborted See if you can increase the memory allocated to your memory partition and try again Missing output specification You left off the equal sign in the VCRRES command line VCRRES couldn t tell which information was yo
78. NOAPPEND NOBOOT NOHASH NOQUERY NOSUPPRESS and NOTRANSFER AFTER date amp time APPEND BEFORE date amp time BOOT COPIES n HASH QUERY MODIFIED OVERRIDE SUPPRESS TRANSFER VOID WAIT HH MM Back up only files modified after specified date and time Operation switch Add files to end of backup medium floppy disks only Operation switch Back up only files modified before specified date and time Operation switch Generate warm boot tape not for floppy disks Operation switch n 5 extra copies of each data block Default for n is 0 5 extra copies VCR only operation switch Calculate a hash total Operation switch Confirm files before backup File switch Back up only files modified since last backup Operation switch Used to override the default backup device if one exists You are prompted for the name of the device Operation switch Suppress files selected display File switch Back up without locking out other users using at least 20 extra copies VCR only To use more than 20 extra copies use COPIES n switch also and set n to more than 15 Operation switch Use when transferring files between systems connected by video cables Operation switch Wait specified time before backup begins VCR only Operation If you inadvertently enter both QUERY and SUPPRESS QUERY takes precedence and the SUPPRESS switch is ignored In the AFTER and BEFORE s
79. NOVEL TXT You may optionally include an adjustment factor which is applied to the word count prior to displaying the count This can be used to account for fixed format output which may contain extra formatting words you do not wish to count For example WRDCNT MALLST TXT 5 MESSAGES Cannot OPEN filename file not found Check your syntax or use DIR to see what files exist and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 WRMGEN FUNCTION Creates a warm boot monitor file on the disk for transfer to a backup media CHARACTERISTICS A warm boot monitor is an abbreviated pre initialized version of your normal monitor file containing enough information to get your system up and running when your System Disk has been erased or written over accidentally After you have performed a warm boot you can restore the other necessary files to your system from backup media and perform a normal boot to restore your entire system to its former configuration For suggestions on what programs to include in your warm boot monitor and for examples of use see your System Operator s Guide FORMAT WRMGEN filename filename is an optional name for your warm boot monitor file The filename will default to the name of your system type with a WRM extension for example AMOSL WRM and the device and account you are logged into OPERATION You may want to use the DEVTBL command to see and make note of what d
80. Number of sequential file size problems on backup before triggering an error Max verif error count 5 Number of files that fail verification before triggering an error Max seq file in use count 5 Number of sequential files in use during backup and verification combined encountered before triggering an error Max contig file in use count 5 Number of contiguous files in use during backup and verification combined encountered before triggering an error Max rec in use count 10 Maximum number of record in use incidents before triggering an error One file may give rise to more than one record in use error Max tape dir block not found 0 Maximum number of tape directory entry problems count encountered before triggering an error Max warnings before error 5 Maximum number of warnings generated before triggering an error MTUSAV OPT User defined Severity Settings System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 19 Notes MTUSAV Occurs when summarizing the incidents during the backup phase While the totals and JOBERR setting will be correct the details will not be complete Only those files which were listed completely will have their date of last backup updated AMOS 2 x only Occurs when writing a completion record about the backup of a particular file Further completion records will not be recorded although subsequent files will be processed and backed up as appropriate An Error reading TOC will probably oc
81. RAM or Blu ray Recorder device or driver messages e Device specified is not a DVD RAM or Blu ray Recorder e Unable to find a DVD or Blu ray Recorder Error messages when setting up or writing to the DVD Recorder e Error Buffer not initialized e Error Device is already in use This indicates that either another user is running the MAKBD program or the DBD is being used in shared read write mode Error Disk in DVD Recorder is not writeable Error DVD RAM driver must be in system memory Error Total data requirements exceed DVD capacity Error Unable to load DVD media This indicates a hardware problem with the DVD RAM drive or a problem with the DVD media System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 MAKBD Page 6 Error Unable to open DVD recording session Try a different DVD media This can also indicate a possible DVD RAM drive problem Error Unable to open for recording Try a different DVD media This can also indicate a possible DVD RAM drive problem Error Unable to read disk information from media Try a different DVD media This can also indicate a possible DVD RAM drive problem Error Unable to write to the DVD A device error has occurred while attempting to record data on the DVD Fatal SCSI error Sense key nn additional sense nn DVD drive device error has occurred Sense key and additional sense provide further error information Please insert a DVD RAM media SCSI error xxxxxxxxx sense error m
82. Reference Manual Rev 07 REDIR Page 2 DEFAULTS Default extensions are INP for input files LST for output files OPTIONS You can use any of the switches available to the AMOS command you use REDIR has no switches of its own OPERATION Enter REDIR the name of the program you want run the direction symbol and the file specification where you want the I O redirection to go to come from For example REDIR SYSTAT N gt OUT LST This places the output of SYSTAT into the file OUT LST For more examples of redirection see Chapter 5 MESSAGES Insufficient memory to run job by n bytes Reduce EDITOR line count See your System Operator for help adjusting the line editor in the system initialization command file Invalid command line argument Check your syntax and try again Job table is full allocate more jobs via the JOBS command You need extra jobs on your system for redirection No alternate languages have been defined There are no other languages available on your system at this time For information on languages see your System Operator s Guide Unable to locate PPEUDO IDV within AMOS See your system operator about locating the file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 REDIR Unable to locate REDIR2 LIT in system memory of SYS See your system operator about locating the file Unable to locate selected terminal driver within AMOS See your system operator about locating the file
83. Reference Manual Rev 18 Chapter 2 Introduction to AMOS Commands Each reference sheet in this manual gives you detailed information on the use of a specific command Before getting into the use of particular commands however it is a good idea to discuss exactly what we mean by the term command A command is simply a specification that selects a disk file AMOS looks for the file and if it finds it it loads it into memory if it is not already in memory and executes it The file selected by a command must be either a machine language program usually identified by a LIT file extension or a command file identified by a CMD or DO extension Because the programs specified by commands are not actually part of the operating system but are simply files on the disk you can add to the commands AMOS recognizes by creating your own machine language programs and command files When you enter a command at AMOS command level AMOS performs a thorough search procedure as it looks for the program or command file specified by the command It looks in various accounts on the System Disk and on the device you are logged into For example if you enter RECALL AMOS follows this search path when looking for a command 1 Look for RECALL LIT in system memory RES 2 Look for RECALL LIT in user s memory partition MEM 3 Look for RECALL LIT in DSKO 1 4 4 Look for RECALL CMD in system memory RES 5 Look for RECALL CMD in user s memory
84. Rev 04 STRDIR FUNCTION Displays a list of the files on a 1 4 Streaming Tape Drive cartridge Can also create a disk file containing the list The STRxxx commands are included only for compatibility with earlier operating system versions Do NOT use these commands unless absolutely necessary Use the MTUxxx commands for all tape backup and CRT620 to create warm boot tapes CHARACTERISTICS Used with STRSAV to write disk files to tape and STRRES to copy files from tape to disk STRDIR can read only cartridges written by STRSAV If your system contains both traditional format and extended disks you must be logged onto the same type of disk when you use STRDIR that you were when you created the backup using STRSAV While STRSAV does work with extended disks in some situations we strongly suggest you use BACKUP to back up extended disks Accepts full wildcard specifications which select the files to be listed in the directory The account and device portions of the specification refer to the disk account and device from which the files were originally backed up See your AMOS User s Guide for information on wildcard file specifications FORMAT STRDIR switch listfilespec filespec filespec s switch is an option request and listfilespec specifies a disk file to contain the directory display The filespec s specify the files on the tape you want to see DEFAULTS The default listfilespec is DIRECT LST in the a
85. VCRRES can only be run under control of the Task Manager or a spawned task if the T switch is specified Such operation is not recommended by Alpha Microsystems u VCRRES locks out the other users on your system unless you specify the T option Check VCRRES is a wildcard command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on using wildcard commands If the cassette you are restoring files from contains a warm boot monitor as well as data files VCRRES skips over the warm boot monitor ignoring it and goes on with the normal file restore process It is a good idea to run DSKANA after you have finished running VCRRES to be sure no errors were introduced into the bitmap especially if you press CTRLYC to interrupt the restore process since the bitmap may be disorganized System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VCRRES Page 2 VCRRES creates a temporary directory file named VCRTOC IPF in the current disk account This file is erased and re created each time VCRRES is used in the account VCRRES also creates a temporary file named FRGTBL IPF Don t use either VCRTOC IPF or FRGTBL IPF as filenames FORMAT VCRRES switch outfilespec filespec filespec s switch switch is an option outfilespec specifies the files to be created on the disk and filespec is a file to be transferred from the cassette including the disk device and account specifications of the files when they were backed up DEFAULTS The file specifi
86. Your job doesn t have the write to physical disk blocks privilege System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 DSKDDT Privileged program must be logged into 1 2 Log into 1 2 and try again Program restricted to use on local system only You cannot use DSKDDT across a network Log into the remote system as a user then use DSKDDT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKDMP FUNCTION Displays contents of physical disk blocks on your terminal in numeric form CHARACTERISTICS DSKDMP is re entrant and re usable The system internally represents all data in numeric form The DSKDMP display shows you the data in the number base the system is currently using for your numeric displays Enter block numbers in that same base See the SET reference sheet for information on changing the display base You must be logged into an operator s account 1 2 to use DSKDMP You may freeze and resume the display by pressing NOSCRU or by pressing CTRLYS and CTRLY Q To interrupt the display press CTRLYC FORMAT DSKDMP devn block devn is the logical device and block is the number of the physical disk block you want to see DEFAULTS The default device is where you are logged The default block is block zero OPERATION Enter DSKDMP and a device specification and a disk block number For example DSKDMP DSK1 202 DSKDMP asks for the size of the block you wish to dump Enter the number of bytes you want d
87. a contiguous file signals a different error it is not transferred to tape The file list will be incomplete if there was an earlier error in the MTUSAV TOC file nn errors while reading a file nn etrors were encountered reading files The files with errors are listed after this message All files listed are corrupt and should not be restored So the backup can continue MTUSAV truncates or extends the listed sequential files on the tape to match the number of blocks in the disk directory entry for the file For contiguous random files MTUSAV could not read a particular block for reasons other than record locks It writes a dummy block to act as a placeholder for the block where the error occurred The file list will be incomplete if there was an earlier error in the MTUSAV TOC file Field size exceeded please re enter Re enter the information using less characters System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 24 File size in directory and on disk do not match bum block count The number of blocks as defined by the directory entry for a sequential file does not match the number of blocks read from the disk If the number of blocks read is less than the number of blocks in the directory entry the file is padded with dummy data to the size defined in the directory entry If the number of blocks read is more than the number of blocks in the directory entry the file is truncated to the size specified in the directory entry
88. a file named BADBLK SYS in account 1 2 of the disk you are certifying This file will hold a list of all bad disk blocks CRT415 finds CRT415 asks you several questions Enter maximum acceptable number of bad blocks Enter the largest number of bad blocks you are willing to accept on your disk CRT415 has a certain upper limit for errors depending on the data capacity of the drive you may wish to accept less When CRT415 finds more than the number you specify it tells you so and returns you to AMOS command level Enter number of accounts to preallocate This information allows CRT415 to pre initialize blocks in the Master File Directory MFD There is no practical limit to the number of accounts you may specify and the number you enter here in no way restricts the number of accounts you can add to the disk in the future The only limiting factors are the size of the logical devices and the amount of data you plan to store in each account Display current track Y or N If you want CRT415 to tell you as it certifies each track enter Y otherwise enter an N Enter serial number 10 char max You may optionally give CRT415 a ten character alphanumeric I D for the physical unit it is certifying CRT415 writes this identifier into the BADBLK SYS file If you do not wish to give the physical unit an identifier just press RETURN After you answer the questions above CRT415 begins to certify the disk When CRT415 e
89. a tape STRSAV is for file backup only not for transfer of data between Alpha Micro and non Alpha Micro computer systems STRSAV is a wildcard file command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on wildcard specifications You may back up files from any disk account onto tape whether or not the account is in the project you are logged into STRSAYV writes the disk specification of each file to the tape but does not transfer any password associated with the disk account You cannot append files to an existing tape Because STRSAV writes the date and time of backup to the tape cartridge use DATE and TIME to check the system date and time before using STRSAV STRSAV creates a temporary directory file named STRTOC IPF in the current disk account This file is erased and rewritten each time STRSAV is used within the account Do not use this filename for one of your own files since it will be written over the next time you use STRSAV or STRRES If you specify STRTOC IPF in an STRSAV command line STRSAV automatically bypasses it STRSAV locks up all other users on your system Be sure to notify other users before O gt using STRSAV FORMAT STRSAV filespec switch filespec s switch filespec specifies the file s you want to back up and switch is an option request The default file specification is and the account and device you are logged into System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 STRSAV Page 2 OPTIONS The sw
90. an INTERN statement in MAIN and in an EXTERN statement in SUB2 and ZETA appeared in an INTERN statement in MAIN and in an OVRLAY statement in SUB1 MESSAGES Fatal error Incompatible object file version One or more of the specified object files is in an old format incompatible with the current version of GLOBAL The object file source should be re assembled with the current version of the assembler Undefined switch switch ignored If you made a typing mistake re run GLOBAL with the proper switch System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 HASHER FUNCTION Generates a hash total for a specified disk CHARACTERISTICS HASHER is re entrant and re usable A hash total is a number computed based on the characteristics of a group of data the hash total thus uniquely identifies that group of data HASHER generates a hash total for a disk based on the contents of the disk Therefore two disks only have the same hash total if they contain identical data You must be logged into 1 2 to run HASHER HASHER is especially useful when you are making multiple copies of a disk You can use HASHER to generate the hash total of the source disk Then every time you use DSKCPY to make copies of that disk you can tell DSKCPY to generate a hash total for the disk copied to If the hash total for the source disk does not match the hash totals for the disks copied to it means a problem occurred during the disk copy OPERATION Enter HASHER
91. and hash total to the disk System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKANA Page 6 The following blocks were in a file but not marked in use You may next see a list of block numbers if you don t there is nothing to worry about A list of block numbers following this message is an indication of something wrong for example the linking structure of the disk has gone astray you must run DSKANA again using L or E The second time look for the file error messages listed below so you can figure out what s wrong If the list of blocks is extremely long you can press CTRLYC to interrupt it While the rest of the block numbers will not display DSKANA will still write the corrected bitmap and hash total to the disk You only see the following messages if you use the L or E switches If you see any of these messages in the listing of the blocks processed by DSKANA you have serious problems with the data on your disk Your best course is to delete the files affected run DSKANA again and restore the deleted files from your backup BITMAP rewrite error code code number The bitmap could not be written back out to the disk The number you see is the error code indicating what the problem was For a list of these error codes see your AMOS Monitor Calls Manual Block creates endless loop in file The linking structure of this file allows the blocks to point back to themselves Block marked as bad A block marked as bad in the BADBLK SYS 1 2
92. and modes enter DSKANA at AMOS level in an operator s account DO NOT run DSKANA when other users are accessing the specified logical disk or you could damage the data on that disk You must be logged into an operator s account 1 2 to run DSKANA DSKANA builds an image of the logical disk s bitmap in your memory partition This means that you need a larger memory partition to analyze large logical devices For example a 1GB logical disk requires about 250KB of memory just to store the bitmap in addition to any other memory requirements device you re analyzing However this requires extra memory and the amount needed is proportional to the total number of statically locked blocks for all devices in the cache DSKANA will report how much memory it uses to save the cache You may have enough memory for DSKANA to restore the disk cache but not enough to continue analyzing the disk If so increase your job s memory partition or run DSKANA from a job with more memory If you use disk cache DSKANA saves and restores the statically locked blocks for the S FORMAT DSKANA filespec devn switch filespec selects a DSKANA output file devn selects the disk device you want to analyze and switch is an option filespec must not be on the device you are analyzing System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKANA Page 2 OPTIONS B Bypass analysis termination if there is not enough memory to save the disk cache If you use t
93. and read operation on a random record on them It lists any read errors it finds CHARACTERISTICS RNDRED is re entrant and re usable Does not harm the data on your disk FORMAT RNDRED devn devn specifies the device you want to test OPERATION Enter RNDRED and the logical device you want to test For example RNDRED DDAL When you want the program to stop press CTRLYC MESSAGES Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use the DEVTBL command to see a list of current devices Cannot perform RNDRED on device name AMOS error message Check the AMOS error message and correct the condition System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 RUN FUNCTION Runs compiled AlphaBASIC programs CHARACTERISTICS RUN is re entrant and re usable If RUN is in system memory each user who wants to use it may use the copy in system memory instead of loading it into his own memory partition Use RUN only on previously compiled programs For more information on AlphaBASIC see your AlphaBASIC User s Manual FORMAT RUN filespec filespec is the compiled AlphaBASIC program you want to execute DEFAULTS The default file extension is RUN RUN assumes the device and account you are logged into OPERATION Enter RUN and the file you want to run For example RUN INVOIC AlphaBASIC executes your program To stop a program press CTRLYC MESSAGES Cannot find program filename Check
94. and the MASK MASK characters are amp e g DBDO DIR 1 2 DBDS A LIT 1 or DBD16 FLP Enter the list of disk Logicals to be transferred Disk Logicals may be entered as a range e g DBDO 20 for DBDO thru DBD20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line DBDO 15 Which Disk Logical s would you like to restore to Enter list of disk Logicals to be transferred Disk Logicals may be entered as a range e g DBDO 20 for DBDO thru DBD20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line UPDO 15 If no wildcarding is used a Note is displayed warning you that all data on these logical s will be lost and asking you to enter YES to continue If YES is entered the entire logical s will be copied The copying process then begins As it progresses status messages are displayed Following are samples of a BDRES process The first sample has no wildcarding and the second sample shows the process with wildcarding SAMPLE 1 Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 38 01 AM Note One or more logical s have no wildcarding assigned Therefore these logical s will have their label block MFD UFDs bitmap and data blocks restored from the backup All data currently on these logical s will be lost Are you sure that you want to do this If so enter yes YES DBDO 19200 150 Mb gt UPDO 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 2
95. and to allow programs to verify the correct disk has been mounted LABEL maintains as part of the label the date the disk was last mounted and the date the disk was originally labeled FORMAT LABEL devn switch devn is the device which you want to label or for which you want the current label displayed or changed and switch is an option OPTIONS E Force logical device to extended format IS Force logical device to standard traditional format System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LABEL OPERATION Page 2 To display a label enter LABEL and a disk specification For example LABEL DSKO Payroll Data PAY001 Created on 1 Jan 80 at OzWiz Inc on System 1 by Melvin Last access 2 Apr 88 To create or change a label log into 1 2 and enter LABEL and the device specification LABEL displays the old label if one exists and asks for new contents for each of the label fields You can press CTRLYC at any time to halt the program The fields are Volume Name Volume ID Installation System Creator Enter the textual description of the disk up to 40 characters The operator can use this field to determine which disk is mounted Enter up to ten characters as the Volume ID This field may be used by programs to determine if the proper disk has been mounted The XMOUNT subroutine which can be called from AlphaBASIC returns this field The MOUNT program also displays this field whenever
96. approximately 5 per run MESSAGES SI cannot be run from a spawned job Your job is a spawned job for example a network connection or a MULTI job You cannot get accurate statistics from this configuration SI will refuse to run System Commands Reference Manual Rev 12 SIZE FUNCTION Displays the size in bytes of a disk file CHARACTERISTICS SIZE is re entrant and re usable The display is in decimal form FORMAT SIZE filespec filespec specifies the file whose size you want to know DEFAULTS SIZE assumes the account and device you are logged into and a file extension of LIT OPERATION Enter SIZE and the file name For example SIZE FORM TXT Size is 1483 bytes MESSAGES Cannot open filespec file not found SIZE was not able to find the file you specified Check your spelling and make sure the account and device specifications were correct Cannot read filespec device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of valid devices System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 SKIP FUNCTION Skips to the next file mark on a tape mounted on a magnetic tape unit CHARACTERISTICS SKIP is re entrant and re usable o Don t use SKIP while another job is using the specified tape drive You may specify up to 7 tape drives for example MTU0 MTU6 The magnetic tape drive you specify must be defined in the system device table as a non shareab
97. as text editors will not work with random files FORMAT CREATE filespec si record si filespec selects the file you want to create and size is the number of disk blocks you wish to allocate to that file The optional record size specifies the size of the records DEFAULTS The default device and account are where you are logged The default extension is DAT OPERATION Enter CREATE the file you want to create and the number of blocks to allocate to it For example CREATE CUSIDX NEW 10 If you have an extended format file system you can specify a record size to define the size of the records for the file For example CREATE SUPPLY RCD 10 1200 MESSAGES Command error Check your syntax and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CREATE Page 2 Cannot allocate random file filespec device full There were not enough contiguous blocks available on the disk to create a file of the specified size Use DSKPAK to consolidate disk blocks and or erase files to create more disk space File specification error Check your syntax and try again Record size must be greater than 0 if specified If you specify the optional record size the size must be greater than zero System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CRT410 FUNCTION Certifies the disk media of a device controlled by the AM 410 Hard Disk Controller CHARACTERISTICS CRT410 is re entrant and re usable Because
98. at AMOS command level HASHER HASHER prompts you to specify the device you want a hash total for It then displays how many blocks are on the disk and the hash total MESSAGES Disk size not defined in table HASHER can t find the device Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system and try again Driver not found Check your syntax or make sure the proper device driver is available See your System Operator for help Privileged program must be logged into 1 2 Log into 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 HELP FUNCTION Displays text files on your terminal containing information about the system CHARACTERISTICS HELP is re entrant and re usable HELP looks first for the specified HLP file in the System HELP File Library DSKO 7 1 next it searches in your project library account your proj 0 and if unsuccessful there it looks in the device and account you are currently logged into If there are HLP files on the same topic in different accounts HELP uses the searching technique described above and displays the first one it finds For example if there is a HLP file for DATE in DSKO 7 1 your project library account and the account you are logged into you see the contents of the one in DSKO 7 1 If it exists only in your project library account and the account you are currently logged into you see the one in your project librar
99. attempting to record data on the DVD e Fatal SCSI error Sense key nn additional sense nn DVD drive device error has occurred Sense key and additional sense provide further error information e Please insert a DVD RAM media e SCSI error xxxxxxxxx sense error message Code nn nn DVD RAM drive device error has occurred Code provides additional SCSI error sense information e Warning Maximum number of devices exceeded extras ignored e Warning Unable to close DVD Device error occurred while closing the current DVD The DVD RAM may or may not be usable Errors concerning the AMOS DVD data structure e The DVD logical unit size is greater than 64K blocks which could mean compatibility problems on AMOS 1 X systems Press RETURN to continue or C to abort MAKDVD The logical disk size on the DVD will be greater than the maximum size of a traditional logical drive e Error Disk geometry calculation was incorrect The AMOS hidden sector parameters calculated are invalid e Error memory previously calculated as available isn t Memory required for data buffers has disappeared e Error No devices specified User did not specify any AMOS logical disks to be copied to the CD e Error Unable to calculate AMOS disk geometry The AMOS hidden sector parameters could not be calculated e Error unable to get AMOS data buffer The system was unable to acquire memory for data buffers e Frror Unable to remove DVD Recorder data buffer from
100. before error count Any incident with a severity The adjusted severity must be of Warning Warning not the default severity Max verif error count Seq file verif error If the file is listed in MTUSAV INF Contig file verif error the incident is not counted Error Accumulation Details Except as noted error accumulation has precedence over directory date changed processing and file listed in MTUSAV INF processing If an incident triggers an error accumulation the other procedures cannot undo that severity boost Boost Max Warnings Before Error You can also set a number of less serious incidents of any type except as noted below which will cause MTUSAV to report an error This is controlled by the Max warnings before error setting in MTUSAV OPT When the total number of notes and warnings equals or exceeds this value MTUSAV reports an error Subsequent incidents of Warning or Note severity are also reported as having Error severity There are two exceptions to this rule Neither of these incidents are counted e Incidents which are not reported because the file is listed in MTUSAV INF e Directory date change warnings AMOS 2 x extended directories only Be careful with this setting as incidents of both Warning and Note severity are accumulated Reduction Directory Date Changed Under AMOS 2 x files in extended directories store the date they were created and last modified If either of these dates chan
101. before proceeding with VCRSAV If another user is reading from or writing to the disk when you use VCRSAV you both could be locked up VCRSAV cannot be run from a job under the control of the Task Manager or from a spawned task if the T switch is used You may back up files from any disk account onto tape whether or not the account is within the project you are logged into Although VCRSAV writes the disk specification of the file to the tape cassette along with the file it does not transfer any password associated with that disk account Before using VCRSAV use the DSKANA program to check the device for errors If there is a problem on the disk you copy from you may not be able to restore from the tape later VCRSAV is for file backup only not for transfer of data between Alpha Micro and non Alpha Micro computer systems Because VCRSAV writes the date and time of backup to the tape you should remember to use the DATE and TIME programs to make sure the system date and time are correct before you use VCRSAV VCRSAV creates a temporary directory file named VCRTOC IPF in the disk and account you are currently logged into This file is erased and recreated each time VCRSAV is used within the account If you specify VCRTOC IPF in a VCRSAV command line it bypasses it System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VCRSAV Page 2 FORMAT VCRSAV filespec switch filespec s switch the filespec s specify the files you want to back up
102. board cache OPERATION Type CBDS and press RETURN CBDS MESSAGES This program is not supported Your system is not running either a RoadRunner CPU board or the AMOS 32 operating system The on board cache is not supported System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CBEN FUNCTION Enables the cache for certain high performance Alpha Micro CPU boards such as those using the 68030 68040 and 68060 CPUs The on board memory cache improves system performance by holding frequently used instructions and data in high speed memory to eliminate slower accesses to main memory CHARACTERISTICS CBEN is re entrant and re usable The on board memory cache controlled by CBEN CBDS should not be confused with the memory cache contained on the CPU chip itself The on chip cache is an instruction cache only The on board cache is a combined instruction and data cache that is transparent to users and programmers in everyday use Both the on chip and on board caches are enabled at bootup time automatically The on chip cache is turned on and off by executing a sequence of program instructions see the AMOS Monitor Calls Manual for details while the on board cache is turned off by the CBDS command and re enabled by the CBEN command The on board cache is not affected by the COMPAT database self modifying code does not have to deal with the on board cache If you use CBDS to disable the cache during testing or debugging you then need to use
103. can change the device specification of a data file You can use ISAM functions from within AlphaBASIC programs or assembly language programs For information on using ISAM see your SAM System User s Guide q Two keyed sequential access methods may co exist on your computer the traditional S ISAM and the newer ISAM Plus ISAM Plus is a re organized easier to use version of ISAM with more power and features If you are using ISAM Plus use the ISMUTL utility instead of ISMBLD See the ISMUTL reference sheet FORMAT ISMBLD filespec switch s filespec selects the name you want to assign to the IDA data and IDX index files and a switch is an option request OPTIONS D Change the data file device specification IN Prevent ISMBLD from using Exclusive Open Mode For information on Exclusive Open Mode and Counted Update Mode see your ISAM System User s Guide System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 ISMBLD Page 2 OPERATION Enter ISMBLD followed by the name you want to assign to the file For example ISMBLD LABELS To create an ISAM file in Counted Update Mode use the N switch If the file you specify does not yet exist ISMBLD asks you a series of questions from the parameters you supply ISMBLD generates a data file primary index file combination ISMBLD asks 1 Size of key Enter the size of the desired key in bytes When you later access the ISAM file you are now building
104. can find the address or address name by looking at the normal SMEM display MESSAGES Cannot locate shared memory block with address xxxx You specified an invalid memory block address to delete Use SMEM without a switch to display valid addresses then try again Cannot locate shared memory block with name xxxx You specified an invalid or non existent memory block name to delete Use SMEM without a switch to display valid block names then try again Possible system interaction xxx no longer exists but SMEM did not remove Another job deleted the shared memory block while you were deleting it too The block has been deleted SMEM already defined and can only be defined once Check your syntax and try again 2SMEM can only be assigned during boot time You cannot define shared memory after the system has finished booting 2SMEM illegal value specified on command line Check your syntax and try again SMEM invalid address specification The address you entered is incorrect Use SMEM without switches to see the addresses System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 SMEM 2SMEM invalid name specification The name you entered is incorrect Use SMEM without switches to see the addresses SMEM not defined Shared memory is not defined in your system initialization command file 2SMEM specified address out of range The address you entered is incorrect Use SMEM without switches to see the addresses 2SMEM speci
105. command line above causes LIBLIT to create an output file named MYLIB LIB containing the specified OBJ files TO DISPLAY A LIBRARY FILE Use the L switch For example LIBLIT L NEWLIB sends the listing of NEWLIB to your terminal display To tell LIBLIT to place the listing in a disk file specify an output file and the L switch For example LIBLIT L LIST NEWLIB System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 LIBLIT TO UPDATE A LIBRARY FILE To update an existing library file enter LIBLIT the library file you want to modify an equal sign and the list of filespecs you wish to add and or delete For example LIBLIT UTILIT UTILIT LIB NADDR or LIBLIT UTILIT NADDR Both of these command lines tell LIBLIT to take the existing library UTILIT LIB and modify it by adding the object file NADDR to it You may specify a group of files by using the inclusion symbols and you may delete files by using the symbol For example LIBLIT NUMLIB FORMAT This command line tells LIBLIT to delete the object file FORMAT The command LIBLIT NEWLIB MATH BINADR SMLLNUM BINWRT tells LIBLIT to add MATH and delete the BINADR SMLLNUM and BINWRT from NEWLIB When replacing an existing module in a library DO NOT just add a new version of the module without first deleting the original module of the same name Doing so can cause problems because both versions will still be in the library The recommended procedure is to first delete the
106. containing the directory CHARACTERISTICS MTUDIR is re entrant and re usable MTUDIR can only read magnetic tapes created by MTUSAV It may be used with 1 2 9 track streaming and Exabyte tape drives MTUDIR works with both traditional and extended format disks Used also with MTURES to restore files from tape to disk A group of files backed up onto magnetic tape at the same time by the same MTUSAV command is known as a save set A save set can be on more than one reel of tape MTUDIR is a wildcard command The account and device portions of the specification refer to the disk account and device from which the files were originally backed up See your AMOS User s Guide for more about wildcard specifications FORMAT MTUDIR listfilespec filespec filespec switch listfilespec specifies a disk file to contain the tape directory display filespecs are files on the tape whose directory listing to display and switch is an option request DEFAULTS The default listfilespec is DIRECT LST in the account and device you are logged into The default filespec is and the account and device you are logged into OPTIONS AFTER date time List only those files saved with a date and time of last modification after the specified date and time The date and time must be in the format specified in your current language definition file BEFORE date time List only those files saved with a date and time of last modification b
107. descriptors that have been used at any one time If the numbers become close to each other then it might be time to think about increasing your allocation in the INI file Rx Status Rx Error Summary is the total of Rx Status Errors Length Error is the count of Rx packets larger than standard Runt Frame is the count of Rx packets smaller than standard Collision is the total number of collisions encountered CRC Error is the total number of CRC errors encountered Frame Too Long is the total number of Rx packets with frames larger than standard MII Error Report is total number of MII errors encountered Receive Watchdog is total number of watchdogs encountered Dribbling Bit is total number of dribbling bits encountered FIFO Overflow is total number of FIFO overflows encountered Fatal Bus Error is total number of fatal bus errors encountered Tx Status Tx Error Summary is the total of Tx Status Errors Loss of carrier is total number of times carrier was lost No Carrier is total number of times no carrier was encountered Late Collision is number of late collisions encountered Excessive Collisions is number of excessive collisions encountered Link Fail Report is number of link failures reported Underflow Error is number of underflow errors encountered Jabber Timeout is number of jabber timeouts encountered Heartbeat Fail is number of heartbeat failures encountered System Commands Reference Manual Rev 14 ESLSI Page 4 Deferred is the n
108. devices and the amount of data you plan to store in each account 3 Display current track Y or N If you want each track displayed as it certifies enter Y otherwise enter N 4 Enter serial number 10 char max You may optionally give CRT410 a ten character alphanumeric I D for the logical device it is certifying CRT410 writes this identifier into the BADBLK SYS file After you answer the questions CRT410 certifies the disk When CRT410 encounters a track it can t verify it tells you so When it finishes it displays the number of bad tracks it found MESSAGES Cannot certify devn device not mounted Use the MOUNT command to mount the specified device Certification incomplete You pressed CTRLYC or some other event interrupted the certification CRT410 now intentionally writes a bad hash total to BADBLK SYS so other programs know the data in the file is incomplete and not to be trusted Re run CRT410 to create a good BADBLK SYS file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 CRT410 Device does not exist Check the device name and re enter the command Use DEVTBL to see a list of devices Device has exceeded maximum number of errors CRT410 found more bad tracks than the value you specified as the maximum number of bad tracks you will accept devn is not at the standard port address Make sure that you are using the correct format program Do you wish to continue The device driver for the sp
109. e Default Values used by the drive if current values have not been set or the drive is unable to access its saved values The information you requested is displayed within a scrollable window Use LH and WJ to view the information Press when you are done ERROR MESSAGES Can t specify bitmap size with optimization enabled Don t specify a bitmap size or turn optimization OFF System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 FMTS2 Page 6 Can t specify logical count or size while optimized traditional logical format is selected You must turn optimization OFF to be able to specify the number of traditional logicals to create and the bitmap size Logical count incorrectly specified You used the LOGICALS switch but did not specify a logical drive count or specified a drive count of zero or greater than 999 Logical format exceeds usable drive capacity You specified a logical drive count and bitmap size that exceeds the capacity of the drive Specify a smaller number of logical drives and or bitmap size Logical format MUST be completely specified When optimization is disabled you must specify both the number of logical drives to create and the bitmap size Program requires AMOS 32 execution FMTS2 requires an MC68020 or later processor It will not run on a computer with an MC68000 or MC68010 processor SASI interface not available on this system You used the SASI switch on a system that does not have a SAS
110. each file before copying File switch APPEND Add files at the end of existing files Operation System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FILTAP Page 2 OPERATION Enter FILTAP and the files you want to back up onto tape For example FILTAP MEMO TXT SCHDLE TXT 310 2 Now FILTAP asks you to enter the tape unit number Enter the unit number of the magnetic tape drive containing the tape reel you want to access FILTAP uses the MTU device code automatically FILTAP then tells you what files it is transferring Remember you can use wildcard file specifications For example if you want to back up all BAS files on the disk FILTAP BAS When you use Q FILTAP asks for confirmation before each transfer Enter Y for yes or N for no do not press after your answer For example FILTAP Q BAS LIT NOQ LST Enter tape unit number 1 STSOR BAS to MTU1 LSTSOR BAS Y TATUS LIT to MTU1 STATUS LIT EW LST to MTU1 NEW LST N Zune You may press CTRLYC at any time to prevent further transfers If FILTAP can t fit all the files you specified on one tape it lets you continue the backup on another reel MESSAGES Cannot find DSKO SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS FILTAP needs this file to process wildcard symbols Make sure SCNWLD SYS is in DSKO 1 4 and you have enough memory to load it in your partition Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list
111. equals decimal 3 etc instead of a key you wish to define Once you have exited from FIXTRN an updated module is saved on the disk If you want the module to have a different name you can use the RENAME command to rename the disk file MESSAGES File specification error Enter FIXTRN again with a filename for the file you wish to create System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 FIX210 FUNCTION Configures a floppy disk driver for a specific combination of floppy disk format disk drive and disk controller Used with the AM 210 Floppy controller and the AM 1000 and AM 1200 systems CHARACTERISTICS FIX210 is re entrant and re usable Because of the large number of possible permutations of floppy disk formats drives and controllers it is no longer possible to provide a separate disk driver program for each combination For information on the large number of floppy disk formats available see your Alpha Micro dealer sl You must be logged into DSKO 1 6 to use FIX210 You may not use single density W AMS format for 8 inch floppies if you are going to be running the drive under control of the AM 210 disk controller FIX210 works only under the AMOS L version of the operating system Remember to add a BITMAP command to your system initialization command file for each new format drive controller combination you create You may also need to modify a DEVTBL command line OPERATION Log into the system Dev
112. error during the restore Run DSKANA on your disk and try the restore again Cannot close filespec Device full This indicates a disk error during the restore Run DSKANA on your disk and try the restore again Cannot restore extended directory format files to an old format disk Cannot restore old format files to an extended directory format disk You must restore files to the same format traditional or extended disk they were backed up from When restoring you must also be logged on to the same type of device you were logged on to when creating the backup Cannot restore tape when logged device format does not match that of the device restoring to You cannot restore files when you are logged into a device whose file system differs from the device you are restoring to one uses extended files the other uses traditional Log into a device with the same file system as the target device then try again Cannot restore with SET VERIFY on Enter RETURN to continue without VERIFY or CTRLC to abort If the number of copies you specified with the COPIES command is less than four or if you specified none as default is 0 and the VERIFY option is set ON the system cannot restore If you press RETURN NOVERIFY is set and the restore continues Disk transfer error An error occurred while the data was being transferred to or from the disk Run DSKANA and correct any problems then try again System Commands Reference
113. example above renames your existing file EXIT SBR to EXIT OLD then it saves the memory module in your partition as EXIT SBR Ifa file named EXIT OLD already exists in the account SAVE erases it before renaming EXIT SBR to EXIT OLD MESSAGES Cannot save filespec memory module not found Use MAP or DIR MEM to see what modules are in memory Illegal backup switch You tried to use the rename option but you did not specify a legal extension after the backslash A file extension may only include letters or numbers and may only be three characters or less long System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 SCSI FUNCTION Displays a list of all SCSI devices attached to your computer CHARACTERISTICS SCSI is reentrant and reusable It displays which SCSI IDs are in use and which are available For the IDs in use it displays the type of device manufacturer s model number and firmware revision If available from the SCSI dispatcher this command also displays the currently configured data transfer parameters This is the same information that is displayed during bootup initialization of the SCSI dispatcher OPERATION To see a list of SCSI devices type SCSI You will see a display similar to this Dispatched SCSI port SCSI id SCSI id 7 reserved SCSI bus host adaptor 6 SCSI 2 tape TANDBERG TDC 4100 05 10CREATED121592 SCSI id 5 No device or unable to report SCSI id 4 No device or unable to report
114. file display file on terminal SET DOS sets normal line termination SET UNIX sets UNIX style line termination CD gt System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 ISOCD Page 2 MESSAGES AlphaCD is installed please uninstall ACD before using ISOCD ISOCD requires a SCSI dispatcher it cannot be used with the SASI port No CD ROM drives found cannot continue Disc is not an ISO 9660 or High Sierra compatible CD ROM Invalid command Unix line termination mode selected Normal line termination mode selected File specification error For at least the TYPE command File not found For at least the TYPE COPY and COPYR commands ISO file specification error Bad CD file name For at least the COPY and COPYR commands 2 AMOS file specification error Bad AMOS file name For at least the COPY and COPYR commands 2No directory specified For at least the CD command Invalid directory Means not found for the CD command Fatal dispatcher execution error code The SCSI dispatcher got an error that it could not process Usually this means the SCSI bus is not functioning properly Note that it may or may not include a leading question mark symbol CD ROM drive is not ready Disc appears to be an audio CD additional sense The SCSI code information from the CD device indicates that this is not an acceptable data CD The additional SCSI sense information may be of assistance in trouble shooting System Commands Reference Manu
115. file by making an entry in your User File Directory and creating an empty disk record for it CHARACTERISTICS MAKE is re entrant and re usable FORMAT MAKE filespec size filespec specifies the new file and size is the number of bytes for the file The size can be any positive number use caution with very large numbers or you may use up too much disk space DEFAULTS The default device and account are where you are logged The default extension is M68 and the size is 0 bytes OPERATION Enter MAKE followed by the specification of the file you want to create and optionally a size in bytes For example MAKE SRCFIL BAS 1000 You can use DIR to verify the file was created MESSAGES File specification error Check your spelling and syntax and try again Command error You did not specify a valid size or you left out the comma in the command line Check your syntax and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MAKQUE FUNCTION Creates a queue file for use with the Task Manager Creates both batch queues and print spooler queues CHARACTERISTICS MAK QUE is re entrant and re usable MAKQUE creates batch queue files inside the account you are logged into Therefore if you wish to submit tasks to that queue from more than one account you must create it in account 1 4 Otherwise the queue is only available to run tasks if you are logged into the specific account where the queue file was cre
116. file containing a compiled program This file has the same name as the file you specified on the COMPIL command line but with a RUN extension To execute this file use RUN System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 COMPIL Page 2 MESSAGES The AlphaBASIC error messages are explained in your AlphaBASIC User s Manual System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 COMPLP FUNCTION Compiles an AlphaBASIC PLUS source file CHARACTERISTICS COMPLP is re entrant and re usable See the AJphaBASIC PLUS User s Manual for information about the AlphaBASIC PLUS programming language System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 CONT FUNCTION Resumes execution of a command file previously interrupted by a PAUSE command CHARACTERISTICS CONT is a DO file located in DSKO 2 2 When you are using a command file and its execution is interrupted because of a PAUSE command in that file you are then returned to AMOS command level At that point you can use other command files run programs use the text editor etc When you are ready to resume execution of the command file you may use CONT to do so When command file execution is interrupted PAUSE saves the remainder of the unexecuted command file in a disk file named CNT CMD in the account the command file is logged into CONT loads the CNT CMD file into memory from the account you are logged into and executes it Therefore do not erase CNT CMD f
117. file transferred from the backup device to the disk After the selected files have been transferred to the disk RESTOR updates the disk directory and lists the restored files on your terminal MESSAGES All date and time switches must be in absolute format See the rules above for specifying dates and times and try again Attempt to initiate device handler failed error code n Check to see if the number of jobs defined in your system initialization file are enough to include one for the device handler task See your System Operator about solving the error condition The error codes are 1 4 b table is full NDLR task already exists Oo BACKUP media not compatible with current software The backup medium you are using is not compatible with the current version of your software See your System Operator for help BACKUP media not file structured RESTOR could not read the label information block RESTOR can only read media created by the BACKUP command System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 RESTOR Page 4 BACKUP media not in correct sequence The second media of a split media backup didn t match the first Make sure you have the correct media If so see your System Operator for help BACKUP media not written by BACKUP program The backup wasn t written by BACKUP See your System Operator about which program restores the data Bypassing filename RESTOR is not restoring the file because it would overwr
118. for which you want a directory listing If you want the directory listing in a file include a listfspec DEFAULTS The default file specification is The default device and account specifications are where you are logged The default listfspec is DIRECT LST in the account and device you are logged into OPTIONS All the switches may be specified with NO before them to cancel them and may be abbreviated to the shortest unique combination BASE Displays base disk address of the file or base memory address for DIR B MEM File switch BDATE Displays last backup date BTIME Displays last backup time System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DIR Page 2 CONTIGUOUS Adds C if file is contiguous random Operation switch CDATE Displays date of creation CTIME Displays time of creation DATA Lists complete filespecs Operation switch Overrides FULL switch EXPANDED Displays all information in an expanded format FULL Full data list Same as adding H B C V HASH Displays hashmark for each file Helps tell file versions apart File switch KILL Delete and replace listfile if one exists Operation switch PROTECTION Displays protection code UDATE Displays last update date UTIME Displays last update time VERSION Displays version number of LIT and RUN files File switch WIDE n List in n columns default is 4 Operation switch The switches BDATE BTIME CDATE CTIME
119. format name text name is any alphanumeric symbol and text is anything not containing a sign Spaces and tabs before and after the text are removed A macro is invoked by S macro name txtl txt2 If the invoked macro is not defined it is ignored If txt1 is not specified the macro invocation is replaced by the text of the macro itself Since macros can be redefined the current text is used If txt1 is specified the current text of the macro is processed and all occurrences of txt1 are replaced by txt2 If macros are defined in the command line attempts to redefine them are ignored Here s an example of a macro SWITCHES D A V Xebb lt lt EC da cc x SWITCHES The rule facility is a way to give a default way to build a module if it is not specified as a target file in the makefile Rules define an action to take by default if no explicit command is given for a file The format is extl ext2 extl and ext2 are AMOS file extensions A rule line should be followed by one or more command lines If there is no explicit description on how to build a specific file all the rules are examined to see if one could be applied in order to build the file The first extension is the one of the source and the second the one of the target file If different rules exist to build the same target they are examined in order and the first one which works is considered as fulfilling the search For example
120. function destroys any existing data on the tape System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MTBOOT Page 2 OPERATION Load a tape into your magnetic tape drive Enter MTBOOT and the name of the warm boot file For example MTBOOT MAGTAP WRM MTBOOT requests information for the tape label Volume Name 40 characters Volume ID 10 characters Installation 30 characters System 30 characters Creator 30 characters Fill in these fields with information to help identify the tape Press after each response MTBOOT then creates the bootable tape MESSAGES Data error undetected by device The VERIFY phase read back a block from the tape that did not match the expected pattern However the tape unit did not report a read or write error in transferring the data This may indicate a problem with the tape or the tape drive Check the tape drive for correct operation and clean it Try the VERIFY option using another tape Field size exceeded You put too much in one of the label fields Re enter using fewer characters Specification error The points to the error Check your syntax and try again Tape is not file structured The tape directory block at the start of the tape could not be located Either the tape was not written by AMOS or the tape is damaged System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MTUDIR FUNCTION Displays a list of the files on a tape backup created by MTUSAV Can also create a disk file
121. is accessed you ll see only the help file text without the definition part and then you can press 1 2 or 3 to see the appropriate help file If you press CTRLYC or CANCEL you return to AMOS command level If you press or ESCJ ESC you are returned to the last help file level OPERATION Enter HELP followed by the name of a topic to see the text file associated with that topic For example HELP VUE Now the screen clears and you see information on the topic you have chosen MESSAGES Error while reading help file A disk or other error was encountered while reading the help file from disk Contact your System Operator Unable to locate help file There is no HLP file for that topic System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 ISMBLD FUNCTION Builds an ISAM index file data file combination CHARACTERISTICS ISMBLD is re entrant and re usable ISAM Indexed Sequential Access Method is a method for organizing and accessing data An ISAM file is an index file data file combination The index file contains pointers to records in the data file The ISAM SYS program quickly finds data records by searching the index file instead of searching the data file itself Although you call ISAM functions from within your AlphaBASIC or assembly language programs you may not run the program ISAM SYS directly from AMOS command level ISMBLD can create a new ISAM file it can add data to a new or existing file and it
122. is below the minimum level when using the TRANSFER switch This message appears whenever you are restoring files from a VCR using T and the backup tape was created with fewer than twenty copies Warn other users on your computer system that you need to use RESTOR without T and when they are ready try again without T WARNING Device handler task failed to respond Reboot system Reboot your system There should be no damage to your data WARNING Run DSKANA to ensure the integrity of the bitmap This is displayed after an error or a C occurs during the restore Run DSKANA WARNING The next file is a split file and is NOT complete The media has ended in a split file and you have chosen not to continue the restore This reminds you the last file restored is not complete You must be logged into the operator s account 1 2 to restore files to any but the logged in project Either log into the same project number or log into account 1 2 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 REWIND FUNCTION Rewinds a 1 2 9 track magnetic tape or a video cassette CHARACTERISTICS DO NOT use REWIND when another job is using the tape unit Such an action causes unpredictable results The tape unit you access must be defined in your system device table MTSTAT SYS must be in system memory for magnetic tape units if you have an S 100 Bus or any non VME system See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initia
123. is expected or a process is finished FORMAT DING number of rings OPERATION Enter DING and the number of times you want the terminal bell to ring at AMOS command level For example DING 5 You can also use DING in a command file For example T lt Backup Project 100 accounts on DSK1 over to DSK0 gt COPY DSK0 DSK1 100 lt FINISHED Remove backup disk gt DING 5 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DIR FUNCTION Produces a directory listing for specific files or accounts CHARACTERISTICS DIR is re entrant and re usable and understands ersatz names You can use DIR to display the list of all files in a specific account tell you what accounts and devices a particular file appears in find the complete specification of a file and to place a copy of a directory listing into a file If you use DIR to create a file to hold a directory listing and if you use the DATA option then programs such as those written in AlphaBASIC can read the file specifications in that file and use that data to open files If your system uses the file protection system protected files will not be displayed by DIR to users without the required access level DIR is a wildcard file command For more information on wildcards see your AMOS User s Guide FORMAT DIR listfspec filespec filespec s switch s filespec is a file specification that selects a file
124. is no limit to the number of accounts you may specify and the number you enter here in no way restricts the number of accounts you can add to the disk in the future The only limiting factors are the size of the logical device and the amount of data you plan to store in each account Display current track Y or N If you want CRT420 to tell you as it certifies each track enter Y otherwise enter N Enter serial number 10 char max You may optionally give CRT420 a ten character alphanumeric ID for the physical unit it is certifying CRT420 writes this identifier into the BADBLK SYS file If you do not wish to give the physical unit an identifier just press RETURN After you answer the questions above CRT420 begins to certify the disk When CRT420 encounters a track it cannot verify it tells you so For example Track 79 Head 2 Sector 3 did not verify On an AM 1000 it displays something like Block 24 did not verify When it finishes certifying the disk CRT420 tells you how many bad tracks it found CRT420 includes a hash total for BADBLK SYS inside the file Other programs can check this hash total against the contents of the file to make sure BADBLK SYS contains undamaged data MESSAGES Block n did not verify CRT420 marked block n as a bad block in the BADBLK SYS file AM 1000 drive System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 CRT420 Certification incomplete You pressed
125. is trying to process a supposed overlay file but has seen no references to the overlay in a previous file Without such a reference SYMLIT cannot construct the overlay Fatal error Overwriting of impure zone not permitted Next expected address is xxxx Overwriting address is yyyy Check the instructions for use of the DSIZE pseudo opcode and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 SYMLIT Page 4 Symbol file finished n errors exist Lets you know how many errors occurred during the processing Undefined switch x ignored SYMLIT didn t recognize the switch you specified See OPTIONS above for the valid switches symbol undefined An external symbol is undefined You referenced a symbol not previously defined or you made a reference to a non existent label Make sure any EXTERNed symbols in one segment are defined by an INTERN statement in another segment System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 SYSACT FUNCTION Adds or deletes user accounts on a specific disk Adds or changes account passwords SYSACT can also initialize an entire disk CHARACTERISTICS SYSACT is re entrant and re usable SYSACT modifies the Master File Directory MFD of a specific disk The MFD lists all accounts on the disk listed by their project programmer numbers and the password if assigned for each one You may add or delete disk accounts and add change or delete account passwords Y
126. job JOBPRI could not find the job you entered on the command line Check your spelling For a list of jobnames defined on your system use TRMDEF You must be logged into PPN 1 2 to set another job s priority Log into 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 JOBS FUNCTION Displays the number of jobs allocated on the system and the number currently in use CHARACTERISTICS JOBS is re entrant and re usable Also used in the system initialization command file to define the number of jobs on the system See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for more information OPERATION Enter JOBS at AMOS level For example JOBS 20 jobs allocated 8 currently assigned MESSAGES Cannot allocate jobs after system is up Enter JOBS and press RETURN JOBS has no other functions at AMOS level If you need to allocate jobs see your System Operator about changing the JOBS command in your system initialization file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 KILL FUNCTION Forces a Control C interrupt to another user s job to attempt to halt the program that job is currently running CHARACTERISTICS KILL is re entrant and re usable Depending on what the job you want to stop is doing KILL may not be able to halt the task In this case and if that job is locked up you may have to reboot your system to free the job FORMAT KILL jobname jJ
127. may see the following messages during the program assembly Assembly Fold No Fold switch doesn t match UNV file You used N when the UNV file was being created but you are not using it on the current assembly or vice versa Symbols may be undefined due to case differences use N or compile without N as appropriate to how you first did Cannot OPEN device name invalid file name Check your syntax and try again Copy file filespec not found The file you wanted to COPY was not where you said it was Check your syntax or use the DIR command to find the file and try again Expression stack error This is an internal M68 error Check your source program to see if you made any errors in specifying expressions System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 M68 Page 4 File specification error You made a mistake in your file specification Check your syntax and try again Invalid UNV file version number aborting Re create your UNV file by re assembling the source program using the current version of M68 2 M68n OVR not found n is a number from 0 to 3 M68 can t find one of the overlays that are a part of M68 Check to see if the specified overlay is in DSKO 1 4 If not use the DIR command to look for the overlay if you find it in another account copy it to DSKO 1 4 If it is in DSKO 1 4 and you still get this message or if you cannot find the file see your System Operator No EN
128. memory e Unable to continue due to one or more errors shown above Testing of logical disk drive transfer rates resulted in the errors listed above Normal informational messages e AlphaDVD creation complete The recording of data on the DVD media is done e Calculating space requirements AMOS partition requires 16165 sectors 2220538 unused sectors remain This shows information about how much space the data consumes on the DVD and how much empty space remains e DVD RAM Recorder located at SCSI id n This shows the SCSI id of the DVD RAM Drive being used e Note that once started the recording operation can be stopped by pressing C e Press RETURN to start recording or C to abort System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 Page 7 MAKDVD This is the final prompt before recording begins You may abort by pressing control C or start the recording process by pressing RETURN e Transferring DSKO e Using Generic SCSI DVD RAM driver DVDRAM This message shows the DVD driver name and description being used e Using Panasonic DVD RAM driver DVDPAN e Waiting for DVD Recorder to finish writing Completed The memory data buffers and the DVD RAM Drive s cache buffers are being recorded on the DVD media e nn complete This message shows percentage of the recording process already completed This message appears on the terminal s status line System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 MAKE FUNCTION Creates a sequential
129. memory available temporarily to at least 32K You may wish to adjust memory allocations permanently in your system INI file Privileged program must be logged into OPR Log into DSKO 1 2 and try again Track n Head n Sector n assigned alternate CRT415 marked track n head n sector n as a bad block in the BADBLK SYS file and assigned an alternate sector to be used instead If the entire track is bad CRT415 omits the Sector number from this message System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CRT420 FUNCTION Certifies the disk media of disks under control of an AM 420 or AM 1000 Winchester Disk Controller CHARACTERISTICS CRT420 is re entrant and re usable You may use this certification program ONLY on devices controlled by an AM 420 or uv AM 1000 Winchester Disk Controller CRT420 communicates directly with the AM 420 or AM 1000 Winchester Disk Controller without going through the AM 420 or the AM 1000 driver program Therefore you MUST NOT run CRT420 at the same time as other programs that access devices under control of an AM 420 or an AM 1000 You must be logged into the System Operator s account DSK0 1 2 to run CRT420 The disk is pre certified at the factory with much greater accuracy than is possible with this program Therefore use this program only in extreme cases such as the unrecoverable loss of your BADBLK SYS file CRT420 certifies a physical unit by writing and verifying dat
130. module and then to add the new version of the module For example to replace the object file KEYSUB LIBLIT MACLIB KEYSUB KEYSUB MESSAGES Command error LIBLIT did not understand your command line Check your syntax and try again Fatal error Incompatible library file version Fatal error Incompatible object file version An object file or library file you specified is in an incompatible format The object file should be re assembled and the library rebuilt using the current versions of M68 and LIBLIT Fatal error xxx is an overlay You may not specify an overlay as an element of an object file library Re type the command line without the overlay System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LIBLIT Page 4 Listing aborted LIBLIT was not able to finish the library listing For example an error occurred while LIBLIT was trying to access a file OBJ files are not libraries they cannot be restricted by a modifier You may only use the and symbols if you are modifying a library The following module was not found xxx You tried to modify an existing library file but the object files you specified were not present in the library file Make sure you did not accidentally use Undefined switch switch ignored Make sure you did not accidentally type when you meant to type and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LINCNT FUNCTION Counts and displays the number of lines in a f
131. next screen page MESSAGES Cannot INIT filespec device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL for a list of devices System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 TYPE Page 2 Cannot open filespec disk not mounted MOUNT the disk and try again Cannot open filespec file not found Check your syntax or use DIR to find the file Cannot open filespec file type mismatch You tried to TYPE a random file You have to use another method such as a BASIC program to display the contents of that file Cannot open filespec illegal user code You specified an account that does not exist Check your syntax or use PPN to see a list of accounts on the device you are using Command syntax error Check your syntax and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 FUNCTION Allows you to save AMOS command lines temporarily and to run them later by typing a single character CHARACTERISTICS U is re entrant and re usable Because the AMOS command line is saved in user memory a system reset erases the command line You can save more than one command line at a time by making a copy of the U LIT program under different names You can then use those programs to save command lines too The command line is stored in your user memory partition with a SCS extension FORMAT U AMOS Command line OPERATION To save an AMOS command line type U and the command lin
132. now asks you for the following information RECORD SIZE SORT recognizes a as the end of each data record but needs to know the size of the largest data record it is going to be dealing with Enter the maximum size in bytes of the logical records in your file Every character is one byte of data including spaces and punctuation Exclude carriage return and line feed bytes The minimum record size is two bytes System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SORT Page 2 KEY SIZE The key is the field in the record on which you want to sort for example customer name SORT asks this question for each key you define You can define up to three keys If you want SORT to use less press after you define the keys you want Enter the size in bytes of the key KEY SORT asks this question for each of the keys you define Enter the column POSITION number in the record where the first byte of the sort key occurs The first byte of a record is position 1 KEY ORDER SORT asks this question for each of the keys you define Enter an A for ascending or D for descending ASCII order SORT now sorts the file If your system has 8 bit character support you see Using extended collating sequence After the sort is done SORT displays statistics MESSAGES Cannot delete filespec write protected Write enable your disk and try again Cannot open filespec file type mismatch You tried to sort a random file You may only sort sequential files Comma
133. of a file sl You can dump a file from MEM or RES ww To display a disk block DUMP BLOCK start block end block devn start block is the number of the first block you want to see end block is the last block you want to see and devn is the specification of the logical device containing the block s DUMP RECORD does the same thing as DUMP BLOCK System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DUMP Page 2 To display a disk bitmap DUMP BITMAP devn To display the disk Master File Directory DUMP MFD devn To display a user s disk directory DUMP UFD p pn devn or DUMP UFD block devn ol You cannot use an ersatz device name to specify the disk account DUMP DI performs the same function and uses the same format as DUMP UFD DEFAULTS DUMP assumes the device and account you are currently logged into and a file extension of LIT OPERATION Enter DUMP and the keyword and arguments you need For example DUMP BLOCK 16407 DSKO You can suspend and re start the scrolling of the DUMP display by using the key or by pressing CTRLYS and CTRLYQ To interrupt a display press CTRLYC The display types are Memory Block and File Displays The most common type of display looks like Block number 12033 of DSK1 DUMP TXT next block link is 6562 00005620 006562 020056 067543The most common 00005640 066555 067157 0O7155itype of display 00005660 066160 074541 063040tak
134. on DB s features and commands DB has two modes screen mode and command mode Screen mode shows you your source code and its execution displays Command mode like command mode in AlphaVUE or AlphaFIX lets you enter commands In command mode you see the command mode prompt gt To use the debugger you must compile the source program with D For example COMPLP test D This produces the RPD file or SPD if a subprogram used with the debugger FORMAT DB filespec The default extension is RPD OPERATION Enter DB and the name of your file For example DB TEST You then see your program text and can step through the program using the debugging commands detailed in your AlphaBASIC PLUS User s Guide MESSAGES See your AlphaBASIC PLUS User s Guide for a complete list of messages System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DBD FUNCTION DBD is a utility that can be used to uninstall the DBD device display the PIC code or eject the media from one of the DVD RAM or Blu ray drives CHARACTERISTICS DBD is re entrant and re usable FORMAT DBD switches OPTIONS HELP Display HELP n Same as HELP V Display version information and exit AD n DVD Recorder is at SCSI ID n PIC Display Product Installation Code EJECT Eject any DVD or Blu ray media U Uninstall OPERATION DBD U is used to uninstall the DBD device prior to removing the media from the DVD or Blu ray drive Type DBD
135. only Illegal value in time format setting The LTF n value is invalid Enter a value of zero or one only Invalid command line AMSCFG could not understand your command line Identify the error and retype the corrected line No queue blocks available AMSCFG needs queue blocks for its internal operation Ask your System Operator to increase the number of queue blocks allocated by AMOS at system initialization time Report is in filename A reminder of the name of the report file you selected with the F command System Commands Reference Manual Rev 06 AMSCFG Page 6 Program aborted by CTRLY C You stopped the program by pressing CTRLC System Commands Reference Manual Rev 06 APPEND FUNCTION APPEND combines one or more source files into a single file CHARACTERISTICS APPEND is re entrant and re usable You cannot create a file in an account outside of the project you are currently logged into unless you are logged into 1 2 You may use APPEND to combine sequential files of any type You can append one file onto the end of another file by specifying the same specification for the new file as one of the old files you are combining APPEND does not change the contents of the old files unless the new file has the same name and extension as one of the old files FORMAT APPEND newfilespec filespec filespec s newfilespec specifies the new file that will hold the contents of the combined file
136. operating system such as AlphaWRITE AlphaCALC etc These products come with their own documentation sometimes in the form of reference sheets that may be inserted into this manual if you wish For detailed information on the system language and text processors see the specific manuals for those processors CONCEPTS Below we define several of the terms that appear frequently in the command reference sheets For more information on system concepts see your AMOS User s Guide AMOS Command Level When you are at AMOS command level you are communicating directly with AMOS the Alpha Micro Operating System and not with a program AMOS is executing AMOS Prompt When you re at AMOS command level you see the AMOS prompt symbol which tells you the operating system is ready for you to enter a command This prompt may be the system default a period or it may be defined using SET Command Line Whenever you enter a command to AMOS you include the name of the command optionally followed by device and or file specifications option switches etc The entire input line is called a command line Command File A command file is an ASCII text file containing valid AMOS system commands and file specifications It can contain most commands and data you can enter at AMOS command level including the name of another command file As AMOS processes a command file it performs the functions called for by System Commands Reference Manual
137. packets Total Send Packets is the total number of packets sent Total Rx Stop is the total number of times the Rx process has stopped Total No Rx Buffers is the total number of times an Rx buffer was not available CINV is total count of referenced packets not on the receive queue CDISC is total count of discarded request NOFSD is the total number of Rx packets with no first segment flag set NOLSD is the total number of Rx packets with no last segment flag set ARDA FCNT is the total number of free Rx descriptors PRDA UCNT is the total number of used Rx descriptors ATDA FCNT is the total number of free Tx descriptors PTDA UCNT is the total number of used Tx descriptors CSRS is the contents of the configuration register five FLAGS is processing flags used by PCI programs RDES0O is the latest Rx descriptor processed NTRI is the total count of interrupts without a Tx or Rx request present MF Overflow is the total number of missed frame count overflows Missed Frames is the total number of missed frames Master Abort is the total number of Master Aborts encountered TLLCNT is the total Tx link loop count wrap count RLLCNT is the total Rx link loop count wrap count PTDA is pending TDA index CTDA is current free TDA index CRDA is current RDA pending to be processed RDA count is total number of Rx descriptors assigned TDA count is total number of Tx descriptors assigned Wrap count is the total number of times the Rx descriptors have b
138. path spec abort You entered the account to transfer to in an invalid format Try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 QDT FUNCTION Allows you to examine and modify locations in memory CHARACTERISTICS QDT is re entrant and re usable The primary use for QDT is not to debug programs but to examine the contents of memory locations in the monitor or at the locations used by the I O ports This is a dangerous program you can destroy the monitor in system memory or damage data You CAN reload a valid copy of your monitor by rebooting the system but you should still be careful using QDT especially if other users are working on the system You must be logged into DSKO 1 2 to run QDT If hex mode has been set by use of the SET HEX command you may enter and display numbers in hexadecimal However any hex number which starts with a letter must be preceded by a 0 for example OFF instead of FF OPERATION Log into OPR and enter QDT at AMOS command level LOG OPR QDT Now you can begin to enter QDT commands Unless you specify a memory address QDT assumes the first memory location you want to display is at address zero w You are entering characters in data mode the usual line editing facilities are not available System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 QDT Page 2 COMMAND SUMMARY B Modify single bytes Place counter changes by 1 E Exit from QDT L Modify 32 bit Longwords Place counter changes b
139. pattern to every block on the disk writes the bad block map in the hidden area of the drive and creates a file named BADBLK SYS in account 1 2 of the first logical disk on the drive BADBLK SYS contains a copy of the bad block map for the drive If the drive has been previously formatted using CRT520 Which CRT520 options you should use depends on whether you have added new bad blocks to the drive using BADBLK since formatting the drive e If you have not added any bad blocks use the same method described above System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 CRT520 e If you have added bad blocks to the list select option 1 then choose to input information from the drive When CRT520 asks if you want to include alternate blocks answer Y BADBLK updates only the bad block map in the hidden sector of the drive so this is the only option which incorporates these blocks into the new bad block map CRT520 then continues by asking if you want to create copies of the map in disk files as described above Other methods of formatting The above methods suggest you take the defect information directly from the drive you re formatting If for some reason this is not possible you have two options e Take the information from a file if the drive has been previously formatted you may have copied the bad block information to disk files as described above You can use either the media defect list file DEF or the ba
140. program can be placed into a Task Manager control file which can be set to run every few days to keep the system clock up to date When doing this however remember to change back and forth between standard and daylight savings time in the UTC command line on the appropriate day FORMAT UTC switch modem port time zone dial prefix See the Operation section for a description of the format OPTIONS P Preserves the baud rate the computer is using to communicate with the modem port Without this switch the computer talks to the modem port at 1200 baud This is how fast the computer talks to the modem not the baud rate the modem uses on the phone line System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 UTC Page 2 OPERATION Enter UTC and the name of the terminal port to which the Hayes compatible modem is connected followed by your local time zone and optionally any dialing prefix required to access an outside phone line For example UTC MODEM1 PST 9W UTC dials the observatory retrieves the current date and time converts it from UTC Universal Time Coordinated format to your local time zone and displays that time and date If you are logged in to OPR the system date and time is also reset The modem port argument must be the name of a terminal port defined by a TRMDEF statement in your system initialization command file to which a Hayes compatible modem is connected The time zone argument lets you specify your local
141. queue blocks See your system operator about increasing or freeing system queue blocks Invalid function SET did not recognize the option you entered Check your syntax and try again Invalid job name Use STAT or SYSTAT to see the current jobnames and try again Memory module deletion failed System Commands Reference Manual Rev 10 SET Page 6 An internal error occurred Try again If the problem persists contact your System Operator 2MTSTAT SYS must be loaded into system memory when using the SET QIC commands AddaSYSTEM MTSTAT SYS command to a test copy of your system initialization file MONTST it re name it when successful and try again Network identification must be specified You did not specify a network ID in a LINK or NDV option Specified network not active Your system cannot locate the specified network No alternate languages have been defined There are no other languages available on your system at this time For information on languages see your System Operator s Guide Operation is only available in release number or higher Check your syntax and the list of options and try again Printer not found SET doesn t recognize the printer you specified Check your spelling or use PRINT or PRNT to see what printers are on your system Privileged operation must be logged into OPR Log into DSKO 1 2 and try again 2SET QIC commands are not available on AM1000 systems SET QIC comm
142. restore does not exist Your backup media contained files from a disk that does not exist on your system and your RESTOR command tried to restore to it Try again restoring files from that disk onto a disk that does exist on your system Device specified is not a supported backup device Check your entry for errors Make sure you used a colon after the device name End of media detected The table of contents for the tape indicated a file past the end of the tape trying to read the file RESTOR reached the end of the tape Not all of your files are actually on the backup tape some files included in the table of contents may not be restorable Error detected while skipping to next file This could indicate a file you were skipping over on your media has a problem See your System Operator for help Fatal error aborting device handler task This is an informative message that occurs after some other fatal error and indicates the device handling task is also aborting Fatal error illegal message code n received from device handler The main task received an error from the device handler it did not understand Try again if the problem persists see your Alpha Micro representative for help Fatal error ITC error code n See your Monitor Calls Manual for an explanation of the error code This indicates an internal communication error ask your System Operator or Alpha Micro dealer for help if this occurs frequently System
143. restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 48 11 AM Elapsed Time DBD14 19200 150 Mb gt UPD14 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 52946 Total 663950 324 194 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 48 15 AM Restori S enrere onea uh ces tate Satie Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 48 50 AM Elapsed Time Restored 0 Files DBD15 19200 150 Mb gt UPD15 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 241467 Total 905417 442 098 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 48 54 AM IRESCOLING sacs irenstea eae E REEE Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 51 37 AM Elapsed Time Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 51 37 AM Elapsed Time DBD Logicals are being uninstalled BDRES 00 00 05 807 200 Kbytes per second 00 00 22 739 795 Kbytes per second 00 00 03 00 00 56 00 00 12 00 00 35 00 02 43 00 13 36 634 000 Kbytes per second 751 366 Kbytes per second 794 292 Kbytes per second 756 371 Kbytes per second 740 696 Kbytes per second System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 BDRES BD BDRI Fou Ex 2 The program has completed SAMPLE 2 RES ES Version 8 0 101 13 Copyright 2007 nd the following possible DBD Recorders ID Description 5 SONY BDRW BWU 100A 4 HL DT STDVD RAM GSA H22N Select one of the above devices 1 DBD000 DBD001 DBD002 DBD003 DB
144. resumed again or when it can be run again after it has run Since AMOS is a multi user system most of its programs are re usable Re usable programs cannot be loaded into System Memory unless of course they are also re entrant Switch or Option Many AMOS commands and programs allow you to select among several options by including switches on a command line A switch is a slash followed by one or more characters You can sometimes include several switches on one command line The specific form switches take varies depending on the particular command Some commands expect every single character after a slash to represent a different switch e g MAP FSR others require each switch begin with a new slash e g PRINT NET BAS COPIES 2 BAN HE See the reference sheet for a particular command to see the switches for it System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Introduction to the Manual Page 1 3 Wildcard A wildcard is a special symbol appearing in a file specification Wildcards allow a file specification to represent more than one file For example the wildcard symbol in this file specification F TXT will select all TXT files whose names begin with F regardless of the rest of the file name The use of wildcard symbols varies among commands Some commands do not recognize wildcards others handle wildcards differently than do the rest of the commands on the system See a command s reference sheet to see how it handl
145. specification DSKCPY assumes you are copying between DSK devices For example if you enter 1 and 0 as the input and output drives DSKCPY assumes you want to copy from DSK1 to DSKO System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKCPY Page 2 OPTIONS H Generates a hash total for the copied disk OPERATION Log into 1 2 and enter DSKCPY LOG 1 2 DSKCPY If your disk drive permits you should now write protect the drive you are copying from this ensures you won t accidentally copy the backup disk onto your source disk DSKCPY asks you for the Input drive Enter the specification of the device you are copying FROM Now DSKCPY asks you for the Output drive Enter the specification of the device you are copying TO For example DSKCPY Input drive DSKO Output drive DSK1 Now DSKCPY makes a literal image of DSKO onto DSK1 As it copies and verifies it tells you how many blocks it is copying DSKCPY copies every block on the disk even if some blocks contain no data The amount of time it takes to perform this disk copy depends on the device MESSAGES Could not find DEVTBL entry for disk mount Please submit to Alpha Micro on a Software Performance Report the details of your use of DSKCPY CRC error during disk copy drive N block X drive N and block X are octal or hexadecimal numbers The Cyclic Redundancy Check detected a problem in data transmission First verify there is a problem by using REDALL to diagnos
146. specifies the account on DSK2 where AMOS can find the file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Chapter 4 Defaults and Wildcard Symbols If you leave out elements of a file specification most commands can fill in some of the missing information for you The assumptions commands make about missing file specification elements are called defaults The defaults a command uses depends on the specific command Each reference sheet in this manual lists the defaults used by the command if they differ from the standard system defaults STANDARD SYSTEM DEFAULTS All AMOS commands use the standard file specification defaults below Several other commands the wildcard file commands also assume additional default information e If you leave out a device and unit number from a specification AMOS assumes you want to access a file on the device you are currently logged into e If you leave out the device unit number e g DSK PA YROL LIT 23 4 AMOS uses the default unit number zero The specification above then selects file DSKO PAYROL LIT 23 4 e If you leave out the PPN AMOS uses as the default the account you are currently logged into e If you leave out a file extension the default extension depends on the command you are communicating with For example TXTFMT assumes a TXT extension ERASE assumes an empty extension The wildcard file commands handle file specification defaults differently than the rest of the commands on the
147. start the recording process 2462959 Page 4 442 098 Mb 4368 369 Mb Note that once started the recording operation can be stopped by pressing C Press RETURN to start recording or C to abort The recording process then begins As it progresses status messages are displayed Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Transferri Ng ng ng ng ng ng ng ng ng ng ng ng ng ng ng ng R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R Waiting for DV EX00 EX00 EX00 EX00 EX00 EX00 EX00 EX00 EX00 EX00 OMDANDHDUBWNHE OO EXO10 EX011 EX012 EX013 EX014 EX015 D recorder to finish writing 20928 216928 2617 36155 63972 7085 57016 17996 40664 8072 32551 3804 84153 19063 52946 241467 Ge Gane GANGES EES ra T Ga Ge Ta T se u sed sed sed sed sed sed sed sed sed sed sed sed sed sed sed sed bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc bloc Also the following information is displayed on the status line KS KS KS KS KS KS KS KS KS KS KS KS KS KS KS KS OMDANHDUBWNHE 10 11 2 13 14 L5 16 Completed of of of f OF OF of of of of of of of OF of of 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 T
148. switch and may be abbreviated UNMOUNT Unmounts the specified disk OPERATION To allow access to a removable AMD file enter XMOUNT followed by the device specification For example XMOUNT REM return XMOUNT then displays how many logicals the device contains This opens the AMD file and builds the appropriate DEVTBL and BITMAP entries in SMEM You must then use the AMOS MOUNT command to mount the desired logical drives To close and disable access to a removable AMD file enter XMOUNT U followed by the device specification For example XMOUNT U REM return This will flush any remaining unwritten data to the AMD file close the file and remove the devtbl and bitmap entries from SMEM If the AMD file is on a removable media you must ensure that the removable device has actually finished its writing process before ejecting the media Failure to allow the device to finish writing may cause loss of data or data corruption Using XMOUNT in conjunction with changing the AMD file in the AMOS disks tab of the System Configuration screen allows you to change the AMD file referenced by the AMOS device without rebooting the AMOS system SYSTEM INITIALIZATION FILE The following changes in the system initialization file may be required Load the device driver into system memory For example SYSTEM REM DVR 1 6 Do NOT add DEVTBL or BITMAP for this device to the system initialization file wv Setup SMEM if it is not already defined
149. system See your AMOS User s Guide for information on these commands WILDCARD SYMBOLS This section discusses special symbols in file specifications A basic specification selects only one file For example DSK1 CRLF M68 300 2 elects the file CRLF M68 on device DSK1 in account 300 2 Wildcard symbols allow one file specification to select several files For example ATRL selects all files in the account and device you are logged into having TXT extensions regardless of name Not all AMOS commands recognize wildcard symbols All of the commands able to process wildcards recognize the standard system wildcards In addition wildcard file commands have an advanced wildcarding ability not shared by the rest of the commands on the system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 4 2 Chapter Four STANDARD SYSTEM WILDCARD SYMBOLS x ALL Dev Matches any symbol or group of symbols in a filename or extension STOCK selects all files in your account having the name STOCK regardless of extension You may precede the with one or more symbols e g F1 M68 but within that name or extension no symbols may follow the Matches any one symbol in a filename or extension DSK M68 selects any file name of six characters ending with DSK and has an M68 extension such as PACDSK M68 DIRDSK M68 and ARTDSK M68 You may place characters before or after s If s appear at the end of a filename or exte
150. terminal input sleep external wait or message waiting status WAIT is often used in the System Initialization Command File when your jobs are being set up See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for more information FORMAT WAIT jobname OPERATION Enter WAIT and the name of the job for whom you want to wait For example WAIT JOB3 When the specified job finishes its current task you see the AMOS prompt You can now proceed with what you wanted to do MESSAGES 2 Non existent Job Check your syntax or use the SYSTAT command to see what jobs are active on your system and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 WINFLP FUNCTION Writes copies of files from Winchester disk to a floppy disk CHARACTERISTICS WINFLP is re entrant and re usable Includes the device and account specifications of the files and the date and time of backup Used with FLPWIN to copy files from a floppy to a Winchester disk and FLPDIR to display a list of files on a floppy disk Allows you to perform one backup on multiple floppy disks This program is provided for compatibility purposes You normally should use BACKUP WINELP doesn t work with extended format disks WINFLP is a wildcard file command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on wildcards Not for transferring data between Alpha Micro and non Alpha Micro computers You may back up files from any disk account onto the fl
151. than the one you are currently logged in under In order to change your user name you must first LOGOFF then LOG on under a different user name Already logged in under account You tried to log to where you are currently logged Bad password Try again and be careful with your spelling If you still have no success see your System Operator for help Command format error You made a mistake in typing in the LOG command Check your syntax and spelling and try again Disk not mounted Mount the disk and try again Error setting lock mode Insufficient queue blocks LOG could not set your file locking status because there are not enough queue blocks You are logged on but file locking is as it was See your System Operator about allocating more queue blocks System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LOG Page 4 Invalid user name The user name you specified is not defined on your system Use MUSER to display a list of valid user names for your system See your System Operator if you want to add or change a user name Nonexistent device You tried to log to an account on a device LOG cannot access the device is not defined in the DEVTBL command in your system INI file does not have a driver program in account 1 6 of your System Disk or is not file structured Use DEVTBL to see a list of currently defined devices on your system Not logged in You entered LOG to find out what account you are logged in under but
152. the CBDS and CBEN commands does not need controlling in the same way The on board cache is transparent in operation and is not affected by such programming tricks as self modifying code FORMAT COMPAT COMPAT DAT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 COMPAT Page 2 OPERATION Entering COMPAT with COMPAT DAT on the command line disables caching for the programs listed in the COMPAT DAT file In COMPAT DAT list the programs one to a line List only the program name with no file extension or account specification You can put comments in COMPAT DAT by starting a line with a semi colon Here is a sample COMPAT DAT using fictitious program names SCHDLP INIJOB This is a comment When you enter COMPAT by itself it shows statistics for each program set to run without instruction caching listing what percentage of CPU context switches are non cached For example The following programs run with internal cache disabled SCHDLP active in 1 2 of total context switches 80 of non cached INIJOB active in 0 3 of total context switches 20 of non cached A total of 1 5 of context switches were non cached MESSAGES Invalid program spec name There is an invalid program name in the COMPAT DAT file Edit the file and correct the error 2 COMPAT requires 68030 processor or better to run Your computer does not have an instruction cache you do not need to use COMPAT Cache compatibility mode is not
153. the MEMORY command Unable to write defect map error n The AM 520 or AM 522 disk controller encountered an error when writing back the modified defect map to the disk The error number is a standard DDB error in the AMOS Monitor Calls Manual You must install a SCSI dispatcher prior to using this program You must install a SCSI dispatcher for your system by using the SCZDSP command in the system command initialization file and rebooting the system You may also see several system error message if you enter an invalid device specification For example Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your entry or use DEVTBL to see a list of the valid system devices Cannot READ filespec disk not mounted Mount the disk and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BAKDIR FUNCTION Displays a list of the files on a specified backup medium Can also create a disk file containing a directory of files o The BACKUP BAKDIR and RESTOR commands are included only for compatibility with earlier operating system versions Do NOT use these commands unless absolutely necessary Use the MTUxxx commands for all tape backup and CRT620 to create warm boot tapes CHARACTERISTICS BAKDIR is re entrant and re usable The backup medium read by BAKDIR must have been previously created with the BACKUP command BAKDIR is a wildcard command i Unless you are using a VCR and T BAKDIR locks up all users on your
154. to be reported more accurately However it may slightly increase the time necessary for programs which do extensive disk I O The default value for both reads and writes is 200 You can change these values to any value in the range 0 3312 Your change lasts only until the system is rebooted or you use SETPEN again FORMAT SETPEN devn devn is the device name of the disk you want to change the penalty values for OPERATION To adjust the read write penalties type SETPEN and the name of the device you want to affect For example SETPEN DSKO This displays the current settings Enter the read penalty value you want to use and RETURN then enter the new write penalty and RETURN You may want to increase the read write penalty settings if a disk intensive job slows down other jobs indicating that its disk accesses are reducing the time allotted to them However be careful in changing these values as setting them incorrectly could decrease overall system performance My The values you enter are changed only in memory When you reboot the system the Yy penalties will return to their default values System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SETPEN Page 2 MESSAGES Error Device not found devn The device you specified could not be found Error Driver not found in system memory devn The device driver for the device you entered is not in system memory Error Drive does not support penalty enforci
155. to clear Only works with certain tape drive related problems e g drive not on line Operation switch NOTIMEOUT Don t wait for input or error condition to clear Abort MTUSAV under control of SOFTABORT Default operation switch TMSYMBOL Include the error type symbol either or at the beginning of displayed messages Default operation switch NOTMS YMBOL Do not include the error type symbol at the beginning of messages Generally used only in control files to avoid Task Manager automatic error aborts Operation switch VERIFY After performing backup rewind tape read files and compare to disk files to verify the data Displays any errors on the screen Does not work when backing up across a network Operation switch VONLY Do not back up verify only Used to verify a previous backup or if a combined backup Verification is interrupted Displays any errors on the screen Does not work when used across a network Operation switch System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 4 OPERATION The rest of this reference sheet describes how to use MTUSAV It starts with basic instructions on entering the command itself then talks about recommended backup procedures using command files and Task Manager control files to automate backups and finally discusses MTUSAV s extensive error reporting and how you can adjust it to your situation Basic Use Before backing up make sure the tape is not wr
156. up at the same time by the same command is known as a save set A save set can extend to more than one reel of tape spanning Tape spanning is not allowed during a backup controlled by the Task y Only some tape drive tape combinations support multi reel backups also called tape N Manager as there is no way to signal when to change the tape MTUSAV records the disk file specification date and reel number on the tape along with the file However it does not transfer any account password when backing up across an AlphaNET network it also does not record the CPU ID of the source computer MTUSAV is not for transfer of data between AMOS and non AMOS computer systems MTUSAV sets the JOBERR field in your job s JCB If there are no errors or warnings JOBERR is zero otherwise it is non zero In a command file you can check the JOBERR field using the IF command immediately following MTUSAV Error processing is explained in detail below System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV FORMAT Page 2 MTUSAV cpulID filespec filespec switches cpuID is an AlphaNET network identification number the filespec s specify the files you want to back up and switches are one or more option requests DEFAULTS The default file specification is and the account and device you are logged into OPTIONS Except as noted the switches are file switches All may be abbreviated to any unique characters Defaults are note
157. versions but welcomes user feedback of any problems Interlink Systems Inc SuperDisk Soft Machines Inc FOLDERS U A Systems Inc AlphaLAN Alpha Base Systems Inc AlphaBASE and Metropolis ProVUE Development Inc SuperVUE al It is not possible to consistently locate SuperVUE modules by looking in system files If AS p y p y 81n sy ww SuperVUE is installed in a different account than DSKO 1 20 AMSCFG will not find the files Any trademarks are the property of their respective holders FOLDER devices do not affect the figures for disk capacity for the logical device on which the folder resides or for total disk space The logical s disk capacity and free space counts reflect the fact that FOLDER is an allocated contiguous file and so takes up room on the logical unit The fact that the FOLDER may contain free space is not germane to the logical s statistics The IDV and TDV switches report on only those drivers that are actually in use by physical terminals on the system Drivers attached to the appropriate system chain but not referenced through the terminal definition chain are not reported on in detail AMSCFG cannot tell from where a particular file has been loaded AMSCFG always assumes the Alpha Microsystems specified default If you have loaded a file from a different account or renamed or copied a file to a different name AMSCFG may incorrectly report a setting AMSCFG does however always display the unambigu
158. was last rebooted S Statistics Display The display you would normally see from any account MESSAGES VDK does not exist The VDK system was not installed when your system was booted See your System Operator to make the appropriate changes to the system command initialization file to load the VDK system on bootup System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VER FUNCTION Displays the name and version number of your system CHARACTERISTICS VER is re entrant and re usable VER is also used in the system initialization command line to unlock keyboards after bootup See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for more information OPERATION Enter VER at AMOS level For example VER AMOS L Version 2 0 304 2 up and running System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 VERIFY FUNCTION Verifies the file s transferred in a system disk copy were correctly copied CHARACTERISTICS VERIFY is re entrant and re usable When you receive software from Alpha Micro the media containing that software includes a file with a name similar to the product and a DIR extension for example for AMOS releases the file is called AMOS DIR This file contains the names version numbers and hash totals for all the files included on that release After you have loaded the software unto your system you can run VERIFY which compares the software now on your system with the directory
159. you are not logged in This message is also seen when you try to execute a command that can t be run unless you are logged in User name is a remote user only and may not log in to this system You cannot log into the system you tried to log into See your System Operator if you need information about the network Unable to locate requested language Your user definition specifies a language not defined on your system Either use a different user name to log in or see your System Operator about defining that language or changing your user definition to an available language System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LOGOFF FUNCTION Logs you off the system CHARACTERISTICS LOGOFF is re entrant and re usable Use LOGOFF if you leave your terminal for any length of time this prevents other users from using your terminal to access your files LOGOFF resets your default device to DSKO LOGOFF also resets the flags in your job table to ECHO OCTAL NODSKERR NOVERIFY and NOGUARD See the SET reference sheet for an explanation of these flags You may only use a few AMOS commands when logged off such as ATTACH SYSTEM HELP LOG LOGON SYSTAT MEMORY DATE TIME and SET LOGOFF deletes any memory modules in your memory partition as it logs you off the system It updates the accounting information that tells how much computer time you used This information can be viewed using the MUSER program OPERATION Enter LOGOF
160. you must remember to pad with blanks or other characters keys smaller than this size Position of key Enter the location of the key within the data record Enter the number of the first character position in the record the key occupies Size of data record Specify in bytes the size of the records in the data file or the maximum size in the case of variable length records Number of records to allocate Number of records which the data file is to contain 5 Empty index blocks to allocate Enter the number of additional empty index blocks you want to allocate Primary Directory If you are creating a data file primary index file combination enter Y otherwise enter N Secondary index to file If you are creating a secondary index file instead of a data file primary index file combination ISMBLD prompts you for the specification of the primary index file to which this secondary index file cross indexes After you supply this information ISMBLD returns you to AMOS command level Data File Device ISMBLD asks this question if you are creating a data file primary index file combination If the index file and data file are to be on the same device just press RETURN otherwise enter the specification of the device on which the data file is to reside Once ISMBLD has created a new data primary index file combination it enters file loading mode It asks you which file you want to lo
161. you to confirm you wish to enter the PIC and if so tests the PIC for correctness Once the PIC is confirmed you can continue the installation MESSAGES PIC code does not verify will need actual error Check to be sure you entered the correct number If problems persist contact your Alpha Micro representative System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 PARITY FUNCTION Turns on parity error detection for most Alpha Micro memory boards and Central Processing Units CHARACTERISTICS PARITY is re entrant and re usable Most Alpha Micro memory boards and CPUs have a parity error detection capability which you can turn on by using PARITY For more information see your Alpha Micro Integrated Systems User s Guide If you don t use PARITY the boards are not able to detect and report parity errors You will probably want to put PARITY in your system initialization command file For information on editing the system initialization file see your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File OPERATION Enter PARITY at AMOS command level PARITY MESSAGES See your System Operator s Guide for information on what happens when a parity error occurs and how to handle such a situation System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 PASS FUNCTION Changes your current account password CHARACTERISTICS PASS is re entrant and re usable Protects system security b
162. you want information about OPERATION Enter FREE and the specification of the disk you want information about For example FREE DSK2 9414 free blocks 9410 blocks in largest free contiguous space MESSAGES File specification error Check your syntax or use the DEVTBL command to see what devices are defined on your system and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 FWUPD FUNCTION Switches the firmware in the flash ROM of the AM 627 tape drive between SCSI 1 and SCSI 2 versions You should use SCSI 2 with the AM 190 board for maximum performance CHARACTERISTICS FWUPD works only from the system operator account DSKO 1 2 Once you use FWUPD to update the AM 627 to SCSI 2 it is not compatible with CPU boards earlier than the AM 190 To use the tape drive with an earlier CPU you must convert the firmware back to SCSI 1 FORMAT FWUPD DVR file file is TSCZ2 to update to SCSI 2 firmware or TSCZ1 to convert back to SCSI 1 firmware OPERATION To update an AM 627 to SCSI 2 enter the following commands LOG OPR FWUPD DVR TSCZ2 FWUPD asks you for the name of the device Type Enter target devic e g STRO STRO FWUPD then updates the firmware this takes about a minute After the AMOS prompt re appears you need to power the computer down and then up again for the new firmware to take effect If you need to return the AM 627 to SCSI 1 operation follow the same
163. your System Operator s Guide for more about file protection The name of the language specified in this field must be one of the languages available as part of the system The default is ENGLSH System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 MUSER Prompt May be up to 19 characters in length Default is a period If PROMPT SYS is loaded in system memory you may use any of the following symbols to display variable information as part of the prompt This is called an interpreted prompt and may result in a displayed prompt longer than 19 characters Current device and drive number C Sends TCRT 2 E Ersatz name of current account If none same as P LG Name of current language Z gt Same as NI NP NB Baud rate Z Z J w Terminal driver name Z Interface driver name Job name Z lt Modem driver name Z ge Interface driver port number in decimal Z n Operating system name L A L FR F FFE SF Z Z G User name P Account number in brackets SC AlphaNET cpu ID SE Ersatz name for AlphaNET cpu ID If none same as SC SV Monitor version UF Free memory in user partition in KB UM Total memory in user partition in KB UX Radix H for hexadecimal O for octal VB Set to bright display VD Set to dim display You can also change the AMOS prompt using the SET command See the SET reference sheet for more information about interprete
164. 0 DBD088 20480 DBD089 20480 DBD090 20480 DBD091 20480 DBD092 20480 DBD093 20480 DBD094 20480 DBD095 20480 DBD096 20480 DBD097 20480 DBD098 20480 DBD099 20480 DBD100 20480 DBD101 20480 DBD102 20480 DBD103 20480 DBD104 20480 DBD105 20480 DBD106 20480 DBD107 20480 DBD108 20480 DBD109 20480 DBD110 20480 DBD111 20480 DBD112 20480 DBD113 20480 DBD114 20480 DBD115 20480 DBD116 20480 DBD117 20480 DBD118 20480 DBD119 20480 DBD120 20480 DBD121 20480 DBD122 20480 DBD123 20480 DBD124 20480 DBD125 20480 DBD126 20480 DBD127 20480 DBD128 20480 DBD129 20480 DBD130 20480 DBD131 20480 DBD132 20480 DBD133 20480 DBD134 20480 DBD135 20480 DBD136 20480 1972 08 18220 12343 3 61 4979 20928 216928 2617 36155 63972 7085 57016 17996 40664 8072 32591 3804 84153 19063 52946 241467 205991 11803 5940 190 2340 635 2995 6914 1268 175355 1425 482 663 12347 18993 267 906 2067 LTA 3s 17914 1866 1192 5933 190 2339 634 2995 6913 1268 KEFA 1431 482 663 12256 18992 242 9060 2067 LDS 17835 1865 11894 9932 19 2334 634 2995 6914 1268 1754 143 654 663 12258 18993 226 890 2062 1773 18633 760 2260 8137 20119 15501 286272 90272 304583 271045 243228 300115 250
165. 0 to create warm boot tapes HINTS RESTRICTIONS Used in combination with STRSAV to write disk files to tape and STRDIR to display a list of files on a tape Only reads tapes created by the STRSAV command Not for transferring data between Alpha Micro and non Alpha Micro computers If your system contains both traditional format and extended disks you must be logged on to the same type of disk when you use STRRES that you were when you created the tape using STRSAV While STRSAV does work on extended disks in certain situations we strongly suggest you use BACKUP to back up extended disks You may not copy to a disk account other than the account you are currently logged into unless you are logged into an operator s account 1 2 If you are in 1 2 and you specify an account that does not exist STRRES creates that account You may copy files into the account you are logged into from any other account regardless of project number or device specification STRRES is a wildcard command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on using wildcard commands The input specification must give the exact specification of the files you want to transfer from the 1 4 streamer cartridge including device and account specifications of the files as they were written to the tape The output specification allows you to specify the device and account the files are to be written to on the disk and to rename the files as they are written out to the disk
166. 02 E AM 8000 EAMOS Release eeeeeeeeee DBD003 307200 36155 271045 9200 EAD8 2 blk REX003 E CD AMOS Release 01 31 2006 DBD004 307200 63972 243228 9200 10E28 0 blk REX004 E AlphaTCP 1 5A Source amp Release DBD005 307200 7085 300115 9200 14CA1l 3 blk REX005 E AlphaNET 2 4 159 4 Rel amp Src DBD006 307200 57016 250184 9200 1538D 3 blk REX006 E AlphaFAX 2 1 100 1 Rel amp Src DBD007 307200 17996 289204 9200 18B3C 2 blk REX007 E MULTI 2 1 192 10 rEL amp SRC 0e DBD008 307200 40664 266536 9200 19CD0 1 blk REX008 E AlphaODBC 1 0 100 Rel amp Src DBD009 307200 8072 299128 9200 1C487 0 blk REX009 E AlphaMAIL 1 2B PR09 05 eeeeeeeeeeee DBD010 307200 32551 274649 9200 1CC69 3 blk REX010 E Xadmin Release amp INIS eeeeeeeee DBD011 307200 3804 303396 9200 1EC34 1 blk REX011 E Command amp Do Files ss 5504 DBD012 307200 84153 223047 9200 1EFEC 0 blk REX012 E Open Logical REX12 eeeeeeeeeeees DBD013 307200 19063 288137 9200 2421B 0 blk REX013 E AMPC 7 0 Release eo diah Cees KAAS heuk DBD014 307200 52946 254254 9200 254B9 2 blk REX014 E AlphaODBC 1 0 100 Rel amp Src ver 1 4Y DBD015 307200 241467 65733 9200 2886E 3 blk REX015 E Open Logical REX15 i e eeeeeeeee reece Pra Se aaa BHa 0 C Ks S4sS S e BITMAP SECTOR ORESET DEV yes Sao SS SSS SSS SS Sn Sa SSS SS SSS SSeS SETEME To
167. 0928 Total 20928 10 219 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 40 37 AM Restoring se ti sity een eel ae eee Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 40 51 AM Elapsed Time 00 00 14 747 429 Kbytes per second DBD1 19200 150 Mb gt UPD1 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 216928 Total 237856 116 141 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 40 57 AM REStOLING as inea leche ns tehee R Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 43 20 AM Elapsed Time 00 02 23 758 490 Kbytes per second System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 BDRES Page 4 DBD2 19200 150 Mb gt UPD2 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 2617 Total 240473 117 418 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 43 24 AM RESCOTING saves itis reves eels cones eae renee Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 43 26 AM Elapsed Time 00 00 02 654 250 Kbytes per second DBD3 19200 150 Mb gt UPD3 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 36155 Total 276628 135 072 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 43 29 AM RESLOPING oscena an d heh ebidaie Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 43 53 AM Elapsed Time 00 00 24 753 229 Kbytes per second DBD4 19200 150 Mb gt UPD4 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 63972 Total 340600 166 309 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 43 58
168. 15 disk controller CRT520 writes a format data pattern to every block of the device so make sure you back up any data you need on that device before you format it CRT520 DESTROYS ALL DATA ON THE DRIVE IT IS FORMATTING CRT520 requires you be logged into the System Operator s account DSKO 1 2 CRT520 creates account 1 2 on each logical unit of the disk you are certifying Then it creates a file BADBLK SYS 1 2 on logical device 0 containing a list of all bad disk blocks and media flaws on the certified device This BADBLK file is a copy of a built in file on the AM 520 and is therefore not essential to your system Use CRT520 ONLY on devices controlled by the AM 520 Disk Controller CRT520 communicates directly with the AM 520 Disk Controller without going through the AM 520 driver program Therefore you MUST NOT run CRT520 at the same time as other programs that access devices under control of the same AM 520 board CRT520 locks up or severely slows down other users on your system warn them before using FORMAT CRT520 devn devn is the specification of the device you want to format System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CRT520 Page 2 OPERATION If you are not familiar with the way the AM 520 handles media defects you may want to read Installation Instructions AM 520 Intelligent Disk Controller PDI 00520 00 before using CRT520 Enter CRT520 followed by the specification of the device you want
169. 153 ji 154 m 155 n 156 o 157 p 160 q 161 r 162 s 163 t 164 u 165 v 166 Ww 167 x 170 y 171 Z 172 173 174 175 176 DEL 177 PAD 200 HOP 201 BPH 202 NBH 203 IND 204 NEL 205 SSA 206 ESA 207 HTS 210 HTJ 211 VTS 212 PLD 213 PLU 214 RI 215 SS2 216 SS3 217 DCS 220 PU1 221 PU2 222 STS 223 Octal Decimal Value 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 145 146 147 Hex Value 5C 5D 5E SF 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 6A 6B 6C 6D 6E 6F 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 7A 7B 7C 7D 7E TF 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 8A 8B 8C 8D 8E 8F 90 91 92 93 ISO IEC 10646 1 1993 E and Unicode 2 0 Name Reverse Solidus Right Square Bracket Circumflex Accent Low Line Grave Accent Latin Small Letter A Latin Small Letter B Latin Small Letter C Latin Small Letter D Latin Small Letter E Latin Small Letter F Latin Small Letter G Latin Small Letter H Latin Small Letter I Latin Small Letter J Latin Small Letter K Latin Small Letter L Latin Small Letter M Latin Small Letter N Latin Small Letter O Latin Small Letter P Latin Small Letter Q Latin Small Letter R Latin Small Letter S Latin Small Letter T Latin Small Letter U Latin Small Letter V
170. 184 289204 266536 299128 274649 303396 223047 288137 254254 65733 1842009 8677 4540 20290 8140 9845 7485 3566 9212 8727 9055 9998 9817 8133 1487 20213 1419 8413 8707 2566 8614 8559 4547 20290 8141 9846 7485 3567 9212 8727 9049 9998 9817 8224 1488 20238 1420 8413 8707 2645 8615 8586 4548 20289 8146 9846 7485 3566 9212 8726 9049 9826 9817 8222 1487 20254 1579 8418 8707 1847 1280 1280 1280 1280 1280 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 9200 128001 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 280 16B9E 17EE1 190AC 19CBB 19D16 1A1F3 1B664 28A3D 28CCC 2B01B 2EE95 2F581 32D30 33EC4 3667A 36E5D 38E28 391DF 3E40E 3F6AD 42A62 51632 SDF5C SEAE4 SFOB1 SFOE2 5SF32B SF3CB SF6B8 5FD7A SFEB7 6006E 601D3 6024D 602F3 60F03 62190 621D3 62AAD 62CB3 62E6F 63FEE 641C1 64D66 65332 65362 655AC 6564B 65939 65FFA 66137 662EE 66455 664CE 66575 6716D 683FA 68437 68D1 68F17 690D3 6A23E 6A41 6AFAF 6B57B 6B5AC
171. 2 4 91 LNKLIT FUNCTION Creates executable machine language programs by linking and resolving one or more assembled object files CHARACTERISTICS LNKLIT is re entrant and re usable When you use M68 to assemble an assembly language program the OBJ file that results is in an intermediate form that is not ready for execution Separate OBJ files may contain symbol references to each other that cannot be fully resolved because these files cannot be assembled together LNKLIT is a linkage editor that links together and resolves several OBJ files to produce an OVR or LIT program file If the program you assembled with M68 was made up of only one file that contains no internal or external symbol references M68 automatically calls LNKLIT for you as Phase 4 of the assembly to produce a program file Otherwise you must use LNKLIT yourself to link the OBJ files that will make up the single LIT file LNKLIT links files together in the order in which you specify them on the LNKLIT command line LNKLIT does not produce a program file if one or more of the files you specify is not found in its assembled object OBJ form LNKLIT supports the use of object file libraries see the LIBLIT reference sheet for information on library files For more information on LNKLIT and assembly programming see your Assembly Language Programmer s Manual It also contains information on library optional and load map files FORMAT LNKLIT switch file
172. 2 2 4 91 ISMDMP Page 2 OPTIONS IN Use Counted Update Mode instead of Exclusive Open Mode For information on Counted Update and Exclusive Open Mode see your SAM System User s Guide OPERATION Enter ISMDMP followed by the specification of the ISAM file whose contents you want to see For example ISMDMP ADDRSS Now ISMDMP asks you for the file to output the data to If you want to see the file on your terminal type TTY RETURN otherwise enter the name of the file you want the data in ISMDMP displays the number of data records it wrote to the file You can now use the TYPE or PRINT commands to display the file or AlphaVUE to examine the file Your JSAM System User s Guide discusses the elements of the ISMDMP display in detail Several of the items of information in the upper portion of the display are parameters that you supply when you used ISMBLD to build the ISAM file for example Size of data record Size of key etc Some of the other important elements of this display are 1 Size of dir entry Amount of storage needed to store key key rounded up to even 4 Size of dir block 512 bytes 2 3 Type of key Always zero 4 Blocking factor This value gives the number of logical data records that fit into each physical disk block This number gives the blocking factor for the data file and is thus 512 record size IDA freelist pointer A longword pointer into the data file
173. 20 3 blk TSTO16 E 231424 60 231364 4464 230 2 blk TSTO17 E 231424 60 231364 4464 240 blk TST018 E 231424 60 231364 4464 250 0 blk TST019 E 1048576 183837 864739 65537 25F 3 blk NEWOOO E 20480 Zla 20459 280 B5E7 3 blk ACC000 E 20480 Lab IA 7709 280 B5ED 3 blk ACC001 E 20480 18477 2003 280 C267 1 blk ACC002 E 20480 6545 3935 280 D473 1 blk ACC003 E 20480 5723 4757 280 DAD8 1 blk ACC004 E 20480 12079 8401 280 E06F 3 blk ACC005 E 20480 6926 3554 280 EC3C 1 blk ACCO06 E 20480 2106 8374 280 F300 2 blk ACC007 E 20480 5925 4555 280 F50F 3 blk ACC008 E 20480 3000 7480 280 FAD9 3 blk ACCO09 E 20480 6914 3566 280 FDC8 2 blk ACCO10 E 20480 1268 9212 280 0489 3 blk ACC011 E 20480 1759 8721 4 280 O5C7 2 bik ACCOIL2 amp 20480 564 9916 280 0780 0 blk ACC013 E 20480 216 20264 280 080D 3 blk ACC014 E 20480 2065 8415 280 0844 2 blk ACCO15 E 20480 90T 9373 280 0A49 2 blk ACC016 E 20480 154 20326 280 0B2D 0 blk ACC017 E 20480 529 9951 280 0B54 1 blk ACC018 E 20480 537 9943 280 0BD9 1 blk ACC019 E 20480 1401 9079 280 0c60 1 blk ACC020 E 20480 1820 8660 280 ODBF 1 blk ACCO21 E 20480 638 9842 280 OF87 0 blk ACC022 E 20480 1032 9448 280 1027 1 blk ACC023 E 20480 1051 9429 280 112A 0 blk ACC024 E 20480 178 20302 280 1231 2 blk ACC025 E 20480 4701 STII 280 125E 3 blk ACC026 E 20480 12347 8133 280 16F6 3 blk ACC027
174. 2007 02 02 50 PM n restored Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 15 36 PM Date amp Time Files have b Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 15 36 PM n restored Date amp Time Files have b Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 16 59 PM n restored Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 16 59 PM Files Date amp Time Files have b Date amp Time Restored 0 Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 16 59 PM DBD Logicals are being uninstalled The program has completed Restored 6 Files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 ENTERED DBD71 19200 150 Mb gt UPD10 19200 150 Restored 1 Files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 ENTERED DBD72 19200 150 Mb gt UPD11 19200 150 Restored 0 Files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 ENTERED DBD73 19200 150 Mb gt UPD12 19200 150 Restored 0 Files File Name Mask _LTT 001 004 ENTERED DBD74 19200 150 Mb gt UPD13 19200 150 Restored 267 Files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 ENTERED DBD75 19200 150 Mb gt UPD14 19200 150 Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 16 59 PM Elapsed Ti Restored 4 Files File Name Mask _LIT 001 004 ENTERED DBD76 19200 150 Mb gt UPD15 19200 150 Elapsed Ti Elapsed Ti Elapsed Time Wx Restored
175. 27 753 037 Kbytes per second DBD9 19200 150 Mb gt UPD9 19200 150 Mb System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 5 Used Blocks 8072 Total 471433 230 192 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 46 18 AM REStOTING netaat eei eee EEE Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 46 23 AM Elapsed Time DBD10 19200 150 Mb gt UPD10 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 32551 Total 503984 246 086 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 46 27 AM Restoring eieiaeo nnee oee ee Ea ae i Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 46 49 AM Elapsed Time DBD11 19200 150 Mb gt UPD11 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 3804 Total 507788 247 943 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 46 52 AM R storiNg is che oe en teen eia Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 46 55 AM Elapsed Time DBD12 19200 150 Mb gt UPD12 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 84153 Total 591941 289 034 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 46 59 AM ReStorin series ata hun tia tee Logical has been restored amp remounted Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 47 55 AM Elapsed Time DBD13 19200 150 Mb gt UPD13 19200 150 Mb Used Blocks 19063 Total 611004 298 342 Mb Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 11 47 59 AM REStOLING es act erene ees eee tanta Logical has been
176. 3 Files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 ENTERED DBD70 19200 150 Mb gt UPD9 19200 150 Mb Elapsed Time Wx Mb Elapsed Time Wx Mb Elapsed Time Wx Mb Elapsed Time Wx Mb Elapsed Time Wx Mb me Wx b 00 01 31 LIT 1 4 00 00 01 LIT 1 4 00 00 01 LIT 1 4 00 00 00 LIT 1 4 00 00 00 LIT 1 4 00 12 46 LIT 1 4 00 01 23 LIT 1 4 00 00 00 00 31 47 Page 10 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 11 BDRES REQUIREMENTS AND SETUP DBD requires the following e AM 8000 Eagle 800 or AMPC 7 X based systems e AMOS 8 1 or later e Asupported DVD RAM or Blu ray drive o BDRES is only supported on AM 8000 Eagle 800 and AMPC 7 X Systems The DBD package contains the following required files e DBD LIT The device driver DBD DVR for the DVD RAM and Blu ray drive in system memory The SSD overlay file DVD000 OVR MAKBD LIT DIRBD LIT BDRES LIT MODIFYING THE SYSTEM INITIALIZATION FILE You must load the device driver into system memory during system initialization by adding the following statement in your system initialization file SYSTEM DSKO DBD DVR 1 6 This statement should be added in the same area of the system initialization file that is currently loading other system device drivers MESSAGES Command line syntax messages e Invalid switch e Invalid switch optio
177. 37498 93926 4464 D5D96 3 blk UPD006 E No Label DBD165 231424 25669 205755 4464 D8236 0 blk UPD007 E No Label DBD166 231424 46682 84742 4464 D9B48 0 blk UPD008 E No Label DBD167 231424 12575 218849 4464 DC8DF blk UPD009 E No Label DBD168 231424 105815 25609 4464 DD527 3 blk UPDO10 E No Label DBD169 231424 82987 48437 4464 E3C7E blk UPDO11 E DB COD 226 222 016 212 7 5 180 DBD170 231424 167523 63901 4464 E8D89 3 blk UPD012 E No Label DBD171 231424 37236 94188 4464 F3123 blk UPD013 E No Label DBD172 231424 11755 219669 4464 F5581 0 blk UPD014 E No Label DBD173 231424 16106 215318 4464 F60FC 2 blk UPDO15 E No Label DBD174 231424 92088 39336 4464 F70B7 3 blk UPD016 E 7 4 Flip Source amp Others 05 DBD175 231424 132169 99255 4464 FCAA6 2 blk UPDO17 E No Label DBD176 231424 101411 30013 4464 104BB9 2 blk UPDO18 E No Label DBD177 231424 72597 58827 4464 10AEC3 0 blk UPDO19 E No Label Fee aB B L 0 C K S BITMAP SECTOR OFFSET DEV L 93 34 9395353353355 5 5555555555 ITEM Total lt Used Free words SOL 3 SOL SPEC T L A B E L TOTAL 23412736 4445326 18967410 Media Label NIGHTLY BACKUP ALL DEVICES
178. 38 DVR _ SIM138 SYS al If your computer uses CMOS boot settings and your system disk is not at SCSI ID 0 the S system disk driver must be a driver created with FIXLOG for that SCSI ID Then WRMGEN asks for the Number of logical units Ifyou do not have a self configuring disk or if the disk driver was created with FIXLOG this question will not appear If you have a self configuring disk Bitmap size is the next question WRMGEN asks fora Language definition table name The default is DSKO filename LDF 1 6 Next WRMGEN asks for the SCSI dispatcher Enter the name of the simple SCSI dispatcher for your computer or if your system doesn t use a dispatcher Then WRMGEN asks for your System terminal interface driver Enter at least the filename of your system terminal interface driver such as AM318 The rest of the filespec defaults to DSKO filename IDV 1 6 Then enter your System terminal interface port number The default value is zero WRMGEN asks for the System terminal interface baud rate You must enter the actual baud rate such as 9600 These baud rates are documented in your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File The default is 19200 Next the program prompts you for the System terminal driver Enter at least the file name of your system terminal driver such as ALPHA The rest of the filespec will default to DSKO filename TDV 1 6 System Commands Reference Manual Rev
179. 40DVR DVR must be in either system or user memory to use 640INI OPERATION You need to use 640INI only after warm booting your computer from a mag tape If your system meets the requirements for 640INI create a warm boot tape containing AM640 MIC 640DVR DVR and 640INI LIT added to the system memory partition list When you warm boot using this tape after you see the Up and running message type 640INI You should see the message Microcode initialization successful You can now read file structured tapes on your mag tape drive MESSAGES 2640DVR DVR expected to be in memory 640INI requires 640DVR DVR in system memory Load the file into memory and try again Driver does not contain an initialization routine The copy of 640DVR DVR in system memory has somehow been corrupted and 640INI cannot find and read the initialization routine You need to find a clean copy of 640DVR DVR and load it into system memory System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 640INI Page 2 Error during initialization A problem occurred during microcode initialization and the process could not complete Make sure AM640 MIC is available in memory or in DSKO 1 6 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 Appendix A Character Sets AMOS uses a single byte character set Such a character set can represent 256 different characters The character set is aligned with a number of international standards A SHORT HISTORY OF CHARACTER SE
180. 440 Mb os Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 09 41 00 A RESTOL NG w sssssu waa hesti bo Se sa wee BS Sib eid SOS Sabue Ve 5 0 o Se Savane wes SYS Logical has been restored amp remounted e Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 09 54 23 AM Elapse Time 00 13 23 DVD5 56320 440 Mb gt TST5 56320 440 Mb hF Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 09 54 23 AM REST OTN elira ahatea a E ra e a T bie aa co a dan Silos aeaa a a Ea je bose na a Logical has been restored amp remounted asa Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 10 07 44 AM Elapse Time 00 13 21 DVD6 56320 440 Mb gt TST6 56320 440 Mb JRE Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 10 07 44 A RESTO ENG ouea diy Wl bis a Mets E A dar ieee sade Beas had ais ie Vo e aoa Logical has been restored amp remounted wae Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 10 21 00 AM Elapse Time 00 13 16 DVD7 56320 440 Mb gt TST7 56320 440 Mb kata Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 10 21 00 A RESEO PING sirada aa Ne Buster eratey de Sudtouraney A Saeietete cre A Sid eee ha thea 4 6 odes Logical has been restored amp remounted System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 Page 5 DVDRES Ses Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 10 34 15 AM Elapse Time 00 13 15 DVD8 56320 440 Mb gt TST8 56320 440 Mb S65 Date amp Time n 18 Sep 2006 10 34 15 A RES EO PARI E EEE E E E ieee ea ine E dete Seda SS aban besa de
181. 446 and AM 447 displays messages for all event types IS Suppresses the email message sent when the program starts IZ Monitor events from the beginning of the RAID log file Otherwise when RADMON restarts it begins checking events from the point where it left off The O R and Z switches are generally used only when a problem is suspected or known and you need more diagnostic information They work only with the AM 446 and AM 447 subsystems not the earlier AM 445 RAID Controller OPERATION RADMON tuns on a background job attached to a pseudo terminal There is no reason to run it on a real terminal unless debugging a RADMON installation since it sends all important messages to the system operator s terminal Follow the steps below to set up RADMON If you want more information about any part of the initialization file see the System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File System Commands Reference Manual Rev 13 RADMON 10 11 12 Page 2 If you want to use e mail notification you must have AlphaMAIL and AlphaTCP s SMTPD installed and be able to send mail from AlphaMAIL to the intended Internet mail user Run MUSER and add a user name to uniquely identify the RADMON job on this computer This will be the FROM name on any mail message RADMON sends Allocate a mailbox for the user name you ve just created Refer to your mail package documentation for instructions Log in as t
182. 46 2800 93D58 2 blk DSKO10 E Metropolis Source from Barry on 08 23 05 DBD149 204800 47953 56847 2800 957DD 3 blk DSKO11 E Backup of ANDO World Fence News DSKO DBD150 204800 50552 54248 2800 986B2 3 blk DSK012 E AlphaTCP 1 5A Release amp Source WIP JC DBD151 204800 134200 70600 2800 9B811 2 blk DSKO13 E D SOFT SOURCE WIP eeee eee ee eeee DBD152 204800 35733 69067 2800 A3B20 1 blk DSKO14 E SSD Stuf for AMOS Systems 44 DBD153 204800 28233 76567 2800 A5E06 1 blk DSK015 E D SOFT SOURCE WIP CONT 000 DBD154 204800 28736 76064 2800 A7999 1 blk DSK016 E Backup Copy of amd_files Jose amd DBD155 204800 64765 40035 2800 A95AA 0 blk DSK017 E ISAM TESTING LOGICAL eeeeeeeee DBD156 204800 54594 50206 2800 AD4EA 0 blk DSK018 E CD Update AlphaFAX 2 1 100 8 DBD157 204800 100907 03893 2800 BOA3B 1 blk DSKO019 E OPEN LOGICAL vens pudea aes tea Takke ee HENS DBD158 231424 151778 79646 4464 B6CC6 3 blk UPD000 E METROPOLIS SOURCE FILES MET00 MET19 DBD159 231424 87003 44421 4464 C0100 0 blk UPDOO1 E No Label DBD160 231424 86383 45041 4464 C55F7 2 blk UPD002 E No Label DBD161 231424 82310 49114 4464 CAA54 0 blk UPD003 E No Label DBD162 231424 70025 61399 4464 CFAB6 blk UPD004 E No Label DBD163 231424 31219 200205 4464 D3F19 blk UPD005 E No Label DBD164 231424
183. 6 7 Header failed though sector matched Data field error The AM 520 couldn t read data and ECC failed in trying to correct Sector not found Sector overrun Check if bytes per sector is set correctly on drive No data synch FIFO data lost Indicates failure of data path between AM 520 and paddle cards Reserved for future use Indicates recoverable error For example an error 4 message indicates the third bit is set 100 binary and the problem is a sector overrun Unable to read defect map in internal format Reading Manufacturer s Media defect list When instructed to input the media defect list from the drive CRT520 first tries to recover the list from the copy in the hidden area of the drive If the drive has not been previously formatted this list does not exist and it reads the information from the manufacturer s media defect list This is the normal operation when formatting a drive for the first time System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CRT520 Page 6 Unable to read existing Bad Block Map The AM 520 was unable to read the Bad Block Map from the disk when requested to do so Try again using a media defect list or inputting the bad block map from a file Unable to read Manufacturer s Media defect list While reading the manufacturer s media defect list ten consecutive tracks were unrecoverable At this point CRT520 assumes the list is not readable and aborts the operation Try
184. ACKS TOTAL previous track gt next S stop P play E eject disk space pause C exit I If you want to run another program while listening to the CD press CTRLYC You return to Ss the AMOS prompt and the CD ROM drive continues to play You can re enter the PLAYCD command at any time allowing you to change tracks eject the disc stop the audio etc System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PLAYCD __Page 2 If you enter the PLAYCD command when you don t have a CD ROM drive attached to your computer you see this message Free SCSI IDs xx XX XX Connect a CD ROM drive with its SCSI ID set to one of the above IDs Press RETURN when ready Connect the CD ROM drive to the SCSI bus and press to play a CD or press TRLYC to return to AMOS command level MESSAGES AlphaCD is installed please uninstall ACD before using PLAYCD PLAYCD has detected that an AlphaCD CD ROM is still installed on the system Use ACD U to unmount the AlphaCD before using PLAYCD CD ROM drive reported an unknown error Sense n The CD ROM drive encountered an error Check that the CD is undamaged and free from scratches Impossible error this CD contains no tracks On querying the CD ROM for its table of contents the CD ROM reported that it is empty No free SCSI addresses you must remove at least one SCSI device in order to use PLAYCD All SCSI addresses on the SCSI bus are in use and none of them contains a CD ROM As
185. AMOS is concerned System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LOKUTL C F H L Page 2 Close a File for a User Unlocks a file and releases all its records LOKUTL asks you for the job name and file ID shown on the File Sequence Display see the F command below As in the command above the file is not CLOSEd as far as AMOS is concerned List Data Base Sorted by File ID Allows you to see the same information as the U command but sorted in a different order Instead of showing you the files being used by each job this command shows you which jobs are accessing each file List LOKUTL commands List Lock options Lists jobs filespecs and job filespec combinations that have locking turned off M Monitor File Locking Operation O Q R S U Gives you a dynamic display of the data base The display is the same as you see from any normal account except that it is updated whenever AMOS services a request or every 50 seconds to reflect the current file lock status of each job At the bottom of your screen you see the word Waiting LOKUTL prints one dot after this word every second until it renews the display When you are ready to stop press CTRLC Set Lock options Turn locking ON or OFF for jobs filespecs or job filespec combinations Quit Returns you to AMOS command level when you are finished using LOKUTL Unlock a Record for a User Unlocks a specific record in a random file LOKUTL asks you f
186. AMOS level LOGON LOGON displays a menu screen A blinking cursor shows you where to enter information LOGON asks you for your user name and possibly a password if you have security on your system If your identification is correct LOGON will verify you have been logged in to your root account MESSAGES Command format error Check your syntax and spelling and try again Disk not mounted Mount the disk and try again File in use cannot set lock mode Press RETURN to continue LOG could not set your file locking status because the job has a file locked You are logged on but file locking is as it was See your System Operator for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LOGON Page 2 Insufficient queue blocks cannot set lock mode Press RETURN to continue LOG could not set your file locking status because there are not enough queue blocks You are logged on but file locking is as it was See your System Operator about allocating more queue blocks Improper password try again Try again and be careful with your spelling If you still have no success see your System Operator for help That name is not recognized try again The user name you entered is not defined on your system Try another user name or see your System Operator for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LOKUTL FUNCTION LOKUTL allows general system users to see a status display of the File Record Locking Service
187. C partially copied files System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MUSER FUNCTION Defines and maintains the list of valid user names CHARACTERISTICS MUSER is re entrant and re usable You must be in DSKO 1 2 to run it When the user names feature is in operation everyone who uses the system has an entry in the list of valid user names To create this list the System Operator defines each user by means of the MUSER formatted screen displays Each person is given a unique user name to use when logging in to the system Every user is also assigned a root disk account At log in time the user definition is made available to system and application programs The programs rely on this information to support each user at that user s level of knowledge You can use MUSER to view the list of active users to update the list and to track each user s system usage MUSER uses function key translation tables with the extension of AMX in DSKO 7 0 OPERATION Log in to account DSKO 1 2 and enter MUSER LOG OPR MUSER USER brings up the main menu and directs you You may add change or delete a user definition and display the list of active users When you choose the add or change command MUSER displays a data entry form Enter data values in the appropriate fields as described below The function key F13 on most keyboards or pressing twice returns you to the main menu Fields of the First Screen User Name The symbolic na
188. C2 Latin Capital Letter A With Lu Circumflex A 303 195 C3 Latin Capital Letter A With Lu Tilde A 304 196 C4 Latin Capital Letter A With Lu System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 6 Appendix A Char Also Octal Decimal Hex ISO IEC 10646 1 1993 E Also Known As Type See acter Called Value Value Value and Unicode 2 0 Name Note Diaeresis A 305 197 C5 Latin Capital Letter A With Lu Ring Above 306 198 C6 Latin Capital Ligature AE Lu 2 307 199 C7 Latin Capital Letter C With Lu Cedilla 310 200 C8 Latin Capital Letter E With Lu Grave E 311 201 c9 Latin Capital Letter E With Lu Acute 312 202 CA Latin Capital Letter E With Lu Circumflex 313 203 CB Latin Capital Letter E With Lu Diaeresis I 314 204 CC Latin Capital Letter I With Lu Grave 315 205 CD Latin Capital Letter I With Lu Acute i 316 206 CE Latin Capital Letter I With Lu Circumflex 317 207 CF Latin Capital Letter I With Lu Diaeresis 320 208 DO Latin Capital Letter Eth Lu N 321 209 D1 Latin Capital Letter N With Lu Tilde O 322 210 D2 Latin Capital Letter O With Lu Grave 323 211 D3 Latin Capital Letter O With Lu Acute 324 212 D4 Latin Capital Letter O With Lu Circumflex 8 325 213 D5 Latin Capital Letter O With Lu Tilde 326 214 D6 Latin Capital Letter O With Lu Diaeresis x 327 215 D7 Multiplication Sign Sm 330 216 D8 Latin Capital Letter O With Lu Stroke 331 217 D9 Latin Capital Letter U With Lu Grave 332 218
189. C68000 or MC68010 processor You must install a SCSI dispatcher to use FMSFLP on the system You are trying to run FMSFLP on a system that has a SCSI interface but does not have a dispatcher installed Device error id 5 sense key 03 media error additional sense 12h 00h Ignore this error message System Commands Reference Manual Rev 09 FMTDVD FUNCTION Formats DVD media using the AM 403 DVD RAM drive for use by AMOS Displays the drive status initializes a drive or rewrites the hidden sector CHARACTERISTICS sl To run FMTDVD you must be logged into the System Operator s Account w To run FMTDVD your computer must support the AM 403 DVD RAM drive You must have a SCSI dispatcher installed and have an AM 403 DVD RAM drive attached to the SCSI bus FMTDVD supports narrow and wide SCSI interfaces FORMAT FMTDVD If you use the format or initialize option FMTDVD destroys all data on all logical devices on the DVD media OPERATION FMTDVD runs in interactive mode Interactive Mode FMTDVD displays a list of the SCSI CD DVD drives on your computer Select the drive you want to affect and press RETURN The FMTDVD menu then displays as shown on the next page System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 FMTDVD Page 2 Alpha Micro SCSI DVD RAM Drive Format Utility FMTDVD Version 1 0 100 Selected SCSI ID 03 Vendor HITACHI Model DVD_RAM GF 2050 Rev XXXX Functions Select Drive Reassign Blocks
190. CBEN or reboot your computer to re enable it If you use CBEN and the cache is already enabled it causes the cache to be flushed If there is no on board memory cache on your system CBEN has no effect OPERATION Type CBEN and press RETURN CBEN MESSAGES This program is not supported Your system is not running either a RoadRunner CPU board or the AMOS 32 operating system The on board cache is not supported System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CDIR FUNCTION Displays the full name uncompressed size and file type for a file compressed by the CMP command CHARACTERISTICS CDIR is an OS Exec program that may be used as an AMOS command CDIR can also display one file at a time multiple files may be processed using the CDIR function in OS Exec Only files compressed using the OS Exec program CMP may be CDIR d The CTYPE command can be used to display the contents of a compressed sequential file The EXP command can be used to expand a file that was compressed using the OS Exec program CMP FORMAT CDIR filespec DEFAULTS CDIR assumes an extension of CMP OPERATION Enter CDIR and the specification of the file For example CDIR TRANS CDIR now displays a message listing the file name uncompressed size in blocks and the type of file TRANS CMP is TRANS TXT 43 sequential MESSAGES File is not an OS Exec compressed file Use the DIR or TYPE command to get information about the file Syste
191. CRC error occurs on a read in that case you cannot retrieve any byte of data good or bad from that sector FIXCRC will warn you if the returned block consists of all zeroes and ask you to confirm you want to write back zeroes to the block overwriting any data in that block System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIXCRC Page 2 MESSAGES Privileged program must be logged into 1 2 Log into 1 2 and try again Unable to correct disk error The disk block you specified cannot be corrected See your Alpha Micro representative for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIXFLP FUNCTION Configures a floppy diskette driver for a specific combination of diskette format disk drive and disk controller Used with the AM 212 and AM 214 controllers CHARACTERISTICS FIXFLP is re entrant and re usable Because of the large number of possible permutations of diskette formats drives and controllers it is no longer possible to provide a separate disk driver program for each combination For information on the large number of floppy disk formats available see your Alpha Micro dealer You must be logged into DSKO 1 6 to use FIXFLP You may not use single density AMS format with either the AM 212 or AM 214 controller Remember to add a BITMAP command to your system initialization command file for each new format drive controller combination you create You may also need to modify a DEVTBL command line See your System Op
192. CTERISTICS This is currently unsupported software meaning it has not been fully tested and documented that errors may not be corrected and that its specifications and or behavior may be changed But please advise us of any documentation or program errors so that we have the opportunity to correct them ISOCD is both re entrant and re useable and requires a 68020 or higher processor ISOCD enters a DOS like prompt and allows for displaying directories changing directories copying files both sequential and random typing files specifying DOS or UNIX line termination FORMAT ISOCD Please contact Alpha Micro Products if you wish to customize this program or to access an ISO CD from within a program DEFAULTS Uses the first CD it finds on the SCSI bus starting with ID 6 and scanning down OPERATION Enter ISOCD It will return with a failure message or a C gt prompt At the prompt you may enter a question mark to get a list of commands and their descriptions For example ISOCD RETURN ISOCD Version 1 0 101 Copyright C 1993 Alpha Microsystems Inc Scanning SCSI bus for CD ROM CD ROM drive located at SCSI id 4 Volume ID PRO62000 created 11 20 2005 06 43 15 CD gt RETURN Available commands QUIT return to AMOS CD directory change directory DIR list files DIR W wide file list COPY file amosfile transfer file to AMOS COPYR file amosfile transfer random file to AMOS TYPE
193. CTERISTICS ERSATZ is re entrant and re usable Ersatz names are defined in INI file s referred to by the ERSATZ command in your system initialization command file ERSATZ will not display ersatz specifications added to the ersatz INI file s since the last system reset See your System Operator s Guide for more information about ersatz INI files and ersatz names ERSATZ can change or delete current ersatz definitions and add new ones while your system is running Any changes you make using ERSATZ are not stored in the ersatz INI files and are therefore lost when your computer reboots FORMAT ERSATZ switch OPTIONS A ersatzdef D ersatzname O ersatzdef WIDE or W OPERATION Add new ersatz definition There must be a blank entry in the ersatz table in order to use A see below Delete ersatz definition for ersatzname Change override definition of an existing ersatz name with the one you enter Display ersatz definitions in multiple columns Number of columns depends on the width of your terminal display To display existing ersatz definitions enter ERSATZ at AMOS command level with or without the W switch For example ERSATZ To add change or delete an ersatz definition you must be logged in to OPR System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 ERSATZ Page 2 To change an existing ersatz definition use the O switch followed by an existing ersatz name and the new meaning you want ERSA
194. CTION TO THE MANUAL 1 1 CONCEPTS AMOS Command Level AMOS Prompt Defaults Switch or Option CONVENTIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL ee f NINNIN N N f wo W p CHAPTER 2 INTRODUCTION TO AMOS COMMANDS COMMANDS TO BE USED WITH CAUTION 2 2 Commands That Can Destroy Disk Contents 2 System Operator Commands 2 N N Access Limitations 2 CHAPTER 3 FILE SPECIFICATIONS 3 1 CHAPTER 4 DEFAULTS AND WILDCARD SYMBOLS 4 1 STANDARD SYSTEM DEFAULTS 4 WILDCARD SYMBOLS 4 STANDARD SYSTEM WILDCARD SYMBOLS 4 CHAPTER 5 INPUT OUTPUT REDIRECTION 5 1 REDIRECTION SYMBOLS 5 1 USING REDIRECTION 5 1 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page ii Table of Contents CHAPTER 6 SYSTEM COMMANDS LIST BY FUNCTION N N N io W W W Oo io aN aN A A THE REFERENCE SHEETS APPENDIX A CHARACTER SETS DOCUMENT HISTORY System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Chapter 1 Introduction to the Manual The purpose of this manual is to provide information on every command on the AMOS system In writing these reference sheets we ve assumed you are already familiar with the AMOS system If this is not true please read your AMOS User s Guide This manual does not contain reference sheets for any AMOS products sold separately from the
195. Command line macro improperly terminated Check your syntax and try again Don t know how to make file filename Add a rule or dependency to your makefile Duplicate target name at line number Check your makefile for an error at the indicated line number Error while processing file filename Cycle detected A target name in your makefile depends on itself Check your dependency tree for the illegal cycle reference Illegal command line macro Check your syntax and try again Mlegal rule at line number Check your makefile for an error at the indicated line number System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MK Page 6 Invalid line type at line number Check your makefile for an error at the indicated line number Invalid option in command line Check your spelling and syntax and try again Invalid source name at line number Check your makefile for an error at the indicated line number Invalid substitution at line number Check your makefile for an error at the indicated line number Invalid symbol at line number Check your makefile for an error at the indicated line number Invalid target name at line number Check your makefile for an error at the indicated line number Invalid target name in command line Check your spelling and syntax and try again Line too long at line number Shorten the long line Nested macros not supported at line number Check your makefile for
196. D REVIVE WAIT WIDTH n OPERATION PRNT Page 2 File prints after date time which may be absolute i e 4 13 88 3 17PM or relative i e 0 1 0 0 03 File switch Print a banner page at list front text is printed on the bottom of banner page up to 50 characters Operation switch Number of copies to print File switch Delete file after printing File switch Print a form feed at list end File switch Prints up to and including specified page File switch Specifies the form needed If form is not on prompts operator job File switch Print a page header at top of every list page File switch Sends you a message when file is done File switch Stops the file from printing Operation switch Sets n file blocks as maximum number of form feeds allowed Limits endless loop form feed errors File switch Maximum number of lines per page File switch Used with H Turns off specified printer Files in queue will be printed Can only be used by the System Operator Operation switch Turns on a printer Can only be used by System Operator Default operation switch Gives files queue priority n Default is 128 range is 1 to 255 The higher n is the higher the file is in the queue File switch Confirms before printing killing a file File switch Restarts file at page or interrupted page if system resets File switch Revises printing instructions for a file already in the queue with sequ
197. D004 DBD005 DBD006 DBD007 DBD008 DBD009 DBDO DBDO DBDO DBDO DBDO DBDO DBDO DBDO DBDO DBDO19 DBDO20 DBDO21 DBD022 DBD023 DBD024 DBD025 DBD026 fo AIYNHDOBWNE DBDO27 DBDO28 DBDO029 DBD030 DBD031 DBD032 DBD033 DBD034 DBD035 DBD036 DBD037 DBD038 DBD039 DBD040 DBD041 DBD042 DBD043 DBD044 DBD045 DBD046 DBD047 DBD048 DBD049 DBD050 DBD051 DBD052 DBD053 DBD054 Page 6 Alpha Microsystems DVD RAM BLU RAY drive found at SCSI id 5 B L O C K S BITMAP SECTOR OFFSET DEV L Seotal t a Sa Used s gt Hs Pree SSwords gt lt nma SOL SOL SPEC T 231424 60 231364 4464 0 0 blk TST000 E 231424 60 231364 4464 F 3 blk TST001 E 231424 1154 230270 4464 1F 2 blk TSTO02 E 231424 137 231287 4464 40 3 blk TSTO003 E 231424 60 231364 4464 63 3 blk TSTO04 E 231424 60 231364 4464 73 2 blk TSTOOS E 231424 60 231364 4464 83 blk TSTO06 E 231424 60 231364 4464 93 0 blk TSTOO7 E 231424 60 231364 4464 A2 3 blk TST008 E 231424 60 231364 4464 B2 2 blk TSTO09 E 231424 60 231364 4464 C2 blk TST010 E 231424 60 231364 4464 D2 0 blk TST011 E 231424 60 231364 4464 El 3 blk TST012 E 231424 60 231364 4464 F1 2 blk TST013 E 231424 60 231364 4464 201 blk TST014 E 231424 60 231364 4464 211 0 blk TSTO15 E 231424 60 231364 4464 2
198. DE 2 TMODE is only supported on SCSI 2 interfaces The tape device you ve entered is not connected to a SCSI 2 interface TMODE does not work with SCSI 1 devices System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FUNCTION Displays information about the system terminals CHARACTERISTICS TRMODEFEF is re entrant and re usable TRMDEF Also used in the system initialization command file to define terminals to the system See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for information OPERATION Enter TRMDEF at AMOS command level You then see a display about the terminals attached to your computer For example TRMDEF B1 TRM1 JO 025574 AM355 1 ALPHA 100 100 100 19200 Edit Each line is the display tells you the terminal name the job to which it is attached the memory address in octal where the terminal definition block for the terminal exists the interface driver used by the terminal the port number the terminal is using the terminal driver the terminal parameters and the baud rate If your terminal uses the line editor the word Edit will follow the baud rate TRMDEF will also display any modem drivers in use MESSAGES Cannot define terminals after system startup Terminals can only be defined in the system initialization command file at bootup time You cannot add extra terminals by running TRMDEF subsequently See your System Operator about adding more te
199. DM statement You left off the final statement ENDM in a macro definition Check your source program Old format UNV file assembly being done with No fold option Your UNV file was created under an older version of M68 that did not allow lower case in symbols and you are using N This could cause problems with symbol definitions You may wish to re compile without N or change your source program Search file filespec not found The file you wanted to SEARCH was not where you said it was Check your syntax or use the DIR command to find the file and try again Sync error This message probably means you are using an object file generated by a different version of M68 than the one you are using now and you have specified the O assembly switch Or you may have found an undiagnosed error in M68 Check your source code if you see no obvious errors try to re assemble the program again without using the O switch thus building a new object file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 OSINST FUNCTION Lets the System Operator enter the Product Installation Code PIC when new versions of AMOS are installed CHARACTERISTICS OSINST is re entrant and re usable You must be in DSKO 1 2 OPR or DSKO 1 4 SYS to run OSINST FORMAT OSINST OPERATION Log into SYS or OPR and enter OSINST LOG OPR OSINST A screen appears directing you to enter the PIC When entered AMOS asks
200. DR FUNCTION Displays a directory listing of an MS DOS formatted diskette CHARACTERISTICS DOSDR accepts wildcards for the DOS file It is re entrant re usable and works with these diskette formats 5 4 360K 3 1 44M DOSDR understands only directory and file names that conform to the MS DOS 8 3 convention It does not understand Windows 95 long file names To use this command you must have a proper disk driver program for your computer s type of floppy disk and defined as MS DOS format when created by FIXFLP The device must be defined in BITMAP and DEVTBL statements in your system initialization command file you may want to load the driver into system memory See your system operator for help FORMAT DOSDR listfilespec devn DOS path listfilespec is an optional AMOS filespec of a file to hold the directory display devn is the AMOS device name for the diskette drive and DOS path is the complete MS DOS specification of the directory you want to display The default path is the root directory Without a listfilespec the directory displays on your terminal OPERATION Enter DOSDR and the device path filename you want For example DOSDR LFDO ALAN DOSDR then displays the directory MESSAGES Invalid path specified Check your subdirectory lists or your syntax and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DOSDR Page 2 This is not a supported MS DOS format Sorry but can t be decod
201. DSKDMP DSKFIL DSKPAK DUMP DVD DVDRES ERASE ERSATZ ESLSI ESNIC EXP FILCOM FILDMP FILTAP FIX FIXCRC FIXFLP FIXLOG FIXTRN FIX210 FIX219 FIX420 FLPDIR FLPWIN FMSFLP FMTDVD FMTFLP FMTSCZ FMTS2 FMT210 FMT219 FORCE FREE FWUPD GETVER GLOBAL HASHER HELP ISMBLD ISMDMP ISMUTL ISOCD JOBALC JOBPRI JOBS KILL LABEL System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 6 2 LDVSTS LOG MAKACD MAKQUE MFDSEQ MONTST MTUSAV PASS PRINT RADMON REWIND SAVE SENDT SI SMEM STRDIR SYSACT TAPE TMODE UTC VER WRDCNT 640INI LIBLIT LOGOFF MAKBD MAP MK MOUNT MUSER PATCH PRNT REDALL RNDRED SCSI SET SIZE SORT STRRES SYSLOG TAPFIL TRMDEF VCRDIR VERIFY WRMGEN LINCNT LOGON MAKDVD MEMORY MONGEN MTBOOT M68 PLAYCD PUSH REDIR RUN SCZCSH SETJOB SKIP SRCCOM STRSAV SYSTAT TAPLOG TXTFMT VCRRES VUE XED LNKLIT LOKUTL MAKE MENU MONHSH MTUDIR OSINST POP QDT RENAME RUNP SCZERR SETPEN SLEEP STAT SUBMIT SYSTEM TDVDEF TYPE VCRSAV WAIT XMOUNT FUNCTIONAL SUMMARY OF COMMANDS Commands that do several functions appear under more than one heading Directory and Account Commands BAKDIR DOSRMD MUSER STRDIR DIR FLPDIR PASS SYSACT File Commands ASCDMP DEL ERASE LINCNT SAVE WRDCNT APPEND DIR EXP LOAD SIZE XED DIRSEQ LOG POP TAPDIR CMP DIRSEQ FILCOM MAKE SORT DOSDR LOGOFF PPN VCRDIR COPY DSKDMP FILDMP PRINT SRCCOM Chapter 6 LOAD MTURES PARITY PPN QU
202. DVD requires an MC68020 or later processor It will not run on a computer with an MC68000 or MC68010 processor You must install a SCSI dispatcher to use FATDVD on the system You are trying to run FMTDVD on a system that has a SCSI interface but does not have a dispatcher installed System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 FMTFLP FUNCTION Formats diskettes used in floppy disk devices that run under the control of the AM 212 or AM 214 Floppy Disk Controller boards Not used in Alpha Micro series prior to the AM 1500 CHARACTERISTICS FMTFLP is re entrant and re usable The AM 212 and AM 214 Floppy Disk Controllers handle devices using single or double density and single or double sided diskettes When you run FMTFLP your job MUST be the only job running on your system You must be in the System Operator s Account DSKO 1 2 to run FMTFLP You cannot use FMTFLP over a network FMTFLP selects the format to use based on the device specification you provide For example if you have configured a floppy disk driver named DDA DVR for a 3 5 drive using double sided double density AMOS format the device specification DDAO tells FMTFLP to use AMOS format to format the diskette in drive zero of that device For information on configuring floppy disk drivers see your System Operator s Guide As it formats FMTFLP writes over any data currently on the diskette FMTFLP disables buffered writes if the diskette was mounted with B
203. Data Link Escape Cc 21 17 11 Device Control One Cc 22 18 12 Device Control Two Cc 23 19 13 Device Control Three Cc 24 20 14 Device Control Four Ce 25 21 15 Negative Acknowledge Cc 26 22 16 Synchronous Idle Cc 27 23 17 End of Transmission Block Cc 30 24 18 Cancel Cc 31 25 19 End of Medium Cc 32 26 1A Substitute Cc 33 27 1B Escape Cc IS4 34 28 1C File Separator Cc IS3 35 29 1D Group Separator Cc IS2 36 30 1E Record Separator Cc IS1 37 31 1F Unit Separator Cc 40 32 20 Space Zs 41 33 21 Exclamation Mark Po System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Character Sets Page 3 Char Also Octal Decimal Hex ISO IEC 10646 1 1993 E Also Known As Type See acter Called Value Value Value and Unicode 2 0 Name Note i 42 34 22 Quotation Mark Po 43 35 23 Number Sign Hash So 1 44 36 24 Dollar Sign Sc 1 45 37 25 Percent Sign Po amp 46 38 26 Ampersand So 47 39 27 Apostrophe Apostrophe Quote Po 50 40 28 Left Parenthesis Opening Parenthesis Ps 51 41 29 Right Parenthesis Closing Parenthesis Pe 52 42 2A Asterisk So 53 43 2B Plus Sign Sm 3 54 44 2C Comma Po 55 45 2D Hyphen Minus Minus Sign Pd 56 46 2E Full Stop Period Po 57 47 2F Solidus Slash Po 0 60 48 30 Digit Zero Nd 1 61 49 31 Digit One Nd 2 62 50 32 Digit Two Nd 3 63 51 33 Digit Three Nd 4 64 52 34 Digit Four Nd 5 65 53 35 Digit Five Nd 6 66 54 36 Digit Six Nd 7 67 55 37 Digit Seven Nd 8 70 56 38 Digit Eight Nd 9 71 57 39 Digit Nine Nd 72 58
204. ES You cannot use COPY to transfer files to resident system memory You must use a SYSTEM command in your system initialization command file Maximum input exceeded You put more characters on the command line than COPY could handle Break your command into smaller commands 2MEM or RES specified on network You cannot access MEM or RES over a network Missing output specification You left out the equal sign and COPY could not tell which was your new file and which was the old file More than one output specification You may not specify more than one new file Check your entry Not copied Destination file already exists You tried to copy to a file that already exists while using NOD Try again with D or specify a different new file Not copied Destination file does not already exist Using REPLACE you tried to copy to a file which does not already exist in the destination account Try again using NOREPLACE or specify an existing destination file Specification error Your command line is not in the proper format The symbol points to the part of the line COPY did not understand Unsuccessful copy filename This is usually followed by another message detailing what went wrong with the copy Check with your system operator if you have trouble locating the problem Wildcard device or unit specified on network You cannot use wildcard symbols over a network System Commands Reference Manual Rev
205. EUE RESTOR RUNX SCZPIC SHELL SLEEPR STATI SYMLIT TAPDIR TIME U VDKUTL WINFLP XY DOSMKD LOGON PUSH CREATE DSKFIL ISOCD PRNT VUE System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 System Commands List by Function Wildcard File Commands AGREP DEL DOSEXP FLPDIR MTUSAV STRDIR VCRDIR APPEND DIR DOSIMP FLPWIN PRINT STRRES VCRRES BACKUP DIRSEQ DVDRES MAP PRNT STRSAV VCRSAV Disk and File Copy Commands APPEND COPY DVDRES MTUDIR STRRES VCRSAV BACKUP DOSEXP EXP MTURES STRSAV WINFLP BDRES DOSIMP FILTAP MTUSAV TAPFIL Text Processing Commands AGREP VUE CMP WRDCNT EXP XED Language Processor Commands BASBP COMPLP LNKLIT SYMLIT Job and Terminal Handling Commands ADJIT JOBALC LOGOFF SLEEP BASIC DB M68 ATTACH JOBPRI LOGON TDVDEF BASICP FIX RUN BAUD JOBS SEND WAIT Memory Partition Commands DEL SMEM LOAD MAP System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 BAKDIR DOSDEL ERASE MTUDIR RENAME TAPDIR WINFLP CMP DSKCPY FLPWIN RESTOR VCRRES LINCNT BASICX GLOBAL RUNP DING KILL SET XY MEMORY Page 6 3 COPY DOSDIR FILTAP MTURES RESTOR TAPFIL TXTFMT COMPIL LIBLIT RUNX FORCE LOG SETJOB SAVE Page 6 4 Analysis and Certification Commands BADBLK CRT610 FMTS2 CLEAR CRT620 HASHER CRT410 DSKANA REDALL Magnetic Tape Unit Commands FILTAP MTUSAV TAPDIR MTBOOT REWIND TAPFI
206. EXPANDED PROTECTION UDATE and UTIME will only display useful information if used with extended file structure disks OPERATION Enter DIR and any file specifications and options you wish at AMOS command level For example DIR VRTUAL LIT 110 7 DPL LIT DIR displays directory listings for the files you specified It gives you the following information for each file the filename extension and the number of disk blocks For example if you enter DIR MEM it shows you the number of bytes of memory for each module in your memory partition At the end of the directory listing DIR gives the total number of blocks taken up by all of the files in the listing or bytes in the case of memory modules If you want your directory in a file specify a listfilespec For example DIR W MYFILS RETURN If you want a directory of files on another computer you are connected to by AlphaNET specify a cpuID DIR 16842754 DSKO 1 4 LIT RETURN Use the V option to display the version of a LIT or RUN file For RUN files the AlphaBASIC program that created it must have the PROGRAM keyword See your AlphaBASIC User s Manual for information on the PROGRAM keyword System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 DIR To search for a particular file on all mounted devices and in all accounts use something like this DIR ALL TAX TBL To display all of the files in the account you are logged into DIR DUMP 1 LI
207. Enter SLEEP followed by the number of seconds you want your job to remain inactive For example SLEEP 20 You may halt the sleep at any time by pressing CTRLYC System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 SLEEPR FUNCTION Causes suspension of a job until the time specified CHARACTERISTICS SLEEPR is re entrant and re usable Generally used inside a command file Can be used with the BACKUP command to perform file backups at specified times without human control FORMAT SLEEPR HH MM AM PM HH is the hour and MM is the minute your terminal will become active again DEFAULTS SLEEPR assumes AM OPERATION Enter SLEEPR and the time you want your terminal to wake up For example SLEEPR 2 10 PM MESSAGES Specification error You did not specify a time or specified the time in an incorrect format Check your syntax and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 SMEM FUNCTION Displays data about the system shared memory pool and lets you remove stuck blocks CHARACTERISTICS SMEM is re entrant and re usable It displays memory addresses in the number base the system is using usually octal If you wish to see addresses in hexadecimal make sure the HEX option is set before using SMEM See the SET reference sheet for information on changing the numeric display base The PUSH and POP commands use shared memory but do not show up on the display
208. F at AMOS command level LOGOFF LOGOFF logs you off the system and lets you know which account you are leaving the date and time the number of disk reads and writes since you logged on the CPU or actual processing time and the connect time length of time since you logged in MESSAGES Error reading USER SYS Error writing USER SYS The user database file DSKO USER SYS 1 2 could not be accessed Usage information is not updated for the user logging off the system Unable to locate current user in USER SYS There is no record of the user in the user database file DSKO USER SYS 1 2 No usage information can be updated System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LOGON FUNCTION Logs you into your root account CHARACTERISTICS LOGON is re entrant and re usable You may use the conversational LOGON program when signing on to the system from a logged out state The program displays a menu request for your user name When you enter your user name and an optional password you are logged in to your root account LOGON also sets your job s file locking status according to the Lock Nolock and Elock Noelock options set up by MUSER If the status is changed the event is recorded in the system log file if event logging is active The LOGON program makes use of function keys and provides an online HELP facility Translation tables with the extension AMX must be installed to use the function keys OPERATION Enter LOGON at
209. FIXLOG unless you wish to change the number of logical devices When using MONGEN for self configuring disks you should specify the correct generic SCSI driver program for your computer SCSI bus combination in response to the New Disk Driver Name prompt See your System Operator s Guide OPERATION Using FIXLOG itself is relatively simple Log into DSKO 1 2 or DSKO 1 6 and type the command then choose which of the two options you want to use For example LOG OPR FIXLOG 1 Change the number of logicals 2 Create a subsystem driver Enter choice However FIXLOG itself is only part of a larger process The two procedures FIXLOG is part of are described below TO CHANGE THE NUMBER OF LOGICAL DEVICES Before starting this procedure back up the entire disk on which you are going to change the number of devices If you are changing the number of devices on your system disk also make a warm boot tape As part of this procedure you erase all data on the disk you re changing System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIXLOG Page 2 After backing up follow this procedure 1 2 Log into OPR and enter FIXLOG as described above Type 1 on the FIXLOG menu For the device specification type the name of the first logical device on the physical disk you want to change the number of logicals on For example Enter device spec DSKO If you have changed the number of logical devices before FIXLOG display
210. For example DOSMKD LFDO DBASE TUTORIAL DOSMKD then creates the directory MESSAGES Directory full Choose another directory Disk full There isn t room on the diskette for another directory System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DOSMKD Page 2 Invalid directory name Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again Invalid path specified Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again This is not a supported MS DOS format Sorry but can t be decoded Your floppy diskette is in a format DOSMKD can t read System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DOSRMD FUNCTION Removes a directory from an MS DOS formatted diskette CHARACTERISTICS DOSRMD is re entrant re usable and works with these diskette formats 5 360K 3 1 44M A directory can t be removed if it has files in it or if a subdirectory of it has files in it type of floppy disk and defined as MS DOS format when created by FIXFLP The device must be defined in BITMAP and DEVTBL statements in your system initialization command file you may want to load the driver into system memory See your system operator for help fr To use this command you must have a proper disk driver program for your computer s FORMAT DOSRMD devn path devn and path give the device and directory you want to delete OPERATION Enter DOSRMD and the description of the directory you want to remove F
211. For example SMEM 5000K This sets up a SMB shared memory area The SMEM statement must be after the last SYSTEM statement System Commands Reference Manual Rev 16 Page 3 XMOUNT MESSAGES Device contains nnn logical units Shows that the device has nnn logical drives configured Device does not exist Device does not exist in DEVTBL when doing XMOUNT U Device is not AMOS format The hidden sector of the device is invalid Error Driver must be in system memory The driver for the device is not in system memory The system initialization file should be modified if necessary Error Invalid Switch A switch other than U was entered Error Not a releasable device The specified device is defined in system memory instead of in SMEM and cannot be unXMOUNTed Error opening device The AMD file could not be opened for the reason shown Error unable to acquire shared memory Either SMEM does not exist or there is insufficient free space or device already exists in SMEM You cannot XMOUNT a device that is already XMOUNTed Impossible error can t find DEV SMEM module For some unknown reason the device information could not be found in SMEM when doing a XMOUNT U System Commands Reference Manual Rev 16 XY FUNCTION Lets you position the screen cursor on your terminal display and set certain terminal attributes CHARACTERISTICS XY is re entrant and re usable To be able to use the XY command you
212. GES AM 212 or 214 does not support single density AMS format Re run FLXFLP and select another format Could not find 21XDVR DVR Could not find APCDVR DVR The file listed was not found in DSKO 1 6 Use DIR to try and locate the file or see your System Operator for help Illegal filename Check your syntax and re enter the filename Invalid device You have a bad version of 21XDVR DVR in DSKO 1 6 See your System Operator for help Invalid response Check your typing and try again with a valid response Please enter Y or N Enter Y for Yes or N for No System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 FIXFLP You must be logged into PPN 1 6 to modify the driver Log into DSKO 1 6 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIXLOG FUNCTION Changes the number of logical devices on a self configuring disk or defines a new subsystem driver for a self configuring disk CHARACTERISTICS You must be logged into account DSKO 1 2 to change the number of logical devices on a self configuring disk FIXLOG should only be run on self configuring disks You must be logged into account DSKO 1 2 or DSKO 1 6 to define a new subsystem driver Running the FIXLOG program without following all the procedures outlined below could severely damage the data on your disk and you may be unable to boot your system Follow the instructions carefully If you are generating a new monitor you do not have to run
213. H is hours and MM is minutes DEFAULTS If the hours is set to 12 the default is PM If set higher than 12 PM will be set even if you add AM If hours is less than 12 the default is AM OPERATION To see the time of day enter TIME at AMOS command level For example TIME 12 30 12 PM To set the system time of day log into any operator s 1 2 account type TIME and the time you want set Some examples LOG 1 2 RETURN TIME 3 12 PM TIME 16 00 MESSAGES Improper time format Check your syntax and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TIME Page 2 You must be logged in to 1 2 to reset the time Log into 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TMODE FUNCTION For SCSI 2 tape drives displays information about tape drive and cartridge format For tape drives that support it sets data compression mode and write format CHARACTERISTICS TMODE is re entrant and re usable It works only with cartridge tape drives attached to a SCSI 2 interface For these drives it displays the current cartridge type and recording format and whether the drive supports data compression or tape format options On drives which support it you can set the compression mode and or tape format FORMAT TMODE devn option devn is the device name of the drive you want information on or to set the write format for and option sets the compression mode or cartridge format OPERATION To d
214. HEX command before running SYSLOG DIAG System Commands Reference Manual Rev 10 SYSLOG Page 2 OPERATION To generate a listing of logged events with diagnostic information enter SYSLOG D SYSLOG generates a new listing in the SYSLOG LST file You may print the file or view it using AlphaVUE To clear the log file LOG 1 2 SYSLOG C MESSAGES The C switch requires that you be logged in to 1 2 Log into an operator s account 1 2 and try again Invalid opcode in filename opcode is nn SYSLOG cannot decode the information in the specified LOGGER file SYSLOG will attempt to resynchronize output at the next entry in the file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 10 SYSTAT FUNCTION Displays information about the jobs running on the system CHARACTERISTICS SYSTAT is re entrant and re usable FORMAT SYSTAT switch switch is an option request OPTIONS IN Don t list the devices and blocks free OPERATION Enter SYSTAT at AMOS command level SYSTAT The name of the job is displayed first then the name of the terminal to which the job is attached Then comes the user name Next is the account the job is logged into Following that is the terminal status for the job The codes stand for AC Control C job is inactive EW External Wait state IO T O access other than terminal MS Message Wait RN Running SI Wait for Software Interrupt SL Sleep state SP Suspended state SW Semaphore Wait T
215. I Terminal Input wait state TO Terminal Output wait state System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SYSTAT Page 2 For more information on job status codes see your AMOS User s Guide After that you see the name of the last program run by the job before you used the SYSTAT command and the number of bytes of memory in decimal allocated for that job System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SYSTEM FUNCTION Displays the programs currently in system memory and provides information about your system CHARACTERISTICS SYSTEM is re entrant and re usable Also used in the system initialization command file to add programs to the system monitor See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for information OPERATION Enter SYSTEM at AMOS command level SYSTEM lists all of the programs currently in system memory and tells you how many bytes of memory are used by the monitor For example SYSTEM The following programs are allocated in system memory SYSMSG USA CMDLIN SYS VUE LIT TRM DVR Total resident monitor size is 361838 bytes Monitor version is 2 0A 308 3 Depending on your type of system you may also see other information System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 TAPDIR FUNCTION Displays a list of the files on a magnetic tape reel Also allows you to create a disk file containing the tape directory CHARACTERISTICS Used with FILTAP
216. I interface 2SCSI ID of drive to operate on MUST be specified You must tell FMTS2 which SCSI drive to format 2SCSI interface not available on this system You used the SCSI switch on a system that does not have a SCSI interface Specified drive does not exist There is no disk drive at the specified SCSI ID on the selected interface bus You must install a SCSI dispatcher to use FMTS2 on the system You are trying to run FMTS2 on a system that has a SCSI interface but does not have a dispatcher installed System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 FMT210 FUNCTION Formats diskettes used in floppy disk devices under the control of the AM 210 Floppy Disk Controller board and the AM 1000 and AM 1200 5 1 4 Mini floppy Disk Controller CHARACTERISTICS FMT7210 is re entrant and re usable The AM 210 Floppy Disk Controller handles devices that use double or single density diskettes and single or double sided diskettes When you run FMT210 your job MUST be the only job running on your system You must be in the System Operator s Account DSKO 1 2 to run FMT210 The AM 210 controller does not support single density AMS format for 8 inch floppies FMT7210 runs only under the AMOS L version of the operating system FMT7210 selects the specific format to use based on the device specification you provide For example if you have previously configured a floppy disk driver named DDS DVR for a Qume device that uses double sided dou
217. IT OPERATION Enter DSKFIL and the specification of the file whose disk addresses you want to see For example DSKFIL SWITCH TXT MESSAGES Cannot DSKFIL filespec file not found Check your syntax or use DIR to find the file File specification error Check your syntax and try again Make sure you entered a filespec No blocks in file There are no blocks allocated to this file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKPAK FUNCTION Consolidates the blocks in use on the disk to create a single area of free blocks CHARACTERISTICS DSKPAK is re entrant and re usable It is used to avoid fragmentation of open space on the disk For more information on file allocation see your System Operator s Guide problems with the disk s file link structure If a minor error in the file link structure does exist packing the disk will magnify the error dramatically possibly resulting in loss of all files on the disk Using DSKANA also frees up any disk blocks marked in the bitmap as in use but not allocated to any file otherwise DSKPAK will not be able to move those blocks into the free block area on the disk resulting in an incompletely packed disk You may also want to use DSKANA on the disk after packing it You also must make sure nobody is using the disk you want to pack before using DSKPAK You must be logged into the System Operator s Account DSKO 1 2 o Before packing the disk you MUST use DSKANA to make sure ther
218. If you specify an asterisk instead of jobname the message is sent to all jobs on the system OPERATION Enter SEND the name of the job you want to communicate with and the message you wish to send For example assume you are job RAY SEND BOB What time is your meeting with the Board If the terminal attached to job BOB is not guarded and is not busy performing a task that interferes with input output the message appears on BOB s terminal RAY What time is your meeting with the Board MESSAGES Busy SEND can t send the message because the job s not at AMOS command level or in terminal input mode Use STAT to see what the job is doing and try again when it is not busy File specification error Check your syntax and make sure you specified a jobname Use SYSTAT or STAT to see the jobnames on your system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SEND Page 2 Guarded The job is protected by SET GUARD Try another method of communication Invalid CPU number The remote system you specified does not exist ITC error occured during send Your message did not arrive at the remote system due to a network problem Try again If the problem persists contact your System Operator Job has no terminal attached The job you want to send to is not attached to a terminal and can t receive your message Job not found Check your syntax or use STAT or SYSTAT to see a list of jobs Job specification error A job was no
219. If you wish to send files to a specific printer enter PRINT the name of the printer you want to use an equal sign and your list of files For example PRINT DRAFT BACKUP S CFIL System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 PRINT MESSAGES 2A device must have network access enabled to be able to print from it You have specified one or more files on a device that has No Network Access set You cannot print files from such a device Use the SET command to enable network access then use the PRINT command again Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see what devices are on your system Cannot INIT device name device not mounted Mount the device and try again Device or P PN on output are illegal You can only specify a printer name on the left of the equals sign Fatal ITC error n Unknown error n returned by remote system The printer you specified is located on a remote system On submitting the print request a network or remote system error occurred Try the print request again If the problem persists contact your System Operator Input file error error message An error occurred while your file was printing Correct the situation indicated by the error and print the file again Invalid argument for COPIES You did not specify a colon followed by a number for the COPIES switch or the number specified was zero or more than 255 Re enter the command with
220. K PLDO BADBLK displays the serial number of the device the number of blocks or tracks marked as bad and lists the bad blocks or tracks System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BADBLK Page 2 ol Block numbers are octal or hex depending on your current output radix Track and head numbers are decimal When used from OPR For most Winchester disk systems you can add blocks to the bad block list for the device For non SCSI devices you can also delete blocks from the list or modify the serial number of the device Some disks also let you create a BADBLK SYS 1 2 file if it doesn t already exist To perform any of these functions be sure you are logged into DSKO 1 2 and enter the BADBLK command For example LOG OPR RETURN BADBLK DSK2 RETURN The is the BADBLK prompt There are general commands you can use with all disks Write out new information and exit Help list instructions List bad blocks tracks Modify serial number warm Other commands depend on the type of device you have enter H to see a menu for your device Adding and Deleting Bad Blocks If you consistently receive messages stating a certain block has an error such as Error 5 Drive 2 Block 4 Cylinder 3 Head 2 Sector 1 you may want to add that block to the bad block list Except for SCSI devices and AM 520 AM 522 controlled drives before using the A D or M commands back up the entire physical device you are going to be changi
221. L Backup Commands BACKUP MAKBD RESTOR VCRRES BAKDIR MAKDVD STRDIR VCRSAV MTUDIR SET TAPLOG CRT610 MTUDIR STRRES WRMGEN System Information Commands AMSCFG DATE ESNIC JOBPRI MEMORY SCZCSH STAT TIME ATTACH DEVTBL FREE JOBS MONHSH SCZERR STATI TRMDEF BADBLK DUMP GETVER LABEL PPN SET SYSLOG UTC System Maintenance Commands ADJIT CBEN DSKDDT MFDSEQ PASS SYSLOG BADBLK COMPAT DSKPAK MONGEN PATCH TIME CACHE DATE FIXCRC MONTST QDT TMODE System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 CRT415 FIXCRC RNDRED MTUINI SKIP 640INI DVDRES MTURES STRSAV BITMAP ERSATZ HELP LDVSTS QUEUE SI SYSTAT VER CAL100 DIRSEQ ISMUTL MUSER SET VDKUTL Chapter 6 CRT520 FMTSCZ VERIFY MTURES TAPE MAKACD MTUSAV VCRDIR COMPAT ESLSI JOBALC LOKUTL SCSI SMEM SYSTEM CBDS DSKANA LOKUTL OSINT SYSACT WRMGEN ACD FUNCTION Makes the logical devices on an AMOS CD accessible without being defined in a DEVTBL statement in your system initialization command file CHARACTERISTICS ACD is re entrant and re usable It temporarily takes control of the SCSI bus preventing other users from accessing it while you connect or disconnect the CD ROM drive initialization command file See the System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization o To make the CD ROM always usable you can add the ACD command to your system Command File for more information For
222. LI Grave 6 363 243 F3 Latin Small Letter O With Ll Acute 364 244 F4 Latin Small Letter O With LI Circumflex 6 365 245 F5 Latin Small Letter O With Ll Tilde 6 366 246 F6 Latin Small Letter O With LI Diaeresis 7 367 247 F7 Division Sign Sm 370 248 F8 Latin Small Letter O With LI Stroke 371 249 F9 Latin Small Letter U With LI Grave 372 250 FA Latin Small Letter U With LI Acute 373 251 FB Latin Small Letter U With LI Circumflex 374 252 FC Latin Small Letter U With LI Diaeresis 375 253 FD Latin Small Letter Y With LI Acute p 376 254 FE Latin Small Letter Thorn LI y 377 255 FF Latin Small Letter Y with Ll Diaeresis System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 8 Appendix A Notes 1 This code point is used by National Replacement Character Sets 7 bit character sets Devices using such an NRC will not print the glyph shown neither will it print glyphs for code points above 127 2 ISO may be reclassifying these code points as Latin Letter as certain Scandinavian languages use these characters as a complete letter not as a ligature Type The characters are broken down into character types by Unicode Cc Control or Format Character LI Lowercase Letter Lm Modifier Letter Lu Uppercase Letter Nd Decimal Number Pd Dash Punctuation Pe Close Punctuation Po Other Punctuation Ps Open Punctuation Sc Currency Symbol Sm Math Symbol So Other Symbol Zs Space Separator Syst
223. LUS programs see your AlphaBASIC PLUS User s Manual FORMAT BASBP switch filespec s switch switch is an option beginning with or Multiple switches can be specified with one delimiter i e dki filespec can be a single file or a list of files contained in a reference data file filname DAT created by the DIR command using D OPTIONS IC Creates a CMD file to compile all converted programs Only with multiple files D Displays all changed lines on the terminal as processed mt Flags all ISAM statements and fixes all ISAM PLUS keyword conflicts IK Fixes all keyword conflicts except ISAM PLUS L Flags all XCALLS to XLOCK or FLOCK All options are global switches If no switches are added all switches are in effect If any one switch is specified all the other switches are off OPERATION Enter BASBP at AMOS command level BASBP ACCNT BAS To convert all BAS files in an account to AlphaBASIC PLUS DIR D CONV DAT BAS Generates file list BASBP CONV Converts the files CONV Como thee rhe Gibee System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 BASBP Page 2 To convert AlphaBASIC 1 3 files to AlphaBASIC 1 4 use the I switch to convert and flag only ISAM ISAM PLUS related conflicts Under AMOS 2 0 and 2 1 AlphaBASIC 1 4 supports only ISAM PLUS but under AMOS 2 2 it supports both ISAM and ISAM PLUS So the ISAM PLUS keyword conversion is always needed but there is n
224. M520 not initialized Cannot read MFR defect map AM 520 not initialized Cannot read defect map AM 520 not initialized These errors indicate the AM 520 board has not been downloaded with the AM520 MIC microcode file MOUNT the drive and try again Cannot have defect block on track zero drive is defective Disk drives under control of the AM 520 must not have any defects on cylinder 0 head 0 It is not possible to add bad blocks in this area If you took the defect information from the drive contact your Alpha Micro dealer If you typed in the defect information you probably made a typographical error Run CRT520 again Defect format not intact on cylinder n head n While reading the manufacturer s media defect list a track was found with a bad media defect format The track is ignored and defects if any on the track are not registered If there are any defects on the track you can add them using BADBLK check the printed manufacturer s defect list Defect map has bad hash total These errors indicate the AM 520 was able to read the Bad Block Map from the disk but its format was not intact Use CRT520 again using a media defect list or inputting the bad block map from a file DEVTBL ENTRY NOT FOUND The device requested has not been defined with a DEVTBL statement in your system initialization file See your System Operator about updating the system initialization file Disk spare area has been exceeded defect count mu
225. Master File Directory structure on the disk has somehow been damaged If the MFD structure has been damaged while using the DELETE option of SYSACT it may still be intact for all other MFD oriented operations Recovery from a damaged MFD may require a complete re initialization of the disk See your System Operator for help Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices Device in use try again later SYSACT must have exclusive use of the disk MFD and bitmap while making any changes These items are locked at the moment by another program Try again in a moment Error during function A device error occurred You may see other messages to further define the error See your System Operator for help Error PPN not written to MFD A project programmer number was added to a floppy diskette and the User File Directory was updated but not the Master File Directory See your System Operator for help Fatal system error while running SYSACT Try using SYSACT again You may want to reboot after warning the other users on the system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SYSACT Page 4 File specification error You made a mistake in specifying the device name Make sure you included the colon and try again PPN format is octal P Pn P 1 to 377 Pn 0 to 377 Check your typing or use the L command to see a list of accounts on the disk Then try again
226. N AlphaXED begins a new line for you when you reach the end of a line If you are editing an existing file AlphaXED loads a copy of that file into memory and takes you directly to the mode Screen mode or Command mode indicated by the START command in the XED INI file If you are in Screen mode you can use the various cursor movement and screen to screen movement commands to move the cursor to the point in your text where you want to make changes Then use the appropriate screen editing commands to effect those changes To transfer from Screen mode to Command mode or from Command mode to Screen mode press or press CTRLY In Command mode you see the cursor waiting after the AlphaXED prompt symbol gt System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 XED MESSAGES The AlphaXED error messages are explained in your AlphaXED User s Guide System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 XMOUNT FUNCTION Opens and makes an external AMOS format disk file available for use as a disk sub device Closes and makes unavailable a sub device that was previously XMOUNTed This command is only available on AMOS 8 x systems CHARACTERISTICS XMOUNT is re entrant and re usable XMOUNT is used to tell the system that you want to access an externally defined native Alpha Micro Diskfile AMD as an AMOS disk subdevice When access to the subdevice is no longer required it can be unXMOUNTed AMOS 8 x systems m
227. O 1 4 f it does it means you didn t have enough memory to load it into your partition If so try to increase your memory by erasing unnecessary files See your System Operator for further help Device not found or mounted device name Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of valid devices on your system and try again If the device isn t mounted use MOUNT FATAL ERROR Program terminated Either the device s bitmap was corrupted or its Master File Directory MFD was damaged Stop other users from accessing the device and run the DSKANA program before trying again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 ERASE Maximum input exceeded You put more characters on the command line than ERASE could handle Break your command into smaller commands 2MEM or RES specified on network You cannot access MEM or RES over a network More than one output specification Re enter the command using one output specification No files deleted Check your syntax or use DIR to find the file s Specification error The symbol points to the error try again with a corrected command line Wildcard device or unit specified on network You cannot use wildcard symbols over a network System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FUNCTION ERSATZ From the AMOS command line displays or edits the currently defined ersatz names In the system initialization command file names an ersatz definition file CHARA
228. O 1 6 Use DIR to try and locate the file or see your System Operator for help Invalid response Check your typing and try again with a valid response You must be logged into PPN 1 6 to modify the driver Log into DSKO 1 6 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIX420 FUNCTION Configures a disk driver for a specific Winchester disk drive CHARACTERISTICS FIX420 is re entrant and re usable You must be logged into DSKO 1 6 to use FIX 420 Remember to add a BITMAP command in your system initialization command file for each new format drive controller combination you create You also need to add a separate DEVTBL command line for each drive you add to the system See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for more information OPERATION Log into the system Device Driver Library account and enter FIX420 LOG DSKO 1 6 FIX420 FIX420 begins by asking you to select the type of drive you have from a menu of devices Select the letter corresponding to your type of drive 4 If you are not sure what kind of disk drive you have see the System History label FIX420 then asks you how many logical drives per physical unit Enter a number between the minimum and maximum listed Then you are asked if you want to create a subsystem driver If your drive is an AM 1001 subsystem answer Y yes to this question and FIX420 creates a subsystem driver for you As part of this
229. OBJ modules Requests DSECT initialization The default is no DSECT initialization Operation switch Includes equated symbols in symbol table file Must use with M or S Operation switch Designates a library file File switch Generates a load map MAP file Operation switch Suppresses the P switch Operation switch Designates an optional file File switch Generates a program LIT or OVR file Operation Designates a required file Cancel L and O Default file switch Generates a symbol table SYM file Default operation switch Doesn t automatically include SYSLIB LIB in linkage Allows maximum DSECT area of 64K rather than the 32K default by allowing full 16 bit signed offsets Enter LNKLIT and the specifications of the files you want to link together For example LNKLIT M VISFIL VIS1 UTILIT LIB L Notice the command line above specifies a library file UTILIT LIB By using the M switch we are also asking LNKLIT for a load map file LNKLIT displays several messages as it process the files the exact messages you see depend on the options you have requested and files you have specified MESSAGES Attempt to directly reference a DSECT symbol Index through a base register when referencing a symbol defined in a data section System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 LNKLIT Command error Check your syntax and try again Fatal error At most one DSIZE may appear
230. ONS HELP Display the available options and exits n Same as HELP IV Display version information and exits COUNT n Creates n DVDs or BD REs containing the same data DEV xxx Uses device and driver named xxx instead of the default DBD System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 MAKBD Page 2 EJECT Ejects the DVD or BD RE in the drive AD n Uses the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive at SCSI ID n instead of scanning the SCSI bus to find a DVD RAM or Blu ray drive The ID can be from 0 to 15 NOEJECT The DVD or BD RE media will not be ejected from the drive PIC Displays the Product Installation Code VERBOSE Display additional error messages MAKBD with no switches will create a DVD or BD RE using the DBD device found by scanning the SCSI bus OPERATION o MAKBD works best on a job with 132 columns set as the terminal width Before starting the program place a DVD RAM or BD RE media in the drive Copying logical disks that are being updated by other users to the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive can result in DVD RAMs or BD REs containing incorrect or incomplete data Type MAKBD from the AMOS prompt MAKBD MAKBD will attempt to find a DVD RAM or Blu ray drive that is compatible with the DVD RAM or Blu ray driver being used The driver must have the name DBD DVR and be loaded in system memory MAKBD will find the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive either using the command line switches DEV and ID or by defaulting to DBD if DEV is not specified and by
231. OPR Log into DSKO 1 2 and try again Sector not found MINO block0 This message is displayed when mounting an unformatted diskette if this is the case it may be ignored If it occurs at any other time it indicates a problem with the diskette see your System Operator This program is for use with AM 219 drivers only You have attempted to format a diskette using a device driver that was not created for the AM 219 controller You can use FMT219 only with the AM 219 controller and drivers created for it using FIX219 Unit number for 5 1 4 inch floppies must be 0 or 1 Try again specifying 0 or 1 Unit number must be 0 3 Re enter specifying a unit number of 0 1 2 or 3 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 FORCE FUNCTION Allows you to force terminal input to another job CHARACTERISTICS FORCE is re entrant and re usable FORCE has two modes single line and multi line Be careful when using FORCE to make sure the job you are forcing input to has enough memory allocated to it to handle the task you are giving it You can t force input to a job not attached to a terminal but you can use FORCE to force input to a job attached to a pseudo terminal for example to bring up the printer spooler under control of a pseudo terminal You may not use FORCE to force input to a guarded job unless you are logged into the System Operator s account 1 2 For information on guarding a terminal see the SET reference sh
232. OS logical disks to a recordable CD media in a supported CD recorder CDs created with MAKACD can be used for software distribution or for system backups Using a 4 speed CD recorder it only takes about 15 minutes to record an entire 600MB CD CD s created with MAKACD can be easily read after mounting the CD with the ACD program CHARACTERISTICS MAKACD copies logical AMOS disk drives onto a recordable or rewritable CD in a format that is compatible with the Alpha Micro ACD program An ACD compatible CD can contain up to approximately 600 megabytes of data MAKACD creates a logical drive structure on the CD media such that each logical drive is equal in size to the largest logical disk drive copied If logical drives of differing sizes are specified the smaller drives will be padded on the CD to equal to the largest logical size copied Only entire logical drives including unused areas can be copied to the CD Rewritable CDs may be erased and reused When recording to a blank CD MAKACD will start recording at the beginning of the CD and use only as much space as required to hold the desired data The Table of Contents will normally be written and the CD can then be used with the ACD program When recording to a partially recorded CD MAKACD will start recording at the first available unrecorded location on the CD Normally all of the desired data will be recorded and then extra filler will be recorded followed by the ACD special sector Finally t
233. OSEXP then transfers the file to the MS DOS diskette The file is converted into MS DOS format System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DOSEXP Page 2 You can specify a wildcard that represents a complete AMOS file specification but not for a partial AMOS file specification For example you could enter DOSEXP LFDO but not DOSEXP LFDO DSK2 10 2 TXT MESSAGES Directory full Choose another directory Diskette full There isn t room on the diskette for the selected file Erase any un needed files and try again or transfer to another diskette Invalid file type Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again Invalid path specified Check your subdirectory lists or your syntax and try again This is not a supported MS DOS format Sorry but can t be decoded Your floppy diskette is in a format DOSEXP can t read Unable to open filespec DOSEXP couldn t find the file on the AMOS side Check your AMOS directory and syntax System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DOSIMP FUNCTION Transfers a file from an MS DOS formatted diskette to AMOS CHARACTERISTICS DOSEXP accepts wildcards for the DOS file and for a full AMOS specification see OPERATION below It is re entrant re usable and works with these diskette formats 5 360K 3 1 44M To use this command you must have a proper disk driver program for your computer s type of floppy disk and defined as MS DOS format when cre
234. OYANK Opens a file without putting any text into memory Useful if you have a file larger than your memory and you want to YANK data into the front of it R Opens a file in another account for Read only access Allows you to see a file in a protected account You can only exit by using Q any changes you make to the file will not be retained SUBROUTINE Executes VUE as if it were being called as a subroutine from another program Suppresses most interactive input and output TRACE Displays each line of the INI VUE file as it processes OPERATION Enter VUE followed by the specification of the file you want to edit For example VUE LETTER TXT If the file you specify does not yet exist you are asked if you want to create it Enter a Y for Yes or an N for No If you enter N AlphaVUE returns you to AMOS command level When you enter a file you will see either text or a screen full of lines of asterisks if the file is empty or new Now you can enter or edit your text If the WRAP feature is set to OFF in your INL VUE file you will have to press at the end of each line to begin a new line If the WRAP feature is ON AlphaVUE will begin a new line for you when you reach the end of a line If you are editing an existing file AlphaVUE loads a copy of that file into memory and takes you directly to the mode Screen mode or Command mode indicated by the START command in the INL VUE file If you are in Screen mode you can use t
235. P Page 2 Disk not mounted Mount the disk and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PPN FUNCTION Displays a list of the account numbers on a specific device CHARACTERISTICS PPN is re entrant and re usable The device holding the Master File Directory you want to display must be mounted PPN lists the account numbers in sorted order but this is not necessarily the order they are in the Master File Directory FORMAT PPN devn devn is the device whose account numbers you want to see DEFAULTS If devn is not entered PPN defaults to the current device OPERATION Enter PPN and a device name For example PPN DSK1 MESSAGES Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of the current devices on your system File specification error Try again entering a valid device name System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PRINT FUNCTION Sends files to a printer or edits the memory based print spooler entries CHARACTERISTICS PRINT is re entrant re usable a wildcard command and recognizes ersatz devices It sends a print request to the line printer spooler program the spooler places your request into a queue or waiting line When a printer becomes available the spooler prints your file You may have several requests in the printer queue waiting for available printers Use the SET command to define the type of form to be mounted on
236. PERATION below OPTIONS A Pop to first PUSHed account clear recorded account list D Display recorded accounts P Pop to previous account S Pop to previous account PUSH the current account onto list OPERATION Enter PUSH an option and an account specification and or user name For example PUSH DSK1 47 2 PUSH RANDOLPH System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PUSH Page 2 PUSH then searches for the account you specified logs you in if it can and remembers the account you left In the first example above PUSH looks on DSK1 for account 47 2 In the second example the user name causes PUSH to log you into the root account of RANDOLPH When you are ready to return enter POP see the POP reference sheet or PUSH P MESSAGES In addition to the messages below see the messages listed in the LOG reference sheet 2 All popped out There was no account remembered by previous PUSHes to get POPped Can t allocate SMEM memory abort Either SMEM shared memory has not been installed on your system or it is fully allocated Check with your System Operator Can t do push An internal error occurred Can t process out of queue blocks abort PUSH needs to allocate a queue block a system resource but none are available Contact your System Operator about allocating more queue blocks at bootup time Illegal option specified abort You specified an invalid option on the command line Re enter the command Invalid
237. PROL 2000 2 edike rota rana tee AM 8000 8 0 Release amp Static Files AM 8000 8 0 Build amp Source Files AM 8000 EAMOS Release 02 e eee eee CD AMOS Release 01 31 2006 AlphaTCP 1 5A Source amp Release AlphaNET 2 4 159 4 Rel amp Src AlphaFAX 2 1 100 1 Rel amp Src MULTI 2516792 LO CED amp SRG priere kentidi AlphaODBC 1 0 100 Rel amp Src AlphaMAIL 1 2B PRO9 05 eeeeeeeees Xadmin Release amp INIS yeeie Ra es Command amp DO FileS gy eke ce cee c eens AMPC 7 0 Release 2 cic ed ce ee tees een AlphaODBC 1 0 100 Rel amp Src ver 1 4Y Open Logical REX15 0 e cece eeeee BD TESTING LOGICAL ONLY AMOS 8 1 June 2007 Release AlphaTCP 1 5A June 2007 Release AlphaNET 2 4 January 2006 Release AlphaFAX 2 1 February 2007 Release MULTI 2 1B June 2007 Release AlphaWRITE sAn PROGA20 0 0 aba EAE slave AlphaWRITE 2 2 PRO6 2000 AlphaCALC 2 0 April 2004 Release ESP 2 62 PRO 919 prae eaii EEEE eae AlphaMAIL 1 2B June 2007 Release AM 8000 configuration files INIs Eagle 800 configuration files INIs AlphaC vol 1 of 2 PR12 97 AlphaC 2 0 vol 2 of 2 PR12 97 XAdmin for AM 8000 Only Release 1 0 AlphaODBC 1 4A February 2007 Release VersiCOMM Plus V3 1 and ZARC OCT2004 Unsupported Software January 2006
238. Project numbers 1 through 77 on DSKO the system disk are reserved for use by Alpha Micro Accounts with the same project number are in the same project users may transfer files into another account if both accounts are in the same project If an account s programmer number is 0 that account is the library account for the project For example 110 0 is the library account for all accounts in the 110 project System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SYSACT Page 2 Me You can exit from SYSACT using the E command or CTRLVC However all changes you D gt make in SYSACT become effective when you make them not later when you exit Therefore be very sure you know exactly what you want to do before you use any SYSACT commands FORMAT SYSACT devn devn is the specification of the logical unit whose MFD you want to modify OPERATION Log into an operator s account 1 2 Enter SYSACT followed by the specification of the logical unit whose MFD you want to modify For example LOG 1 2 RETURN SYSACT DSK2 The SYSACT prompt symbol is an asterisk After the asterisk you may enter any of the commands below COMMAND SUMMARY A p pn C p pn D p pn E H I Adds account p pn to the disk SYSACT asks you for a password If you don t want the account to have a password just press RETURN Passwords must be six characters or less Changes the password of the account p pn SYSACT prompts you for a new password 0 6 al
239. R MTURES and MTUSAV updated BITMAP and FIXLOG New Manual DSO 00043 00 Re wrote the book to include all new 2 0 features Information on extended disks new BACKUP commands etc Added CRT520 and FMTSCZ added SCSI disk information to BADBLK added error messages and clarified BACKUP BAKDIR RESTOR all STR and VCR commands Revised chapter 2 chapter 5 DSKDDT DSKDMP MONTST PRNT and SYSACT Added changes to BACKUP and related programs Added new FIXTRN and MFDSEQ reference sheets revised CREATE CRT610 DSKANA FILCOM LOG REDALL RNDRED and SET to document new features Added new DOS utility programs also CBEN CBDS UTC XED WRDCNT LINCNT CDIR CMP CTYPE EXP TDVDEF REDIR POP PUSH GETVER MK OSINST AGREP DB SMEM and BASBP Updated BACKUP BADBLK CRT610 DIRSEQ DSKANA ERASE FILCOM FILTAP FIXFLP FIXTRN FMTFLP FMTSCZ LOG LOGON LOKUTL MONGEN MOUNT MTUDIR MTURES MTUSAV MUSER SET SORT SYSACT TAPDIR TAPFIL VCRRES and VCRSAV Added ACD ADJIT AMSCFG BASICP BASICX COMPAT COMPLP DOSEXP FIX219 FMT219 FWUPD LDVSTS System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Document History Revision 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 Release 2 3 2 3A 2 3A 2 3A PR 6 98 2 3A PR 4 99 2 3A PR 10 99 2 3A PR 10 99 2 3A PR 06 00 2 3A PR 06 00 2 3A PR 06 00 2 3A PR 06 00 8 0 05 04 8 X 10 06 8 X 9 07 Date
240. Recorder device or driver messages Device specified is nota DVD RAM Recorder This DVD RAM Recorder requires a different driver The current driver is XXXXXX The required driver is xxxxxx The device and driver selected are inappropriate for the physical DVD RAM drive Unable to find a DVD Recorder Unknown DVD Recorder Error Unsupported DVD Recorder drive found The DVD RAM Recorder is not supported by MAKDVD Error messages when setting up or writing to the DVD Recorder Error Buffer not initialized Error Device is already in use This indicates that either another user is running the MAKDVD program or the DVD is being used in shared read write mode Error Disk in DVD Recorder is not writeable Error DVDram driver must be in system memory Error Total data requirements exceed DVD capacity Error Unable to load DVD media This indicates a hardware problem with the DVD RAM drive or a problem with the DVD media Error Unable to open DVD recording session Try a different DVD media This can also indicate a possible DVD RAM drive problem Error Unable to open for recording Try a different DVD media This can also indicate a possible DVD RAM drive problem Error Unable to read disk information from media Try a different DVD media This can also indicate a possible DVD RAM drive problem Error Unable to write to the DVD System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 MAKDVD Page 6 A device error has occurred while
241. Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 16 Setting Backup Options the MTUSAV OPT File The MTUSAV OPT file contains the severity settings for incidents with a user definable severity Other incidents have a set severity level which cannot be altered by a user MTUSAV searches for MTUSAV OPT using the following search path 1 Login account of the MTUSAV job 2 P 0 account of the MTUSAV job 3 DSKO 1 2 If MTUSAV OPT is not found MTUSAV uses the default severity settings as listed in the table below If you use the SYSFILES switch MTUSAV looks for MTUSAV OPT only in DSKO 1 2 MTUSAV OPT is an ASCII sequential file Each line contains the name of the incident being handled as in the first column of the table below an equals sign and the incident severity either Note Warning or Error Blank lines text after a semicolon or hash character and tabs or spaces before or between words or around the equals sign are all ignored letting you format and comment the file for best readability The text is not case sensitive The easiest way to create MTUSAV OPT is to start by using MTUSAV OPT2LIST LOG This places the default incident severity levels in the MTUSAV LOG file in the correct format for MTUSAV OPT Rename MTUSAV LOG to MTUSAV OPT then edit it to change the severities as you want You can set the severity for the following incidents in MTUSAV OPT Incident Name Default Meaning Note Temporary File Control Error read
242. Rev 18 Page 1 2 Chapter One each line of the file Command files can also contain several special symbols that affect the way the file is displayed on the terminal screen as it is processed and that allow the file to ask for input from the user A special kind of command file called a DO file allows you to specify text arguments which AMOS substitutes in place of special parameter symbols Defaults When you leave information out of a command line AMOS often has a set of information it substitutes for the missing items For example if you don t tell AMOS what account a file is in it usually assumes it is in the account you are currently logged into Defaults vary among commands Check the reference sheet for a specific command to see what defaults it uses In particular the special commands called wildcard file commands handle defaults differently than other commands on the system File Specification Data on a disk is organized into logically related groups called files Whenever you want to identify a file to an AMOS command enter that file s specification which includes its name and where it is located if necessary Re entrant A program is re entrant when it can be used by more than one user at a time and is therefore able to be loaded into System Memory where it can be shared by all users Re entrant programs are also re usable Re usable A program is re usable when it can be interrupted during its operation and then
243. Rewrite Hidden Sector Format Drive Info List Defects Initialize Drive Mode Sense To navigate the menus use and WJ To invoke a highlighted function press RETURN To abort menu functions and return to the AMOS prompt press or C To return to menu functions from submenus press ESC You can do any of the following in interactive mode Select Drive Selects drive to use in the operations listed below Reassign Blocks The AM 403 does not support this function Rewrite Hidden Sector Re initializes the drive s hidden sector If the hidden sector becomes corrupted you may use this command to restore it without destroying any user data assuming the hidden sector is initialized as it was before it became corrupted Whenever the hidden sector is written the diagnostic cylinder is also re initialized This is necessary since the diagnostic cylinder always begins right after the last logical drive defined on the device Format s Unless you are tryingto correct a media problem you should always use Initialize Drive YS instead of Format Formats and initializes the selected drive You can select the directory type and either set the bitmap size and number of logicals or have FMTDVD optimize the logical configuration Here are the settings for some common configurations e For traditional directories using the entire drive with the largest possible bitmaps set Directory Type to Traditional and Optimize to Yes
244. S 1 2 is created by a disk certification program for certain kinds of disk devices It contains a list of the bad blocks or tracks on those devices You must never destroy or alter the contents of aBADBLK SYS 1 2 file To protect the integrity of a device s certification data COPY won t overwrite BADBLK SYS 1 2 COPY supports command file error checking See your Command File User s Manual FORMAT COPY newfspec filespec filespec switch newfspec is the specification of the file to be created and the filespec s are the files to be copied A switch is an option request To copy to a terminal newfspec is the name of the terminal in the format TRM terminal name You can only copy to a terminal which uses the TRM driver DEFAULTS The initial default filespec is and the account and device you are logged into The default newfspec is and the account and device you are logged into unless you are logged into 1 2 in which case it is and the device you are logged into The default switches are D NOQ NOR and NOS System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 COPY Page 2 OPTIONS All the switches are file switches and may be abbreviated QUERY Confirm before copying NOQUERY Don t confirm copy Default DELETE Overwrite existing file Default NODELETE Don t overwrite existing file REPLACE Overwrite existing files only Do not copy if there is no existing file NOREPLACE Do not overwrit
245. S command Although CTYPE can only display one file multiple files may be displayed using the CTYPE function in OS Exec CTYPE tries to output the uncompressed content of ANY file compressed by OS Exec Before using CTYPE use CDIR to be sure the uncompressed file is a sequential file that can be displayed on a terminal Only sequential files compressed using the OS Exec program CMP may be displayed using CTYPE The EXP command can be used to expand the contents of a compressed sequential file The CDIR command can be used to list the type size and name of a compressed file FORMAT CTYPE filespec OPERATION Enter CTYPE and the file specification For example CTYPE TRANS CTYPE then displays the uncompressed content of the file MESSAGES Bad Input File The file cannot be expanded due to a problem in the compressed file s content File is not an OS Exec compressed file Use the TYPE command to display the file The file specified is not in the format expected by CTYPE Use the TYPE command to display the file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DATE FUNCTION Sets or displays the system date CHARACTERISTICS DATE is re entrant and re usable You don t need to be logged in to display the date To set the system date you must be logged into an operator s account 1 2 FORMAT DATE datespec datespec is a date in the date format specified in your language definition file For U S Eng
246. S process dvdres DVDRES Version 8 0 101 5 Copyright C 2002 Alpha Micro Products Found the following possible DVD Recorders ID Description t 5 HL DT STDVDRAM GSA 4081B Zy 3 HITACHI DVD RAM GF 2050 Select one of the above devices 1 DVD RAM drive found at SCSI id 5 CD title Alpha DVD Backup DVD RAM contains 9 logical units DVDO Open Logical UPD Os pea aiin o be elie eye dh Es mounted 56320 DVD1 Open Logical 22 UPDI anyer aa ote cb ath tere e mounted 56320 DVD2 Open Logical UPD ZE suse k SAe ede SR hs oe mounted 56320 DVD3 Open Logical 2UPDS i e oe on eS ees mounted 56320 DVD4 Open Logical UBD 2 ssc c ee ee ete tated west mounted 56320 DVD5 Open Logical 2 URDO Se pee aa E E E des mounted 56320 DVD6 Open Logical s UPDE rs wwe es bea eee ees mounted 56320 DVD7 Open Logical as UPDI isis 58 SAS See Sa dog shoes mounted 56320 DVD8 Open Logical s wUPD Os Suae es eis slated eb ese Shad mounted 56320 Which DVD Logical s would you like to restore Enter the list of disk Logicals to be transferred Disk Logicals may be entered as a range ex devO 20 for devO thru dev20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line DVDO 8 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 DVDRES Page 4 Which Disk Logical s would you like to restore to Enter list of disk
247. S2 destroys all data on all logical entire physical disk before proceeding System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 FMTS2 Page 2 OPTIONS Options may be abbreviated only as shown in parentheses BITMAP B number Specifies bitmap size of a logical drive EXTENDED E Creates extended format logicals FORMAT P Formats and initializes INFORMATION INFO Displays device information default INITIALIZE INIT Initializes only LOGICALS L number Specifies number of logical drives to create NO OPTIMIZE NOPT Disables logical format optimization Must also use B and L switches OPTIMIZE O Optimizes logical format for drive capacity default REWRITE HSZ RHSZ Rewrites just the hidden sector SASI The drive to format is on SASI bus SCSI The drive to format is on SCSI bus default OPERATION FMTS2 runs in command line or interactive mode Three features Reassign Blocks List Defects and Mode Sense are available only in interactive mode Command Line Mode To use FMTS2 in command line mode you include the SCSI ID and options you want on the command line For example FMTS2 ID 6 SCSI F E This command formats the disk at SCSI ID 6 and creates extended logicals Interactive Mode To run FMTS2 in interactive mode don t include any parameters or switches on the command line If FMTS2 detects both SASI and SCSI interfaces on the system a dialog box asks you to J selec
248. SCSI bus you will be asked to choose the device you wish to use After entering the DIRBD command the following will be displayed DIRBD Version X X xxx x Copyright 2007 Alpha Microsystems If DIRBD finds multiple DVD RAM or Blu ray drives while scanning the SCSI bus the following message will be displayed to allow you to select the drive to use System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 DIRBD Found the following possibl ID Ty nn 2 nn Select one The following is a DIRBD DIRBD Version 8 0 100 Found the following possibl ID T 5 Zs 4 Select one of th DBD Recorders Description XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXKXXXKXXXKXX XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX of the above devices nn sample of a DIRBD process Copyright 2007 DBD Recorders Description SONY BDRW BWU 100A HL DT STDVD RAM GSA H22N 2 above devices Page 2 Alpha Microsystems DVD RAM or Blu ray drive found at SCSI id 4 B L 0 C K S BITMAP SECTOR OFFSET DEV L ITEM Total Used Free words SOL SOL SPEC T L A B E L DBD000 307200 20928 286272 9200 0 blk REX000 E AM 8000 8 0 Release amp Static Files DBD001 307200 216928 90272 9200 1470 3 blk REX001 E AM 8000 8 0 Build amp Source Files DBD002 307200 2617 304583 9200 E849 2 blk REX0
249. SK6 Waiting for DVD Recorder to finish writing Completed Also the following information is displayed on the status line 20 complete The percentage complete shows how much of the total amount of data has been written to the DVD RAM When all data has been written to the DVD RAM the following message is shown AlphaDVD creation complete And then the DVD is ready to use REQUIREMENTS AND SETUP MAKDVD requires the following A 68030 or faster processor A full interrupt enabled SCSI dispatcher DCACHE with the number of read ahead blocks set to 7 for best performance AMOS 2 3A or later A supported DVD RAM drive The MAKDVD package contains the following required files MAKDVD LIT The device driver for the DVD RAM drive The DVD DEV file that contains supported DVD RAM drive information The SSD overlay file DVD000 OVR MODIFYING THE SYSTEM INITIALIZATION FILE See the software installation instructions in PDI 00403 00 for software installation information System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 Page 5 MAKDVD MESSAGES Command line syntax messages Invalid switch Invalid switch option System requirements messages MAKDVD requires a 68030 or higher CPU MAKDVD requires a full interrupt level dispatcher MAKDVD requires a SCSI dispatcher MAKDVD requires AMOS 2 x or compatible operating system Memory partition is too small for MAKDVD An additional nnnK of memory is required DVD RAM
250. ST and TESTFIRST together System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 7 MAKACD Invalid switch Invalid switch option System requirements messages MAKACD requires a 68030 or higher CPU MAKACD requires a full interrupt level dispatcher MAKACD requires a SCSI dispatcher MAKACD requires AMOS 2 x or compatible operating system Memory partition is too small for MAKACD An additional nnnK of memory is required CD Recorder device or driver messages Cannot open xxx device in use Another user is currently using the CD recorder Device specified is not a CD Recorder This CD Recorder requires a different driver The current driver is XXXXXX The required driver is xxxxxx The device and driver selected are inappropriate for the physical CD recorder Unable to find a CD Recorder Unknown CD Recorder Error Unsupported CD recorder found The CD recorder is not supported by MAKACD Error messages when setting up or writing to the CD Recorder Error Buffer not initialized Error CD Recorder out of data during recording The computer was unable to supply data to the CD recorder fast enough to keep the recorder supplied with data The CD is incomplete and unusable If others were using the system during recording try again without the other users Otherwise try again using a slower maximum recording speed see the SPEED switch Error Disk in CD Recorder is not writeable Error Disk in CD Recorder is not writeab
251. T 8 DSK1 12 34 APPEND TXT 16 DIRECT LST 3 DSKCLR CMD 5 Total of 4 files in 32 blocks To display a directory listing for specific files DIR HEX LIT SYSIT AA HEX LIT sleek DSK1 105 5 SYSITI AA 87 DSK1 105 5 SYSIT2 AA 8 Total of 2 files in 95 blocks SYSIT3 AA 42 DSK1 140 2 SYSITO AA 6 Total of 2 files in 48 blocks Grand total of 5 files in 154 blocks Notice DIR gives subtotals for each listing matching a filespec if that listing contains two or more files MESSAGES Account does not exist p pn The indicated account does not exist Check your entry and if you need to create the account see the SYSACT reference sheet for help Cannot find DSKO CMDLIN SYS 1 4 DIR needs this file to process wildcard symbols in your file specifications CMDLIN SYS does not exist in the proper account or you don t have enough memory in your partition to load in the file See your System Operator for help Device not found The device you specified does not exist Check your spelling or use DEVTBL to see a list of the devices defined on your system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DIR Page 4 Device not mounted Mount the device and try again Illegal output specification The output specification you used was incorrect Check your spelling and the description of output specification above Maximum input exceeded You put more characters on
252. TABORT switch the command file continues If this same situation occurs in a control file it doesn t ask for user input Instead if you use TIMEOUT the control file checks the error condition for example is the tape in the drive still write protected every few seconds for the number of minutes you specify If the error isn t corrected in that time MTUSAV aborts and if you ve used the SOFTABORT switch the control file continues Entering TIMEOUT 0 is the same as not using the TIMEOUT switch Even using TIMEOUT there is no way to change tapes for a multi tape backup while in a control file MTUSAV will abort according to the SOFTABORT setting if there is not enough room on a single tape If you use TIMEOUT without SOFTABORT any actions following MTUSAV in the command or control file are not performed unless you correct the error condition within the TIMEOUT time limit Neither SOFTABORT or TIMEOUT has any effect if you are using MTUSAV from AMOS command level not in a command or control file Using MTUSAV With the Task Manager Because little interaction is possible when running a control file under the Task Manager MTUSAV reduces its functionality MTUSAV s responses to error conditions which can be corrected e g a tape is write protected or no tape is in place are controlled by the TIMEOUT and SOFTABORT switches as described above Other conditions cannot be corrected For example tapes cannot b
253. TAP only works under AMOS 32 and AMOS L versions of the operating system You may not copy to a disk account if it is not in the project you are copying from unless you are logged into the System Operator s account 1 2 You may copy files into the account you are logged into from any other account regardless of project number FORMAT TAPFIL switch outfilespec filespec filespec switch switch is an option request outfilespec specifies the files to be created on the disk and the filespec s specify the files to be copied from the tape including the disk device and account specifications of the files when they were backed up DEFAULTS The output specification filename and extension default to the file specifications and the device and account you are logged into If you re logged into 1 2 the default output account specification is and if the account you are copying to does not exist TAPFIL creates it The file specification defaults to and the account and device you are logged into The default magnetic tape drive device specification is MTU System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TAPFIL Page 2 OPTIONS All switches are file switches and may be abbreviated QUERY Confirm before copying files NOQUERY Don t confirm copy Default DELETE Copy over existing files Default NODELETE Don t copy over existing files OPERATION Enter TAPFIL the optional output specification an equal sign
254. TBL to see a list of devices on your system and try again Cannot OPEN device name protection violation Log into OPR or the account you want to write into and try again Cannot read device name device is not mounted Mount the device and try again Cannot restore extended directory format files to an old format disk Cannot restore old format files to an extended directory format disk You must restore files to the same format traditional or extended disk they were backed up from When restoring you must also be logged on to the same type of device you were logged on to when creating the backup Device full See your System Operator about erasing files from or clearing room on the device System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 STRRES Page 4 Files may not be transferred to RES You may only add programs to system memory by using SYSTEM statements in your system initialization file Missing output specification You left out the equal sign in the STRRES command line STRRES couldn t tell which information was your file specification and which was your outfilespec Try again More than one output specification Try again using only one output specification Not copied Destination file already exists Try again using D if you want the file copied over Not selected Destination file has same HASH as source file You used H and STRRES found matching hash totals on the cartridge and the disk The files
255. TS The first international standard was set in 1965 by ECMA European Computer Manufacturer s Association and was known as ECMA 6 The character set was adopted by other standards bodies and is also known as US ASCII DIN 66003 and ISO 646 The standard only defined a basic alphabet and did not allow for national characters in use in many European countries Such characters were incorporated by specifying twelve code points see Note 1 in the table below as being places where replacement characters could be defined For example Germany defined the letter A at code point 91 where the character was located These character sets were called the national ISO 646 variants Portability of files containing such characters were low In 1981 the IBM PC introduced an 8 bit character set with Code Page 437 a character set with many special characters In 1982 DEC MCS Multi Language Character Set was released This character set was very similar to ISO 6937 2 which in turn is almost identical to the modern standard for 8 bit character sets ISO 8859 In 1985 ECMA standardized ECMA 94 which dealt with almost all European languages ECMA 94 was taken up by ISO as ISO 8859 1 through 8859 4 and standardized in 1987 Microsoft released MS DOS 3 3 in 1987 which used Code Page 850 This code page uses all the characters from ISO 8859 1 plus a few extra at code points representing the non printing characters A second code page Code Page 819 is
256. TST will not find the correct SCSI ID and will not work See the MONGEN and FIXLOG reference sheets for more information You can also use MONTST to test warm boot files When doing this don t specify an INI file FORMAT MONTST monitor spec system INI filespec monitor spec specifies the monitor you want to test and system INI filespec specifies the system initialization command file you want to use The initialization file MUST be in DSKO 1 4 of the newly booted system For example if you are MONTSTing a monitor with a floppy driver MONGENed into it the initialization file must be on DSKO of the floppy drive System Commands Reference Manual Rev 06 MONTST Page 2 DEFAULTS The default monitor file is your system default monitor file DSKO AMOSL MON 1 4 or DSKO0 AMOS32 MON 1 4 The default extension is MON the default account for the monitor is DSKO 1 4 MONTST assumes the default system initialization file DSKO AMOSL INI 1 4 or DSKO AMOS32 INI 1 4 for the system INI filespec The default file extension is INI the default account is DSKO 1 4 A These defaults apply even for computers which use CMOS boot settings and have a S different default monitor or initialization file specified in CMOS OPERATION Log into account DSKO 1 2 and enter MONTST followed by the specifications of the system monitor and the system initialization command file to bring the system up under For example LOG OPR
257. TURN to start recording or C to abort The recording process then begins As it progresses status messages are displayed Transferring DSKO in real mode Transferring DSK6 in real mode Waiting for CD recorder to finish writing Completed Also the following information is displayed on the status line 20 complete buffer 95 The percentage complete shows how much of the total amount of data has been written to the CD The buffer percentage shows how full the CD recorder s internal cache buffer is When all data has been written to the CD in real mode the following messages are shown Writing Table Of Contents AlphaCD creation complete And then the CD is ready to use REQUIREMENTS AND SETUP MAKACD requires the following A 68030 or faster processor A full interrupt enabled SCSI dispatcher DCACHE with the number of read ahead blocks set to 7 for best performance AMOS 2 3A or later A supported CD Recorder The MAKACD package contains the following required files e The device driver for the CD Recorder e The CDR DEV file that contains supported CD recorder information System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MAKACD Page 6 e The SSD overlay file CDRO00 OVR MODIFYING THE SYSTEM INITIALIZATION FILE The CD recording device must be specified as a non sharable device in a DEVTBL statement in the system initialization file Example DEVTBL CDRO No other changes are required in the system ini
258. TUSAV OPT to adjust severity is described below MTUSAV indicates the final severity of an incident after all MTUSAV OPT processing by starting each message relating to the incident with the symbol shown above As MTUSAV executes it remembers the severity of the gravest incident encountered so far In addition to the three discussed above there are two severities MTUSAV OPT cannot adjust standard AMOS DDB errors and Control C aborts These five levels form a hierarchy of incident importance the Incident Priority hierarchy as listed Priority Used For None Notes do not set JOBERR Low DDB file error codes usually temporary conditions Vv Warnings setting JE WRN v Other errors defined in error tables except JE CTC Highest Control C setting JE CTC Just before MTUSAV exits it writes the value of the highest priority incident to JOBERR You can then test this value by using IF LIT as the next command in a command file or by using a program that has its PH ERR bit set in its program header Listing Severity Levels You can list MTUSAV s default severity levels for user controllable incidents by running MTUSAV OPTL or MTUSAV OPT2 if you add the LOG switch the list is also placed in the MTUSAV LOG file You should use OPT2 LOG to create a list you can then modify to create an MTUSAV OPT file as discussed below After you have set up an MTUSAV OPT file you can list the settings that result from the merge of the default sett
259. TY n RESTART NORESTART REVIVE SEQUENCE n switches SUSPEND OPERATION Page 2 Task will execute specified relative time after submitted time Specify an output file for the task Default is control filename LOG File remains permanently in the queue executing at specified time Negates PERMANENT Task needs priority of 1 to 512 to run Default is 256 The greater the number the higher in the queue You cannot change a task s priority while it is running File restarts if system crashes while it is running File will not restart Revives a suspended task Updates task n with switches Suspends task Enter SUBMIT followed by an optional queue filespec and equal sign Then enter a control filespec and any optional switches If no control file is specified SUBMIT shows you the queue listing For example to submit the file TEST CTL SUBMIT TEST The next command submits TEST CTL to queue OURQUE SYS It is placed permanently in the queue and runs every day after 3 12 AM starting on March 17 1989 If the system crashes the task is restarted upon bootup The queue display shows a P under status to show it is permanent SUBMIT OURQUE TEST RESTART PERM AFTER 17 03 89 03 12 In the next case the command instructs the Task Manager to change the memory requirements of job 14 in the queue to 40K You don t need a job name since the sequence number is unique SUBMIT SEQUENCE 14 MEMORY 40K MESSAGES
260. TZ O OLDDEF DSK2 112 0 This changes the definition of OLDDEF from whatever it was to DSK2 112 0 To delete an existing ersatz definition use the D switch and the ersatz name ERSATZ D OLDDEF This deletes the ersatz definition for OLDDEF n Any change you make using D or O takes effect immediately for all users If other users are using the ersatz name you change or delete you could keep their commands from working or cause a file copy or deletion for example to affect the wrong disk account Be very careful when affecting ersatz names used by multiple users To add a new ersatz definition follow the A switch with the new definition ERSATZ A NEWDEF 1964439999 DSK3 66 77 This adds the indicated meaning for the name NEWDEF To add an ersatz definition there must be a blank entry in the ersatz table Blank entries are created when you delete an ersatz entry or by using the B switch with the ersatz command in the system initialization command file See the System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for more information about the B switch Me When adding an ersatz name remember that ersatz names cannot start with a number The W first character in the name must be a letter MESSAGES Cannot add definition ERSATZ table full You used the A switch to add a new ersatz name but there are no blank entries in the ersatz table You can use D to delete an ersatz definition and create a blank entry
261. The warm boot is a procedure you use to restore your system when your System Disk is erased or written over accidentally A warm boot from a 1 2 tape requires a special monitor file you generate using the WRMGEN command and which is pre initialized with enough information to get your system up and running on one terminal and in one memory partition Then you can restore the damaged files to your System Disk from other 1 2 tape backups you previously created using FILTAP A magnetic tape cannot contain both a warm boot monitor and data files See the FILTAP reference sheet for information on creating a separate data backup tape MTBOOT works only on AMOS 32 and AMOS L versions of the operating system FORMAT MTBOOT filespec switch filespec is the specification of the warm boot monitor file you want to copy onto the streamer tape The default filespec has the same name as your system monitor with a WRM extension i e DSKO0 AMOSL WRM 1 4 or DSKO AMOS32 WRM 1 4 switch is one of the options listed below OPTIONS BOOT Transfers a warm boot file from disk onto the tape and labels the tape as a warm boot tape CHECK Reads entire tape and checks that the tape can be read without device errors Block statistics are updated as the check proceeds VERIFY Writes known data pattern to the entire tape then rewinds tape and reads it back checking for data errors Block statistics and errors are updated as the program proceeds This
262. This error may appear when DVDRES displays the contents of the DVD It means that the logical which was backed up had no data in it other than the label block and MFD It is ignored because the bitmap words cannot be calculated Normal informational messages e The program has completed The recording of data from the DVD media is done e DVD RAM Recorder located at SCSI id n This shows the SCSI id of the DVD RAM Drive being used e Note that once started the restoring operation can be stopped by pressing C However if the restoring is stopped a DSKANA or SYSACT to the last logical that was interrupted needs to be done The last logical that was interrupted will have a mixture of new and old blocks that will cause problems e Restoring DSKO e Using Generic SCSI DVD RAM driver DVDRAM This message shows the DVD driver name and description being used e Using Panasonic DVD RAM driver DVDPAN System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 ERASE FUNCTION Erases files from the disk CHARACTERISTICS ERASE is re entrant re usable a wildcard command and recognizes ersatz names FORMAT ERASE filespec filespec s switch filespec is a file to be erased and switch is an option request or ERASE filespecl filespec2 filespecn switch filespec1 is a file to be erased if a file matching any of filespec2 through filespecn is present DEFAULTS ERASE uses the device and account you are lo
263. To send files to the printer with the least number of blocks in its queue or to the default printer set by the System Operator enter PRNT and the files you want to print For example PRNT LST If you wish to send files to a specific printer enter PRNT and the name of the printer you want to use an equal sign and your list of files For example PRNT DRAFT BACKUP S CFIL You can change the switch settings for a file already in the queue using the sequence number of the file you want to change and the switch or switches you want to add or change For example PRNT SEQ 17 C 5 This causes PRNT to print five copies of the file with sequence number 17 MESSAGES You may see any of the standard system error messages resulting from invalid device and account specifications In addition you may see Buffer full some files not listed The number of files in the print queue exceeds the number displayed on the screen Command line too long Buffer full some files are not killed The command line passed to a remote printer is too long Split the command into two and enter each shorter command in turn System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PRNT Page 4 Destination network does not exist Destination node does not exist Destination socket does not exist Destination socket not enabled You have specified a remote system which cannot be accessed or which does not have a spooler accessible over the network Check yo
264. a GLB extension and the name of the first segment specified on the GLOBAL command line FORMAT GLOBAL switch filespec filespec s switch is an option and the filespecs specify the OBJ files DEFAULTS The default file extension is OBJ The device and account defaults to where you are logged OPTIONS GLOBAL switches may be abbreviated and are operation switches LONG n Produces a list file up to n lines long The default is 80 IT Outputs in a slightly different format with more lines per page WIDE n Produces a list file up to n characters on a line The default is 130 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 GLOBAL Page 2 OPERATION Enter GLOBAL any optional switches and a list of the files you want For example GLOBAL W L MAIN SUB1 SUB2 If you have more file specifications than will fit on one command line end the line with a comma GLOBAL prompts you with an asterisk and you can enter the next line of file specifications You may enter as many lines as you want as long as all preceding lines end with a comma GLOBAL reads each file you specify and builds a table of global symbols in memory Here is a portion of what a GLOBAL listing file might look like M Ss 58 A U U B B N 1 2 ALPHA E BETA E M E ZETA IO The listing file above tells us the symbol ALPHA appeared in an INTERN statement in the file MAIN and in an EXTERN statement in file SUB1 BETA appeared in
265. a command file entry for the tape label is too large MTUSAV truncates it to the maximum length As discussed above in Recommended Procedures you can use the IF command to check JOBERR after MTUSAV finishes To do this IF must be the next command after the MTUSAV data otherwise AMOS resets JOBERR and the value from MTUSAV is lost Error Reporting You do not need to know the following information to use MTUSAV successfully We provide it for advanced users who want to understand the technical aspects of error handling or who want to be able to customize MTUSAV s error reporting A great many things can go wrong during a backup disks can fill up files can be left open or opened during the backup and more To handle all of these situations MTUSAV s error processing procedures are necessarily complex The following sections contain e A discussion of incident severity and priority e A series of tables showing the various incidents that can occur at each stage of MTUSAV processing and MTUSAV s response to each e Ways you can control incident reporting both by listing files for which some types of errors shouldn t be reported and by changing the severity of certain incidents ol The rest of this reference sheet refers to any condition which triggers exception error P gt processing as an incident Error refers only to an incident of a specific severity as discussed below Incident Severity and Priori
266. a disk is mounted Enter the name of your installation or company This field which may be up to 30 characters long may be useful when exchanging disks between different installations Enter the name of the computer system this disk was created on This field which can be up to 30 characters long is useful when a particular installation has more than one computer system Enter the name of the person creating the disk This field may be up to 30 characters long To change a logical device to extended format after its label block has been damaged LABEL DSKO E Payroll Data PAYOO1 Created on 1 Jan 90 at OzWiz Inc on Systeml by Melvin Last access 2 Apr 94 Are you sure you want an EXTENDED logical Y Logical changed to extended format Label updated MESSAGES Cannot combine both E and S switches These two switches are mutually exclusive you cannot use them in the same LABEL command System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 LABEL Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see what devices are defined on your system then try again Disk is not labeled The disk does not have a label If you wanted to give it a label this message means you are not logged into account 1 2 do so and try again File specification error Check your syntax against the format of the LABEL command and try again Illegal switch You have enter
267. a in every block of the device THIS DESTROYS ALL THE DATA CURRENTLY ON THE DISK If you must use CRT420 make sure you back up any data you need on that device before you certify it CRT420 creates account 1 2 on the disk you are certifying Then it creates a file BADBLK SYS 1 2 containing a list of all bad disk blocks on the device For information on the program that displays BADBLK SYS see the BADBLK reference sheet Multiple logical devices on the same Winchester technology physical unit share the same BADBLK file FORMAT CRT420 devn OPERATION Make sure no one else is using your system Then log into OPR and enter CRT420 and the specification of the device you want to certify For example LOG OPR CRT420 PLDO System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CRT420 Page 2 CRT420 now warns you that CRT420 will destroy all the data on the disk Make sure you have backed up any data on the disk you may need You can stop the program at this point by pressing CTRLYC CRT420 creates a file named BADBLK SYS in account 1 2 of the disk you are certifying CRT420 then asks you several questions Enter maximum acceptable number of bad tracks CRT420 has a set maximum number of bad tracks depending on the data capacity of the drive you may choose to accept less Enter number of accounts to preallocate This information allows CRT420 to pre initialize blocks in the Master File directory MFD There
268. a one block header file at the front of each file You can skip over this header block by using TAPE once or by using the SKIP command To rewind tapes use the REWIND command If you make a mistake in answering TAPE questions you may press CTRLYC to exit TAPE System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TAPE Page 2 OPERATION If you intend to use the TAPE option of converting ASCII characters to EBCDIC characters or vice versa you can customize the conversion for your application You must do the customizing modification BEFORE using TAPE The modification is made to a table in the System Library account TAPE refers to For further information about making customized conversions between ASCII and EBCDIC see your System Operator s Guide Enter TAPE at AMOS command level TAPE The screen clears and TAPE asks you if you want to copy a file from disk to tape or copy a file from tape to disk Select the appropriate option Then you are asked to select what type of character code conversion you want Remember the conversion if any is done on the data going to the output device Whether this device is the disk or tape unit depends on your answer to the first question Copying Disk Files to Tape TAPE begins to ask a series of questions It requests a file specification give the AMOS specification of the file you want to copy and a device specification give the specification of the tape drive to which you want to copy Now TAPE ask
269. a specific printer on the system FORMAT PRINT switch printer filespec filespec switch printer is the specification for a printer filespec is a file to be printed and switch is an option request J If you use PRINT K while connected to another computer using a version of AlphaNET S earlier than 2 2 the Q switch has no effect DEFAULTS The default printerspec is the printer with the least number of blocks waiting in the queue to be printed unless the System Operator has used the DEFAULT command in the spooler parameter file to define another printer default The default switch settings depend upon the specific printer being used The defaults for each printer are set by the System Operator The default filespec is a null name and LST extension The initial default device and account is the account and device you are currently logged into OPTIONS All switches may be abbreviated to any unique characters BANNER text Print a banner page up to 50 characters at listing front Operation switch NOBANNER No banner Default operation switch COPIES n Number of copies to print File switch DELETE Delete file after print File switch System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PRINT Page 2 NODELETE Don t delete Default file switch FORMFEED Print a final form feed at each listing end File switch Abbreviation is FF NOFORMFEED No form feed Default file switch FORMS form Specify form
270. a to a log file For example Now MTUSAV copies the files onto the tape If your tape device supports tape spanning and all MTUSAV DSK1 66 1 VERIFY LOG This backs up all files in the account DSK1 66 1 then compares the files on the tape to the disk and writes the results to the MTUSAV LOG file in the account you re logged into System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 5 MTUSAV Recommended Procedures This section gives recommended procedures for using MTUSAV We do not recommend a particular backup frequency completeness of backup backup method full incremental etc or tape rotation These all depend on your situation Plan for the worst These procedures refer to topics especially error handling and reporting covered later in this reference sheet MTUSAV can record a lot of information about each backup which can be invaluable if you need to restore data To take advantage of these abilities we recommend Always do a DSKANA of the devices from which you are backing up before the MTUSAV Correct any file system errors before backing up Before running MTUSAV always log into a device with enough free space to record all of the TOC and VER entries The TOC file needs roughly one block for each 30 files backed up the VER file requires one block for each ten files Always use the LOG and VERIFY options The LOG switch creates a disk file containing all the information MTUSAV records about the ba
271. able machine language program LIT or OVR file M68 understands nested macro calls nested conditionals and program segmentation using overlay statements and AUTOEXTERN EXTERN and INTERN statements al M68 is not re entrant or re usable and so can t be loaded into system memory AS y y M68 runs in five distinct phases some of which are called in response to optional switches or special situations If your file contains no internal or external references M68 automatically calls the linkage editor to link your program as Phase 4 of the assembly otherwise you must explicitly use the LNKLIT or SYMLIT commands to create a resolved executable program from the OBJ file created by M68 For information on using the macro assembler LNKLIT and SYMLIT see your Assembly Language Programmer s Manual It also contains information on the object file library generator LIBLIT and the global cross reference generator GLOBAL FORMAT M68 filespec switches filespec selects the source file you want to assemble and the optional switches select the M68 options you want to use DEFAULTS M68 assumes a file extension of M68 Unless you specify one of the listing switches M68 does not provide an assembly listing The device and account default to where you are logged System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 M68 OPTIONS Page 2 You may specify multiple switches by entering them after a single symbol at the en
272. account System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 PATCH FUNCTION Installs software patches into existing machine language programs CHARACTERISTICS PATCH is re entrant and re usable The patch you install will normally be supplied to you by your dealer in either printed form or on recording media If the patch is given to you in printed form you will need to enter the patch into the computer using AlphaVUE before you use PATCH Patch files are special macro assembler source files PATCH assembles the patch file using M68 and then uses PTCH LIT to insert the changes into the existing program PATCH checks for the proper hash total and version number of the existing file and once the patch has been completed it also makes sure the new hash total and updated version number are correct If for any reason the hash total or version number is wrong no patch is done and your original program file remains unmodified FORMAT PATCH existing program WITH patch file existing program is the program you want to patch and patch file is the source file containing the patch to be made The default existing program extension is LIT the default patch file extension is M68 OPERATION Enter PATCH the name of the original program WITH and the name of the patch program For example PATCH TEST WITH TESTP PATCH displays information as it processes You will see hash totals for the old and new patched version
273. active You have not specified any programs to run with the cache disabled System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 COMPIL FUNCTION Compiles AlphaBASIC programs producing an executable RUN file CHARACTERISTICS COMPIL is re entrant and re usable The program you compile is a BASIC source program previously saved after using AlphaBASIC in interactive mode or created using AlphaVUE For more information on COMPIL RUN and BASIC see your AlphaBASIC User s Manual COMPIL does not require your AlphaBASIC program to have line numbers If COMPIL finds an error it does not produce a RUN file FORMAT COMPIL filespec switch s filespec is the file containing the program you want to compile and switch is an option request COMPIL assumes an extension of BAS OPTIONS IA Selects long addressing mode 24 bit L Creates a file listing your program line by line after an offset number so errors can be easily found M Displays message for each unmapped variable N Suppresses printing of COMPIL statistics 0 Omits line number references from compiled code to reduce size Error messages won t report line numbers IT Displays each line as it compiles to help find errors OPERATION Enter COMPIL and the specification of the file you want to compile For example COMPIL PROJCT BAS COMPIL displays messages after the command line showing the compilation status When COMPIL finishes and if it found no errors it produces a
274. ad data from You may either press to create an empty data file or you may specify a sequential data file from which you want to load data ISMBLD assumes a file extension of SEQ for this data file After loading the data file ISMBLD returns you to AMOS command level If you are not creating a new data index file combination that is if you specified a file to ISMBLD that already exists ISMBLD goes directly into file loading mode Instead of asking you the list of file parameter questions above it tells you it is processing the existing file and asks for the name of the file from which to load data If you press RETURN ISMBLD does not load from a file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 ISMBLD To change the data file device after an ISAM file has been created use the D switch on the ISMBLD command line For example if you want to change the device of the data file from DSKO to DSK1 ISMBLD MAIL D Processing existing file Current device name is DSKO Enter new device name DSK1 MESSAGES Attempt to add duplicate key key Make sure you have not tried to load a key twice from the same data file Duplicate secondary key left out key You tried to use ISMBLD on a secondary index file the key listed is already in an index file End of input file in middle of record You loaded an ISAM file with data from a sequential data file but the parameters you gave to ISMBLD when yo
275. again but input the media defect list from a file or type it in from the keyboard System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CRT610 FUNCTION Checks and verifies the quality of video cassettes for use as disk file backup media Optionally creates a warm boot monitor cassette using a warm boot monitor file built by WRMGEN Also has the option of calibrating a remotely controlled VCR CHARACTERISTICS CRT610 is re entrant and re usable Your system must contain the appropriate video controller board A warm boot boots your system from a special warm boot video cassette when it can t boot from the System Disk See the WRMGEN reference sheet for more information FORMAT CRT610 filespec switch filespec specifies the warm boot monitor you want to copy onto video cassette and switch indicates an option The default warm boot monitor is your system monitor for example DSKO AMOSL WRM 1 4 or DSKO AMOS32 WRM 1 4 OPTIONS All options are operation switches and may be abbreviated to unique characters BOOT Creates a warm boot cassette If you specify a filespec B is assumed default CALIBRATE Calibrates a remote control VCR Must also use V Locks out other users on your system CHECK Reads a cassette and displays status Does not harm data Turns off B and V FILE Like C but status put in file VCRSTS LST where you are logged Overwrites existing LST file HARD Used with CHECK to retry a maxim
276. aits after the appropriate statement for you to respond Y for yes or N for no You don t need to press after Y or N For example MTURES BAS Q Enter tape device nam MTUO STRO MTU MTUO DSK3 NEW BAS 10 3 to DSK2 NEW BAS 10 3 Y TU0O DSK3 SCRTICH BAS 10 6 to DSK2 SCRTCH BAS 10 6 N System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 MTURES MTURES requires the first reel mounted be the first reel of a save set and each subsequent reel be from the same save set and be in the correct order If MTURES detects an out of sequence reel it displays a message on your terminal and gives you a chance to mount the correct one MTURES prompts you each time a new reel is required When the restore is finished rewind the tape and return it to its storage location To restore all files on the tape to the disks and accounts they were originally backed up from log into account DSKO 1 2 and enter MTURES ALL ALL You can restore all files backed up from one logical device to a different logical device For example to restore files from DSK2 onto DSKS log into DSKO 1 2 and enter MTURES DSK5 DSK2 To restore all the logical devices on a tape to the devices of a subsystem disk for example SUB log into DSKO 1 2 and enter MTURES SUB ALL The subsystem you re restoring to should have the same number of logical devices as the disk the files were backed up from single fil
277. al Rev 15 JOBALC FUNCTION Displays your job name CHARACTERISTICS JOBALLC is re entrant and re usable JOBALC is also used in the system initialization command line to define jobs to the system See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for more information OPERATION Enter JOBALC at AMOS level For example JOBALC Your job name is MELVIN System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 JOBPRI FUNCTION Displays and changes job priorities CHARACTERISTICS JOBPRI is re entrant and re usable In a timesharing environment each user receives a certain number of real time clock ticks before the CPU moves on to another job If you increase this unit of time called a quantum for a particular user you speed up that job and consequently slow down the jobs of the other users on the system Increasing the number of ticks the CPU spends on a job is called increasing the job s priority You should not change your job s priority or the priority of other jobs on the system unless there is a very good reason for it indiscriminate changes in job priorities might be unpopular with other users on the system and may slow overall system performance You may have job priorities between 1 and 254 The JOBPRI command value tells the system to use that many clock ticks for the specified job The normal setting for a job is 13 To change another job s priority you must be logged in
278. al information The AM 212 20 floppy diskette drive does not support this feature System Commands Reference Manual Rev 09 FMSFLP Page 4 Initialize Media Same as the format option described above except that it doesn t format the media before writing the logical drive information 4 If the diskette s formatting is OK use this option instead of format This will save you time R If you initialize a diskette using a density that differs from its formatted density the P gt diskette will be unusable Mode Sense Retrieves mode sense information from the drive You can view these values e Current Values control the current operation of the drive e Changeable Values indicate which bytes bits are changeable e Saved Values control the current operation of the drive unless they are changed by a Mode Selected command e Default Values used by the drive if current values have not been set or the drive is unable to access its saved values The information you requested is displayed within a scrollable window Use 1 and W to view the information Press when you are done ERROR MESSAGES Logical format exceeds usable drive capacity You specified a logical drive count and bitmap size that exceeds the capacity of the drive Specify a smaller number of logical drives and or bitmap size Program requires AMOS 32 execution FMSFLP requires an MC68020 or later processor It will not run on a computer with an M
279. alpha micro alpha micro alpha micro alpha micro alpha micro alpha micro alpha micro alpha micro alpha micro alpha micro alpha micro AMOS System Commands Reference Manual 1998 Alpha Microsystems REVISIONS INCORPORATED REVISION DATE 00 March 1988 01 December 1988 02 September 1989 03 April 1991 04 September 1996 05 March 1997 06 June 1997 07 December 1997 08 June 1998 09 April 1999 10 October 1999 11 February 2000 12 August 2000 13 January 2001 14 March 2001 15 February 2002 16 May 2004 17 October 2006 18 September 2007 To re order this document request part number DSO 00043 00 This document applies to AMOS version 2 3A PR 06 00 AMOS 8 0 and later The information contained in this manual is believed to be accurate and reliable However no responsibility for the accuracy completeness or use of this information is assumed by Alpha Microsystems The following are registered trademarks of Alpha Microsystems Irvine CA 92614 AMOS Alpha Micro Alpha Micro AlphaACCOUNTING AlphaBASIC AlphaCALC AlphaFORTRAN 77 AlphaLAN AlphaWRITE inSight am AlphaRJE The following are trademarks of Alpha Microsystems Irvine CA 92614 AlphaBASIC PLUS AlphaVUE AMPC AMTEC AlphaDDE AlphaConnect DART AlphaMAIL AlphaNET ESP MULTI All other copyrights and trademarks are the property of their respective holders ALPHA MICROSYSTEMS 17534 Von Karman Irvine CA 92614 Table of Contents CHAPTER 1 INTRODU
280. am error detected on split file An error occurred on the second media of a split media backup Check to make sure you have the correct media If so see your System Operator or your Alpha Micro dealer for help Split file sequence number mismatch detected The second media of a split media backup did not match the first Check to make sure you have the correct media If so see your System Operator or your Alpha Micro dealer for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 7 RESTOR Table of Contents file not found This message appears whenever a Table of Contents file was written onto the backup medium by the BACKUP command but RESTOR could not find it This error should not occur unless the backup recording medium is damaged Unable to run device handler task The device handler failed to communicate with the main task after it was spawned See your System Operator or Alpha Micro dealer for help Unspecified error received The main task received an error from the device handler it did not understand Try again if the problem persists see your Alpha Micro dealer for help VCR failed to respond to command This could indicate a problem with the remote control of your VCR with the connection between your computer and your VCR or with your computer Make sure your cables are properly connected if the cable is okay try to locate whether it s the VCR or computer so you can get it fixed WARNING Copy count
281. am lines For example 10 PRINT This program computes interest rates 20 INPUT Enter balance BALANCE To run a program in memory enter RUN System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 BASIC Page 2 MESSAGES The AlphaBASIC error messages are listed in your AlphaBASIC User s Manual System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 BASICP FUNCTION Allows you to use AlphaBASIC PLUS in interactive mode CHARACTERISTICS BASICP is re entrant and re usable See the AJphaBASIC PLUS User s Manual for information about the AlphaBASIC PLUS programming language fr To exit from AlphaBASIC PLUS enter BYE To interrupt the execution of a program press CTRLYC System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 BASICX FUNCTION Allows you to use AlphaBASIC in interactive mode using the integral math coprocessor on a 68040 CPU chip CHARACTERISTICS BASICX is re entrant and re usable It functions only on a computer with a 68040 CPU with an integral math coprocessor Except for using the math functions of the 68040 to increase performance it works exactly like the BASIC command See the AlphaBASIC User s Manual for information about the AlphaBASIC programming language To exit from AlphaBASIC enter BYE To interrupt the execution of a program press cTALVC System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 BATCH FUNCTION Loads commands frequently used by command files into your memory partitio
282. ames of the files it is selecting to save As STRSAV copies it prints one dot for each fifteen files transferred You may press CTRLYC at any time to stop further transfers When you use Q STRSAV asks for confirmation before each transfer Enter Y for yes or N for no it is not necessary to press RETURN Remember the placement of Q in the command line can affect which files it applies to For example STRSAV DAT Q BAS C40 DAT to C40 DAT LSTSOR BAS to LSTSOR BAS Y NEW BAS to NEW BAS N System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 Page 3 STRSAV You can use H to calculate hash totals for certain files to identify a particular version of the file This saves time when you use STRRES to restore files to the disk because you can specify H to transfer only the files with different hash totals You can use B to transfer a warm boot monitor to a cassette and also back up other files onto the same cassette See the CRT620 and WRMGEN reference sheets to find out more about warm boot monitors MESSAGES Cannot find DSK0 SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS STRSAV needs this file to process wildcard symbols in your file specifications Make sure SCNWLD SYS is in the proper account and you have enough memory to load it in your partition Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system and try again Cannot READ device name device
283. an adjusted COPIES value Invalid argument for FORMS You did not follow FORMS with a colon and the forms name Re enter the command with a corrected FORMS switch Invalid argument for LPP Invalid argument for WIDTH You did not specify a colon followed by a number for the switch Re enter the command with the correct switch format System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PRINT Page 4 LPTSPL Please mount form form name on printer name The spooler operator job gets this message if you specify a form type that is not defined as being mounted on the printer The spooler operator should put the proper form on the printer More than one printer specified You specified more than one printer on the command line to the left of the equals sign Re enter the command specifying only one printer No files in print request PRINT was not able to find the files you specified Check the command line again and make sure the device and account specifications are correct No spooler allocated A print spooler has not been installed on your system Ask your System Operator to install one Not enough free queue blocks for entire request Each file in the print request uses a system resource called a queue block There are not enough queue blocks for your entire request to be satisfied Wait until some files have printed then resubmit the PRINT command for those files which were not selected Including the WAIT switch paus
284. an error at the indicated line number 2Not enough memory Your job does not have enough available memory Unload modules from your memory partition switch to another job with more memory or ask your System Operator to increase your job s memory allocation Too many files Reduce the number of files referenced in your makefile Unexpected end of file at line number Check your makefile for an error at the indicated line number System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 7 Unknown target name in command line Check your spelling and syntax and try again Unrelated command at line number Check your makefile for an error at the indicated line number System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MK MONGEN FUNCTION Generates a new system monitor CHARACTERISTICS MONGEN is re entrant and re usable The system monitor is generated by overlaying the specified disk driver program into the existing monitor This new monitor lets you access any disk for which you have a disk driver program as the System Device The monitor you usually use is in account DSKO 1 4 and has a name that reflects your type of system The disk driver you will use is one of the driver programs in DSKO 1 6 MONGEN inserts the specified driver into the monitor overlaying the old driver and then leaves the new monitor in memory On AM 212 and AM 214 devices with AMOS release 2 2 or later you must create a monitor using either BFLP DVR
285. an example of user computer communication represents the characters the computer displays on your terminal screen In our examples the keycap symbol appears whenever you need to press a certain key on your terminal keyboard The name of the key you need to press appears inside the keycap symbol like this RETURN If you need to press the TAB key you would see AB or the ESCAPE key ESC Sometimes the ESCAPE key is labeled ESC or ALT MODE This indicates a control sequence you press on the keyboard The key is pressed and held down while the indicated key is also pressed This symbol in front of a capital letter means the letter is a control character For example when you press CTRLYC it appears on your screen as C AC is the control character used like the key to cancel most programs and return you to AMOS command level This symbol means halt It indicates an important note you should read carefully before going further in the documentation Usually text next to this symbol contains instructions for something you MUST or MUST NOT do so read it carefully System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Introduction to the Manual Page 1 5 SYMBOL MEANING This symbol means hint It indicates a helpful bit of information or a short cut that could save you time or trouble al This symbol means remember It indicates something you should keep in mind S while you are following a set of instructions System Commands
286. and FLPDIR to see a list of files on the floppy disk Only copies files written using the WINFLP program You must use a separate FLPWIN command for each floppy disk You may not copy to a disk account unless you are either in the same project as the account you are copying files to or you are logged into a System Operator s account 1 2 You may copy files into the account you are logged into from any other account FLPWIN is a wildcard file command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on wildcard commands FORMAT FLPWIN switch outspec filespec filespec switch switch specifies a FLPWIN option outspec is the device and account the files are to be written to on the disk and to optionally rename the files as they are written out to the disk The filespec s are the file s to be transferred from the floppy disk including the disk device and account specifications where they were backed up from DEFAULTS The output specification defaults to the input specification If you are logged into 1 2 the default output account specification is and if the account you are copying to does not exist FLPWIN creates it The input specification defaults to and the account and device you are logged into The default switches are NOQ and D The default floppy device specification is DDAO System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FLPWIN Page 2 OPTIONS If you place NO before the switch i e NOQ it can
287. and Optimize to Yes Enter the number of logical devices you want FMTS2 calculates the bitmap size Then first turn off optimization and then change Directory Type to Traditional After choosing a configuration press to continue Then to begin formatting the drive select which drive defect list to use Format Without Grown Defects reassigns only the bad blocks included in the manufacturer s defect list It does not reassign any blocks marked as bad since the drive was installed defect list in error for example if a bad cable had caused blocks to appear defective Some drives reassign bad blocks automatically If you use this option those blocks are no longer marked as bad o Use this option only if you have reason to believe blocks have been added to the Format With Grown Defects reassigns all blocks currently marked as bad Use this option in most circumstances Vendor Default Format use this option only if you cannot format the drive using either of the above options It uses vendor default parameters to format the drive If you decide you don t want to format the drive select Cancel and press RETURN Otherwise the drive begins formatting when you make your selection Drive Info Displays the following information about the currently selected drive Usable capacity Block size Format status Formatted capacity amount of space being used for logical drives Number of logicals Size of each logical drive
288. and any file specifications For example to copy all LIT files from the tape originally backed up from account 110 2 on DSK2 over to your current account DSK3 110 5 TAPFIL DSK3 110 5 DSK2 LIT 110 2 Now TAPFIL asks you to enter the tape unit number Use Q to confirm files before transfer Enter a Y for Yes or an N for No after each TAPFIL prompt You do not need to press after Y or N For example suppose you are logged into DSK2 and you are copying files from magnetic tape drive MTUO TAPFIL OLD DSK3 M68 10 Q Enter tape unit number 0 MTUO DSK3 B32 M68 10 4 to DSK2 B32 0LD 10 4 Y TUO DSK3 SCRTCH M68 10 6 to DSK2 SCRTCH OLD 10 6 N You may press CTRLYC at any time to stop the file transfer To restore all files to the devices and accounts they were backed up from enter TAPFIL ALL ALL MESSAGES Bypassing BADBLK SYS 1 2 BADBLK SYS exists to prevent bad blocks ona device from being allocated and should never be directly accessed You can t copy the BADBLK SYS 1 2 file Cannot find DSK0 SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS TAPFIL needs this file to be able to process wildcard symbols in your file specifications This message can mean SCNWLD SYS does not exist or you do not have enough memory to load it into your partition System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 TAPFIL Cannot OPEN device name protection violation Either log into 1 2 or the account you
289. and exit DEV xxx DVD Recorder device name is Xxx AID n DVD Recorder is at SCSI ID n PIC Display Product Installation Code U Uninstall IV Set hardware read after write verification OPERATION DVD adds DEVTBL and BITMAP entries to the AMOS system so that data can be randomly read or written on the DVD media DVD U is used to uninstall the DEVTBL and BITMAP entries prior to removing the media from the DVD drive Before starting the program place an AMOS formatted DVD media into the DVD RAM drive The media may contain existing data See the FATDVD or MAKDVD commands for instructions on formatting a blank media or for copying AMOS logical disks to the DVD media Type DVD options from the AMOS prompt DVD RETURN System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 DVD Page 2 DVD will attempt to find a DVD RAM drive The DVD driver must be in system memory DVD will find the DVD RAM drive either using the command line switches DEV and ID or by defaulting to DVD if DEV is not specified and by scanning the SCSI bus if ID is not specified If more than one DVD CD type device is found when scanning the SCSI bus you will be asked to choose the device you wish to use Found the following possible DVD Recorders ID Description 1 nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX 2 nn XxXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX Select one of the above devices Additional information about the DVD RAM drive is then displayed DVD RAM Recorder located at SCSI id 3
290. andler failed error code n Check to see if the number of jobs defined in your system INI file are enough to include one for the device handler task The error codes you may see are 1 Job table is full 4 SHNDLR task already exists If you see 1 add more jobs in the JOBS command in your system INI file If you see 4 it means more than one user was running BACKUP RESTOR or BAKDIR at the same time System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 BAKDIR BACKUP media not compatible with current software The backup medium you are using is not compatible with the current version of your software See your System Operator for help BACKUP media not file structured BAKDIR could not read the label information block BAKDIR can only read media created by the BACKUP command BACKUP media not written by BACKUP program Restore using the appropriate restore program Cannot be logged onto the backup device Check your entry for errors Make sure you used a colon after the device name Cannot open message socket ITC error n See your Monitor Calls Manual for an explanation of the error code This indicates an internal communication error ask your System Operator or Alpha Micro dealer for help if this occurs frequently Cannot use device AMOS error message Either your ersatz default device definition or the device you specified after OWVERRIDE was incorrect Using the AMOS error message as a clue to what is wrong c
291. ands are not available with the current hardware configuration The type of streamer and or system hardware you have does not allow SET QIC commands to work You may only set density on MTU devices It is invalid to try to set recording density on any other device than an MTU 2 tape device Your terminal does not support option You tried to SET your terminal to do something it can t do System Commands Reference Manual Rev 10 SETJOB FUNCTION Starts up a job CHARACTERISTICS SETJOB is both re entrant and re usable When the system is reset or powered up it automatically attaches the first job to the first terminal defined in your system initialization command file Except for that special case however the system does not automatically attach any jobs to terminals If you want a job to be able to use a terminal for input and output you must explicitly attach the job and the terminal This process involves the use of such commands as ATTACH KILL FORCE MEMORY WAIT etc The SETJOB command consolidates all these lines into one easy to understand line SETJOB is most commonly used in your system initialization command file but it can be used at AMOS level FORMAT SETJOB jobname terminal memory command command Jobname is the name of the job you want to start terminal is the terminal to ATTACH it to memory is the amount of memory to assign to the job you may specify K or M for kil
292. annot be found or is corrupted or the tape was not written using VCRSAV The data on the tape cannot be read System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VCRRES FUNCTION Writes files from video cassette tape to disk Lets you restore file oriented disk backup from video cassette to disk CHARACTERISTICS VCRRES is re entrant and re usable Used in combination with VCRSAV to write disk files to video cassette tape and VCRDIR to display a list of files on a video cassette Only reads tapes created by VCRSAV Not for transferring data between Alpha Micro and non Alpha Micro computers This program is provided for compatibility purposes If your VCR tape was created by BACKUP use RESTOR to restore files If your system contains both traditional format and extended disks you must be logged onto the same type of disk when you use VCRRES that you were when you created the backup using VCRSAV You may not copy to a disk account other than the account you are currently logged into unless you are logged into an operator s account 1 2 If you are in 1 2 and you specify an account that does not exist VCRRES creates that account You may copy files into the account you are logged into from any other account regardless of project number or device specification with other users on your system before proceeding with VCRRES If another user is reading from or writing to the disk when you use VCRRES you both could be locked up However
293. application the modules that should result from a re build target files lists of other modules the target files depend on and the command s to be issued to get new target files This is done by entering dependency lines and command lines in the makefile For example ACOUNT LIT lt CREDIT OBJ DEBIT OBJ INTRST OBJ GLC ACOUNT In this example ACOUNT LIT is the target file monitored by MK Each time MK is invoked it compares the modification date and time of ACOUNT LIT to those of CREDIT OBJ DEBIT OBJ and INTRST OBJ If any of those files have been modified more recently than ACOUNT LIT the command line GLC ACOUNT is issued to AMOS which should produce a new version of ACOUNT LIT The process can be a lot more complex and the makefile can have more than one target file Some dependencies may appear in many places also There can only be one target file per dependency line To ease the creation of a makefile the macro and rule facilities are included Macro is a kind of shorthand for items that occur in many different places A macro is defined either in the makefile or in the MK command line It can then be used either to reproduce its definition text at different places or with some part of its original text replaced by text specified when it is invoked System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MK Page 2 A macro line defines the text of a macro Macros may not be nested Macro lines have the
294. ard it When you are finished rewind the tape and store it TO VERIFY A CASSETTE This function writes a specific data pattern to the cassette and then reads it back to make sure the data was recorded accurately If you have a video monitor you can attach it to the VCR and visually verify the data was recorded accurately the words Alpha Micro appear in large block letters n This procedure destroys all data on the cassette Load a cassette into the VCR and rewind it Make sure the tape doesn t contain data you need Then enter CRT610 V CRT610 asks for the cassette size in hours You can specify a value of one to six hours The default is two Press after your answer Then it asks for the number of copies You can specify from four to 255 Press after your answer The default value is four If the recorder you are using is a remote controlled VIDEOTRAX VTR CRT610 automatically operates the VTR until the function is finished If the recorder you are using is not remote controlled CRT610 gives you step by step directions for manually operating your VCR CRT610 V displays the number of blocks written as it goes along When it is done writing it reads the tape to check the data This takes as long as the original recording As it reads the tape CRT610 displays the same statistics C does see above TO CHECK A CASSETTE USING THE F SWITCH The F switch functions like C except it sends the statistics display to the disk file VCRSTS
295. are copying to is full Remove unwanted files from the disk before rerunning MTURES or use MTURES to restore files to a different device Unit number must be between 0 and 7 Re enter a correct number You are not logged in under 1 2 you can t create p pn Log into 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MTUSAV FUNCTION Writes copies of disk files to 1 2 9 track magnetic tape streamer tape Exabyte tape or DAT A file oriented disk backup program CHARACTERISTICS MTUSAV is re entrant re usable and used for file oriented disk backup Used with MTURES to transfer files from magnetic tape to disk and MTUDIR to list a directory of files on a tape You can also use MTUSAV to check the quality of a backup tape MTUSAV works with both traditional and extended format disks MTUSAV spawns a slave job during the backup process Therefore the JOBS statement in the system initialization command file must be at least one larger than the number of jobs allocated in the JOBALC statements Before using MTUSAV you should always use DSKANA to check the device for errors If there is a problem on the disk you copy from you may not be able to restore from the tape later MTUSAV is a wildcard command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on using wildcard specifications You may back up files from any disk account whether or not the account is within your current project A group of files backed
296. are identical so no transfer is necessary Not selected Source file does not have a calculated HASH total You used H but the cartridge does not contain a HASH total to compare H was not used when the files were saved Output MFD is full The Master File Directory only has room for 63 entries The transfer in progress would have created a new account but there is not enough room in the MFD See your System Operator Tape is not file structured The tape you are trying to read was not written by STRSAV Make sure you have mounted the right tape You are not logged in under 1 2 can t create p pn You cannot copy to a nonexistent account unless you are logged into an operator s account 1 2 If you copy to a nonexistent account while logged into 1 2 STRRES creates the account for you System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 STRSAV FUNCTION Writes copies of disk files to 1 4 streaming tape drive cartridges It is a file oriented disk backup program The STRxxx commands are included only for compatibility with earlier operating system versions Do NOT use these commands unless absolutely necessary Use the MTUxxx commands for all tape backup and CRT620 to create warm boot tapes CHARACTERISTICS STRSAV is re entrant and re usable Copies a file and its device account specification along with the date and time of backup Used with STRRES to restore files to disk and STRDIR to give a directory of files on
297. arks the tape with an end of tape marker at the point before the disk error All files prior to that point can be restored This indicates your disk has an error Run DSKANA to correct the file error then re run VCRSAV again Invalid argument for WAIT Check your syntax You may have to put the WAIT switch at the end of the command line so it doesn t interpret other parts of the command line as a time nn files not transferred Beyond 32mb boundary Use BACKUP command If you attempted to save files past the 32Mb boundary on an extended disk this message tells you how many files were not transferred Use BACKUP to save these files Process suspended while saving filename The transfer is now complete Job aborted This message appears if you press CTRLYC during the save VCRSAV aborts the job and marks the tape with an end of tape marker All files prior to that point can be restored Zero blocks in this file Not selected VCRSAV found a directory entry for a file with a size of zero blocks It will not copy a zero block file It skips the file and continues System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VDKUTL FUNCTION VDKUTL allows general system users to see a status display of the virtual disk cache system VDKUTL also allows the System Operator when logged into OPR or SYS to implement changes to the list of wildcard specifications for the files to be used on the virtual disk system These changes must have been pre
298. asks you to enter the tape unit number It then displays the directory The first number on the line tells you the file s relative position on the tape Next you see the device specification the filename and extension and the account specification of the file as it appeared on the disk it was being backed up from The next number tells you the number of disk blocks the file takes up TAPDIR now tells you whether the file is a linked sequential file L or contiguous random file C Finally TAPDIR gives the date and time of the backup To create a disk file containing the directory display include a listfilespec For example TAPDIR DATAFL LST ALL DAT creates the file DATAFL LST in the account and device you are logged into containing a directory display for all DAT files on the tape If your printer is defined as a terminal you may send the display to a printer by using an output specification of TRM MESSAGES Cannot find DSKO SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS TAPDIR needs this file to process wildcard symbols in your file specification See your System Operator for help Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system Cannot READ device name device is not mounted Mount the device and try again Cannot read filemark reason A tape error was encountered Device full See about erasing unneeded files or acquiring more disk memory More tha
299. ated We recommend you allocate 100 records for BATCH queue files This is usually enough space in which to schedule tasks and it does not take up much disk space If you schedule a great number of tasks allocate more records MAKQUE creates only one spool file DSKO SPLQUE SYS 1 4 You can use MAKQUE to re create the file if you need to change its parameters Spool queue files handle one file per record set up as many records as you need to handle your usual load of printer requests For example if you allocate 20 records to SPLQUE SYS it will be able to handle 20 print requests at a time For information on the Task Manager see your Task Manager User s Manual For information on the Print Spooler see your System Operator s Guide OPERATION Enter MAKQUE at AMOS command level MAKQUE MAKQUE asks you what type of queue file you want Batch B or Spooler S Enter the letter for the type of queue file you would like to create Then you are asked for the name of the queue file this question won t display if you are creating the spool queue The program assumes an extension of SYS You must specify a name for the queue or you will get a file specification error MAKQUE then asks for the number of queue records to be allocated Your response defines the size of the queue and how many tasks it can handle or how many files the printer queue can have init For example if you specify 100 records the Task Manager would be able to sche
300. ated by FIXFLP The device must be defined in BITMAP and DEVTBL statements in your system initialization command file you may want to load the driver into system memory See your system operator for help FORMAT DOSIMP AMOS filespec devn path DOS filespec switch AMOS filespec is the file specification which may include the device and account of the file on the AMOS side devn is the diskette device path is the directory path defaults to root account and DOS filespec is the file you want to transfer Do not put any spaces on either side of the equal sign DEFAULTS The AMOS device and account default to where you are logged The AMOS filename defaults to the DOS filename w The name is truncated to six characters if the DOS filespec is longer than six characters OPTIONS B Transfer in binary mode Q Query Asks you to confirm import of each selected file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DOSIMP Page 2 OPERATION Enter DOSIMP and the AMOS and DOS device and file specifications you want For example DOSIMP DBTUT TXT LFDO DBASE TUTORIAL READ ME DOSIMP then transfers the file to the specified AMOS account The file is converted to AMOS format You can specify a wildcard that represents a complete AMOS file specification but not for a partial AMOS file specification For example you could enter DOSIMP LFDO but not DOSIMP DSK2 10 2 TXT LFDO MESSAGES File not fo
301. ation Try again using only one listfilespec Tape is not file structured Please correct then press RETURN when ready The tape you have mounted is not in MTUSAV format Make sure the correct reel of tape is mounted on the correct tape unit Unit number must be between 0 and 7 You ve entered an invalid tape unit number Try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MTURES FUNCTION Writes files to disk from 1 2 9 track magnetic tape streamer tape 4mm tape or 8mm tape Lets you restore file oriented disk backup from tape to disk CHARACTERISTICS MTURES is re entrant and re usable Used with MTUSAV to write disk files to magnetic tape and MTUDIR to display files on a tape Only reads tapes created by MTUSAV Not for transferring data between Alpha Micro and non Alpha Micro computers MTURES works with both traditional and extended format disks You may not restore files to a disk account unless you are logged into that account or an operator s account 1 2 MTURES is a wildcard command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on using wildcard commands The input specification must give the full specification of the files you want to transfer from the magnetic tape including device and account specifications of the files as they were written to the tape The output specification lets you specify the device and account the files are to be written to on the disk and to rename the files as they are wri
302. ay have multiple AMD files on the local hard drives or on removable media such as DVD RAM This command makes it possible to change which AMD file is accessible to AMOS for a particular device name It also allows the removable media to be conveniently replaced Read only AMD files whether on the hard drive or on read only removable media are not supported After a device is XMOUNTed it must then be MOUNTed before full AMOS access is available XMOUNT U will automatically do an unmount XMOUNT automatically creates the DEVTBL and BITMAP information in system shared memory and therefore requires SMEM to be initialized Prerequisites A DVR dev DVR DVR PCDSK DVR must exist or be created There must NOT be DEVTBL and BITMAP entries for the device in the system INI file SMEM must be initialized and have sufficient free space to hold the device s DEVTBL entries and BITMAP information This means that XMOUNT cannot be used until after the final SYSTEM and SMEM statements in the system INI The device driver dev DVR must be in system memory loaded during system initialization The device must be defined on the AMOS Disk tab of the System Configuration screen and point to a valid AMD file FORMAT XMOUNT U dev U dey is the specification of the device you want to xmount and u is a switch that causes the device to be unmounted System Commands Reference Manual Rev 16 XMOUNT Page 2 OPTIONS This switch is an operation
303. be the same as the new file specification SAMPLE1 BAS SAMPL2 BAS the extension is assumed to be the same as the previous file specification SAMPL1 BAS and CLOSE TXT MESSAGES Cannot OPEN filespec file not found Check your syntax or use DIR to locate the file Command error Check your syntax and try again File specification error Check your syntax and try again You may not append to files on device MEM You cannot change the size or contents of a module in user memory by using the APPEND command System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 ASCDMP FUNCTION ASCDMP displays the data in physical disk blocks in ASCII form on your terminal CHARACTERISTICS ASCDMP is re entrant and re usable It displays all printable ASCII characters in the block including HT LF CR and FF All non printable characters display as periods Enter the number of the disk block you want to display in the same number base the system is using for your numeric displays usually octal You can change the system display base to hexadecimal by using the SET command ol You must be logged into DSKO 1 2 to use ASCDMP CS FORMAT ASCDMP devn physical block number devn is the device name and physical block number is the number of the physical block on the disk you want to display DEFAULTS devn defaults to DSKO The physical block number defaults to zero OPERATION Log into OPR DSKO 1 2 and enter ASCDMP optionally fo
304. ble density STD format the device specification of DDSO tells FMT210 to use STD format to format the diskette in Drive Zero of that device For information on configuring floppy disk drivers see your System Operator s Guide As it formats FMT210 writes over any data currently on the diskette FMT210 requires you to mount a diskette before formatting it After formatting a diskette use the SYSACT I command to initialize it unless you are going to use DSKCPY to make a literal image of another diskette on the newly formatted one FORMAT FMT210 devn devn specifies the device holding the diskette you want to format OPERATION Enter FMT210 followed by the specification of the device holding the diskette you want to format For example FMT210 DDA1 This tells FMT210 to format the diskette in Drive One of the floppy device using the DDA driver program and therefore to use the AMS format System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FMT210 Page MESSAGES Cannot format diskette write protected Remove the write protection tab from the diskette and try again Device does not exist The device you specified is not defined Check your spelling or use DEVTBL to see a list of currently defined devices Disk not mounted Mount the diskette and try again Error code x on track n A media drive or controller error occurred at track n of the diskette For information on the error codes see your disk device hardware
305. cations default to the device and account you are logged into The output specification defaults to the file specification in the case of the filename and extension and to the account and device you are currently logged into Therefore if you don t specify a device everything on the tape is written to the device you are logged into For example if you are logged into DSKO everything is written onto DSKO even if the files were written to the tape from other disks Be careful to specify an output specification if the files on the tape came from more than one disk Unless of course you do want to transfer them all onto one disk If you are logged into an operator s account 1 2 the default output specification is all accounts on that disk In the System Operator s account it is all accounts on all disks this means files are restored to their original account numbers from which they were written to the tape If you use ALL as the input specification VCRRES restores all the files on the tape to where depends on the output specification OPTIONS All switches can be abbreviated to any unique letter combination DELETE Copy over existing file default file switch NODELETE Don t copy over existing file file switch HASH Restore only files with different hash totals on the disk file switch Files must have been saved with VCRSAV H NOHASH Don t compare hash totals Default file switch QUERY Confirm befor
306. ccount and device you are logged into The default filespec is and the account and device you are logged into OPTIONS The only STRDIR switch is KILL It is an operation switch that deletes any listfile that matches the specified listfilespec before creating the new listfile System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 STRDIR Page 2 OPERATION Enter STRDIR and the files you need For example to send a directory display of all the DDAT and BAS files on a cartridge to your terminal load the desired cartridge into the streamer unit and enter STRDIR ALL DAT BAS The first number of the display is the file s relative position on the tape Next you see the device specification the filename and extension and the account specification of the file as it appeared on the disk it was backed up from The next number tells you the number of disk blocks the file takes up The letter following the block count tells you whether the file is sequential or linked file L or a random or contiguous file C Then STRDIR gives the date and time the file was originally copied onto that cartridge Finally STRDIR gives the hash total for the file if one was calculated with the STRSAV HASH option At the end of the directory display STRDIR tells you how many files were listed If the cartridge contains a warm boot monitor a message tells you the tape is Bootable This indicates a warm boot monitor is the first file on the cartridge even thou
307. cd Gilder ated diva te adeeb cand Logical has been restored amp remounted ee Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 10 47 30 AM Elapse Time 00 13 15 O SaaS Date amp Time Mon 18 Sep 2006 10 47 30 AM Elapse Time 02 00 16 DVD Logicals are being uninstalled The program has completed Now all data has been copied to the AMOS Logicals TSTO TST8 and the AMOS logicals TSTO TST8 are ready to use REQUIREMENTS AND SETUP DVDRES requires the following AM 8000 Eagle 800 or AMPC 7 0 based systems AMOS 8 1 or later A supported DVD RAM drive n DVDRES is only supported on AM8000 Eagle 800 and AMPC 7 0 Systems The DVDRES package contains the following required files DVDRES LIT The device driver for the DVD RAM drive The DVD DEV file that contains supported DVD RAM drive information The SSD overlay file DVD000 OVR MODIFYING THE SYSTEM INITIALIZATION FILE See the software installation instructions in the AMOS 8 X Owner s Manual DSM 00226 00 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 DVDRES Page 6 MESSAGES Command line syntax messages e Invalid switch e Invalid switch option System requirements messages e DVDRES requires AMOS 8 x or compatible operating system e Memory partition is too small for DVDRES An additional nnnK of memory is required DVD RAM Recorder device or driver messages e Device specified is not a DVD RAM Recorder e This DVD RAM R
308. cels the switch Switches may be abbreviated Defaults are NOQ and D QUERY Confirm before copying files File switch DELETE Copy over existing files File switch OPERATION Enter FLPWIN followed by the specifications you need For example to copy all LIT files from the floppy disk originally backed up from account 110 2 on DSK2 over to your current account DSK3 110 5 FLPWIN DSK3 110 5 DSK2 LIT 110 2 Now FLPWIN asks you to enter the backup device name the name of your floppy drive Remember you may specify wildcard file specifications to FLPWIN as in the input specification LIT above Use the Q switch to ask for confirmation before each transfer Enter Y for Yes or N for No after each prompt Do not press after your answer For example FLPWIN OLD DSK3 M68 10 Q Enter backup device DDAO DDAO DSK3 NEW M68 10 3 to DSK2 NEW OLD 10 3 Y DDAO DSK3 SCRTCH M68 10 6 to DSK2 SCRTCH OLD 10 6 N You may press CTRLYC at any time to stop the file transfer Remember the placement of the FLPWIN switches modifies their effect MESSAGES Attempt to copy files out of sequence New file is number N last file was number M Files split between two floppy disks are given sequence numbers 0 1 2 etc You tried to get a file which is split between two floppy disks but the file on the floppy disk you inserted isn t the second half of the file Make sure you have the right floppy Bypa
309. ch for specific strings of text perform local and global replacements move and delete blocks of text and change various editing parameters AlphaVUE copies into memory the file you want to edit and makes a backup file by renaming the disk file to a BAK extension When you exit AlphaVUE the new edited version of the file goes out to disk under the original name and extension of the file You may edit a file too big to fit into your memory partition An AlphaVUE initialization file INI VUE allows you to set your own default editing parameters See your AlphaVUE Text Editor User s Guide for more detail on using AlphaVUE and setting up the INI VUE file text you are in Screen mode Pressing brings you to Command mode Now enter an 4 To exit AlphaVUE enter Command mode if you see lines of asterisks or if you see your F to exit and update your file or a Q if you want to exit without updating FORMAT VUE filespec switch filespec selects the file you want to edit and switch is an option request DEFAULTS The defaults AlphaVUE uses for example the default file extension are defined in the AlphaVUE initialization file INI VUE System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 VUE Page 2 OPTIONS All the switches may be abbreviated to any unique characters BATCH Suppresses most screen display output Especially for use with Task Manager to reduce unnecessary screen output to the LOG files N
310. ckup process VERIFY compares the files on tape against the disk files Always have LOGGER set up on the system MTUSAV cannot recover from CPU exceptions such as address errors adequately so it aborts with a JOBERR value reflecting the type of CPU exception The system may be in an unstable state after the exception and should be reset as soon as possible The backup tape may not be readable or restorable All CPU exceptions are reported to LOGGER Always create a SYSLOG LST file and examine it for errors Always use a command file to run unattended MTUSAVs Structure the command file to trap as many errors as possible Here is a skeleton DO file which you can adapt to your needs R LOG lt account gt ERASE MTUSAV LOG MTUSAV VER MTUSAV efilespecss i OG VERIFY BRIEF ies y enter MTUSAV data here 7 IF ERROR SEV NUL AND LOOKUP MTUSAV LOG 1 GOTO ALL OK ENDIF 7 Insert problem reporting procedures here l PRINT MTUSAV LOG LOG OPR insert OPR password here if needed SYSLOG PRINT SYSLOG LST LOG P EXIT ALL OK System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 6 INT MTUSAV LOG UNE ao DKOW Q O ine vs INT SYSLOG LST lt MTUSAV finished without errors gt LOG SP EXIT This file follows all of the recommendations It logs into an account on a device with plenty of fr
311. command line again and make sure the device and account specifications are correct Only operator is allowed to turn printer on or off Only a user logged into the System Operator s account OPR DSKO 1 2 can use the ON and OFF switches System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 5 PRNT Output printer not found Check your spelling or use the PRNT command alone to display the printers set up for your system Print spooler is not installed The Task Manager communicates with the spooler through the Inter Task Communication system This error means some part of the process is not hooked up This could be because the Task Manager is not properly installed or because the Inter Task Communication system is not set up See your System Operator Printer already turned off Printer already turned on You tried to turn off or on a printer that was already in that state Printer name not specified The command needs to have a printer to operate on One was not specified Re enter the command specifying the appropriate printer Queue entry not found The specified printer queue entry was not found and could not be updated Check the sequence number and try again Queue file is full The destination printer s file holding outstanding print requests is full and cannot accept more requests until current ones have been satisfied Try again later Spooler file error The destination spooler encountered an error wh
312. comparison 00001 00001 First line of text 00002 00002 So far all the same 00003 A line only in the first file 00004 00003 Text is again the same but line is different 00004 A line only in the second file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 SRCCOM Page 2 The numbers on the left of the display are the line numbers of the first file The next column of numbers are the line numbers of the second file The dashes indicate a line not appearing in the second file but appearing in the first file The pluses indicate a line of characters not appearing in the first file MESSAGES Cannot open filename file not found SRCCOM could not find one or both of the files you specified Check your syntax or use DIR to see what files are in your account System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 STAT FUNCTION Displays a continuously updating status of all the jobs on your system CHARACTERISTICS STAT displays memory addresses in the number base the system is using for your numeric displays usually octal If you wish to see these addresses as hexadecimal numbers make sure the HEX option is set before using STAT See the SET reference sheet for information on changing the numeric display base Do not use STAT inside a Task Manager Control file The nature of Control file operation means it can t halt the STAT display Therefore the Control file locks up a
313. computer S Notify other users before using BAKDIR BAKDIR can be set up to use a default backup device This is useful if you normally use one device for most or all of your backups When this default is in effect you don t have to tell BAKDIR what device you wish to use thus saving a step in the backup process To set up a device as the default define an ersatz device called BACKUP in your ERSATZ INI file For example BACKUP VCRO Define the device you want as your default backup device after the name If you want to use another device after the default is set up use OVERRIDE and you will be prompted for the device name If you don t have a default device and if you don t use O BACKUP displays a menu of available devices FORMAT BAKDIR switch listspec filespec s switch switch is an option request listspec specifies a disk file for the directory and filespec s specify the file s you want displayed DEFAULTS The default 1 1espec is and the device and account you are logged into The default switches are NOK and NOT The default listspec is DIRECT LST and the device and account you are logged into System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BAKDIR Page 2 OPTIONS All BAKDIR switches affect all filespecs on the command line Placing NO before a switch turns off the switch Switches may be abbreviated FULL Displays all available information about the files on the media HASH D
314. correct Check the format and reboot your computer REDALL FUNCTION Performs a disk diagnostic test by reading all or a specified number of the records on a disk and reporting any read errors CHARACTERISTICS REDALL is re entrant and re usable Does not harm the data on your disk FORMAT REDALL devn number of records devn specifies the logical device you want to read and number of records is the number of disk records you want to read If you omit number of records REDALL reads all of the records on the disk OPERATION Enter REDALL the device to test and the number of records to read For example REDALL DSK1 100 REDALL displays the number of records it is reading It displays the appropriate messages if any read errors occur If you see any read errors notify your System Operator They may be correctable with FIXCRC or DSKDDT MESSAGES Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your spelling or use DEVTBL to see a list of valid devices Cannot perform REDALL on device name AMOS error message Check the AMOS error message and correct the condition Cannot read device name disk not mounted MOUNT the device and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 REDIR FUNCTION Redirects Input Output Lets you send input or output from a command or program to another command or program CHARACTERISTICS REDIR is re entrant and re usable The REDIR command itself is only
315. create a new one either using the M option or by re certifying the disk Remember some disks do not have a BADBLK SYS file BADBLK SYS is full No more entries allowed BADBLK SYS for this device is full Contact your Alpha Micro representative Cannot read defect map controller not initialized The AM 520 or AM 522 disk controller for the specified disk has not been properly initialized in the system initialization file Revise the initialization file and reboot the system before retrying Can t fetch BADBLK SYS 1 2 This message occurs only on AM 415 and AM 1000 systems The BADBLK program could not load BADBLK SYS into memory Contact your Alpha Micro representative CAUTION hash total did not verify The BADBLK SYS file contains a bad hash total the data in the file does not match the hash total for the file The data in the file is invalid Make a backup copy of the entire physical device then re certify the disk System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BADBLK Page 4 Command format error You entered the A or D command incorrectly Be sure you specified the proper number or numbers for your type of disk Could not list defects Format code unrecognized The list of defects on a SCSI drive is not in a supported format The drive is not usable in its current state D command not allowed on SCSI drives You cannot delete a bad block from the list for a SCSI device Duplicate entry The block you tried
316. cted the end of a streaming tape cartridge before completing the backup there was not enough room on the tape for all the files you specified Use a larger capacity backup device or split your backup into two or more sections End of media detected on a split file Place a new diskette in the drive and continue the backup Fatal error aborting device handler task This is an informative message that occurs after some other fatal error and indicates the device handling task is also aborting Fatal error illegal message code n received from device handler The main task received an error it did not understand from the device handler Try again if the problem persists see your Alpha Micro dealer for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 5 BACKUP Fatal error ITC error code n See your Monitor Calls Manual for an explanation of the error code This indicates an internal communication error ask your System Operator or Alpha Micro dealer for help if this occurs frequently Field size exceeded Re enter You ve exceeded the length of the current field Make a shorter entry No supported backup devices found Your system is not set up for any of the three supported backup devices so you can t specify a device Program aborted by device handler Device not ready The medium you are trying to back up to is write protected Either switch media or write enable the medium you re using Tape is full
317. cur in the summary part of the backup phase report Occurs when summarizing incidents during the verification phase While the totals and JOBERR setting will be correct the incident list will not be complete MTUSAV LOG will have the incident details listed after the appropriate file Occurs when writing an incident record about the verification of a particular file Further incident records will not be recorded in the MTUSAV VER file but will still be listed in the MTUSAV LOG file An Error reading VER will probably occur in the summary part of the verification phase report Occurs when writing to the MTUSAV LOG file Totals and JOBERR will continue to be set correctly but details of incidents will not be recorded in the LOG Certain errors will still be reported to SYSLOG as Isited in the Error Tables Ifa file listed in MTUSAV INF encounters this incident the severity is taken from the Bkup file known entry if that entry is less severe than the original entry Can be further modified by error accumulation processing If a file listed in MTUSAV INF encounters this incident the severity is taken from the Verif file known entry if that entry is less severe than the original entry Can be further modified by error accumulation processing If this incident is encountered MTUSAV continues to verify the file If a file encounters this incident the severity of the reported error is taken from the
318. cylinder always begins right after the last logical drive defined on the device Format Mi Unless you are tryingto correct a media problem you should always use Initialize Drive Y instead of Format Formats and initializes the selected drive You can select the directory type and either set the bitmap size and number of logicals or have FMTS2 optimize the logical configuration Here are the settings for some common configurations e For traditional directories using the entire drive with the largest possible bitmaps set Directory Type to Traditional and Optimize to Yes FMTS2 calculates both bitmap size and number of logical devices e For extended directories using the entire drive set Directory Type to Extended and Optimize to Yes Enter the number of logical devices you want FMTS2 calculates the best bitmap size System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 FMTS2 ae Page 4 For absolute maximum 32MB traditional logicals set Directory Type to Traditional and Optimize to No Enter 4096 for the bitmap size Adjust the number of logicals until adding one more will put drive utilization over 100 FMTS2 recalculates the percentage each time you leave the Number of Logicals field For any other drive configuration you can set Optimize to No and enter the Directory Type Bitmap Size and Number of Logicals you want To figure the best traditional bitmap size for a given number of logical devices set Directory type to Extended
319. d block map file MAP You can also use the from a file option if the drive has not been previously formatted by typing the manufacturer s defect list into an AlphaVUE file then using that file as the source e If the bad block map is not in a file on the drive you can choose to enter the information from the keyboard and type in the manufacturer s defect list Each entry is in this format Cylinder Head Byte from index length in bits All numbers are in decimal After you choose either method answer CRT520 s questions and proceed as described above If you are inputting from a file you are not asked if you want to create the equivalent media defect list or bad block map file since it already exists MESSAGES Errors on the AM 520 may be recoverable or non recoverable At AMOS level when DSKERR is set the driver may report two types of recoverable errors Recoverable disk erroror ECC correctable error Both of these errors result in correct operation and good data The messages below are unrecoverable errors you will have to correct the condition before re using CRT520 Bad Block Map in incorrect format These errors indicate the AM 520 was able to read the Bad Block Map from the disk but its format was not intact Use CRT520 again using a media defect list or inputting the bad block map from a file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CRT520 Page 4 Cannot format drive A
320. d device you are logged into OPTIONS All switches are operation switches and can be abbreviated KILL Deletes existing listfile before creating new listfile TRANSFER Don t lock other users out of system OPERATION Enter VCRDIR followed by an optional listfilespec and equal sign and your file specifications For example to send a directory display of all the DAT and BAS files on a video cassette to your terminal enter VCRDIR ALL DAT BAS You then see a message telling you other users will be locked out or you are using T If you continue VCRDIR runs your VCR and produces the directory If you do not have a computer controlled VideoTRAX VTR VCRDIR gives you instructions for running your VCR The first number on the directory line tells you the file s relative position on the tape Next you see the device specification the filename and extension and the account specification of the file as it appeared on the disk it was backed up from The next number tells you the number of disk blocks the file takes up The letter following the block count tells you whether the file is a sequential or linked file L or a random or contiguous file C Next VCRDIR gives the date and time the file was originally backed up And finally VCRDIR shows you the hash total of the file if one was calculated when the file was backed up by VCRSAV At the end of the directory display VCRDIR tells you how many files were listed in the di
321. d in the list AFTER date time APPEND NOAPPEND BEFORE date time BRIEF DMY NODMY EXTRA NOEXTRA LOG MODIFIED Back up only files modified after specified date and time Operation switch Append LOG output to existing MTUSAV LOG in login account if present Operation switch If MTUSAV LOG already exists overwrite it Default operation switch Back up only files modified before specified date and time Operation switch Display only the accounts backed up and the number of files in each not the file names This shows the progress of the backup without the slowdown displaying file names can cause Operation switch Reports all dates in the format dd mm yy or yyyy after 1999 Operation switch Reports all dates in the format set in your language definition file Default operation switch Output additional information on the screen and in the MTUSAV LOG file Allows you to see the current error severity settings after MTUSAV OPT has been processed Operation switch Don t include extra information in MTUSAV LOG Default operation switch Creates a disk file log of the MTUSAV procedure The log file is MTUSAV LOG in the current disk account The contents and layout of the log file may vary between software versions Programs which parse this file for key words or phrases may need to be changed when a new version of MTUSAV is released Operation switch Back up only files modified since las
322. d level To access a local symbol specify the non local symbol preceding the local symbol enter a space then enter the local symbol For example in using the Search command gt S LABEL 10 LABEL is the non local symbol preceding the local symbol 10 COMMAND SUMMARY Below is a brief list of FIX commands see your AlphaFIX User s Manual for a full list Display Mode or CTRLY J Move cursor down one instruction or CTRLYK Move cursor up one instruction or CTRLYT Move cursor down a page 24 instructions or a Move cursor to current PC location or CTRLY P Toggle breakpoint CTRLY X Proceed to breakpoint Single step Command Mode S Search for symbol Q Leave AlphaFIX Dn or An Modify address register GO Execute AMOS command MESSAGES Alternate terminal does not exist The terminal name you specified with the T switch does not exist Use TRMDEF to list the names of available terminals and re enter an amended command line Alternate terminal is attached to a job The terminal you specified is attached to a job Detach it by attaching another terminal to that job and re enter the FIX command System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 FIX Incorrect symbol file version FIX only supports SYM files generated with later versions of SYMLIT that produced variable length symbols FIX will ignore the SYM file Symbol file not found debugging without symbols A SYM file corresponding to the file yo
323. d may be abbreviated to any unique characters Defaults are D NOQ and T AFTER date time Restore only those files saved with a date and time of last modification after the specified date and time The date and time must be in the format specified in your current language definition file BEFORE date time Restore only those files saved with a date and time of last modification before the specified date and time The date and time must be in the format specified in your current language definition file DELETE Copy over existing files NODELETE Do not copy over existing files QUERY Confirm before selecting files NOQUERY Do not confirm files TAPESKIP Use fast tape search on SCSI streamers NOTAPESKIP Do not use fast tape search OPERATION Enter MTURES followed by an optional output specification an equal sign and the input specification s For example to copy from a magnetic tape all BAS files originally backed up from account 110 2 on DSK2 over to your current account enter MTURES DSK2 BAS 110 2 Then MTURES asks you to enter the tape unit number Enter a digit from 0 to 7 for the tape unit you wish to use If your computer has more than one device assigned to the same unit number you are asked for the device name the choices are listed for you MTURES scans the directory on the tape and displays a list of the files that fit the specification you entered earlier If you used the Q switch MTURES w
324. d of the command line B text IC E L M20 0 R IT V a x IX OPERATION Generate a bottom footer title on every page of the listing using text as the title Must be the last switch on the command line Include conditionals in the assembly listing conditionals are usually suppressed Write to assembly listing only lines containing an error Generate a listing file by calling Phase 3 during assembly Creates an output file with the same name as your source file but a LST extension Allow assembler to accept 68020 instructions and addressing modes Syntax error S appears if you do not use and such code exists Don t force assembler to fold lower case to upper Use the current object file by omitting assembly Phases 1 and 2 You must use either the T L or R switch with this switch L is default Generate a cross reference listing Display assembly listing on your terminal Lets you specify a value on the M68 command line to be examined during the assembly process a specifies type of value and x the value List all macro expansions usually suppressed Enter M68 followed by the specification of the file you want to assemble For example M68 MATH M68 If you want to select one or more of the M68 options specify the appropriate switches at the end of your command line after a single symbol For example M68 MATH RT As it assembles your file M68 reports on the status of the assembly p
325. d prompts Job Settings MUSER displays the current settings The settings are OCTAL or HEX DISK ERROR or NO DISK ERROR VERIFY or NO VERIFY CONTROL C ON or CONTROL C OFF GUARD or NO GUARD ECHO or NO ECHO and LOCK or NOLOCK and ELOCK or NOELOCK These are the same settings that may be changed by the SET program from AMOS command level To change these settings use the arrow keys or to move to the item you wish to change Press the SPACE BAR to change the setting from one state to the other System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MUSER Page 4 MESSAGES Duplicate user name choose another name You entered a user name that already exists Find another name and try again Not enough disk space to save updated user file MUSER was unable to finish due to insufficient disk space Exit from MUSER erase some files you no longer need and try again 2Not enough memory to run MUSER You will need approximately 45K Run MUSER from another job or allocate more memory to your job Unrecognized command type HELP for more information The word you entered is not one of the MUSER commands Read the menu and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 M68 FUNCTION Assembles an assembly language program file into an unlinked machine language file CHARACTERISTICS M68 is a full macro assembler It assembles a source text file M68 file into an intermediate object form OBJ file that can be linked into an execut
326. ding operation can be stopped by pressing C System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 7 MAKBD e Press RETURN to start recording or C to abort This is the final prompt before recording begins You may abort by pressing control C or start the recording process by pressing RETURN e Transferring DSKO e Using Generic SCSI DVD RAM and BD RE driver DVDBD This message shows the DVD driver name and description being used e Waiting for DVD Recorder to finish writing Completed The memory data buffers and the DVD RAM Drive s cache buffers are being recorded on the DVD media e nn complete This message shows percentage of the recording process completed for the current logical This message appears on the terminal s status line System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 MAKDVD FUNCTION Copies one or more AMOS logical disks to a recordable DVD RAM media in a supported DVD RAM drive DVDs created with MAKDVD can be used for software distribution or for system backups DVDs created with MAKDVD can be easily read or written after mounting the DVD with the DVD program CHARACTERISTICS MAKDVD copies logical AMOS disk drives onto a DVD in a format that is compatible with the Alpha Micro DVD program A DVD can contain up to approximately 4 7 gigabytes of data MAKDVD creates a logical drive structure on the DVD media such that each logical drive is equal in size to the largest logical disk drive copied If logical drives of differ
327. disk e SCSI error xxxxxxxxx sense error message Code nn nn CD recorder device error has occurred Code provides additional SCSI error sense information e Too slow The disk drive is too slow to keep up with the CD recorder e Warning Unable to close track Device error occurred while closing the current CD track The CD may or may not be usable e Warning Unable to read existing track numbers Starting with track 0 Errors concerning the AMOS CD data structure e Calculated and true starting points are different Recording will start at sector nnnnnn with a filler of nnnnnn sectors This is only a warning indicating that recording will start at a different location on the CD than originally assumed e The AlphaCD logical unit size is greater than 64K blocks which could mean compatibility problems on AMOS 1 X systems Press RETURN to continue or C to abort MAKACD The logical disk size on the CD will be greater than the maximum size of a traditional logical drive e Error Disk geometry calculation was incorrect The AMOS hidden sector parameters calculated are invalid e Error getting AMOS data buffer The system was unable to acquire memory for data buffers e Error memory previously calculated as available isn t Memory required for data buffers has disappeared e Error No devices specified User did not specify any AMOS logical disks to be copied to the CD e Error Unable to calculate AMOS buffer size The s
328. documentation Invalid device The device you specified is not a floppy disk device or is not compatible with the AM 210 Floppy Disk Controller board Check your spelling or use DEVTBL to see the devices on your system No interrupt received after WRITE TRACK Indicates either a bad drive or a bad controller board See your Alpha Micro representative Privileged program must be logged into OPR Log into DSKO 1 2 and try again Program not supported You can only run FMT210 under the AMOS L version of the operating system Sector not found MINO block0 This message is displayed when mounting an unformatted diskette if this is the case it may be ignored If it occurs at any other time it indicates a problem with the diskette see your System Operator Unit number for 5 1 4 inch floppies must be 0 or 1 Try again specifying 0 or 1 for the unit number System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 FMT210 Unit number must be 0 3 Re enter specifying a unit number of 0 1 2 or 3 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FMT219 FUNCTION Formats diskettes used in diskette drives that run under the control of the AM 219 diskette drive controller CHARACTERISTICS FMT219 is re entrant and re usable When you run FMT219 your job MUST be the only job running on your system You must be in the System Operator s Account DSKO 1 2 to run FMT219 FMT7219 selects the format to use based on the device sp
329. dule about 100 tasks This number also controls the sequence rotation The sequence numbers in this case would increment to 100 before starting again at 1 If you do not enter an allocation number MAKQUE prompts you again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MAKQUE Page 2 MESSAGES Cannot delete filename file in use A problem was encountered while processing the queue file usually a disk block could not be read from or written to Contact your System Operator Fatal Error RES QFLOCK SYS not found File error during queue file initialization You did not provide enough queue blocks Run MAKQUE again and increase the number of queue blocks you specified File specification error You did not provide a correct name for the queue file you wanted to create Run MAKQUE again and enter a correct filename System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FUNCTION MAP Allows you to see what modules are in your memory partition and in system memory Also provides information about those memory modules CHARACTERISTICS MAP is re entrant and re usable You may not use MAP to see information about memory modules in other users partitions When you load disk files into your memory partition those copies in memory are called memory modules A memory module retains the same name and extension as its corresponding disk file MAP displays memory addresses in the number base the system is using for your numeric displays
330. e For example U PRINT COPIES 2 LST RST WAIT NOBANNER U remembers the command line but does not send it to the monitor To change the saved command line use U again and enter a new command line To run a saved command line enter U at AMOS command level MESSAGES No previous command is saved There is no AMOS command line saved Save the line you want to use and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 U UTC FUNCTION Retrieves the current time and date from the U S Naval Observatory in Washington DC optionally setting the system date and time to the retrieved value The Observatory maintains a cesium atomic clock which provides a highly accurate source of timing information CHARACTERISTICS UTC is re entrant and re usable Requires the use of a Hayes compatible modem capable of 1200 baud communication Places a short less than one minute long distance toll phone call to 202 653 0351 in Washington DC Resets the system time and date if run while logged in to OPR Only understands time zones from Atlantic to Nome Standard Times Remember that most systems can only set the system clock to the nearest minute so the seconds value retrieved from the Observatory is effectively lost While the Observatory s clock is highly accurate remember the time information is being transmitted over telephone circuits that may introduce considerable delay up to 5 seconds for satellite circuit routings This
331. e packets of that type The number of packets that could not be successfully transmitted This is normally the result of too many collisions The number of incoming packets that were rejected due to a CRC error A high CRC rate may indicate a faulty network card or poor signal quality on the network cable The number of incoming packets that were rejected due to a framing error A high framing error rate may indicate a faulty network card or poor signal quality on the network cable The number of transmission attempts that were unsuccessful because another interface tried to transmit at the same time This number will normally go up gradually if it increases quickly it indicates a high amount of network traffic The number of incoming packets lost because the network interface was not in a state where it could receive packets It is normally zero if it isn t it usually indicates the system could not respond fast enough to the packet being received The number of times the driver ran out of buffers to hold received packets This should normally be zero if it isn t the driver had to discard one or more received packets to make room for new incoming packets The lost packet count includes the number of packets discarded Protocols The protocol type code and name for each protocol registered with the driver If LDVSTS doesn t recognize a type code it displays unknown as the protocol name MESSAGES Could not find driver in
332. e to a disk and TAPDIR to see list of files on a tape FILTAP writes the date and time of backup to the tape This program is included for compatibility purposes MTUSAV and MTURES are the preferred backup methods for magnetic tape see those reference sheets FILTAP does not work with extended format disks FILTAP is NOT for transferring data between Alpha Micro and non Alpha Micro computers use TAPE for that purpose FILTAP works only on the AMOS 32 and AMOS L versions of the operating system Lets you perform one backup on multiple tape reels FILTAP is a wildcard file command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on wildcard specifications You may back up files from any disk account onto tape whether or not the account is within the project you are logged into Although FILTAP writes the disk specification of the file to the magnetic tape along with the file it does not transfer any password FORMAT FILTAP filespec switch filespec switch filespec specifies a file to back up and switch is an option request DEFAULTS The default file specification is and the account and device you are logged into The default magnetic tape drive device specification is MTU OPTIONS Placing NO before the switch cancels it All switches may be abbreviated Defaults are NOQUERY and APPEND Use NOAPPEND if you are writing to a blank tape otherwise FILTAP continuously searches for a file to append after QUERY Confirm
333. e an ACD compatible CD using the CDR device found by scanning the SCSI bus The CD will be created using the maximum recording speed of the CD Recorder without first doing a test copy OPERATION Before starting the program place a blank CD or partially recorded CD in the CD recorder My Recording on a partially recorded media will render all previously recorded information D gt inaccessible It is recommended that the system be idle Other users or system activity could interfere S with CD recording and cause the CD to be unusable Once recording has started the CD recorder must receive a constant stream of data until the entire recording is finished If the CD recorder runs out of data before recording is finished the program will abort with a fatal error Copying logical disks to the CD recorder that are being updated by other users can result in CDs containing incorrect or incomplete data Type MAKACD from the AMOS prompt MAKACD MAKACD will attempt to find a CD recorder that is compatible with the CD recorder driver being used The driver must have the same name as the CD recorder device name and either be loaded in system memory or reside in DSKO 1 6 MAKACD will find the CD recorder either using the command line switches DEV and ID or by defaulting to CDR if DEV is not specified and by scanning the SCSI bus if ID is not specified If more than one CD type device is found when scanning the SCSI bus you will be asked to ch
334. e are no Because DSKPAK re organizes the disk file structure completely it is a good idea to back up the disk before using DSKPAK on it just in case there are any problems with the disk If the system crashes while a DSKPAK is in progress you must use DSKANA after you reboot the system to clean up the disk before writing to it FORMAT DSKPAK devn OPERATION Log into account DSKO 1 2 Use DSKANA to clear up the disk you want to pack You should also be sure you have a current backup of the disk Then enter DSKPAK and the specification of the device you want to pack For example DSKPAK DSK1 DSKPAK warns you all users must be off the disk you are going to pack When you are sure this is true press RETURN You may press CTRLI C to stop at this point System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKPAK Page 2 DSKPAK makes as many passes through the disk as it needs to pack it completely The number of passes DSKPAK makes depends on how much your disk is in need of packing DSKPAK prints one dot for each disk account processed MESSAGES Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to display the devices defined on your system and try again Cannot lock directory or device name disk not mounted MOUNT the disk and try again File specification error The file specification was entered wrong Check to be sure you included the device specification and check your spelling The
335. e changed during either backup or verification so tape spanning is impossible In such cases MTUSAV aborts gracefully under control of the SOFTABORT flag and JOBERR is set appropriately Regardless of the SOPFTABORT and TIMEOUT settings if you submit the control file containing MTUSAV to the Task Manager using the ERROR switch the Task Manager will abort the control file after MTUSAV exits if MTUSAV has displayed a message starting with with ERROR FATAL with ERROR WARNING or either with ERROR ALL You can avoid this by using the NOTMSYMBOL switch on the MTUSAV command line If a control file entry for the tape label is too large MTUSAV truncates it to the maximum length System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 8 Using MTUSAV in a Command File Command files allow more interaction than control files In particular terminal input is possible In fact if an action is necessary for example a tape is write protected MTUSAV forces a prompt to the screen regardless of the setting of Trace or Silence mode in the command file Therefore you can see the message correct the problem and respond to the prompt so the command file will continue If the command file is run unattended such as for an overnight backup operator intervention is not possible and you will want to use the TIMEOUT n and or SOFTABORT switches discussed above so the command file can continue in case of an error If
336. e computer and use MONTST to test your new initialization file If everything is correct STAT should show the RADMON job in an S1 sleep state If you set up e mail notification a message is sent to the specified addresses telling them that RADMON is running unless you also used the S switch System Commands Reference Manual Rev 13 If there is a problem change the SETJOB statement to attach RADMON to a real terminal and MONTST again Check the terminal for error messages so you can correct the situation Once you re satisfied everything is working correctly rename your test initialization file to make it your standard initialization file MESSAGES Micropolis RAID controller not found Either you entered an incorrect value for the SCSI ID or you did not enter a SCSI ID and RADMON could not find the controller when it polled the SCSI bus No supported RAID controller found Either you entered an incorrect value for the SCSI ID or you did not enter a SCSI ID and RADMON could not find the controller when it polled the SCSI bus RADMON Error communicating with RAID controller RADMON did not understand the responses it received when it polled the RAID controller This program requires a SCSI dispatcher be installed You cannot use RADMON if your computer doesn t use a SCSI dispatcher Usage RADMON ID x email person system person system S R Z O The syntax of your RADMON command line in RADMON_ JIN is not
337. e device specification is DDAO OPTIONS KILL Delete existing listfile before creating the new one Operation switch OPERATION Enter FLPDIR and the specifications you need For example to display all the files on a floppy disk on your terminal FLPDIR ALL Now FLPDIR asks you to enter the device name of the backup device Enter the name of your floppy drive The default device code is DDAO System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FLPDIR Page 2 The first number on the directory display line tells you the file s relative position on the floppy disk Next you see the device specification the filename and extension and the account specification of the file as it appeared on the disk it was being backed up from The next number tells you the number of disk blocks the file takes up on this disk FLPDIR now tells you whether the file is a linked sequential file L or a contiguous random file C and also whether a file is split across multiple media S Finally FLPDIR displays the date and time of the backup At the end of the directory display FLPDIR tells you how many files were listed in the display If your printer has been defined on your system as a terminal you may send the display directly to a printer by using an output specification of TRM printer name MESSAGES Cannot find DSK0 SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS See your System Operator about locating the file Cannot INIT device name device does not exi
338. e existing files only Default SUPPRESS Don t display the name of each file as it is copied Display the total number of files transferred at the end of the copy NOSUPPRESS Display each file name as it is copied Default OPERATION Enter COPY and the file specifications for the new file and the files you want copied For example COPY SORT TXT WORK1 TXT WORK1 TXT to SORT TXT Total of 1 file transferred Remember you can use wildcard symbols and COPY assumes certain filespec defaults For example COPY DSK1 OLD NEW copies all files with a NEW extension from the account and device you are logged into over to the same account on DSK1 The new files have the same names but have extension OLD When you use the Q switch COPY asks you for confirmation of each transfer Remember the placement of the switch on the command line can affect which files it affects When COPY prompts you for confirmation answer with a Y for Yes or an N for No Do not press after your answer For example COPY SRCFIL 110 2 WRKFIL QUERY RETURN WRKFIL BAS TO SRCFIL BAS 110 2 Y WRKFIL RUN TO SRCFIL RUN 110 2 N fr You may use CTRLVC at any time to halt the copy System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 COPY To copy to a terminal use the terminal name in place of the new file specification For example COPY TRM TRM2 SYS AMOS INI This displays the contents of AMOS INI on the terminal TRM2
339. e final bars represent a breakdown of sequentially written blocks per physical disk write When physical writes are performed the driver attempts to perform them as multi sector operations whenever possible Up to eight sequential blocks may be written per disk access resulting in better overall performance MESSAGES Driver not found The requested driver could not be found Check the name by using DEVTBL and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SCZCSH Page 2 Invalid driver type The specified driver does not support write caching Choose another driver System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SCZERR FUNCTION Displays and optionally clears the SCSI error statistics CHARACTERISTICS SCZERR is re entrant and re usable The SCSI dispatcher counts all errors for each SCSI device whether corrected or not SCZERR displays the accumulated error counts for each SCSI device on the system FORMAT SCZERR A OPTION IA Causes SCZERR to report errors for all 16 possible SCSI devices whether or not they exist on the system Without the A switch errors are displayed for only those SCSI devices that exist in the dispatcher OPERATION Type SCZERR or SCZERR A SCZERR displays a screen showing the SCSI ID of the first SCSI device on the computer with the number of errors of each type for that device Press to see the error statistics for the next device When the errors for the last device have been disp
340. e in numeric form CHARACTERISTICS FILDMP is re entrant and re usable May only be used with sequential files See the DUMP reference sheet for information on dumping random files Displays the file data in the number base currently in use on your job See the SET reference sheet for information about setting number bases Sixteen bytes of data are displayed on each screen line FORMAT FILDMP filespec filespec specifies the file whose contents you want to see The default device and account is where you are logged The default extension is OBJ OPERATION Enter FILDMP and the specification of the file whose data you want to see For example FILDMP INIT LIT 057 124 124 114 040 106 111 114 104 115 120 040 050 103 157 yG Press the key or CTRL S and CTRLYQ to freeze and re start the display To end the display press CTRLYC MESSAGE Cannot open filespec file not found Check your syntax or use DIR to find the file and try again Cannot open filespec file type mismatch The file is a random file use the DUMP command File specification error Check your format and typing and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FILTAP FUNCTION Writes copies of disk files to magnetic tape CHARACTERISTICS FILTAP is re entrant and re usable Writes files to a magnetic tape along with their device and account specifications Used in combination with TAPFIL to transfer files from a magnetic tap
341. e index file combination The index file contains pointers to records in the data file ISAM SYS quickly finds data records by searching the index file instead of searching the data file itself powerful easier to use ISAM Plus If you are using ISAM Plus use the ISMUTL utility instead of ISMDMP See the ISMUTL reference sheet ISMDMP may also be used to convert ISAM files to ISAM Plus format See the conversion hints in your ZSAM Plus User s Guide Two keyed sequential access methods may co exist on your computer ISAM and the more The purpose of ISMDMP in display mode is to aid in debugging programs that use ISAM Much of the information in the display is of help only to the experienced systems programmer and some of the information is of use only to programmers working on the ISAM program itself Dumping data to a sequential file can be useful for data backup w Although you call ISAM functions from within your AlphaBASIC or assembly language programs you may not run the ISAM SYS program directly from AMOS command level For more information on using ISAM and ISMDMP see your ISAM System User s Guide FORMAT ISMDMP filespec N filespec selects the ISAM data or index file you want to dump and N selects the Counted Update Mode option DEFAULTS The default extension of the ISAM file you want to dump is IDX The default extension of the file that will contain the data is SEQ System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS
342. e one in memory is locked there by AMOS Cannot INIT filespec device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system and try again Cannot load filespec file not found Check your syntax or use DIR to find the file and try again Cannot load filespec disk not mounted MOUNT the disk and try again Contiguous files may not be loaded Random files cannot be loaded into memory Program restricted to use on local system only You cannot LOAD a file from a remote system over a network COPY the file to your system then LOAD it Warning Program is not reusable You have loaded a program file that is not re usable The file has been loaded but it may not function properly after the first time it is executed We recommended you use DEL to remove it from your memory partition System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LOG FUNCTION Logs you into an account Once you are on the system LOG displays which account you are logged into or transfers you between accounts and devices CHARACTERISTICS LOG is re entrant and re usable You may only use a few AMOS commands if you are not logged into the system such as LOG LOGON SYSTAT MEMORY ATTACH SYSTEM DATE TIME HELP and SET LOG recognizes ersatz devices For example LOG BAS logs you into the AlphaBASIC library account DSKO 7 6 For a list of the ersatz devices available on your system enter ERSATZ at AMOS command le
343. e restoring FORMAT OPTIONS BDRES switches HELP Display the available options and exits n Same as HELP DEV xxx Uses device and driver named xxx instead of the default DVD ID n Uses the DVD RAM or Blu ray Drive at SCSI ID n instead of scanning the SCSI bus to find a DVD RAM Drive The ID can be from 0 to 15 IV Display version information PIC Display Product Installation Code System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 BDRES Page 2 OPERATION o BDRES works best on a job with 132 columns set as the terminal width Before starting the program place the DVD RAM or Blu ray media with the logicals you wish to copy in the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive Then type BDRES from the AMOS prompt BDRES BDRES will attempt to find a DVD RAM or Blu ray drive that is compatible with the driver being used The driver must have the same name as the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive device name and be loaded in system memory BDRES will find the drive either using the command line switches DEV and ID or by defaulting to DBD If more than one DVD RAM or Blu ray type device is found when scanning the SCSI bus you will be asked to choose the device you wish to use for copying from After entering the BDRES command the following will be displayed BDRES Version X X xxx x Copyright 2007 Alpha Microsystems If BDRES finds multiple possible DVD RAM or Blu ray drives while scanning the SCSI bus the foll
344. e selecting files file switch System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 VCRRES NOQUERY Don t confirm copy default file switch SEARCH Search for a file using FAST FORWARD Operation switch Manual VCRs only TRANSFER Copy files without locking other users out of the system Operation switch Because with T you share CPU time with other users the restore could miss files if your system is being heavily used Since VCRRES erases files of the same name on the disk before trying to restore from the tape this means you could lose files What constitutes heavy use depends on the system and the number of copies saved if you have any doubt about the restore don t use T OPERATION Enter VCRRES and the files you need For example to copy all BAS files originally backed up from account 110 2 on DSK2 over to your current account enter VCRRES DSK2 BAS 110 2 You then see a warning other users will be suspended while VCRRES is running or if you used T you may not be able to restore files if your system is in heavy use If you proceed VCRRES either runs the VCR to complete the restore if you have a VideoTRAX automatic VTR or instructs you in running your VCR VCRRES displays a list of the files on the cassette that fit the specifications you entered earlier If you used Q VCRRES waits after the appropriate statement for you to respond Y for yes or N for no You don t have to press RETURN For example
345. e system and try again when it is ready for access Device full There is not enough room on your disk to do the copy you requested See what you can do to free up memory space Files may not be transferred to RES You cannot transfer files to resident system memory You must use aSYSTEM command in your system initialization command file Missing Output specification You left out the equal sign and CPMCPY could not tell which was your AMOS file and which was your CP M file More than one output specification You may not specify more than one AMOS file Check your entry System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 CPMCPY Specification error Your command line is not in the proper format The symbol points to the part of the line CPMCPY did not understand System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CPMDIR FUNCTION Displays the directory of a CP M diskette CHARACTERISTICS CPMDIR is not re entrant or re usable CPMDIR uses the IMG DVR floppy driver to access the data on the CP M diskette you must have a valid copy of that program in account 1 6 of the System Disk For information on configuring floppy disk drivers see your System Operator s Guide The IMG device must be defined in your system device table CPMDIR assumes the diskette whose directory you want to see is mounted on CP M device A AMOS device IMG0 CP M device B is AMOS device IMG1 A CP M is a
346. e that can be read from the disk by following the internal forward pointers was larger than the number of blocks indicated in the disk file s directory entry The file system is corrupt MTUSAV truncates the tape file to the number of blocks specified in the disk directory entry and data may be lost The file is corrupt Bkup seq file read error Error MTUSAV cannot read a disk block from a sequential file on disk Bkup contig file read error Error MTUSAV cannot read a disk block from a contiguous file on disk Bkup file known Note The file is listed in MTUSAV INF If the incident is one of those listed for MTUSAV INF use this severity Problems During Verification Verif seq file error Error A sequential file on tape did not match its partner on 7 9 disk For AMOS 2 x systems the file sizes are the same but the contents differ Verif contig file error Error A contiguous file on tape did not match its partner on 7 9 disk For AMOS 2 x systems the file sizes are the System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 18 Incident Name Default Meaning Note same but the contents differ Tape dir block not found Error A directory block on the tape was not found when MTUSAV was expecting one The AMOS disk file system is corrupted and or the tape is bad One or more files may be missing or corrupted on the tape Verif seq file not exist Warning A sequential file that was present when the backup 7 was made and copied to ta
347. e the bitmap of the device you re analyzing Run DSKANA from a job with more memory or increase your memory partition size System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 5 DSKANA No file errors There were no file errors found during the DSKANA Privileged program must be logged into 1 2 Log into an operator s account 1 2 and try again Restoring blocks into disk cache status DSKANA is putting the statically locked blocks for the device back into the disk cache Status may be e Done All blocks for the device have been restored to the disk cache e Error Not enough space to store all locked buffers There were not enough buffers in the disk cache to restore all previously locked blocks e Error General disk error A disk error of some type has occurred Rewriting BITMAP Informs you DSKANA is rewriting the bitmap number file errors detected This displays the number of file errors found If you used C you should re run DSKANA without C to correct these file errors The following blocks were marked in use but not in a file You may see a list of block numbers following this message This is not necessarily anything to be alarmed about Running DSKANA frees up the blocks listed under this message by marking them free for use If the list of blocks is extremely long you can press CTRLYC to interrupt it While the rest of the block numbers will not display DSKANA will still write the corrected bitmap
348. e the disk and report any read errors The problem can be fixed using DSKDDT but the data in the block may be lost Disk size not defined in table DSKCPY doesn t know the number of disk blocks per disk for the devices you are trying to copy between This means you are copying between devices DSKCPY doesn t know about See your System Operator for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 DSKCPY Driver not found DSKCPY couldn t find the device driver program for the specified non DSK device That means the driver was not in system memory user memory or DSKO 1 6 See your System Operator Input and output devices must be the same You entered device specifications in which the three character device code was different For example you tried to copy DSK1 to AMS1 Invalid switch Re enter the command line using a valid switch 2No BADBLK SYS on input device 2No BADBLK SYS on output device No BADBLK SYS on output device Recertification recommended Cannot fetch BADBLK SYS The device has lost its BADBLK SYS media flaw file or that file cannot be read from disk The drive needs to be backed up using another backup method before recertification and DSKCPY is tried again Privileged program must be logged into 1 2 Log into 1 2 and try again Sector not found during disk copy drive N block X drive N and block X are octal or hexadecimal numbers The contents of a disk sector have become unformatted V
349. e to ISAM Plus format Index file full If this happens during the splitting of an index block your index file may be destroyed It s always a good idea to add extra empty index blocks when you create the file Index structure is smashed This message indicates serious structural damage to your index file You may need to rebuild your ISAM Plus file Invalid key type Enter 1 for alphanumeric 2 for unsigned binary and 3 for concatenated key Invalid record size Enter a record size of between 4 and 65535 bytes ISAMP SYS not found You must load ISAMP SYS in MEM or RES prior to using ISMUTL s functions Key outside record The key is outside the record boundary All keys must be within a record Maximum binary type size 8 Enter a key size of eight bytes or less Maximum extra percentage 900 You can request up to tenfold the number of index blocks allocated Maximum key size 161 Enter a key size of 161 or less System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 ISMUTL Page 4 Maximum number of 2nd key directories 64 This message appears when an assembly language program is interfacing with ISMUTL Make sure the number is 64 or less No such secondary key number You are trying to access a secondary key directory which has not been created Number of records dumped is mismatched with the number of records in the file There is an inconsistency between the number of records dumped and the number o
350. e total Tx link loop count wrap count RLLCNT is the total Rx link loop count wrap count PTDA is pending TDA index CTDA is current free TDA index System Commands Reference Manual Rev 14 Page 3 ESLSI CRDA is current RDA pending to be processed RDA count is total number of Rx descriptors assigned TDA count is total number of Tx descriptors assigned Wrap count is the total number of times the Rx descriptors have been wrapped TIMER CNT is the total number of timer interrupts ARL CNT is current total number of available Rx descriptors PRH CNT is the highest level of Rx descriptors used ATL CNT is current total number of available Tx descriptors PTH CNT is the highest level of Tx descriptors used PINFUS CNT is the total number of packets not for us IINT CNT is total invalid interrupt count NIS CNT is the total number of normal interrupt count AIS CNT is the total number of abnormal interrupt count CUNF CNT is the total Tx underrun count PRDA AS is pending RDA index RCOKERR is the total receive dead status count TCOKERR is the total transmit dead or txabort status count q The PRH CNT amp PTH CNT fields are very important RDA count tells you S the number of receive descriptors have been allocated PRH CNT tells you the highest number of receive descriptors that have been used at any one time Conversely TDA count tells you the number of transmit descriptors have been allocated and PTH CNT tells you the highest number of transmit
351. e value for RETURN then type the setting you want and RETURN To leave the ADJIT screen type END or press CTRLYC Y The values you enter are changed only in memory When you reboot the system the S priority settings will return to their default values MESSAGES Error feature not supported by this release Your current AMOS monitor doesn t support dynamic job scheduling System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 AGREP FUNCTION Searches all files in the local account for an ASCII string CHARACTERISTICS AGREP is re entrant and re usable AGREP is a quick way to find a string of characters in a set of files without having to VUE each in turn You may search in a binary file but only for ASCII characters AGREP will not search in random files OPTIONS D Sends file name s and number of occurrences to SEARCH DIR F Turn on folding All characters compared without regard to case L Send output to SEARCH LST IN Turn off screen auto paging IT Turn on token mode search OPERATION Enter AGREP in the account you want to search You are then prompted for the search string which can be any length sequence of printable characters including blanks and tabs There are no wildcard characters When you press RETURN you are prompted for the file s to be searched the files must be in your current account Enter the files to be searched and any options For example AGREP String to search for INVENTORY
352. ean your cassette is damaged Use CRT610 to check the tape Unable to run device handler task The device handler failed to communicate with the main task after it was spawned See your System Operator or Alpha Micro dealer for help Unspecified error received The main task received an error from the device handler it did not understand Try again if the problem persists see your Alpha Micro dealer for help VCR failed to respond to command This could indicate a problem with the remote control of your VCR with the connection between your computer and your VCR or with your computer Make sure your cables are properly connected if the cable is okay try to locate whether it s the VCR or computer so you can get it fixed 2 WARNING Copy count on tape is below the minimum level when using the TRANSFER switch If your computer is busy this could mean BAKDIR won t work properly You may want to try again without T System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 5 BAKDIR WARNING Device handler task failed to respond Reboot system Reboot your system There should be no damage to your data System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BASBP FUNCTION Aids in converting AlphaBASIC programs to AlphaBASIC 1 4 or AlphaBASIC PLUS files CHARACTERISTICS BASBP is re entrant and re usable Accepts one or more AlphaBASIC BAS files as input and outputs the converted file BP For more information on AlphaBASIC P
353. eans any data on the disk you are copying to will be irretrievably lost after a disk copy is done DSKCPY will wipe out the BADBLK SYS file if you are copying to a disk with a BADBLK SYS file You must be logged into 1 2 to run DSKCPY v Do not run DSKCPY while anyone is accessing either of the disks involved in the copy You may use DSKCPY on any kind of disk device However the three character device specification must be the same for both devices you are copying between For example if you want to make a copy of DSKO a Winchester disk you may copy it to DSK1 or DSK6 but you may not copy it to AMSO or STD3 DSKCPY works only on devices which use the traditional directory structure Do not use o DSKCPY on extended format disks DSKCPY optionally generates a hash total for the backup disk when it has finished the disk copy This feature is useful if you are making multiple copies of a disk the hash total displayed at the end of the disk copy should be the same for each disk copied The hash total gives you an extra way to verify the copies made are identical to the master disk since two disks will only have the same hash total if their contents are identical For information on generating a hash total for a disk without using DSKCPY see the HASHER reference sheet FORMAT DSKCPY switch switch is an option request DEFAULTS If you enter just the unit numbers of the disks you want to copy between instead of a full device
354. eas of the last recorded session on the CD This command may be used more than once to successively erase multiple sessions from the CD Once a session is erased the previous session may become available Uses the CD Recorder at SCSI ID n instead of scanning the SCSI bus to find a CD Recorder The ID can be from 0 to 15 The CD will not be ejected from the recorder Do not write AMOS filler and ACD special sector information The newly recorded data will not be accessible by the ACD program Do not write out the table of contents when recording is finished The newly recorded data will be inaccessible until the TOC option is used to write the table of contents Displays the Product Installation Code Sets the maximum recording speed to n times the normal audio speed This switch can be used to force recording at a slower speed if the system is unable to supply data to the CD Recorder System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 3 MAKACD Speeds from 1 to 32 may be specified If the CD Recorder does not support the speed specified recording will be done at a lower supported speed TOC Writes the table of contents of the current CD and exits TEST Write CD in test mode which does everything except turn the CD laser on when recording TESTFIRST Does a TEST first followed by the actual CD recording if no errors were encountered in the TEST VERBOSE Display additional error messages MAKACD with no switches will creat
355. ease correct then press RETURN when ready or press Control C to abort Correct the situation and continue End of reel please mount next tape in save set and press RETURN to continue or press Control C to abort restore Remove the reel and mount the next Missing output specification Try again with an output specification More than one output specification Re enter using only one outfilespec Not Copied Destination file cannot be deleted The current file was selected for transferring to disk However the disk file could not be deleted so it could be replaced The tape file was not copied to disk Not Copied Destination file already exists You specified the NOD switch and the destination file already exists If you do want the file copied over the current one try again without the NOD switch Tape is not first reel of save set Please correct then press RETURN when ready or press Control C to abort Place the first reel in the drive and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 5 MTURES Tape is not file structured Please correct then press RETURN when ready The tape was not created in MTUSAV format Make sure you have the correct reel of tape and you specified the correct tape unit number Tape is not from the same save set or is out of sequence Place the correct tape in the drive and try again Unable to continue restore output device full The disk you
356. ecification you provide For example if you have configured a floppy disk driver named PCF DVR for a 3 5 drive using double sided double density PC format the device specification PCFO tells FMT219 to use PC format to format the diskette in drive zero of that device For information on configuring floppy disk drivers see your System Operator s Guide As it formats FMT219 writes over any data currently on the diskette FMT219 disables buffered writes if the diskette was mounted with B see MOUNT If the device is not mounted FMT219 mounts it but without buffered writes enabled After formatting the diskette you may want to remount it to enable buffered writes After formatting a diskette use the SYSACT I command to initialize it unless you are going to use DSKCPY to make a literal image of another diskette on the newly formatted one FORMAT FMT219 devn devn specifies the device holding the diskette you want to format OPERATION Enter FMT219 and the device that holds the diskette you want to format For example FMT219 MIN1 This tells FMT219 to format the diskette in drive one of the floppy device using the MIN driver program System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 FMT219 Page MESSAGES Cannot format diskette AMOS error message The diskette could not be formatted for the reason given Try to correct the situation or see your System Operator for help Privileged program must be logged into
357. ecified device defines the hardware address of the device to be a non standard port Carefully check that you want to certify this device as you may be specifying a device not under control of an AM 410 disk controller Then enter Y or N as appropriate Nonexistent device Check your spelling and try again Use DEVTBL or SYSTAT to see a list of the devices on your system Privileged program must be logged into OPR Log into OPR and try again S100 data transfer error An error occurred with the AM 410 controller A number of these errors can indicate hardware problems Track 0 did not verify First track must verify Get technical help to determine why track 0 did not verify Track n did not verify CRT410 marked track n as a bad track in the BADBLK SYS file 215 bad tracks is maximum Try again entering 15 or less System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CRT415 FUNCTION Certifies the disk media of a Winchester device that runs under control of the AM 415 High Performance Winchester disk controller CHARACTERISTICS CRT415 is re entrant and re usable CRT415 certifies a physical unit by reading the factory encoded media flaw information on each track and head of the unit and constructing a BADBLK SYS file in account 1 2 of the first logical device o You may use this certification program ONLY on High Performance Winchester devices that run under control of the AM 415 CRT415 communicates directly with
358. ecorder requires a different driver The current driver is Xxxxxx The required driver is XXXXXX The device and driver selected are inappropriate for the physical DVD RAM drive e Unable to find a DVD Recorder e Unknown DVD Recorder Error Unsupported DVD Recorder drive found The DVD RAM Recorder is not supported by DVDRES Error messages when setting up or reading from the DVD Recorder e Error Buffer not initialized e Error Device is already in use This indicates that either another user is running the DVDRES program or the DVD is being used in shared read write mode e Error Disk in DVD Recorder is not writeable e Error DVDram driver must be in system memory e Error Unable to load DVD media This indicates a hardware problem with the DVD RAM drive or a problem with the DVD media e Error Unable to read disk information from media Try a different DVD media This can also indicate a possible DVD RAM drive problem e Fatal SCSI error Sense key nn additional sense nn DVD drive device error has occurred Sense key and additional sense provide further error information e Please insert a DVD RAM media e Warning Maximum number of devices exceeded extras ignored e Warning Unable to close DVD Device error occurred while closing the current DVD The DVD RAM may or may not be usable System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 Page 7 DVDRES SCSI error message from the driver DVD RAM drive device error ha
359. ed Your floppy diskette is in a format DOSDR can t read System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DOSEXP FUNCTION Transfers a file from AMOS to an MS DOS formatted diskette CHARACTERISTICS DOSEXP accepts wildcards for the DOS file and for a full AMOS specification see OPERATION below It is re entrant re usable and works with these diskette formats 5 1 4 360 K 3 1 2 1 44M Because MS DOS does not support contiguous random files DOSEXP will not transfer contiguous files To use this command you must have a DOS disk driver program created using FIXFLP Y or FIX219 for your computer s diskette drive The drive must be defined using this driver in BITMAP and DEVTBL statements in your system initialization command file you may want to load the driver into system memory See your system operator for help FORMAT DOSEXP devn DOS filespec AMOS filespec switch devn is the diskette device DOS filespec is the optional name to be given the file on the diskette uses AMOS name if not specified and AMOS filespec is the specification of the file to be transferred The AMOS device and account default to where you are logged Do not put any spaces on either side of the equal sign OPTIONS B Transfers data in binary Q Query Asks you to confirm export of each selected file OPERATION Enter DOSEXP and the DOS and AMOS specifications For example DOSEXP LFDO TEST NEWPROGR EXE DSK3 NEW ABC 120 53 D
360. ed an invalid switch Only E and S are legal switches for LABEL Label updated The label block has been successfully updated its directory format was changed and or the noise words were corrected Noise words will be updated When using the E or S switch if the label block s noise words are wrong LABEL will update them when it updates the label Switch valid only in Operator Account 1 2 You can use the E or S switches only when logged in an operator account 1 2 Log into 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LDVSTS FUNCTION Displays statistical information accumulated by a particular LAN driver LDV A LDVs are similar to NDVs The most notable difference is that LDVs are hardware drivers S only They do not perform any network protocol specific functions CHARACTERISTICS LDVSTS is re entrant and re usable It displays statistical information retrieved from the LDV specified on the command line The LDV is polled for this information several times a second only changed statistics are updated on the screen You can press CTRLIC at any time to exit the program FORMAT LDVSTS ldv Idv is the name of the driver whose statistics you want to see You do not need to include the LDV extension OPERATION LDVSTS displays three categories of information Driver Information The driver name version type of network hardware it controls and a device number indicating which ha
361. ee an asterisk prompt If you want to specify more files than will fit on one command line you may continue the command line by ending the current line with a comma LIBLIT displays an asterisk and you may continue entering filespecs You may enter as many lines as you wish as long as the preceding line ends with a comma DEFAULTS The default library spec extension is LIB The default filespec extension is OBJ If you do not include an account and device specification LIBLIT looks for the files specified in the account and device you are logged into then it looks in your project library account P 0 Finally LIBLIT looks in the System Library account DSKO 7 7 If you do not include an output specification LIBLIT creates an output file with the same name as the first input specification If you use the L switch to create a library listing LIBLIT uses the default extension LST for that listing output file If you use the L switch and omit an output file specification LIBLIT displays the listing on your terminal OPTIONS L List the library file either on the terminal or ina file This listing looks like a load map file and lists all library object files and all INTERNed symbols OPERATION TO CREATE A LIBRARY FILE Enter LIBLIT and the specification of the library file you want to create an equal sign and the specifications of the object files you want to combine For example LIBLIT MYLIB ADNUM RDBIN WRTBIN ASCCHK The
362. ee space and erases any existing LOG and VER files The MTUSAV command line includes LOG and VERIFY these are an integral part of the checking process As shown the IF command must immediately follow MTUSAV s input parameters or AMOS will overwrite JOBERR The IF command branches to ALL OK if there were no errors and MTUSAV LOG was produced Checking for the log file is crucial since MTUSAV LOG was erased before MTUSAV and we used the LOG option if there is no MTUSAV LOG after MTUSAV runs something bad happened For example there may have been insufficient memory to execute MTUSAV e After a backup print the MTUSAV LOG file and keep it with the tape If you need to restore files you can quickly check to see if the backup was intact If any files had a problem when they were backed up you may want to take special action before restoring them For example you may want to copy an existing disk file to a file with a different name before restoring the tape copy Using in Command Control Files Using MTUSAV in a command file or Task Manager control file is often very convenient as it allows unattended backups to run when no one is using the computer However an unattended backup can present its own problems Using the SOFTABORT and TIMEOUT switches can be key to getting the best results from MTUSAV in a command or control file The SOFTABORT and TIMEOUT Switches By default if an error occurs while MTUSAV is running in a command
363. ee the text you are editing displayed on the screen and move the screen cursor to the location in your file you want to view or edit In Command mode AlphaXED lets you search for specific strings of text perform local and global replacements move and delete blocks of text and change various editing parameters AlphaXED copies into memory the file you want to edit and makes a backup file by renaming the disk file to a BAK extension When you exit AlphaXED the new edited version of the file goes out to disk under the original name and extension of the file You may edit a file too big to fit into your memory partition An AlphaXED initialization file XED INI lets you set your own default editing parameters See your AlphaXED User s Guide for more detail on using AlphaXED and setting up the XED INI file To exit AlphaXED enter Command mode by pressing ESC At the AlphaXED prompt gt enter F to exit and update your file or Q if you want to exit without updating FORMAT XED filespec switch filespec selects the file you want to edit and switch is an option request If you don t specify a filespec you are prompted for one The default extension can vary see your AlphaXED User s Manual DEFAULTS The defaults AlphaXED uses for example the default file extension are defined in the AlphaXED initialization file XED INI System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 XED Page 2 OPTIONS All the
364. een wrapped TIMER CNT is the total number of timer interrupts ARL CNT is current total number of available Rx descriptors PRH CNT is the highest level of Rx descriptors used System Commands Reference Manual Rev 14 Page 3 ESNIC ATL CNT is current total number of available Tx descriptors PTH CNT is the highest level of Tx descriptors used PINFUS CNT is the total number of packets not for us IINT CNT is total invalid interrupt count NIS CNT is the total number of normal interrupt count AIS CNT is the total number of abnormal interrupt count CUNF CNT is the total Tx underrun count q The PRH CNT amp PTH CNT fields are very important RDA count tells you S the number of receive descriptors have been allocated PRH CNT tells you the highest number of receive descriptors that have been used at any one time Conversely TDA count tells you the number of transmit descriptors have been allocated and PTH CNT tells you the highest number of transmit descriptors that have been used at any one time If the numbers become close to each other then it might be time to think about increasing your allocation in the INI file Rx Status Rx Error Summary is the total of Rx Status Errors Length Error is the count of Rx packets larger than standard Runt Frame is the count of Rx packets smaller than standard Collision is the total number of collisions encountered CRC Error is the total number of CRC errors encountered Frame Too Long is the total numbe
365. eet FORMAT FORCE jobname commands data or FORCE jobname commands data commands data blank line commands data are any valid AMOS commands or data you can enter from the keyboard OPERATION Enter FORCE followed by the name of the job you wish to force input to Then enter the commands data you want to force For example FORCE JOB2 RUN INVEN Here s an example of a multi line FORCE FORCE JOB3 LOG DSK0 110 5 TXTFMT HEADER System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FORCE Page 2 MESSAGES Guarded The job you tried to force is guarded Log into OPR if you want to try again Job busy The targeted job is not ready to receive further commands it is not in Ti state Try again later No terminal attached to job You need to use the ATTACH command to assign a terminal to the job you want to force input to You can assign a pseudo terminal if you do not need to see any output from that job However you cannot force to a pseudo terminal that uses a NULL terminal driver Nonexistent job FORCE doesn t recognize the name of the job you are trying to force to Check your syntax or use TRMDFF to see what jobs are on your system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FREE FUNCTION Displays the number of free blocks on the disk and the number of blocks in the largest free contiguous space CHARACTERISTICS FREE is re entrant and re usable FORMAT FREE devn devn is the disk
366. eet for information on setting forms FORMAT PRNT switch printer filespec filespec switch printer is the specification for a printer and the filespecs identify the file s you want to print DEFAULTS The default printer is the printer with the least number of blocks waiting in the queue to be printed unless your System Operator has used the DEFAULT command in the spooler parameter file to define another printer default The default switch settings depend upon the specific printer being used the defaults for each printer are set by the System Operator The default filespec is a null name and LST extension The initial default device and account is where you are logged OPTIONS With some switches such as SUSPEND and START where the PRNT command must identify page numbers the file being printed must either have been formatted using TXTFMT or have been specified with the HEADER switch Placing NO before a file switch cancels the switch The default switches are NOB NOD FF NOFINISH NOH NOINFORM NOLIMIT ON NOQ NORESTART and NOSTART Switches may be abbreviated to any unique characters System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PRNT AFTER mm dd yy hh mm A PM BANNER text COPIES n DELETE FF FINISH page FORMS form HEADER INFORM KILL LIMIT n LPP n OFF ON PRIORITY n QUERY RESTART page SEQ n switch START page SUSPEN
367. efault DVD ID n Uses the DVD RAM Drive at SCSI ID n instead of scanning the SCSI bus to find a DVD RAM Drive The ID can be from 0 to 15 IV Display version information PIC Display Product Installation Code System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 DVDRES Page 2 OPERATION Before starting the program place the DVD media with the logicals you wish to copy in the DVD RAM drive Type DVDRES from the AMOS prompt DVDRES DVDRES will attempt to find a DVD RAM drive that is compatible with the DVD RAM driver being used The driver must have the same name as the DVD drive device name and be loaded in system memory DVDRES will find the DVD RAM drive either using the command line switches DEV and ID or by defaulting to DVD If more than one DVD RAM type device is found when scanning the SCSI bus you will be asked to choose the device you wish to use for coping from After entering the DVDRES command the following will be displayed DVDRES Version X X xxx x Copyright 2002 Alpha Micro Products If DVDRES finds multiple possible DVD RAM drives while scanning the SCSI bus the following message will be displayed to allow you to select the drive to use Found the following possible DVD Recorders ID Description I nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX 2 nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX Select one of the above devices Additional information about the DVD RAM drive driver and media contents is
368. efore the specified date and time The date and time must be in the format specified in your current language definition file KILL or K Deletes an existing listfile before creating a new one Operation switch System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MTUDIR Page 2 OPERATION Enter MTUDIR an optional listfilespec and the input filespec s For example MTUDIR ALL DAT BAS MTUDIR asks you for the tape unit number Enter a single digit for the tape drive you wish to use If your computer has more than one tape backup device with the same unit number MTUDIR asks Enter tape device name devices MTUDIR lists the devices that share that unit number Enter the one you wish to use MTUDIR displays the reel label for the reel mounted on the selected unit Beginning a directory display with a tape from the middle of a multi reel save set may result in error messages being displayed while MTUDIR tries to synchronize itself with the tape s directory structure After displaying the label information MTUDIR displays a line of data for each selected file in the directory The first number on the line tells you the file s relative position on the tape Next you see the device specification of the file as it appeared on the disk it was backed up from then the number of disk blocks the file takes up The letter following the block count tells you whether the file is a linked sequential file or a contiguous random file If you wa
369. em Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Revision A00 A01 A02 A03 A04 A05 A06 A07 A08 A09 00 01 02 03 04 Release L 1 0 L 1 0A L1 1 L1 1 L1 1A L 1 3B 32 1 0 L 1 3C 32 1 0A 2 0 2 0A 2 1 2 2 2 3 Date 06 82 10 82 03 83 06 83 08 83 05 84 06 85 05 86 07 86 12 86 03 88 12 88 09 89 04 91 09 96 Document History Description New Document Part Number DSS 10004 00 Added AM 600 T Magnetic Tape Utility Program Reference Sheets Added VCR and 1 4 Streamer Tape Driver backup commands Added info on initializing BADBLK SYS disk drives and modifying BADBLK SYS to Added new LOKSER commands LOKGEN and LOKUTL Other minor changes Added AM 415 information to BADBLK and FIX420 Added CRT415 and VER reference sheets Added Winchester disk information to BADBLK and FIX420 Added CPMCPY CPMDIR MENU MTBOOT and SHELL Added 1 2 mag tape density settings to SET Added the MONHSH reference sheet Revised CRT610 DIR SET VCRDIR VCRRES VCRSAV and VUE commands Updated DSKANA MONGEN MAKQUE SET STAT and TSKINI Added CACHE ERSATZ PRNT and VERIFY Added new VCR remote control information Changed BITMAP to include size field Added FIXLOG sheet Added reference sheets for new commands IF LOGGER LOGON MUSER SETJOB SYSLOG Updated DO LOG LOGOFF SYSTAT and TRMDEF AMOS 32 only Added reference sheets for new commands MTUDI
370. emory modules have the same name and extension as their corresponding files on the disk Use MAP or DIR MEM to display modules in your memory partition FORMAT SAVE filename ext filename ext rename extension filename ext selects a module you want to save as a disk file DEFAULTS SAVE assumes a file extension of If you specify just a filename SAVE saves all memory modules of that name regardless of their extensions OPERATION Enter SAVE and the file s you want to save For example SAVE SYS LIT SAVE displays a list of the memory modules being saved as disk files These files are placed in the account into which you are currently logged If you ask SAVE to transfer a copy of a module to your account and a disk file of that name already exists SAVE erases the original disk file and replaces it with a copy of the memory module For example SAVE TLC ERASE TLC LIT SAVE TLC TIT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 SAVE Page 2 If you do not want SAVE to erase an existing file use the rename option Follow the list of filespecs with a slash and any extension you choose Before saving any memory modules SAVE will rename to the new extension any existing files with the same names as those memory modules For example assume you have a file in your account named EXIT SBR SAVE EXIT SBR OLD RENAME EXIT SBR SAVE EXIT SBR The
371. ence n by adding or replacing specified switch es Note two slashes File switch Do not enter a file specification when using the SEQ switch Start at specified page File switch Suspend file printing File switch Revives suspended file File switch Wait to print if queue is full Ties up terminal Operation switch Page width in characters 80 132 Used with H File switch To find out if any print requests are waiting in the printer queue System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 PRNT This command lists the contents of the queue for all of the printers defined on the system If you wish to see the contents for a single printer enter PRNT followed by the name of the printer whose queue you want to see and an equal sign For example PRNT DIABLO The display you see tells you what files are waiting to be printed their sequence number and priority what form type they are to be printed on which options have been selected for each how many blocks remain for each file how many copies of each file are to be printed and which file is currently being printed It also displays the total number of blocks in the queue If there are no print requests in the queue you will not see any files listed If you have more than one printer defined on your system you will see a message at the bottom of the screen telling you to press the Return key to continue When you do so the next printer s queue listing is displayed
372. enerate a symbol table file SYMLIT processes files in the order in which their specifications appear on the command line You may not specify an overlay or library file as the first file on the command line SYMLIT supports library and optional files For information on library optional and load map files see your Assembly Language Programmer s Manual This manual also contains information on SYMLIT M68 LNKLIT GLOBAL and LIB For information on AlphaFIX see your AlphaFIX User s Manual FORMAT SYMLIT switch filespec filespec switch The filespecs select the files you want to process and switch is an option request You may not specify an overlay or library file as the first filespec on the command line DEFAULTS SYMLIT uses the default extension of OBJ unless you are specifying a library file in which case it uses the default extension of LIB SYMLIT assumes the account and device you are logged into If it does not find the file there it looks in your project library account P 0 Finally it looks in the System Assembly Language account DSKO 7 7 OPTIONS B Doesn t force word alignment of OBJ modules E Includes equated symbols in symbol table file Use with M to put equated symbols in the load map file Operation switch System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 SYMLIT Page 2 L Designates a library file File switch M Generates a load map MAP file Operation switc
373. ent ways you can select a menu option The first way is to enter the number of the selection you want The six major options are numbers 10 to 60 Type the number of the selection you wish and press RETURN and the next level of menu appears or that function is performed The second way is to use the cursor control arrow keys to move the selection marker onto the function you wish to select press RETURN and the next level of menu appears or that function is performed MOVING THE SELECTION MARKER Use the cursor control arrow keys to move the position of the selection marker If your terminal doesn t have such keys you can move the selection marker by pressing and holding down while typing K up J down H left or L right The menus are set up so the selection marker wraps around the screen If you are at any edge of the menu screen and you press a key that would move the selection marker in a direction that is off the screen you will see the selection marker appear on the opposite side of the menu This features makes it easy to reach any place on the screen with just a few keystrokes With a little imagination you can find the quickest way to position the selection marker to any place on the menu GETTING HELP To see a display of helpful information place the selection marker on the function you want information on or type the number of it and type EXITING A MENU DISPLAY To go back to the previous menu p
374. er the current baud rate will be displayed OPERATION To find the current baud rate enter BAUD BAUD Current baud rate is 9600 To change the baud rate type BAUD followed by a legal baud rate For example BAUD 300 MESSAGES Baud rate baud rate is not a legal baud rate Try again with one of the baud rates listed above System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BDRES FUNCTION Copies one or more AMOS logical disks from a recordable DVD RAM or Blu ray media in a supported DVD RAM or Blu ray drive to AMOS logical disks The logical disk s being copied to must be the same bitmap word size as the AMOS logical disk if the entire logical is being copied without wild carding If wild carding is being used then any file on any logical can be copied to any AMOS logical with sufficient unused capacity o BDRES is only supported on AM 8000 Eagle 800 and AMPC 7 X systems CHARACTERISTICS BDRES copies logical AMOS disk s from a DVD RAM or Blu ray media to an AMOS disk drive The DVD RAM or Blu ray media AMOS disk and the AMOS disk being copied to must be the same bitmap word size if the entire logical is being copied without wild carding The BDRES software will copy logical drives of differing sizes if the logical is being copied with wild carding BDRES will not allow for differing bitmap size logicals to be copied without wild carding If an unequal bitmap word size is tried BDRES will ignore the request and continue with th
375. er in symbolic or numeric form If FIX finds a SYM file for the program you are debugging it attempta to display all values in symbolic form Either octal or hex form may be used for numeric values use the SET command in Command Mode to change the current radix For more information see your AlphaFIX User s Manual FORMAT FIX T termname filespec command line T termname displays the output from the program being debugged on termname filespec is the file you want to debug and command line is any input the program you want to debug would have The default file extension is LIT fr If you use T termname cannot be attached to a job OPERATION Enter FIX followed by the specification of the file you want to debug and any following command line text For example FIX REMOVE ACCT LIT FIX loads the file into your memory partition unless it is already there It also attempts to locate the corresponding SYM file and load it into memory FIX then enters Command Mode prints a status display and the registers It then prompts you with a right angle bracket gt You may now enter FIX commands or press to enter Display Mode In the case above FIX will debug the program REMOVE which is acting upon the file ACCT LIT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIX Page 2 To exit AlphaFIX go to Command Mode and enter Q FIX deletes all memory modules it created including the program you were debugging and returns you to comman
376. er name system but if you do not include it in the LOG command you are prompted for it If you use user name alone you are logged into your root account System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LOG Page 2 DEFAULTS If you leave out a device specification when you first log into the system LOG uses DSKO as a default If the account you have specified doesn t appear on DSKO LOG searches the rest of the units of that device If you are already logged in but leave out the device specification LOG uses as a default the device you are logged into if the account does not appear on that device LOG searches the rest of the units of that device beginning with device unit 0 If you use LOG when you are already logged into the system LOG uses the project or programmer number of the account you are logged into as the defaults OPTIONS IN Do not access the START CMD file when logging in to this account Operation switch OPERATION To log into the system enter LOG and an account specification and or user name For example LOG DSK1 47 2 LOG RANDOLPH LOG then searches for the account you specified In the first example above LOG looks on DSK1 for account 47 2 In the second example the user name causes LOG to log you into your root account When the account is entered LOG then looks to see if a password is required passwords are assigned by the System Operator for system security If an account password is needed you are p
377. erator s Guide for details OPERATION Log into the system Device Driver Library account and enter FIXFLP LOG DSKO 1 6 FIXFLP FIXFLP now asks questions to identify the type of diskette drive you have and the type of driver you want to create diskette size drive type diskette format single or double density and single or double sided Finally it asks you for the driver name Each driver must have a unique three letter name Then FIXFLP configures the driver and tells you the bitmap size This is the number of words you assign to the bitmap when you define the device in your system initialization file Write this number down For example here is how you could define a driver for a 3 5 diskette drive using double sided double density diskettes under AMOS System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIXFLP Page 2 FIXFLP Enter drive type A 8 inch B 5 1 4 inch C 3 1 2 inch Selection C Format A AMS or B DOS Selection A Density A Double or B High Selection A Enter new driver name DDA New driver is now in memory bitmap size is 180 Although the new driver is in memory it is not yet a file on the disk Save it to the disk by using the SAVE command For example SAVE DDA DVR If you are adding a new device to the system remember to modify your system initialization command file to change the system device table and bitmap areas See your System Operator s Guide MESSA
378. erify there is a problem by using REDALL to diagnose the disk and report any read errors Sentinel field error during disk copy drive n block x drive n and block x are octal or hexadecimal numbers The contents of a disk block have become unformatted Verify there is a problem by using REDALL to diagnose the disk and report any read errors Sorry output disk is write protected Write enable the disk and try again Undefined error during disk copy drive n block x drive n and block x are octal or hexadecimal numbers A hard error occurred which was not definable Verify there is a problem by using REDALL to diagnose the disk and report any read errors System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKCPY Page 4 Verification error at block nnn After DSKCPY copied the data in the specified disk block it was not able to verify the data on the output disk This means the data changed between the time it was read on the source disk and the time it was read on the output disk Try using DSKCPY again If you see this message frequently you may have hardware problems System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKDDT FUNCTION Allows you to examine and change data directly on the disk CHARACTERISTICS DSKDDT is re entrant and re usable The numbers you give to DSKDDT tell it which disk locations you want to examine DSKDDT should be used only by an experienced System Operator and with extreme caution A mistake could easily d
379. errupted will have a mixture of new and old blocks that will cause problems e Restoring DSKO System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 BITMAP FUNCTION Displays memory locations used by AMOS CHARACTERISTICS BITMAP is re entrant and re usable A bitmap is a storage allocation map that tells the system which disk records are free and which are in use The bitmap is originally set up in your system initialization command file using BITMAP statements See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for more information OPERATION Enter BITMAP BITMAP The display you see tells you what memory locations have been assigned to the disk bitmaps defined at the time of system initialization For example you might see something like this DSKO Bitmap DDB at 55349 buffer at 394938 paged bitmap 16665 words or DSKO Bitmap DDB at 430 buffer at 402 size of 810 words MINO No bitmap allocated Each line of the BITMAP display gives you the following information Devn Bitmap DDB at x buffer at y paged bitmap size x is the memory location of the bitmap DDB and y is the location of its buffer MESSAGES Cannot allocate bitmaps after system startup At AMOS level BITMAP has no specifications or options Try again entering only BITMAP RETURN System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CACHE FUNCTION Allows you to control the Disk Cache Buffer system and to find out informatio
380. es from SCSI streaming tape devices However it may significantly affect the performance of other jobs on the system especially if other jobs are accessing other SCSI devices Therefore on systems with many users you may want to use NOTAPESKIP Using the default TAPESKIP option can dramatically decrease the time needed to restore S MESSAGES Bypassing bad directory block MTURES did not find the directory block it expected The bad block is bypassed and MTURES continues to look for a directory block The current file may be corrupt Note the filename and check the file carefully after the restore process has completed This is most often caused by backing up a disk which has file errors on it use DSKANA before backing up Bypassing BADBLK SYS 1 2 BADBLK SYS 1 2 is a file holding device specific information and should not be transferred from one logical device to another The file will not be transferred to disk Bypassing unrequested account devn p pn The restore is skipping the account listed because you are not restoring any files from it System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MTURES Page 4 Cannot create PPN 377 377 it is not a valid PPN under AMOS 2 x You requested a transfer of files to PPN 377 377 which is not available under AMOS 2 x Device Full Make more room on the device by erasing unwanted files or select a different output device Drive is not on line and at load point Pl
381. es the form 00005700 071157 006555 Q66541lof this example The first number on the left ending with a colon is the memory address containing the first byte of data on the line In this example memory addresses 00005620 and 00005621 contain the two bytes of data 006562 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 DUMP Each group of six digits after the memory address represents two bytes 16 bits of data in octal form If the system is using hexadecimal for your numeric displays dump displays the data in groups of eight bits one byte On the far right of the display is a field showing the eight bit ASCII form of the data It displays the same data as the numbers in the center of the display but translated into their character representation Non printing characters such as Control characters appear as dots Bitmap Display The disk bitmap display consists of ones and zeros Each disk block is represented in the bitmap by a one if the block is in use or a zero if it is empty Each line of the display begins with a number which ends in a colon this octal or hex number is the number of the disk block represented by the first one or zero on that line At the end of the display is the total number of free blocks in decimal on the disk Since the format for dumping the bitmap is different than the format for dumping a disk block dumping the disk block containing the bitmap will appear to give different informatio
382. es the processing of the print requests until more queue blocks are available Output printer not found on remote system There was no active printer of the given name on the remote system you specified Choose another printer name Printer not found Check your spelling or enter PRINT at AMOS level to see what printers are defined on your system Remote printer chains to another remote printer The printer network is configured incorrectly The specified printer does not have a physical device associated with it Instead the remote system is trying to redirect the print request to another printer on another remote system This is invalid Contact your System Operator System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 5 PRINT Remote print spooler not responding Either the remote system or the spooler on the system cannot be contacted System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PRNT FUNCTION Sends files to a printer or edits the printer queue CHARACTERISTICS PRNT is re entrant re usable a wildcard command and recognizes ersatz names It prints files using the Task Manager print spooler The spooler places your request into a queue or waiting line When a printer becomes available the spooler prints your file You may have several requests in the printer queue waiting for available printers Use the SET command to define the type of form to be mounted on a specific printer on the system See the SET reference sh
383. es wildcards Wildcard File Command Switches Wildcard file commands distinguish between two types of switches file switches and operation switches If a file switch is directly after a file specification it affects only that file For example ERASE MTDVR M68 MTDVR LIT QUERY MTDVR OBJ tells ERASE to ask for confirmation before erasing MTDVR LIT It erases the other two files without asking for confirmation An operation switch affects all files on the command line no matter where it is placed For example the WIDE option with the DIR command affects the directory display for all specified files no matter where it appears on the command line Wildcard file commands allow you to set the default switch by placing the switch in front of a file specification For example ERASE Q MTDVR MTDVR OBJ NOQ SRCFIL BAS tells ERASE to ask for confirmation before erasing the first and third files specified on the command line See your AMOS User s Guide for more information on wildcard file command switches and default switches CONVENTIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL This manual conforms to the other Alpha Micro publications in its use of a standard set of graphics conventions We hope these graphics simplify our examples and make them easier for you to use Unless stated otherwise all examples of commands are assumed to be entered at AMOS command level System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 1 4 SYMBOL devn filespec
384. essage Code nn nn DVD RAM drive device error has occurred Code provides additional SCSI error sense information Warning Maximum number of devices exceeded extras ignored Warning Unable to close DVD Device error occurred while closing the current DVD The DVD RAM may or may not be usable Errors concerning the AMOS DVD data structure Error Disk geometry calculation was incorrect The AMOS hidden sector parameters calculated are invalid Error memory previously calculated as available isn t Memory required for data buffers has increased bump your memory partition Error No devices specified User did not specify any AMOS logical disks to be copied to the CD Error unable to get AMOS data buffer The system was unable to acquire memory for data buffers Error Unable to remove DVD Recorder data buffer from memory Unable to continue due to one or more errors shown above Testing of logical disk drive transfer rates resulted in the errors listed above Normal informational messages AlphaDBD creation complete The recording of data on the DVD media is done Calculating space requirements AMOS partition requires 16165 sectors Media sectors available 2236703 2220538 unused sectors remain This shows information about how much space the data consumes on the DVD and how much empty space remains DVD RAM Recorder located at SCSI id n This shows the SCSI id of the DVD RAM Drive being used Note that once started the recor
385. estroy your disk s file structure You must be logged into an operator s account 1 2 to run DSKDDT You cannot use DSKDDT across a network you can use it only on local disks The block number for DSKDDT must be in the current numeric display base usually octal The replacement data must be in octal regardless of the current display base See the SET reference sheet for information on setting the display base FORMAT DSKDDT devn block devn is the device containing the block you want to see and block is the number of the disk block you want to examine and change The devn defaults to the disk you are logged into OPERATION Be sure you are logged into 1 2 and enter DSKDDT followed by an optional device specification and a block number For example DSKDDT DSK1 202 DSKDDT reads the block lists any errors it finds and is then ready for you to modify the block Use the DSKDDT commands listed below DSKDDT displays two bytes of data at a time To see the first two bytes of the block type a slash To see the next two bytes press WJ or LINE FEED For example 0 00452 2 44510 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKDDT Page 2 The number on the left of the slash is the RELATIVE disk location within the block you want to examine the first byte is offset zero not one If you are examining block 202 the display above tells you the first two bytes in block 202 are 00452 and the second two bytes are 44510
386. etailed instructions on using FMTSCZ see Installation Instructions SCSI Disk Drives PDI 00436 21 MESSAGES Could not list defects Possible incompatibility Press RETURN See your System Operator or contact your Alpha Micro representative for help Defect is in the wrong format Re enter The defect you entered is not in the proper format for the drive on your system Re enter a valid number Drive would not select Make sure the drive is working and properly defined See your System Operator for help Error on drive n sense key n sense code n See your System Operator s Guide for a list of the error codes Incompatible format of defect file The file you entered contained the wrong type of defect data Use VUE to check your file Option 3 will show you how the format should appear Insufficient memory to run FMTSCZ LIT FMTSCZ could not allocate enough memory to execute Try deleting unnecessary memory modules or see about increasing memory Number of logicals is zero Try again and enter a valid number of logical devices System Commands Reference Manual Rev 05 Page 3 FMTSCZ There are no drives available Use the SELECT DRIVES option or abort Select option 1 or 5 Warning Drive displayed is the system disk This message reminds you the selected drive is your system disk Be certain you have both a complete backup media and a bootable backup media System Commands Reference Manual Rev 05 FMTS2
387. evices are defined on your system and whether they are sharable or not You may need this information during the WRMGEN process If you have a self configuring disk use the BITMAP command and write down the size in words of your bitmap Enter WRMGEN at AMOS command level Enter a filename if you want your warm boot file to be called something other than the default For example WRMGEN WRMGEN BACKUP WRM Now the program asks you to specify how you want the warm boot monitor to be initialized First it will ask for the Input monitor Enter the name of your system monitor file You must enter at least the file name such as AMOSL The rest of the filespec defaults to DSKO filename MON 1 4 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 09 WRMGEN Page 2 Next WRMGEN asks for the System disk driver You must enter at least the file name such as SCZRR or SCZR60 The rest of the filespec defaults to DSKO Filename DVR 1 6 The filespec must be three characters and cannot be DSK Depending on your system type use the following guidelines to specify the disk driver filename to use System Type Disk Driver SCSI Dispatcher Filename Older Systems with SASI Interface and no SCZDVR DVR None enter RETURN Roadrunner board AM 1000 1200 1400 1600 1500VME 2000M V ME 3000M VME 172 or AM 174 boards 540 SCSI controller Eagle 100 200 300 500 550 SCZRR DVR SIMRR SYS AM 6000 or AM 6060 SCZR60 DVR SIMR60 SYS Eagle 450 SCZ1
388. executed The line must start with a TAB character to be considered a command line It must follow either a rule or dependency line or another command line Macros can be invoked and a special marker n can be used to force a carriage return line feed pair to be inserted at a given point In addition in a command line related to arule the following macros can be used represents the name of the target without the extension represents the full name of the target lt represents the name of the source file If you want to continue any logical line onto the next line of the file end the line with a backslash followed by a newline If the following line starts with a non blank character it will be appended to the line with no intervening spaces If the next line starts with one or more blanks it will be appended with a single intervening space You may also put comments any place in the makefile A comment begins with the pound character and continues to the end of the line System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MK Page 4 Here is a complete example of a makefile Description file for the make command SEOD cc d r m68 obj m68 n mk lit lt tdvcng obj fdtser obj allocbh obj parse obj proces obj mk obj inklit s mk fdtser allochb parse proces tdvcng cinit syslb0 1 parse obj lt parse c mkdefs h mac memory h mac stdio h cc parse d r proces obj lt mk c mac stdio h mac memory h
389. f files DIRSEQ can sequence in a single PPN is proportional to your job s memory If an account has a large number of files in it it may not sequence if you have a small memory partition DIRSEQ displays how many files can be sequenced DIRSEQ needs more memory to sequence files on extended directory logical devices than w on conventional disks The A switch also requires more memory When you use A on a standard logical you can sequence only about half as many files per PPN in a given memory partition as when you don t use it When you use A on an extended directory you can sequence only about 80 as many files FORMAT DIRSEQ devn p pn switch devn specifies the logical unit containing the directories you want to arrange p pn is the account and switch is an option OPTIONS A Use ASCII sort order numbers sort before letters E Sort file names by extension then name IN Don t delete unused directory blocks DEFAULTS DIRSEQ assumes the device and account you are logged into and RADSO sort order System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 DIRSEQ Page 2 OPERATION Enter DIRSEQ with specifications and options if needed For example DIRSEQ DIRSEQ displays your current memory and how many files it can sequence then it orders the entries in the directory for the account Use DIR to see a display of your alphabetically ordered account directory If you are in an operator s account 1 2 you can se
390. f the records in the file This usually means your index file is damaged You might see this message if you are dumping the file and you press CTRL C before the task was finished Overlap keys must be alphanumeric type You can t define any byte in a record as both binary and alphanumeric You may define any byte as alphanumeric and concatenated since a concatenated key is an alphanumeric key which is formed by combining alphanumeric fields into one key System error This message indicates a serious error Contact your Alpha Micro dealer with information on the conditions under which the error occurred This secondary key has been deleted This message also appears when you re trying to obtain statistical information about a deleted directory Too many concatenated fields The number of repetitions for a concatenated key may not exceed 16 Check your program key definitions Too many data file blocks Your IDA file contains more than 2 32 logical records Too many index blocks Your index file has more than 2 32 blocks Warning free index blocks is less than minimum requirement Use the ADDIDX command to add more index blocks or delete some records You won t be allowed to add more records until you create more space System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 ISOCD FUNCTION Allows access to the files on ISO 9660 CDs Files may be typed or copied to AMOS sequential or random access files CHARA
391. f the above devices Additional information about the DVD RAM drive driver and media is then displayed Using Generic SCSI DVD RAM driver DVDRAM DVD RAM Recorder located at SCSI id 3 MAKDVD then asks for an optional title for the DVD The title may be up to 60 characters long You may enter an optional title for the DVD or press RETURN for none Title Next MAKDVD asks for the AMOS logical drives to copy to the DVD as follows Enter the list of disk devices to transfer onto the DVD media Devices may be entered as a range ex dev0 20 for dev0 through dev20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line Enter the logical drives to be copied and then just a return when all desired drives have been entered DSKO DSK6 DSKO 64660 blocks DSK6 64660 blocks MAKDVD then displays information about how much space is required on the CD and where recording will start Calculating space requirements AMOS partition requires 16165 sectors 2220538 unused sectors remain MAKDVD then gives you the opportunity to abort or to start the recording process System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 MAKDVD Page 4 Note that once started the recording operation can be stopped by pressing C Press RETURN to start recording or C to abort The recording process then begins As it progresses status messages are displayed Transferring DSKO Transferring D
392. fied size will not fit into available memory Your system memory size is too large Reduce it and try again 2SMEM you must be logged into PPN 1 2 to remove shared memory Log into 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SORT FUNCTION Alphabetically and numerically sorts data records in a sequential text file CHARACTERISTICS SORT is re entrant and re usable Sorts logical records in ascending or descending order Sorts only sequential files will not sort Random files SORT replaces the file you specify with another file of the same name in which the data are arranged in the proper order SORT uses the precedence in whatever language table is set for your job i e for American English the ASCII values If you are sorting ASCII text in ascending order all data that begin with upper case letters come before those with lower case If you are sorting in descending order all data records that begin with lower case letters come before those with upper case You may sort a text file too large to fit into memory all at one time SORT does not understand wildcard symbols SORT can handle a maximum record size of 510 bytes The file cannot contain a null S byte FORMAT SORT filespec filespec is the file you want to sort SORT assumes an extension of DAT and the account and device you re logged into OPERATION Enter SORT and the specification of the file you want to sort For example SORT LABELS DAT SORT
393. file to make sure that the software copied correctly to your system The directory programs are created using the DIR command with the D V and H switches FORMAT VERIFY switch filespec filespec is the file specification for the Master Directory Listing and switch is an option request DEFAULTS VERIFY assumes the device and account you are currently logged into The default filespec is DSKO AMOS DIR _ 1 4 OPTIONS FILE or F Puts results in a file named VERIFY LST in the account you are in D devn Override device specification in the DIR file with the device name entered OPERATION Enter VERIFY add a filespec if other than AMOS DIR or if the file is in another account For example VERIFY NEWREL DIR System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 VERIFY Page 2 You see a display of the files listed in NEWREL DIR and a status message for each When VERIFY has finished it displays a summary of the errors found If the files you want to verify are on a logical device other than the one specified in the DIR file use the D switch For example VERIFY D DSK2 NEWREL DIR The files listed in NEWREL DIR are looked for and verified on DSK2 regardless of the device specified in NEWREL DIR MESSAGES filespec not found The indicated file was listed in the Master Directory Listing but was not found on your system It might have been erased or renamed or might not have been copied at all Try copying
394. first symbol following REDIR on the line Quotes the character following it so it is not interpreted as a command The default extensions are INP for input files and LST for output files USING REDIRECTION To use redirection enter the AMOS command followed by the redirection symbol and the redirection command For example SYSTAT N gt OUT LST The above command places the output of SYSTAT into the file OUT LST Another example VUE INPUT TST lt VUECMD INP The above command takes the contents of VUECMD INP and uses it as input to the VUE program You can also combine the kinds of redirection For example VUE INPUT TST lt VUECMD INP gt OUT LST System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 5 2 Chapter Five If you are redirecting input from a file and the end of the file is reached the input source reverts to the keyboard TVO redirection can both execute DO files and be used within CMD or DO files Because input redirection works regardless of terminal input mode redirection works where DO files won t for example connecting across a network running VUE etc I O direction uses process spawning This means you must have extra jobs available on your system allocated in a JOBS statement in your system initialization command file Redirection reduces the size of your memory partition by about 8K while it is being used Some programs such as AlphaWRITE use terminal features that require responses back from a real te
395. for TAPLOG so this message reminds you how to enter the command correctly System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TDVDEF FUNCTION Displays the currently available terminal drivers CHARACTERISTICS TDVDEF is re entrant and re usable Also used in the system initialization command file to define alternate terminal drivers to your system See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for information You can switch your terminal to use a different terminal driver by using the SET TERMINAL DRIVER command see the SET reference sheet OPERATION Enter TDVDEF and AMOS will display the currently available terminal drivers defined on your system For example TDVDEF Currently defined Terminal Drivers ALPHA AM60 TV171 GRAF MESSAGES Cannot define terminal drivers after system startup Enter only TDVDEF and press RETURN You can t define terminal drivers at command level only in your system INI file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 TIME FUNCTION Displays or sets the system time of day CHARACTERISTICS TIME is re entrant and re usable You must be logged into an operator s account 1 2 to set the time Allows you to use military 24 hour format when you set the time Some clock calendar chips in early AMOS systems do not allow the seconds to be set This is a limitation of the chip not of AMOS FORMAT TIME HH MM AM PM H
396. fully ISO 8859 1 compliant THE ISO 8859 FAMILY OF STANDARDS AND AMOS The ISO 8859 x character sets are designed for maximum interoperability and portability All of them are a superset of US ASCII and will render English text properly The code points OxAO through OxFF are used to represent national characters while the characters in the range 0x20 through 0x7F are the same as in the ISO 646 US ASCII character set Thus ASCII text is a subset of all ISO 8859 character sets and will be rendered properly by them The code points 0x80 through Ox9F are earmarked as extended control characters and are not used for encoding characters The ISO 8859 family of standards consists of 8859 1 For Europe Latin America the Caribbean Canada and Africa 8859 2 For Eastern Europe 8859 3 For SE Europe and a miscellany of alphabets such as Esperanto and Maltese 8859 4 For Scandinavia and the Baltic states mostly covered by 8859 1 also 8859 5 For languages using the Cyrillic alphabet 8859 6 For languages using Arabic 8859 7 For modern Greek System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 2 Appendix A 8859 8 8859 9 8859 10 For Hebrew Known as Latin 5 The same as 8859 1 except for Turkish instead of Icelandic characters Known as Latin 6 for Lappish Nordic and Eskimo languages ISO 8859 1 also known as ISO Latin 1 has the required characters to display most Western European languages It supports Afrikaans Basque Catalan
397. fy a DEVTBL command line See your System Operator s Guide for details OPERATION Log into the system Device Driver Library account and enter FIX219 LOG DSKO 1 6 FIX219 FIX219 now asks what type of driver you want to create and the name you want to give the driver program It then configures the driver and tells you the bitmap size This is the number of words you assign to the bitmap when you define the device in your system initialization file Write this number down For example FIX219 RETURN Enter desired driver format A PC 1 44Mb 3 1 2 PC 720Kb 3 1 2 PC 1 2Kb 5 1 4 PC 360Kb 5 1 4 AMOS 720Kb 3 1 2 AMOS 800Kb 5 1 4 AMOS 1 2Mb 5 1 4 AMOS 1 44Mb 3 1 2 B C D E F G H Selection F RETURN Enter new driver name MIN RETURN New driver is now in memory Bitmap size is 100 words System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIX219 Page 2 This creates a driver for AMOS formatted 5 25 diskettes with 800KB capacity Although the new driver is in memory it is not yet a file on the disk Save it to the disk by using the SAVE command For example SAVE MIN DVR If you are adding a new device to the system remember to modify your system initialization command file to change the system device table and bitmap areas See your System Operator s Guide MESSAGES Cannot load DSK0 219DVR DVR 1 6 The file 219DVR DVR was not found in DSK
398. g enough Either use a tape with a longer recording time or set your VCR to a faster recording rate Remote control error Your VCR or the software had a problem with the remote control Try again if the problem persists check your VCR or contact your Alpha Micro representative for help Tape control error Your VCR or the software had a problem with the remote control Try again if the problem persists check your VCR or contact your Alpha Micro representative for help The VERIFY switch must be specified along with the CALIBRATE switch Re enter the command line using both V and CA VCR cannot be remotely controlled Your VCR is not remote controllable you can t calibrate a tape for it VCR failed to respond to command Try again if the problem persists check your VCR or contact your Alpha Micro representative Warm boot monitor file has zero blocks Not used The warm boot file you specified had a zero block size this is not allowed Warning Possible equipment media problems This message appears if the Reliability Ratio of your tape is less than 100 1 It indicates either your cassette is bad or your VCR has a problem Possible causes might be worn out tape dirty recording heads on the VCR or improper cabling to the VCR If you determine you have no equipment problems the tape is probably bad Copy off all the files and discard it You must be logged into 1 2 to calibrate VCR Log into 1 2 and try again
399. g verification MTUSAV either encountered an error trying to open a disk file or the contents of the disk file did not match the file on the tape If no other errors were reported and no other job was active between the backup and the verification then the backup did not correctly save the data in this file More likely is that another message will indicate the cause for the verification error for example there was another job writing to the file as it was being saved The file list will be incomplete if there was an earlier error in the MTUSAV TOC file nn errors during a directory scan for devn p pn There was a disk device error while MTUSAV was searching for files in the AMOS disk directory structure This aborts the MTUSAV The backup is incomplete not all the files are transferred to tape If this occurs in the backup phase verification is not attempted Check the tape carefully to see if it can be used to restore those files saved to tape prior to the disk error nn errors while opening a file nn files reported an error when MTUSAV tried to open them for reading A list of files causing the errors follows this message Listed sequential files were not transferred to the tape and do not generate a verification error Listed contiguous random files are transferred if the error is File in Use MTUSAV backs up the file block by block without regard for record locking Therefore the data integrity of the tape file is in question If
400. ges between backup and verification it indicates someone has edited or deleted and recreated the file In this case even if the file size has changed or the data on the disk doesn t match the data on the tape the incident is reported as a Verif dir date changed note rather than a size or data mismatch either of which has a default value of warning AE You can change the severity of all three incidents involved dir date changed size W mismatch and data mismatch in MTUSAV OPT The directory date mismatch severity is used only if it is less than the other incident encountered System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 21 MTUSAV Reduction File is Known to MTUSAV If a file is listed in MTUSAV INF the incidents listed in Omitting Files from Error Checking the MTUSAV INF File are reported with the severity defined for known files in MTUSAV OPT as long as this is less than the severity they would otherwise have For more details on known files and MTUSAV_INF see page 15 MESSAGES A date or a time must be specified for all date and time switches You specified a BEFORE or AFTER switch without also specifying both a date and time All date and time switches must be in absolute format The BEFORE or AFTER switch must include a date and time in absolute format not a relative format You aborted the updating of the disk directory entries for each file backed up Each disk which has an e
401. gged into as default file specifications The default extension is null an extension zero characters long OPTIONS The switches are file switches and may be abbreviated QUERY Confirm the erase NOQUERY Don t confirm the erase OPERATION Enter ERASE and the files you want to erase For example ERASE ACCNT BAK ACCNT BAK Total of 1 files deleted 45 disk blocks freed System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 ERASE Page 2 If you use Q ERASE asks you to confirm each deletion ERASE BAK QUERY MATH BAK Y TRIG BAK N You don t need to press after typing Y or N You may press CTRLIC at any time to stop erasing files The second format lets you erase a file only if some other file is present For example you want to delete backup BAK files but only if the corresponding M68 file exists You can use this command ERASE BAK M68 ERASE finds each M68 file in turn checks to see if there is a matching BAK file and erases it if it finds it MESSAGES Account does not exist p pn Check your typing or use PPN to list the accounts on your disk Bypassing BADBLK SYS 1 2 BADBLK SYS exists to prevent bad blocks on a device from being allocated and should never be directly accessed No files transferred You cannot erase the BADBLK SYS file Cannot find DSKO CMDLIN SYS 1 4 ERASE needs this file to be able to process wildcard symbols Check to see if CMDLIN SYS exists in DSK
402. gh it may not appear on the directory listing you requested MESSAGES Cannot find DSKO SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS STRDIR needs this file to process wildcard symbols Make sure SCNWLD SYS is in DSKO 1 2 and you have enough memory to load it in your partition Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see what devices are listed on your system and try again Cannot READ device name device is not mounted MOUNT the device and try again More than one output specification Try again using only one listfilespec 2No file oriented device corresponding to device name is mounted Check your syntax or MOUNT the device and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 Page 3 STRDIR No such files STRDIR was unable to find any files matching your input specification Try using STRDIR ALL to see all files listed on the tape Tape is not file structured STRDIR can only read tapes written by STRSAV Make sure you loaded the correct tape cartridge System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 STRRES FUNCTION Writes files from a 1 4 Streaming Tape Drive cartridge to disk Allows you to restore file oriented disk backup from tape cartridge to disk The STRxxx commands are included only for compatibility with earlier operating system versions Do NOT use these commands unless absolutely necessary Use the MTUxxx commands for all tape backup and CRT62
403. h IN Suppresses the S switch Operation switch 0 Designates an optional file File switch P Generates a program LIT or OVR file Operation R Designates a required file Cancels L and O Default file switch IS Generates a symbol table SYM file Default operation switch U Doesn t automatically include SYSLIB LIB in linkage IX Allows maximum DSECT area of 64K rather than 32K default by allowing full 16 bit signed offsets OPERATION Enter SYMLIT and the files you want to process For example SYMLIT M VISFIL VIS1 UTILIT L The command line above specifies a library file UTILIT LIB L By using M a load map file is also created If you have more file specifications than will fit on one line end the current command line with a comma SYMLIT then displays an asterisk and you may continue your list of file specifications SYMLIT displays several messages as it processes the files The exact messages you see depend on the options requested and files specified MESSAGES Attempt to directly reference a DSECT symbol Index through a base register when referencing a symbol defined in a data section Command error Check your syntax and try again Fatal error At most one DSIZE may appear in an overlay Check the instructions for use of the DSIZE pseudo opcode and try again specify overlay overlay as optional Overlays may not be optional Try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2
404. hat user and send mail to the intended Internet mail user Log to the SYS account then create a test copy of your initialization file COPY TEST INI AMOS32 IN Then VUE the test file Add one to the number of jobs in the JOBS statement Add a JOBALC statement defining a job called RADMON Add a TRMDEF statement for a pseudo terminal called RADMON For example TRMDEF RADMON PSEUDO NULL 80 80 80 Add a SETJOB command to attach the RADMON job to the RADMON pseudo terminal SETJOB RADMON RADMON 70K RADMON JIN If you want RADMON to send e mail notification make sure the e mail driver program is loaded into memory somewhere before the first SYSTEM statement This statement must also be before the SETJOB statement for the RADMON job Finish from the test initialization file In SYS create a file called RADMON JIN containing these statements iT LOG user name RADMON ID id EMAIL address address option s user name is the RADMON name you set up in step 2 If you aren t using e mail notification it can be any user name id is the SCSI ID of the RAID controller If you don t include the SCSI ID RADMON will poll the SCSI bus until it finds the controller Each optional address is an e mail address you want RADMON to send notification messages to Each one must be in standard Internet address format person system Make sure no one else is using th
405. he DVD RAM may or may not be usable SCSI error message from the driver DVD RAM drive device error has occurred Code provides additional SCSI error sense information SCSI error SCSI status nn sense key xx sssssssssssssss Add Sense Code Qualifier Code ac qc nn SCSI Status Code XX SCSI Sense Key code ssss Interpreted sense key code if known ac SCSI Additional Sense Code qc SCSI Qualifier Code Errors concerning the AMOS DVD RAM or BD RE data structure Error Disk geometry calculation was incorrect The AMOS hidden sector parameters calculated are invalid Error memory previously calculated as available isn t Memory required for data buffers has increased Error Unable to calculate AMOS disk geometry The AMOS hidden sector parameters could not be calculated Error unable to get AMOS data buffer The system was unable to acquire memory for data buffers Error Unable to remove DVD Recorder data buffer from memory System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 13 BDRES Normal informational messages e The program has completed The recording of data from the DVD media is done e DVD RAM Recorder located at SCSI id n This shows the SCSI id of the DVD RAM Drive being used e Note that once started the restoring operation can be stopped by pressing C However if the restoring is stopped a DSKANA or SYSACT to the last logical that was interrupted needs to be performed The last logical that was int
406. he Table of Contents will normally be recorded and the newly recorded data can then be used with the ACD program If you record data on a previously recorded CD ACD will use the newly recorded information and ignore all data that was previously placed on the CD MAKACD uses the available user memory for data buffers in order to continue supplying data to the CD recorder while other system or multi user activity occurs Excessive system or multi user activity can still interfere with the steady flow of data to the CD recorder causing fatal recording errors FORMAT MAKACD switches System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 HELP n IV COUNT n DEV xxx EJECT ERASE ALL ERASE QUICK ERASE SESSION AID n NOEJECT NOFILL NOTOC PIC SPEED n Page 2 Display the available options and exits Same as HELP Display version information and exits Creates n CDs containing the same data Uses device and driver named xxx instead of the default CDR Ejects the CD in the recorder and exits Erases the entire rewritable CD by overwriting all data areas on the CD Erases the rewritable CD by clearing only the control information without actually overwriting the data areas of the CD This causes the CD to react like a blank CD when read or written Do not use this switch if the rewritable CD contains more than one session Erases the last session from a multi session rewritable CD by overwriting all data ar
407. he correct save set Tape is out of sequence please mount the correct tape Current reel is mm reel nn is required You ve mounted the wrong tape it is from the current save set but is the wrong reel number Replace it with the correct tape The version of TAPSER LIT you are using usually held in SYS does not support driver interrogation for tape spanning features Tape spanning is not allowed even if the tape device supports it If tape spanning is not required on this backup the backup will TAPSER LIT is out of date You must use version 3 0 126 or later proceed normally Update your software to the latest version Transfer was aborted with errors The backup was aborted due to a tape or disk directory search error The backup is incomplete with one or more selected files not on tape The tape may not be restorable as the end of transfer protocol may not have been written The tape needs careful inspection to determine its usefulness Transfer was completed without DIR OPEN READ or LOCK errors The specified files were transferred to tape without any directory search file in use device bum block count or record in use errors Errors could still be found during verification if one was requested Transfer was completed with errors One or more errors were encountered in transferring the specified files to tape The backup completed but one or more files were not correctly backed up A list of the errors follows this mes
408. he percentage complete shows how much of the current logical s used blocks has been written to the DVD RAM or Blu ray media When all data has been written to the DVD RAM the following message is shown AlphaDBD creation complete And then the DVD RAM or BD RE is ready to use REQUIREMENTS AND SETUP DBD requires the following AM 8000 Eagle 800 or AMPC 7 x system A fully interrupt enabled SCSI dispatcher AMOS 8 1 102 2 or later A supported DVD RAM or Blu ray drive The DBD package contains the following required files e DBD LIT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 5 MAKBD The device driver DBD DVR for the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive in system memory The SSD overlay file DVD000 OVR MAKBD LIT DIRBD LIT BDRES LIT MODIFYING THE SYSTEM INITIALIZATION FILE You must load the device driver into system memory during system initialization by adding the following statement in your system initialization file SYSTEM DSKO DBD DVR 1 6 This statement should be added in the same area of the system initialization file that is currently loading other system device drivers MESSAGES Command line syntax messages e Invalid switch e Invalid switch option System requirements messages e If your memory partition is too small for MAKBD the following message will display Error Memory requirements have not been met CODE N Minimum memory to run MAKBD LIT is 430 KB 449 320 bytes DVD
409. he tape is full switch is one of the options listed below DEFAULTS The default switch is BOOT The default filespec is your system warm boot monitor for example DSK0 AMOS32 WRM 1 4 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CRT620 Page 2 OPTIONS All switches are operation switches and may be abbreviated BOOT Creates a warm boot cartridge Default CHECK Reads cartridge and displays status ERASE Erases all data and re tensions cartridge FILE Used only with VERIFY Writes the verification statistics to a file in addition to displaying them The file is called xxxSTS LIT xxx is the name of the tape device GRAPH Used only with VERIFY Creates an AMIGOS graph file showing the relationship between soft errors and tape position The graph is displayed and written to a file called xxxSTS GDF where xxx is the name of the tape device You cannot use GRAPH with an MTUx device TENSION Re tensions tape by spinning it start to finish and back at high speed VERIFY Writes data to tape reads it back and displays status Destroys all data on the tape OPERATION HOW TO CREATE A WARM BOOT TAPE B Create a warm boot monitor file using WRMGEN Load a blank tape in your streamer drive and enter CRT620 and the optional file specification of the warm boot monitor Since B is the default you don t have to specify it For example CRT620 SPECAL WRM If you enter just a file name and extension as above CRT620 lo
410. he various cursor movement and screen to screen movement commands to move the cursor to the point in your text where you want to make changes Then use the appropriate screen editing commands to effect those changes To transfer from Screen mode to Command mode or from Command mode to Screen mode press or press CTRL In Command mode you see several lines of information on the screen The cursor is waiting after the AlphaVUE prompt symbol gt If HELP is ON in the INI VUE file and if the file MENU HLV exists either in account DSKO 7 1 or in the account you are currently logged into following the display shown above you System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 VUE will see a summary of the AlphaVUE editing commands You may now use the various Command mode commands MESSAGES The AlphaVUE error messages are explained in your AlphaVUE Text Editor User s Guide System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 WAIT FUNCTION Allows you to delay the execution of any programs by your job until another job completes a task CHARACTERISTICS WAIT is re entrant and re usable Sometimes a task you want to do must be done AFTER another task is finished If another job is performing the task you have to wait for you can use WAIT to let you know when that other job is finished with what it is doing A job s task is said to be completed when that job enters one of the following states
411. heck the appropriate entry and correct it Can t find device handler in DEVTBL See your Alpha Micro dealer for help Device specified is not a supported backup device Check your entry for errors Make sure you used a colon after the device name End of media detected While reading the directory from a streaming tape BAKDIR reached an end of tape marker This normally indicates a problem with the streaming tape Fatal error aborting device handler task This is an informative message that occurs after some other fatal error and indicates the device handling task is also aborting System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BAKDIR Page 4 Fatal error illegal message code n received from device handler The main task received an error from the device handler it did not understand Try again if the problem persists see your Alpha Micro dealer for help Fatal error ITC error code n See your Monitor Calls Manual for an explanation of the error code This indicates an internal communication error ask your System Operator or Alpha Micro dealer for help if this occurs frequently List file already exists This message appears if you used the NOK switch and the specified listspec already exists Erase the listspec or use another listspec No supported backup devices found Your system is not set up for any of the supported backup devices so you can t specify a default device TOC file not found This may m
412. his switch locked blocks for the device will not be restored into the cache if there is not enough memory to do so May be used with other switches IC Checks for errors without rewriting the bitmap open files won t corrupt the file structure Don t use if other users are ACTIVELY using the disk you may get false blocks marked in use errors through the file structure won t be damaged Good for automated overnight file backups where users might have left files open Can be used with E and L to select the type of display E Lists only account numbers and disk blocks where errors occur L Displays full list of all accounts account directories and files plus disk addresses of blocks they occupy Displays error messages as they occur M Checks if device is mounted If not displays error message and bypasses device OPERATION Enter DSKANA followed by the specification of the device whose contents you want to analyze and any optional switches For example DSKANA DSK3 You see nothing for some moments until DSKANA finishes reading the disk except the numbers of the accounts as DSKANA progresses through the disk accounts When DSKANA finishes reading the disk it displays information about the disk analysis see MESSAGES below Every time the system updates the bitmap it computes a hash total and compares it with the previously stored value This allows you to verify the bitmap was correct since DSKANA also comp
413. ical devices Make sure the warm boot tape contains VUE LIT DSKANA LIT the command to let you restore from your backup tape MTURES LIT RESTOR LIT etc and other useful programs Warm boot using the new warm boot tape Run the SYSACT program using the I initialize option on all of the disks on which you are changing the number of logical devices Run the DSKANA program If everything is correct run the SYSTAT command If no Bitmap kaput error appears for DSKO then continue System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 FIXLOG 10 If the disk you re changing is a SCSI drive skip this step If not type the BADBLK command followed by the device name Select the L option to list the bad blocks on the disk Select the H option to see a list of other possible selections Every disk has a certain number of bad blocks which are quite acceptable as long as they re listed in the bad block file so the system can work around them An error message tells you if there are any problems If no error messages appear you know the logical devices have been successfully changed If you have problems contact your Alpha Micro dealer or the Alpha Micro Technical Assistance Center for help 11 Now use MTURES or RESTOR to load all the information back onto the disk you changed 12 Reboot your system If you have any problems with your system initialization command file that do not allow your system to boot perform the warm boot again
414. ice and U For example MOUNT ARC4 U If you want to sequence down a Winchester disk use the U option as above using this option sequences down the entire physical disk uv Remember to unmount the physical unit containing DSKO LAST To display a list of the disks mounted on the system enter MOUNT MOUNT displays the Volume Name and Volume ID of each disk containing a label For information on labeling a disk see the LABEL reference sheet System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 MOUNT MESSAGES Buffered Writes Enabled Failure to unmount disk before removing will result in lost data Reminder to unmount the disk when you re done Command Error The command line you entered is invalid Try again using the correct format Device not ready Try again when the device is fully cycled up If you wish MOUNT to wait until the device is ready use W Drive sequence error The device you tried to mount did not sequence up properly See your System Operator this could indicate a problem with the disk Error removing DDB buffer An internal error occurred Try the command again If the error persists inform your System Operator 2No buffer pool allocated for specified device Buffered writes not enabled You tried to mount with B but the device is not set up for buffered writes Remount without B No disk currently mounted Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system No
415. ice Driver Library account and enter FIX210 LOG DSKO 1 6 FIX210 FIX210 now asks you questions to identify the type of floppy drive you have CDC 8 drives have an LED indicator light in the middle of the door latch Qume 8 drives have an LED indicator light on the front upper left hand corner of the drive Then it asks you if you want to use double density disks enter Y for Yes or N for No FIX210 then asks you to select the type of format you want the driver to use You may not specify the AMS format if it is for an 8 inch floppy using single density format FIX210 asks if you are using double sided disks Answer Y or N Finally FIX210 asks you to enter the new driver name Each driver must have a unique three character name System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIX210 Page 2 Now FIX210 configures the driver and tells you the bitmap size This is the number of words you assign to the bitmap when you define the device in your system initialization file Write this number down Although the new driver is in memory it is not yet a file on the disk Save it to the disk by using the SAVE command For example SAVE DDS DVR RETURN If you are adding a new device to the system remember to modify your system initialization command file to change the system device table and bitmap areas See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File MESSAGES AM 210 does not support single density AMS for
416. if both a C OBJ rule and a M68 OBJ rule exist they should be defined in that order for the C file to be compiled otherwise the M68 file would be considered as the source of the target If the M68 OBJ rule is defined first a new OBJ file is created if the M68 file is compiled and therefore the C program won t be compiled Here s an example of a rule m68 0bj m68 n System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 MK This specifies that for any OBJ module not defined as a target file in a dependency line an attempt is made to rebuild it using M68 with the N switch is a special macro that indicates the filename without the extension A dependency line describes what files trigger the re creation of the target file if they are modified The format is target lt filename s target is the name of the file that should be made and the filename s is a list of file the target depends on If any of the filenames is more recent than the target the commands that should follow the dependency line are executed and their result should be to produce a new target file Target can also have a name starting with a period In that case it is considered as a pseudo target a file that does not actually exist Also the list of dependents should be empty in this case The use of pseudo targets is handy to do special functions like erasing temporary files or printing sources files A command line gives an AMOS command to be
417. ile You may also adjust the line count prior to the display CHARACTERISTICS LINCNT is re entrant and re usable LINCNT considers a line to be terminated by a line feed character whether or not a corresponding carriage return character accompanies it LINCNT is designed to work with text files Using it on binary data files will not yield useful results FORMAT LINCNT filespec adjustment filespec is the file specification and adjustment is a factor applied to the result number OPERATION Enter LINCNT followed the file specification for the file in which you wish to count lines For example LINCNT MALLST TXT You may optionally include an adjustment factor which is applied to the line count prior to displaying the count This can be used to account for fixed format output which may contain blank or header lines you do not wish to count For example LINCNT MALLST TXT 5 LINCNT is useful when used with IO redirection and piping For example to display the number of ersatz devices defined on your system you can send the output of the ERSATZ program to LINCNT and include an adjustment factor to account for the header and blank line output by ERSATZ ERSATZ LINCNT 2 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 LINCNT Page 2 MESSAGES Cannot OPEN filename file not found Check your syntax or use DIR to see what files exist and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2
418. ile processing its queue file Contact your System Operator sTSKSPL Please mount form form name on printer name The spooler operator job sees this message if you specify a form type not defined as being mounted on the printer The spooler operator should then put the proper form on the printer and use the SET program to tell the printer spooler that form is ready System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PUSH FUNCTION PUSH works similarly to LOG except it remembers the account you came from so you can use the POP command to return CHARACTERISTICS PUSH is re entrant and re usable See the LOG reference sheet for operation details Unlike LOG PUSH will not log you from one device to another unless you enter the device name to log to For example if you are logged into an account on DSK1 and want to PUSH to account 66 5 on DSK2 you must enter PUSH DSK2 66 5 RETURN Just entering PUSH 66 5 does not work Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for information on shared fr Your system must have shared memory to use PUSH and POP See your System memory For every five PUSHes you use one system queue block FORMAT PUSH switch devn p pn switch is an option devn is the device name p is the project number and pn is the programmer number If you are already logged into an account you may be able to abbreviate the account number depending on where you want to PUSH to see O
419. in an overlay Check the instructions for use of the DSIZE pseudo opcode and try again Fatal error Attempt to specify overlay overlay name as optional You may not use O if that object file is an overlay Fatal error DSIZE must not appear in an overlay Check the instructions for use of the DSIZE pseudo opcode and try again Fatal error Expression stack error An error occurred when LNKLIT evaluated some expressions in your files If you see this error report it and the conditions under which it occurred to Alpha Micro Fatal error Expression stack overflow You exceeded the number of nested expressions that LNKLIT can handle Try to find the overly complex expression in your source file and simplify it Fatal error First file must not be a library To enable LNKLIT to correctly resolve external references to a library you must specify the program referencing that library before you specify the library file itself Try again with the library file after the reference file Fatal error First file must not be an overlay To enable LNKLIT to correctly resolve external references to an overlay you must specify the program that references that overlay before you specify the overlay file itself Try again with the files in the proper order Fatal error Incompatible library object file version One or more of the object or library files is in an old format not compatible with the current version of LNKLIT The object file sho
420. in system memory The DVD or Blu ray driver must be loaded into system memory during the AMOS boot process System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 3 DBD Media is not AMOS format insert an AlphaDBD and try again DVD cannot read AMOS device information from the DVD or Blu ray media Remove the media from the drive and make sure it is an AlphaDBD Re insert the media and try DBD again If the problem still occurs either it does not contain AMOS information or the DVD drive needs maintenance There is no media installed in the DVD RAM drive Insert a DVD or Blu ray media into the drive Unable to find a DVD RAM Recorder No device that looks like a DVD or Blu ray recorder was found You must install a SCSI dispatcher prior to using this program A SCSI dispatcher is required to use DBD System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 DEL FUNCTION Erases modules from your memory partition CHARACTERISTICS DEL is re entrant and re usable When you load a file into memory from the disk that copy in memory is called a module DEL erases such modules from your memory partition NOT from the disk You may use the wildcard symbols and in your file specifications When it deletes modules it shifts any remaining modules down in memory if they have memory addresses greater than the deleted modules DEL cannot delete modules which have been locked in memory by setting the LOK bit flag in the module s flags word FORMAT
421. inal input To Waiting for terminal output to complete For more information on job status codes see your AMOS User s Guide Qfree is the number of queue blocks allocated but not in use If this number is less than 15 it indicates your system is low on queue blocks You may want to allocate more by adding to the number that follows the QUEUE command in your system INI file The Up time is the time the system has been running since it was booted The Disk queue number is the number of users waiting to access the disk or waiting for a disk access to complete This information is valid only on certain hardware configurations During the display you may press to suspend the display and show the question Enter command Q R onthe bottom line Typing Q clears the screen and returns you to AMOS Typing R resumes the STAT display You may also use CTRLYT or CTRLYR These cause the display to move forward or backward over 17 jobs This is useful if you have more than 17 jobs defined on your system A down arrow on the display indicates there are more jobs to view an up arrow means you can move backward You may press CTRLI C to exit the display at any time System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FUNCTION STAT1 Displays a continuously updating status of all the jobs on the system concentrating on job scheduler and disk activity CHARACTERISTICS STAT 1 displays more detailed technical information than the STAT command It swi
422. ing TOC Warning For all incidents in this category MTUSAV either 1 cannot read or cannot write a block to the disk MTUSAV will not try to access the file again The program will continue but the file will not be complete Error writing TOC Warning 2 Error reading VER Warning 3 Error writing VER Warning 4 Error writing LOG Warning 5 User Abort Control Verif user abort Warning If a C comes in while the list of verification errors in being displayed the list is terminated but MTUSAV continues Date update user abort Warning Even if set to Error MTUSAV will not treat this as a fatal error Parameter File Control MTUSAV INF invalid line Warning Usually a file specification error MTUSAV INF read error Warning Cannot read a block from the disk MTUSAV OPT invalid line Warning MTUSAV OPT read error Warning Cannot read a block from the disk System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 17 MTUSAV Incident Name Default Meaning Note Problems During Backup Bkup seq file in use Warning MTUSAV could not open the sequential file for input 6 as another job had the file open The file is not saved to tape Bkup error seq file open Error MTUSAV could not open the sequential file for any reason other than another file had the file already open The file is not saved to tape Bkup contig file in use Warning On trying to open the contiguous file LOKSER 6 reported that another user had the file open for exclusive use MTUSAV
423. ing else If you want to attach a terminal to a job logged into an account ATTACH asks you for the password of that account if one exists before it attaches the specified job and terminal You can attach your terminal to a job but be careful the job has some memory allocated to it or you will not be able to do much A typical use for ATTACH might be to attach a printer to a job as a terminal so you can get a paper copy of the program s output FORMAT ATTACH terminal job If you specify a terminal you should also specify a job If you specify a job alone it will attach that job to your own terminal OPERATION To find out what jobs and terminals are attached to each other enter ATTACH For example ATTACH TERM1 attached to JOBA TERM2 attached to JOBC DUKE attached to SPOOL System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 ATTACH Page 2 To attach your terminal to a specific job add a job name For example ATTACH JOBA To attach a specific job to a specific terminal enter ATTACH followed by the terminal name a comma and the job name For example ATTACH TERM1 JOB4 The terminal names are set by the TRMDEF commands in your system initialization command file To see the names of all of the terminals on the system enter TRMDEF at AMOS level The first column on the left of the display lists all of the terminals MESSAGES Account not found on login disk for specified job You attempted to attach a termi
424. ing sizes are specified the smaller drives will be padded on the DVD to equal to the largest logical size copied Only entire logical drives including unused areas can be copied to the DVD DVD ram media may be erased reused and modified If logical drives of differing sizes are specified the smaller logicals that have been o padded on the DVD media will not be randomly writeable later when using the DVD program However all logical units on the DVD can be randomly read when using the DVD program MAKDVD will start recording at the beginning of the DVD and use only as much space as required to hold the desired data MAKDVD uses the available user memory for data buffers in order to continue supplying data to the DVD RAM drive while other system or multi user activity occurs FORMAT MAKDVD switches System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 Page 2 HELP Display the available options and exits n Same as HELP IV Display version information and exits COUNT n Creates n DVDs containing the same data DEV xxx Uses device and driver named xxx instead of the default DVD EJECT Ejects the DVD in the drive and exits AD n Uses the DVD RAM Drive at SCSI ID n instead of scanning the SCSI bus to find a DVD RAM Drive The ID can be from 0 to 15 NOEJECT The DVD media will not be ejected from the drive PIC Displays the Product Installation Code VERBOSE Display additional error messages VERIFY Set hardware read after wr
425. ing the index file instead of searching the data file itself Two keyed sequential access methods may co exist on your computer ISAM and the newer ISAM Plus If you are using ISAM use the ISMDMP and ISMBLD utilities instead of ISMUTL Although you call ISAM Plus functions from within your AlphaBASIC AlphaC or assembly language programs you may not run the ISAMP SYS program directly from AMOS command level For more about using ISAM Plus see your SAM Plus User s Guide FORMAT ISMUTL filespec filespec selects the ISAM Plus index data file combination you want to create examine or change DEFAULTS The default extensions of the index data ISAM Plus file combination are IDX and IDA If you use ISMUTL to load or dump an ISAM Plus file the default extension of the input output file is SEQ OPERATION Enter ISMUTL and the specification of the ISAM Plus file you want to create modify or examine For example ISMUTL ADDRSS System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 ISMUTL Page 2 If the file does not exist ISMUTL begins to ask a series of questions concerning the number of data records and their size as well as information on the position type and size of the keys the new index file will contain If the file does exist ISMUTL displays a menu from which you can choose the operation you want to perform on the file You may choose from the following LOAD Load a file CHANGE Change data device name
426. ings and MTUSAV OPT by running MTUSAV EXTRA System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 10 Error Tables The following tables list the incidents that cause error processing during MTUSAV There is a table for each stage of MTUSAV processing program initialization tape drive interaction backup and verification with an additional table of incidents which could occur at any point Notes following each table expand on some of the descriptions The columns in each table are e Incident A brief description e Mode Some incidents are handled differently depending on the mode MTUSAV is operating in There are three modes e T operating under the Task Manager e C operating under a command file e J interactive e Abort If the problem is essentially irrecoverable MTUSAV will abort its operation quickly It may finish any pending operations before terminating e Where How the error is reported e T a message on the terminal e S an entry in SYSLOG SYS e L a message in MTUSAV LOG e JOBERR How is JOBERR affected This could be e Blank JOBERR is not set e Asterisk JOBERR is set based on the user settings in MTUSAV OPT and the runtime history e A fixed value JOBERR is set to this value on termination under the rules described above for JOBERR priority e OPT Text The text used in MTUSAV OPT for defining the incident severity This is blank if the incident severity cannot be set in MTUSAV OPT e Acc An
427. ining system commands You can execute such a file by entering its name at AMOS command level A DO file can contain all of the elements of a command file In addition a DO file allows you to pass arguments to the file by including parameter symbols in that file You can then specify the arguments to be substituted for those symbols when you execute the DO file A DO file can be created using the AlphaVUE text editor If a DO file has a DO extension you may call it simply by entering its name at AMOS command level providing no LIT or CMD files of the same name exist in your account or the system library accounts If the file does not have a DO extension you must specify DO before the name of that file in order to execute it FORMAT DO filespec argument argument filespec selects the DO file you want to execute and the arguments are optional text items separated by spaces you wish to substitute for parameter symbols in the DO file DO assumes a file extension of DO OPERATION Enter the name of the DO file and the arguments for the file if any For example PROCES WRITE TXT If your DO file does not have a DO extension type the command DO the name of your DO file and the arguments For example DO FORMAT GO WRITE TXT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DO Page 2 MESSAGES Cannot locate filespec Check your syntax or use DIR to find the file System Commands Reference Manual Re
428. int Please correct then press RETURN when ready Correct the problem and continue Error reading MTUSAV TOC file An error occurred while MTUSAV was trying to read the TOC file The error listing is not complete Error reading MTUSAV VER file Listing of files that failed to verify is incomplete An error occurred while MTUSAV was reading the file containing details of verification errors The list of verification errors is incomplete although the count of verification errors is accurate Error listing terminated You pressed Control C during the file error listing Error reading disk file During verification MTUSAV cannot read a disk file for comparison against a tape file A verification error is raised and verification continues from the start of the next tape file nn errors caused by file or record locks nn contiguous random files were either locked exclusively by another job or had one or more records locked when MTUSAYV tried to save those records to tape In either case MTUSAV read the affected blocks by bypassing AMOS s record locking system Although the data was saved correctly to tape the consistency of data saved is questionable as the file might have been undergoing update as it was being backed up The file list will be incomplete if there was an earlier error in the MTUSAV TOC file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 23 MTUSAV nn errors caused by file verification failure Durin
429. is not mounted MOUNT the device and try again Cannot save File beyond 32MB boundary Use BACKUP command One of the files you ve specified is past the 32MB boundary of an extended disk You must use BACKUP to save these files Field size exceeded Re enter Check the maximum length of the field and try again nn files not transferred Beyond 32MB boundary Use BACKUP command If you attempted to save files past the 32MB boundary on an extended disk this message tells you how many files were not transferred Use BACKUP to save these files Output file spec not allowed You tried to specify an output file or included an equal sign before the input specifications Try again without the output file Zero blocks in this file Not selected STRSAV found a directory entry for a file with a size of zero blocks It will not copy a zero block file It skips the file and continues System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 STRSAV Page 4 STRSAV can also display standard AMOS error messages followed by while copying filespec This tells you how far STRSAV got before the error You can then use STRDIR to display the directory file of the cartridge and see how many files were actually transferred All the files listed before the one shown in the message are recoverable the rest are not System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 SUBMIT FUNCTION Submits files to and edits the Task Manager queue file CHARACTERISTICS
430. isplay information about the tape drive and the cartridge currently in it type TMODE and the device name For example TMODE STRO Cartridge type DC6320 or DC6525 Recording format Unknown Options for this drive none If you use TMODE with a drive which supports compression modes such as an AM 648 DAT drive this is the result TMODE DATO Recording format DDS DC compression Options for this drive DDS Standard 2Gb format DDS DC compressed 4Gb format To force the AM 648 drive to write in standard DDS non compressed mode type TMODE DATO DDS System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TMODE Page 2 To return to compressed mode type TMODE DATO DDS DC Drives which support setting the tape format as well as the compression mode such as the AM 650 have more options but the operation method is the same Type TMODE and the device name to see the current format options then set the option by using TMODE again with the device name and the setting you want When setting an option the cartridge in the drive should support the format or compression mode you want to set For more details about using TMODE with your tape drive please refer to the installation instructions for your drive MESSAGES Cannot INIT Devn device does not exist The device name you entered does not exist Check your spelling and re enter the command File specification error You must enter a device name with TMO
431. isplayed Each line displays eight groups of 16 bits For example DSKDMP 3063 Block size 128 003101 052057 046124 042040 045523 046504 020120 034002 This example shows the first 128 bytes of block 2063 DSKDMP always begins with the first byte of the block The default block size is 512 If the block size is larger than 256 DSKDMP pauses every 256 bytes Press to continue System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DSKDMP Page 2 MESSAGES Block size is too large Enter a smaller block size Cannot read illegal block number You gave DSKDMP a block number that does not exist Use the DUMP command to display the blocks on your disk Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of the devices on your system Cannot READ device name disk not mounted MOUNT the disk and try again Privileged program must be logged into 1 2 Log into account 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DSKFIL FUNCTION Tells you what disk blocks are used by a specified file CHARACTERISTICS DSKFIL is re entrant and re usable The numbers you see are displayed in the number base currently in use on your system usually octal See the SET reference sheet for information on changing number bases FORMAT DSKFIL filespec filespec selects the file whose block numbers you want to see The default file extension is L
432. isplays the hash total of the file if backed up with H KILL Delete existing file matching the listpec before creating a list file OVERRIDE Overrides default backup device You are prompted for the device name PROTECTION Displays the protection codes if any of the files on the media SUPPRESS Don t display a dot on the terminal as records are read TRANSFER Don t lock out users from system VCR only UDATE Displays the last date updated Useful if you are going to use the BEFORE or AFTER switches with RESTOR OPERATION Enter BAKDIR and the desired switches and file specifications For example BAKDIR DSKO MEMO TXT 150 0 DSK1 TEST M68 100 3 BAKDIR displays a menu of available backup devices Select the device you want BAKDIR then asks you to confirm the device name is correct if so press RETURN If not enter the correct one BAKDIR instructs you in running the backup device selected Follow its directions and BAKDIR displays the directory The first number on each line is the file s relative position on the medium Next you see the full file specification and the size of the file in 512 byte blocks The letter after the file size tells if the file is a random or linked L file or a sequential or contiguous C file Then you see the date the file was backed up and the file protection bits If the files were backed up with H the last item on the line is the hash total MESSAGES Attempt to initiate device h
433. it again from the backup media Hash mismatch The hash total of the file on your system did not match the hash total for that file as listed in the Master Directory Listing This could indicate a copying error If the file does not have a version number this could also indicate your current file is a different version than the one in the MDL Try copying the file again from the backup media Invalid MDL format The Master Directory Listing was not created with the H V and D switches If your release AMOS DIR file caused this error message contact Alpha Micro If you are trying to use another file as the MDL re run DIR with these three switches only Verified The file has verified as being the same as it was on the transfer medium Version mismatch is x x xxx MDL x x xxx The version of the file on your system did not match the version listed in the Master Directory Listing This could mean a different version of the file was copied over the original file or a copying error occurred Check your source file and determine which version you wish to have System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 VUE FUNCTION Creates and edits text files CHARACTERISTICS AlphaVUE is re entrant and re usable AlphaVUE is a screen oriented text editor You see the text you are editing displayed on the screen and move the screen cursor to the location in your file you want to view or edit In Command mode AlphaVUE allows you to sear
434. itches can be abbreviated to any unique combination of letters BOOT Create a warm boot cartridge operation switch NOBOOT Don t create a warm boot cartridge default operation switch HASH Calculate a hash total file switch NOHASH Don t calculate a hash total default file switch QUERY Confirm before selecting files file switch NOQUERY Don t confirm default file switch SUPPRESS Don t list files on terminal as they are backed up May speed up backup NOSUPPRESS Lists files on the terminal OPERATION Load an empty cartridge into the streamer unit and enter STRSAV followed by the specification selecting the files you want to back up For example STRSAV MEMO TXT SCHDLE TXT 310 2 STRSAV reminds you no one else may use the system while it is running Press to continue or CTRLYC to exit If you press RETURN STRSAV erases and rewinds the cartridge If you used BOOT STRSAV first asks for the input warm boot file name Type the name of the warm boot monitor file you generated with the WRMGEN program The default specification is DSKO AMOSL WRM 1 4 STRSAV then asks for the tape label data Volume name up to 40 characters Volume ID up to ten characters Installation maximum 30 characters System also 30 characters and Creator thirty characters This information is displayed by STRDIR It helps other people know what is on the tape and who put it there STRSAV now displays the n
435. ite an existing file Bypassing Table of Contents An informative message Cannot be logged onto the backup device Check your entry for errors Make sure you used a colon after the device name Cannot open message socket ITC error n See your Monitor Calls Manual for an explanation of the error code This indicates an internal communication error ask your System Operator or Alpha Micro dealer for help if this occurs frequently Make sure you have a MSGINI line in your system INI file Cannot use device AMOS error message Either your ersatz default device definition or the device you specified after OWVERRIDE was incorrect Using the AMOS error message as a clue to what is wrong check the appropriate entry and correct it Can t find device handler in DEVTBL See your Alpha Micro dealer for help CMDLIN error detected during file transform process Your version of CMDLIN doesn t match your version of RESTOR See your System Operator or Alpha Micro dealer about updating CMDLIN or RESTOR System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 5 RESTOR Directory is damaged Something is wrong either with your RESTOR command or with your system s account structure This message could occur if your command caused an attempt to create an account and you were not logged into OPR If this is not the case see your System Operator about using DSKANA or other diagnostic programs to check the account structure Disk device specified for file
436. ite protected Type MTUSAV and the specification of the files you want to back up For example MTUSAV MEMO TXT SCHDLE TXT 310 2 or MTUSAV DSK5 MTUSAV asks for the tape unit number Enter a digit from 0 to 7 If your computer has more than one device with the same unit number MTUSAV asks which device to use Next MTUSAV prompts you for information it stores in the save set label the Volume name 40 characters Volume ID 10 characters Installation 30 characters System 30 characters and Creator 30 characters the files won t fit on a single tape MTUSAV prompts you to mount new tapes as needed As you remove each tape label it with the reel number as well as other backup information so you can tell which is which You may also want to write protect the tape so it is not accidentally overwritten The process continues until all files are backed up Me Not all backup devices support multi reel backups tape spanning If your device does Y gt not support tape spanning an error message displays if the tape is filled For error checking you can use the VERIFY switch VERIFY reads every file on the tape block by block and compares it to the corresponding file on the disk If a file is not copied to tape for example if it was a sequential file locked by another job it does not cause a verification error since only files actually on the tape are checked You can use LOG with VERIFY to write the verification dat
437. ite verification MAKDVD with no switches will create a DVD using the DVD device found by scanning the SCSI bus OPERATION Before starting the program place a DVD media in the DVD RAM drive Copying logical disks that are being updated by other users to the DVD RAM drive can result in DVDs containing incorrect or incomplete data Type MAKDVD from the AMOS prompt MAKDVD MAKDVD will attempt to find a DVD RAM drive that is compatible with the DVD RAM driver being used The driver must have the same name as the DVD drive device name and be loaded in system memory MAKDVD will find the DVD RAM drive either using the command line switches DEV and ID or by defaulting to DVD if DEV is not specified and by scanning the SCSI bus if ID is not specified If more than one DVD RAM type device is found when scanning the SCSI bus you will be asked to choose the device you wish to use for recording System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 Page 3 MAKDVD After entering the MAKDVD command the following will be displayed MAKDVD Version X X xxx Copyright C 2001 Alpha Micro Products InG Initializing SCSI DVD RAM Recorder If MAKDVD finds multiple possible DVD RAM drives while scanning the SCSI bus the following message will be displayed to allow you to select the drive to use Found the following possible DVD Recorders ID Description 1 nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX 2 nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX Select one o
438. ive needs cleaning or maintenance FATAL ERROR can t locate DVR ACD DVR Reboot the system and copy ACD DVR into DVR before using ACD again ACD cannot find a necessary companion file ACD DVR in the DVR account usually DSKO 1 6 Reboot the system and copy the needed file into DVR Impossible error can t find ACDn entries in DEVTBL Impossible error freeing queue blocks that aren t allocated ACD detected a system problem when unmounting the CD ROM Reboot the system Invalid command line ACD to install or ACD U to un install ACD did not understand the command line you entered No free SCSI addresses you must remove at least one SCSI peripheral in order to access AlphaCD All available SCSI IDs are in use and there is no CD ROM drive attached The SASI bus supports only four SCSI devices the SCSI 2 bus supports seven and the Wide SCSI 2 bus supports 15 To use a CD ROM drive power down your computer remove one of the devices from the SCSI bus and attach the CD ROM Not enough contiguous queue blocks to create device table You must allocate more via the QUEUE statement in your system initialization command file ACD uses a system resource called queue blocks to temporarily create device table entries describing the logical units on the CD ROM disk ACD cannot allocate enough contiguous blocks As queue blocks are a dynamic system wide resource either try again in a few seconds or increase the number of
439. k controller board Must be in OPR Disables on board caching for the specified device Must be in OPR Displays whole numbers in hexadecimal Sets the language translation table for the job Turns on the specified network Must be in OPR Turns off the specified network Must be in OPR Enables file locking for job for traditional devices Records event in system log Disables file locking for job for traditional devices Records event in system log Turns on network driver for non AlphaNET network Must be in OPR Turns off network driver for non AlphaNET network Must be in OPR Displays whole numbers in octal Programs terminal function keys System Commands Reference Manual Rev 10 Page 3 ae PROMPT x QIC11 QIC24 QICNORMAL REDIRECTION NOREDIRECTION SEEKOP dsk NOSEEK dsk TERMINAL TEST NOTEST VERIFY NOVERIFY ISIABT job SET Defines the AMOS prompt Maximum 19 characters See below for interpreted prompt information Uses QIC11 format for streaming tape drive Uses QIC24 format for streaming tape drive Uses normal format for streaming tape drive Enables I O redirection See Chapter 5 Disables I O redirection See Chapter 5 Turns on seek optimization for the specified device including all logical units on the device Improves disk access speed for heavily used systems Turns off seek optimization for the specified device including all logical units on the device Se
440. l 2007 02 01 02 PM Files have been restored Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 01 12 PM ENTERED DBD67 19200 150 Mb gt UPD6 19200 150 Mb ENTERED DBD68 19200 150 Mb gt UPD7 19200 150 Mb Restored 2 Files File Name Mask LIT 001 004 Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 01 13 PM Files have been restored ENTERED DBD69 19200 150 Mb gt UPD8 19200 150 Mb Elapsed Time Elapsed Time Elapsed Time Elapsed Time Elapsed Time Elapsed Time Elapsed Time Elapsed Time 00 08 03 LIT 1 4 00 00 00 LIT 1 4 00 01 56 LIT 1 4 00 00 00 LIT 1 4 00 05 28 LIT 1 4 00 00 04 LIT 1 4 00 00 09 LIT 1 4 00 00 10 LIT 1 4 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 BDRES Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 02 44 PM Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 02 44 PM n restored Thu 55 Jul 2007 02 02 45 PM Date amp Time Files have b Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 02 45 PM n restored Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 02 46 PM Date amp Time Files have b Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 02 46 PM n restored Thu 55 Jul 2007 02 02 46 PM Date amp Time Files have b Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 02 47 PM n restored Thu 5 Jul 2007 02 02 47 PM Date amp Time Files have b Date amp Time Thu 5 Jul
441. l of SOFTABORT 3 The file is not backed up 4 The contents of the file are saved regardless of file or record locking Data integrity may be compromised System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 13 MTUSAV 5 This occurs when MTUSAV has opened a contiguous file for reading sharing and another job opens the same file exclusively LOKSER allows this but forces a file in use D EFIU error the next time MTUSAV reads the file The file is saved regardless of record or file locking and data integrity may be compromised 6 Ifa block of a sequential file cannot be read a block containing nulls is written to tape If there are unread blocks in the file the tape file is padded with the same number of null blocks This file will not verify and data integrity is compromised Some remedial disk management and data restoration work is required 7 Ifa block of a contiguous file cannot be read a block containing an ASCII message followed by nulls is written to tape in its place Data integrity is compromised Subsequent blocks will be handled normally Some remedial disk management and data restoration work is required 8 The block is read regardless of locking Data integrity may be compromised 9 The disk file system is corrupted The number of blocks in the file as defined by the file s directory entry does not match the number of blocks AMOS can read from the file MTUSAV treats the file size defined in the disk direct
442. layed the program asks Do you want to clear the error counters yes no Typing Y clears the error counters and exits the program Typing N exits the program without clearing the counters Any other response repeats the question MESSAGES Error statistics are not available The version of the SCSI dispatcher on your computer does not support error reporting You need a later version of the dispatcher to use this feature System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SCZERR Page 2 Please answer the question correctly You must respond either Yes or No System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SCZPIC FUNCTION Enters the Product Installation Code PIC for the SCSI dispatcher Once the PIC has been entered displays the PIC OPERATION See your system owner s manual or the installation instructions for your SCSI controller for how to use SCZPIC to enter the PIC for your SCSI dispatcher Once you ve entered the PIC you can display it by entering SCZPIC fr SCZPIC is not required in AMOS 2 3 or later versions of the operating system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SEND FUNCTION Sends a message to another job CHARACTERISTICS SEND is re entrant and re usable and recognizes ersatz names Sends a one line message to any job that can receive terminal input and does not have GUARD set see the SET reference sheet for information on GUARD FORMAT SEND cpulD ersatz name jobname message
443. le last session is not empty Error Disk is full and cannot be used Error Media is not rewritable and cannot be erased Error Total data requirements exceed CD R capacity Error Unable to load CDR media This indicates a hardware problem with the CD recorder or a problem with the CD media Error Unable to open CD recording session Try a different CD media This can also indicate a possible CD recorder problem Error Unable to open track for recording Try a different CD media This can also indicate a possible CD recorder problem Error Unable to read disk information from media Try a different CD media This can also indicate a possible CD recorder problem System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MAKACD Page 8 e Error Unable to set desired write mode A device error has occurred while attempting to setup the CD recorder for real mode or test mode recording e Error Unable to set recording speed A device error has occurred while attempting to setup the CD recorder for the desired recording speed e Error Unable to set write mode A device error has occurred while attempting the setup the CD recorder recording mode e Error Unable to write to the CD A device error has occurred while attempting to record data on the CD e Fatal SCSI error Sense key nn additional sense nn CD recorder device error has occurred Sense key and additional sense provide further error information e Please insert a CD Recordable
444. le device The program MTSTAT SYS must be in system memory if you have an S 100 Bus system or any non VME system For information see your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File In order to use MTSTAT SYS you must be running the AMOS 32 or AMOS L version of the operating system FORMAT SKIP devn devn specifies a magnetic tape drive OPERATION Make sure the tape you want to access is mounted then enter SKIP followed by the specification of the tape drive you want to access For example SKIP MTUS SKIP issues a command to the magnetic tape driver to read forward on the currently mounted tape until it detects a file mark If the drive is positioned at the front of a file this command causes the tape driver to skip to the next file MESSAGES File specification error Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of the valid devices System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SLEEP FUNCTION Puts the current job in a waiting state for a specified period of time While in this waiting state the job will not accept any input or perform any tasks CHARACTERISTICS SLEEP is re entrant and re usable The SLEEP command is useful in command files for keeping your job inactive until another procedure completes Allows you to select the length of time messages will stay on the terminal screen FORMAT SLEEP seconds DEFAULTS The default is 0 seconds OPERATION
445. le to enable the disk cache and reboot the system Network access denied You specified a device on another computer networked to your own You cannot use CACHE across the network Not enough cache space available There are not enough disk buffers available in the cache to lock the MFD UFD file or block you specified You may have to allocate more memory to the disk cache system Specification error You made a syntax error in the input line An arrow points to the error Switch error You specified an invalid switch See the operation section above for the switches and re enter the command System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CAL100 FUNCTION Calibrates the time of day clock oscillator on AM 100 L AM 1000 AM 1200 AM 1500 and AM 2000 series systems CHARACTERISTICS CAL100 is re entrant and re usable For further information on calibration see your Alpha Micro Integrated Systems User s Guide This program is only for use by qualified maintenance personnel Requires the use of a n high precision counter for the calibration procedure The CPU is shipped from the factory fully calibrated Normally you will not need to re calibrate the time of day clock You will only need to use this program if the time of day clock oscillator is out of calibration when you initially install the CPU board in the system or during subsequent maintenance After you have completed the calibration procedure you should rese
446. le you want to create and a device specification give the specification of the tape drive you want to use You must now supply blocking information to TAPE When writing data from a disk file to tape this information is optional TAPE has a default record size and blocking factor it can use However when writing from tape to a disk file you MUST supply blocking information TAPE asks you the size of the data records in bytes including record delimiter characters and the number of data records in each tape block These values were established when you first wrote the data onto the tape TAPE now tells you how many characters it is going to read per tape block If this number is not satisfactory for example if it is zero you made a mistake in answering the earlier TAPE questions Press CTRLYC to exit TAPE Then try again If the number is okay TAPE asks you if you want carriage return linefeed pairs after each record Answer with Y for YES or N for NO and press RETURN You may wish to have TAPE append carriage return linefeed characters at the end of each record if you will be reading the data file with an AlphaBASIC program or AlphaVUE TAPE now asks you how many tape blocks you want to read When you enter this value remember TAPE reads fewer blocks if it finds an end of file marker or if it reaches the end of the tape TAPE asks you to press when the tape is loaded and when the drive is on line After TAPE reads the data from the
447. lears the log page of the tape when it finishes Different tape drives record different statistics in the log page The information you see depends on the tape drive you re using MESSAGES Device does not log tape statistics Either your tape drive does not support the LOGSNS command or it does not support the error log pages that TAPLOG does You cannot us TAPLOG with this drive System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TAPLOG Page 2 Device error sense key meaning Additional sense codes The drive returned a SCSI error message with the sense key and sense codes listed meaning is the description of the sense key listed For more information on SCSI error sense codes see the tape drive manufacturer s manual If you do not have DSKERKR set all you see of this message is Device error Device is not a tape drive You entered TAPLOG followed by the device name of a disk drive instead of a tape drive Device busy info Device error info Request sense command failed The tape drive did not respond properly to a SCSI command Check the drive and its connection before retrying TAPLOG If it fails a second time contact your System Operator and have the additional information on hand 2SCSI dispatcher not found TAPLOG works only with the SCSI dispatcher No dispatcher is running on your computer so you can t use TAPLOG Usage TAPLOG dev0 C where dev0 is name of tape device You ve used the wrong syntax
448. library file should be a separate routine because when your fr program refers to a symbol in the library file LNKLIT or SYMLIT links in the entire object file required to resolve the reference For example if the library file UTILIT LIB contains the object files GETNUM SUBT REAL and BINWRT and your program refers to a routine contained in the GETNUM file LNKLIT or SYMLIT links in the entire object file GETNUM from UTILIT LIB even if that file contains more than one routine For more information on library files and on LIBLIT M68 LNKLIT and SYMLIT see your Assembly Language Programmer s Manual FORMAT LIBLIT works either in a creating editing mode or in a display mode LIBLIT ibrary spec filespec filespec or LIBLIT L listspec library spec filespec The first mode is the creating editing mode where library spec selects the name of the library file you want to build and the filespec s specify the object files for the library The second is the display mode where listspec indicates a disk file for the listing The backslash symbol indicates the following file should be removed from the library file or excluded from the listing If you include files inside parenthesis those files are treated as a group System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LIBLIT Page 2 You must supply at least one filespec If you don t specify it on the LIBLIT line you s
449. lish the format is mm dd yy If you include datespec you reset the system date to the date you enter DATE automatically sets the day of the week to match If you do not include datespec DATE displays the current system date OPERATION To display the date enter DATE at AMOS command level For example DATE Thursday February 22 1996 To set the date log into 1 2 and enter DATE followed by the new date in the format for your language For example LOG 1 2 DATE 10 21 95 MESSAGES Invalid year entered Only dates from 1980 through 2079 are allowed Two digit years from 80 through 99 are considered 1980 1999 Years from 00 through 79 are considered 2000 2079 Use format date format You did not enter the date in the proper format for your current language definition file try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 DATE Page 2 You must be logged into 1 2 to reset the date Log into 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 DB FUNCTION DB is an interactive program that lets you debug a BASIC PLUS program at the source language level CHARACTERISTICS DB is re entrant and re usable Functions variables and statements are referred to by the names from the original source file It lets you set breakpoints at statements view and change variable values and run the program on a statement by statement basis See your AlphaBASIC PLUS User s Manual for complete information
450. lization Command File A magnetic tape is said to be at load point when the metallic film at the start of the tape is positioned at the read head fr Use REWIND for remotely controlled VCRs which start to play when a write protected cassette is inserted to rewind the tape back to load point REWIND works with the AMOS 32 and AMOS Lversions of the operating system only FORMAT REWIND devn devn is the tape unit you want to rewind OPERATION Make sure the tape you want to rewind is mounted Then enter REWIND followed by the specification of the tape unit For example REWIND MTU7 or REWIND VCRO REWIND returns you to AMOS command level while the tape is still rewinding System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 REWIND Page 2 MESSAGES Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your entry or use DEVTBL to see a list of valid devices for your system and try again Device not ready The tape drive reported that it is not ready for operation Check that the tape is loaded correctly and the drive is ready for operation File specification error Check your syntax and try again Tape cannot be rewound t is at load point The tape is already fully rewound and ready for use Tape is already rewinding The tape is already rewinding The command was superfluous System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 RNDRED FUNCTION RNDRED randomly selects disk tracks and performs a seek
451. llowed by a device specification and physical block number For example LOG OPR ASCDMP DSK2 200 To find out what blocks are contained in a specific file use DSKFIL MESSAGES Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see the devices defined on your system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 ASCDMP Page 2 Cannot read device name disk not mounted MOUNT the disk and try again Privileged program must be logged into OPR Log into DSKO 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 ATTACH FUNCTION Connects a job to a terminal or displays the jobs and terminals attached on a system CHARACTERISTICS ATTACH is re entrant and re usable When the system is reset or powered up it automatically attaches the first job to the first terminal defined in your system initialization command file Except for that special case however the system does not automatically attach any jobs to terminals If you want a job to be able to use a terminal for input and output you must explicitly attach the job and the terminal by using the ATTACH or SETJOB command If you want to attach a job and a terminal already linked to other units the ATTACH command detaches the job and the terminal from their previous attachments Then it will attach the freed job and terminal to each other This is the only way you can detach jobs and terminals i e by attaching them to someth
452. locks read could indicate the tape is going bad or you have faulty hardware When all of the tape has been read CRT620 rewinds the tape and erases all of the data it wrote Remove the cartridge and store it N The statistics available will vary from device type to device type For example soft error gt statistics are not available from MTX Exabyte devices You can use the FILE and or GRAPH switches during verification to write the verification statistics and a plot of soft errors by tape position to files You can later look at these files to check the quality of the tape HOW TO CHECK A PREVIOUSLY RECORDED CARTRIDGE C Switch Load the cartridge you want to check into your 1 4 streamer unit Type CRT620 C RETURN When it is through CRT620 displays the same statistics as V Y See the warning about verifying backup quality in the Characteristics section MESSAGES Data error undetected by device The data pattern read from the tape was not the same as that written to the tape You either have the wrong tape in the streamer drive or the tape may be bad Field size exceeded Re enter Try again using only the number of characters allowed or less Specification error Check your spelling and try again the arrow points to the error System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CTYPE FUNCTION Displays a file compressed by the CMP command CHARACTERISTICS CTYPE is an OS Exec program that may be used as an AMO
453. lphaC 2 0 vol 2 of 2 PR12 97 XAdmin for AM 8000 Only Release 1 0 AlphaODBC 1 4Y January 31 2006 VersiCOMM Plus V3 1 and ZARC OCT2004 Unsupported Software January 31 2006 AMPC 7 0 Bootable Release Jan2006 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 BDRES DBD137 20480 9 20471 1280 7054D 1 blk AMMO19 E Open Logical eeeee eee cece eee eeees DBD138 204800 162036 42764 2800 70550 1 blk DSKO00 E AMOS System Disk Oct2004 05 DBD139 204800 152190 52610 2800 7A38E 0 blk DSKO01 E Working Logical for CD OCT Release DBD140 204800 9839 94961 2800 8382E 1 blk DSK002 E AlphaC 1 1 406 Release Logical DBD141 204800 21720 83080 2800 841CA 3 blk DSKOO3 E LOTTO amp UNOFICIAL WIP eee0000 DBD142 204800 34277 70523 2800 85701 2 blk DSK004 E Folders from Library System DBD143 204800 29214 75586 2800 8787B 2 blk DSK005 E OPEN LOGICAL sscscscscscscsrseso DBD144 204800 32100 72700 2800 89503 3 blk DSK006 E SSD Stuf for AMOS Systems Current DBD145 204800 57897 46903 2800 8B45D 2 blk DSK007 E MEXICO S VERSION OF ALPHAFAX DBD146 204800 37409 67391 2800 8ECE8 2 blk DSKOO8 E OPEN LOGICAL piegpedaee erpeori t raene DBD147 204800 44953 59847 2800 91171 2 blk DSK009 E AlphaFAX ACCOUNTS eeeeeeeeeeeeees DBD148 204800 27154 776
454. m Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CDIR Page 2 The file specified is not in the format expected by CDIR Use the DIR or TYPE command to get information about the file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CLEAR FUNCTION Writes zeros to all or to a specified number of the free blocks on the specified disk CHARACTERISTICS CLEAR is re entrant and re usable When you erase a file from the disk the data is not destroyed only the access to it is Until those blocks are used again the contents of the file remain CLEAR guarantees the data is overwritten with zeros so it cannot be retrieved You must be logged into DSKO 1 2 to run CLEAR You can t use CLEAR across a o network CLEAR locks the logical disk you specify so nobody else can access it until CLEAR is finished CLEAR will NOT write to any blocks marked in the bitmap as being in use FORMAT CLEAR devn DEFAULTS CLEAR assumes you want to clear all the free blocks on the disk if you do not specify a number of blocks to clear OPERATION Log into OPR Enter CLEAR and the device you want to clear For example CLEAR DSK3 You then see How many blocks do you want to clear 4 You may press CTRL C at any time to stop the program If you just press RETURN CLEAR will write zeros to all of the free blocks on the disk CLEAR displays a period for every block it clears When CLEAR is finished it displays the number of blocks cleared This number
455. m the operation on the specified UFD The switches for the LIST command are STATIC List the blocks in the static queue DYNAMIC List the blocks in the dynamic queue HASH List the blocks in the hash queue The switches may be abbreviated fr You can use an ersatz name for the device specification Here are some examples ON UNLOCK F PAYROL DAT LOCK MFD DSKO DSK2 CLEAR FILE DSK1 PAYROL DAT 126 10 You may add a CACHE command to your System Initialization Command File after the final SYSTEM command so the CACHE is set up at the time of system bootup MESSAGES Argument error You specified an invalid argument in the input line An arrow points to the incorrect part of the line Command error You specified an invalid command name in the input line An arrow points to the incorrect command Disk cache does not exist The disk cache file DCACHE SYS does not exist is in the wrong account or was not loaded into system memory by your system INI file Check to see DCACHE SYS exists in DSKO 1 4 and use SYSTEM to be sure it s loaded System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 CACHE Disk cache is already OFF Disk cache is already ON You tried changing the state of the disk cache to the state it was in already The command is ignored Disk cache is OFF The disk cache was not enabled at bootup time or has been turned off with the OFF command Edit your system command initialization fi
456. mac ctype h cc proces d r mk obj lt mk c mac stdio h mac memory h mac ctype h cc md d mins 65535 maxs 1048575 The modification time of a file has a precision of a minute so a modification to a source file done within a minute after the last update will not be detected FORMAT MK switch es macro s target file target file macros specifies macros that affect the assembly process and target file specifies the file s to be made DEFAULTS The default makefile is MK MKF in your current account OPTIONS IA If no target specified A attempts to rebuild all targets that are not up to date C filename Put commands in a command file instead of executing them F filename Specify a different makefile A Ignore errors IN Don t execute commands but display them on screen IS Don t display anything on the screen IT Change the file modification timestamp to current time without executing the commands System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 5 MK OPERATION Enter MK followed by any macros or target files you need For example MK STOCK RP ORDER RP MESSAGES Can t allocate file table not enough memory Try increasing your available memory space or reducing the number of files in your makefile Can t make file filename Check the makefile command that tried to build the file for errors Can t open file filename Check your spelling and syntax or use DIR to find the file and try again
457. mat Re run FIX210 and select another format Could not find 210DVR DVR The file 210DVR DVR was not found in DSKO 1 6 Use DIR to try and locate the file or see your System Operator for help Illegal filename Check your syntax and re enter the filename Invalid device You have a bad version of 210DVR DVR in DSKO 1 6 See your System Operator for help Invalid response Check your typing and try again with a valid response Please enter Y or N Enter Y for Yes of N for No Program is not supported You are not running under the AMOS L version of the operating system The AM 210 floppy disk controller is only supported under that version System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 FIX210 You must be logged into PPN 1 6 to modify the driver Log into DSKO 1 6 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIX219 FUNCTION Configures a diskette driver for use with the AM 219 diskette drive controller Supports both 3 5 and 5 25 drives and both AMOS and DOS diskette formats CHARACTERISTICS FIX219 is re entrant and re usable The AM 219 supports a large number of diskette capacities and formats FIX219 lets you create one or more drivers to support the types of diskettes you want to use You must be logged into DSKO 1 6 to use FIX219 Remember to add a BITMAP command to your system initialization command file for each new format drive combination you create You may also need to modi
458. may be smaller than the number you specified if there were fewer free blocks on the disk than the number of blocks you asked to clear System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CLEAR Page 2 MESSAGES Cannot use CLEAR over network You cannot CLEAR disks on another system through a network File specification error Try again using a valid device name Use SYSTAT to display a list of active devices for your system Invalid number try again You entered an illegal number Try again using a positive whole number Privileged program must be logged into 1 2 Log into 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CMP FUNCTION Compresses an AMOS file CHARACTERISTICS CMP is an OS Exec program that may be used as an AMOS command Although CMP can only compress one file at a time multiple files may be compressed using the Compress function in OS Exec Compress DOES NOT delete the files it compresses This must be done as a separate operation o Prior to erasing the uncompressed files make a backup copy of them as a precaution Files are compressed using a one pass adaptive algorithm Files need not contain repeated characters to be compressed Virtually all uncompressed files are compressible CMP can process sequential and contiguous i e random files The resulting compressed files are in the sequential file format The CTYPE command can be used to display the contents of a compressed sequential file
459. me for the user is a string of printable ASCII characters including spaces The maximum length is 20 characters Letters are stored and displayed in upper or lower case but are compared independent of case Password The user password is independent of any password assigned to a particular PPN This optional field provides extra security System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MUSER Root Account Mail Account Privileges Class of user Experience Level Statistics Job Priority File Protection Language Page 2 The root account is the device and disk account which is the user s central or home account Because a user may have many accounts for different projects the way to identify him personally is by his root account This is where the user can touch base regularly to read reminders and messages In the case of a user who is defined but not allowed to log in to your system assign REMOTE for his root account With a network you can send electronic mail to users on remote systems without allowing them to log in to your own system Every AlphaMAIL user has four mail accounts This field includes the first account where a user s mail will be delivered This field defines the default privileges this user will be assigned at login time The possible privileges are read system memory write system memory read physical disk blocks write physical disk blocks change privilege levels and use diagnostic
460. ment Scheduler 3 5 Al phaRdJE 4 0 PRIO 96 io hera tie esters dares oo InSight am Toolkit 2 0 AMOS UPS Monitor Software V1 3 178 ALDHAMATE 2 2B PRIO ve siete cele suaylece tain ie 3 ove AlphaLAN 8 0 Alpha Side PR08 02 i MUDET 21A PRII esas cs tired e eeen EAr Filer Leh ISAM asegrownde o nesae Baie Spa s Filer 2 0 LISAME ogra aie ci v tesei ACEEA VPSearch 14 6 PR87 92 ines tacts hie enh eaa ACUCOBOL 8 5 22 3B aaa e Sos ecg EEA AlphacC 2 0 Volume 1 of 2 PR12 97 AlphacC 2 0 Volume 2 of 2 PR12 97 Soft Machines ProductS ri Enr ERAEN ences Starr Accounting 4 10 Vol 1 Starr Accounting 4 10 Vol 2 Metropolis 7 5 y2k Version PRO8 2002 DART Release UNSUPPORTED PR10 99 Unsupported Software PRO9 2005 OO OO OOO O 0 O O OO O O70 0 0 0 O O o 5 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 7 DBDO56 20480 DBDO57 20480 DBDO58 20480 DBDO59 20480 DBD060 20480 DBD061 307200 DBD062 307200 DBD063 307200 DBD064 307200 DBD065 307200 DBDO66 307200 DBD067 307200 DBD068 307200 DBD069 307200 DBDO70 307200 DBDO71 307200 DBDO72 307200 DBDO73 307200 DBDO74 307200 DBDO75 307200 DBDO76 307200 DBDO77 2048000 DBDO78 20480 DBDO79 20480 DBDO80 20480 DBDO81 20480 DBD082 20480 DBD083 20480 DBD084 20480 DBD085 20480 DBD086 20480 DBD087 2048
461. mmand File OPERATION Enter QUEUE at AMOS command level For example QUEUE 97 Queue blocks available MESSAGES 2No queue blocks allocated See your System Operator about increasing the number of blocks assigned in your system initialization file Requested queue block allocation extends beyond 8MB 2No queue blocks allocated The number of queue blocks you requested would cause a queue block to reside at a memory location greater than 8MB This in not a valid AMOS configuration Reduce the number of queue blocks requested and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 RADMON FUNCTION Monitors status of AM 445 AM 446 and AM 447 RAID controller Sends notification messages if a fault occurs CHARACTERISTICS RADMON tuns on a background job and checks the RAID controller for error conditions once a minute If it finds one it sends messages to the system operator s terminal and optionally to one or more email addresses It is used only in the system initialization command file FORMAT RADMON ID id EMAIL address address option s id is the SCSI ID of the RAID controller If you leave it out RADMON polls the SCSI bus until it finds the controller Each address is an email address to send notification messages to It must be in standard Internet mail format name system OPTIONS O With AM 446 and AM 447 displays event types other than those normally displayed R With AM
462. more information about using AlphaCD see the AlphaCD Installation Instructions which come with AlphaCD FORMAT ACD U OPTIONS U Unload Use this switch to temporarily prevent other users from accessing the SCSI bus while you disconnect the CD ROM drive or switch CDs It also removes the ACDxxx device table entries created by ACD OPERATION If you need to attach a CD ROM to your computer follow the instructions below 1 Before attaching your CD ROM drive to the computer type SCSI to see what SCSI IDs are available on your computer 2 Follow the instructions for your CD ROM drive to set the drive s SCSI ID to an available ID 3 Make sure no one is using the computer and power it down following the instructions in your Owner s manual 4 Attach the CD ROM drive to the external SCSI connector or an available connector on an external SCSI cable Be sure not to exceed the allowed length of the physical SCSI bus This is especially important on the Wide SCSI 2 bus System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 ACD Page 2 5 Turn on power to the CD ROM drive and power up the computer Insert the correct media into the CD ROM then type ACD ACD locates the CD ROM drive and displays the number of logical units on the drive the number of queue blocks used while the CD is attached normally less than 100 and the name of each logical device on the CD If there is no CD in the drive the program displays There i
463. n CHARACTERISTICS BATCH is a command file in DSKO 2 2 the command file library account that accepts no arguments or switches BATCH loads these programs into memory GOTO LOAD LOOKUP PAUSE TRACE EXITEXIT Using BATCH speeds up the execution of a command file if that file uses many or all of these programs The BATCH command is best used at the front of a command file All of the above programs are re entrant so the System Operator may place them into system memory where they can be used by everyone on the system BATCH takes up about 1500 bytes of your memory partition You may want to include a DEL command at the end of a command file containing the BATCH command so the programs loaded into your memory partition will be deleted when you exit the command file OPERATION Enter the command at AMOS level BATCH MESSAGES You may see the standard AMOS message file not found if any of the files have been deleted from DSKO System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BAUD FUNCTION Changes the baud rate data transfer rate the system uses to communicate with a terminal CHARACTERISTICS BAUD is re entrant and re usable Make sure your terminal is able to communicate at the speed you specify to the BAUD command The baud rates the system supports are 50 75 110 134 5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 3600 4800 7200 9600 19200 38400 57600 FORMAT BAUD baud rate number If you do not enter a baud rate numb
464. n System requirements messages e BDRES requires AMOS 8 x or compatible operating system e If your memory partition is too small for MAKBD the following message will display Error Memory requirements have not been met CODE N Minimum memory to run BDRES LIT is 1 240 KB 1 269 760 bytes DVD RAM or Blu ray Recorder device or driver messages e Device specified is not a DVD RAM or Blu ray Recorder System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 BDRES Page 12 Unable to find a DVD Recorder Error messages when setting up or reading from the DVD or Blu ray Recorder Error Buffer not initialized Error Device is already in use This indicates that either another user is running the BDRES program or the DVD is being used in shared read write mode Error Disk in DVD Recorder is not writeable Error DBD driver must be in system memory Error Unable to load DVD media This indicates a hardware problem with the DVD RAM drive or a problem with the DVD media Error Unable to read disk information from media Try a different DVD media This can also indicate a possible DVD RAM drive problem Fatal SCSI error Sense key nn additional sense nn DVD drive device error has occurred Sense key and additional sense provide further error information Please insert a DVD RAM media Warning Maximum number of devices exceeded extras ignored Warning Unable to close DVD Device error occurred while closing the current DVD T
465. n when all desired drives have been entered DSKO DSK6 MAKACD will the check the transfer rate of the drives specified to make sure they are fast enough to supply the continuous data stream required by the CD recorder If the speed is less the 300K per second the program will terminate If the speed is between 300K and 600K per second recording speed will be limited to 1x If the speed is between 600K and 1000K per second recording speed will be limited to 2x If the speed is greater than 1000k per second recording will take place at the maximum speed of the CD recorder or the speed specified by SPEED in the command line whichever is slower DSKO 64660 blocks Transfer rate 1263K per second ok DSK6 64660 blocks Transfer rate 1196K per second ok System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 5 MAKACD MAKACD then displays information about how much space is required on the CD and where recording will start Calculating space requirements AMOS partition requires 16165 sectors 289735 unused sectors remain Calculated starting AMOS sector is 0 MAKACD then gives you the opportunity to abort or to start the recording process Note that once started the recording operation can be stopped by pressing C which will render the CD R disk unusable Warning The CD Recorder must receive data constantly Other users on the system could delay data transfers and render the CD R disk unusable Press RE
466. n about it Disk caching may speed up your system by reducing disk access CHARACTERISTICS CACHE is re entrant and re usable For more information on setting up and using the cache see your System Operator s Guide When used from an operator s account 1 2 or from 1 4 CACHE puts you in an interactive mode in which you can modify the cache When used from any other account CACHE displays statistics about the disk cache system OPERATION Enter CACHE at AMOS command level For example CACHE Normally you see the CACHE display When used from 1 2 or 1 4 CACHE enters an interactive mode In interactive mode you see an asterisk prompt symbol The format for an interactive command in this mode is command switch device filename The commands are ON Turn on the disk cache system OFF Turn off the disk cache system LOCK Lock the specified block or file in the cache UNLOCK Unlock the specified block or file CLEAR Remove the specified block or file from the cache STATUS Display statistics about the cache HELP List the available commands LIST List static dynamic or hash blocks you must specify a switch EXIT Return to AMOS System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CACHE Page 2 The switches for the LOCK UNLOCK and CLEAR commands are BLOCK Perform the operation on a specified block FILE Perform the operation on the specified file MFD Perform the operation on the specified MFD UFD Perfor
467. n computers which do not support FMTS2 CHARACTERISTICS FMTSCZ is re entrant and re usable You must be logged into the System Operator s Account DSKO 1 2 to run FMTSCZ If you use the format option FMTSCZ destroys all data on all logical devices on the specified physical disk Be sure you have a complete backup of the entire physical disk before proceeding You can only run FMTSCZ on SCSI drives connected to the SASI SCSI port It does not use the SCZDVR DVR driver program nor does it require the drive to be set up in the system initialization command file SCSI drives do not have a BADBLK SYS 1 2 file all disk defects are handled automatically by the drive However you may use BADBLK to add new defects See the BADBLK reference sheet for details FMTSCZ sets up account 1 2 on each logical device when it is done formatting You must then re install your files from your backup OPERATION Log into DSKO 1 2 and type FMTSCZ LOG OPR FMTSCZ FMTSCZ displays the drive status for all drives on the SCSI bus You are asked to press to continue and when you do you see the FMTSCZ menu shown on the next page System Commands Reference Manual Rev 05 FMTSCZ Page 2 Drive status List defects Reassign defective blocks Format drives Initialize drive Rewrite hidden sector Display drive table Exit to AMOS OANRDUAARWNE Enter choice You may type at the main menu to see a HELP display For more d
468. n file If you see 4 it means someone else is running BACKUP RESTOR or BAKDIR BACKUP media not compatible with current software The backup medium you are using is not compatible with the current version of your software See your System Operator for help Cannot be logged onto the backup device Check your entry for errors Make sure you used a colon after the device name System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BACKUP Page 4 Cannot open message socket ITC error n See your AMOS Monitor Calls Manual for an explanation of the error code This indicates an internal communication error ask your System Operator or Alpha Micro dealer for help if this occurs frequently Make sure you have a MSGINI line in your system initialization file Cannot use ersatz name ersatz name not found Check your syntax or define the ersatz name in your ERSATZ INI file Cannot use device AMOS error message Either your ersatz default device definition or the device you specified after OVERRIDE was incorrect Using the AMOS error message as a clue to what is wrong check the appropriate entry and correct it Can t find device handler in DEVTBL See your Alpha Micro dealer for help Device specified is not a supported backup device Check your entry for errors Make sure you used a colon after the device name Diskette is full Place a new diskette in the drive and continue the backup End of media detected The device handler dete
469. n one output specification Try again using only one output specification No file oriented device corresponding to device name is mounted TAPDIR cannot find a logical unit matching your specification Check your syntax This could also indicate the tape was not written by FILTAP System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 No such files TAPDIR TAPDIR was unable to find any files matching your input specification You may want to use TAPD Tape is not file st R ALL to display every file on the tape ructured The tape you are trying to read was not written by the FILTAP program Make sure you have mounted the correct reel of tape Unit number must be between 0 and 7 The unit number must be within the range indicated Re enter a valid number System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TAPE FUNCTION Copies data from disk files to tape or from tape to disk CHARACTERISTICS TAPE is re entrant and re usable TAPE can perform customized data conversion between ASCII and EBCDIC and it recognizes a conversion table CONVRT TBL in the System Library account DSKO 1 4 which you can modify character for character CONVRT TBL MUST be in SYS for TAPE to function If you are copying a magnetic tape created on another system chances are the data is incompatible with the AMOS system For example AlphaBASIC requires all data records end with a carriage return linefeed pair If these are not presen
470. n than using DUMP BITMAP Actually the information is the same only the format is different Master File Directory Display Every disk contains a Master File Directory containing a list of all accounts on the disk and the starting block number of all individual user file directories UFDs Each line of the display represents one UFD The number on the left gives the disk block number and the relative address of the MFD entry in that disk block The characters in the center give the account PPN The number on the right gives the disk block at which the UFD for that account begins Deleted accounts are marked with an asterisk User File Directory Display The display gives the following information about the directory entries Block The disk block number containing the directory entry being displayed Offset The position in bytes of the directory entry relative to the start of the block Displayed in octal or hex Filename The name and extension of the file On traditional format disks 80 indicates the file has been erased Size The number of disk blocks in the file displayed in decimal Active The number of active data bytes in the last block of the file Displayed in octal or hex Link The address of the first disk block of the file Displayed in octal or hex Deleted files are marked with an asterisk System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DUMP Page 4 MESSAGES Cannot open filespec device d
471. n try again Insufficient free memory You do not have enough memory in your partition to run DSKPAK See your System Operator about increasing your memory Privileged program must be logged into OPR Log into account DSKO 1 2 and try again Some blocks are marked in use but not in a file Please run DSKANA immediately After the disk was packed DSKPAK detected a file system problem Prevent other users from accessing the disk and run DSKANA Then run DSKPAK again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DUMP FUNCTION Displays on your terminal the contents of memory random and sequential disk files Master File Directories disk bitmaps user directories or disk blocks CHARACTERISTICS DUMP is re entrant and re usable DUMP accepts different kinds of arguments depending upon the kind of data you want to display Specify numbers in the same number base the system is currently using for displays usually octal All hexadecimal numbers must start with a number or a zero See the SET reference sheet for information on changing the system display base You may abbreviate the DUMP keywords for example BI instead of BITMAP FORMAT There are six different formats for the DUMP command To display memory DUMP start address end address start address is the first address of the memory block you want to display and end address is the last To display a file DUMP filespec filespec is a valid file specification
472. nal to a job logged into an account which no longer exists on the device specified or the default device See what can be done to log the job into another account Bad password You did not specify the correct password Check your spelling and try again 2Nonexistent job You tried to attach a terminal to a job not defined on your system Check your typing or use SYSTAT to see a list of the jobs defined on your system Nonexistent terminal You tried to attach a job to a terminal not defined in a TRMDEF command in your system initialization command file Use the TRMDEF command to see a complete list of all of the terminals defined on your system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BACKUP FUNCTION The BACKUP command copies files from a hard disk drive to the specified backup device along with their disk device and account specifications and the date and time of the backup uv The BACKUP BAKDIR and RESTOR commands are included only for compatibility with earlier operating system versions Do NOT use these commands unless absolutely necessary Use the MTUxxx commands for all tape backup and CRT620 to create warm boot tapes CHARACTERISTICS BACKUP is re entrant and re usable and a wildcard command Files can be copied from any disk account to the backup medium regardless of the account logged into No account passwords are copied You use BACKUP in combination with BAKDIR which displays a directory of files on back
473. nate the sequenc Press whatever single key you want to use to tell FIXTRN you are finished with a definition The most commonly used key for a terminator since you rarely want to include it in a definition is or DELETE As you press the key FIXTRN echoes it or its code to your screen You may NOT use as a terminator any key that sends a two character sequence for example another function key Next FIXTRN asks Enter the key you wish to have translated Press the key you wish to define or re define for example the F1 key If the XLT module in memory already has a definition for the key you just pressed FIXTRN displays the current definition You must enter the characters EXACTLY as you wish them sent EVERY character you enter at this point is part of the key definition This means you can t edit your definition since a or System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 FIXTRN Page 2 CTRLY U is entered as part of the key definition If you make a mistake typing just start again by entering the terminator character and re entering the key to define Once the key is defined to your satisfaction enter the terminator character to end the definition To enter a decimal for a number pressing a numeric key on the keyboard gives an ASCII value press and the underline character followed by and a letter CTRLYA represents an ESC sequence which also equals decimal value one CTRLYB represents decimal 2 ETRLYC
474. nce the last time the log file was cleared Its summary gives the total number of times each event type occurred the average time between system restarts average uptime and the system availability as a percentage of the total time covered by the report Fora complete list of special events which are monitored under AMOS and instructions on setting up event logging see your System Operator s Guide al LOGGER LIT which actually records the error messages will report an error code 99 to S the status display if it cannot record the message because there are not enough queue blocks available If this error tends to reoccur please contact the Alpha Micro Technical Assistance Center FORMAT SYSLOG switch filespec The optional filespec is the specification of the log file for the event logging system The default specification is DSKO SYSLOG SYS 1 2 This should match the file you enter in the LOGGER statement in your system initialization command file Even if you specify a different log file name the output file for SYSLOG is always SYSLOG LST in the account which the user is logged in to OPTIONS IC Clears the log file SYSLOG SYS after producing the report D Adds a second line to the log file which includes diagnostic information The diagnostic information added to the log file is the content of the stack at the time of the event For ease of interpretation ensure your job is set to give hexadecimal output by using the SET
475. ncounters a bad block it tells you so For example Track 79 Head 2 Sector 3 assigned alternat If all sectors on a track are bad CRT415 displays just the track and head numbers on your terminal When it finishes certifying the disk CRT415 tells you how many bad blocks it found System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 CRT415 CRT415 computes and stores a hash total for BADBLK SYS in the file Other programs can check this hash total against the contents of the file to make sure BADBLK SYS contains undamaged data MESSAGES n bad blocks is maximum n is the maximum number of allowable bad blocks for the drive You tried to give a number larger than n Re enter a proper number Cannot certify device name device not mounted Use MOUNT to mount the device and run CRT415 again Cannot certify device name not the physical device The device you specified on the command line was not the first logical device on the physical unit Run CRT415 again using the device specification of the first logical device on the drive Certification aborted Informs you the program was interrupted CRT415 writes a bad hash total to the BADBLK SYS file so other programs know the data in the file is incomplete and should not be trusted Re run CRT415 to provide a good BADBLK SYS file Control C abort Informs you the program was interrupted prior to certification The BADBLK SYS file on the disk remains untouched
476. nd STAT continues to run until you reboot the system OPERATION Enter STAT at AMOS command level For example STAT Status of AMOS Version 2 0 151 on 27 Apr 89 Time 05 00 32 PM Job Term PPN Prog Bytes address CPU Time Status JOB1 TERM1 DSKO0O 200 2 VUE 68122 1572746 00 08 34 4 RN Ti JOB2 TERM2 LOGOFF 68608 430746 00 00 00 0 C Ti TASK MANAGR DSKO 1 2 TSKIDL 8192 222746 00 02 59 9 RN S1 Qfree 109 Up time 52 20 22 Disk queue 0 All of the displays are updated as they change The first item is the job name These jobs are defined in your system initialization command file Next the display shows you which terminal each job is attached to and the account it is logged into if there is no PPN number the terminal is logged off The program the job is executing is displayed next with the number of Bytes in use and the memory address of the program following After that it shows the amount of CPU time the program has used and the status code which shows what phase is currently operating The codes for the Status display are AC Control C job at AMOS command level Cc Control C pending Ew Waiting for external event Fi Waiting in LOKSER queue System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 STAT Page 2 Io TO accessing other than terminal Ms Waiting for ITC message PI Has processor locked Rn Running Si Waiting for software interrupt Sl Sleeping Sp Suspended Sw Semaphore wait Ti Waiting for term
477. nd specification error A filename was not entered on the command line Re enter the line including the name of the file to be sorted Cannot find Sort I O module A file SYS SORSVA SYS was not found SORT LIT requires that file to be accessible Enter A or D Answer A for ascending order or D for descending order Entire key must be within record Either the record size is too small or the key size is too big Re enter the numbers adjusting one or the other Insufficient memory for sort Delete any unnecessary memory modules from your user memory or see your System Operator about increasing your memory System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 SORT Key size must be gt 0 Key size must be less than record size Record size must be gt 0 Enter a correct number Maximum record size is 510 bytes The maximum size of a data record in your file is 510 bytes SORT cannot handle larger record sizes Sort error Device VDKO has overflowed The virtual disk VDKO was used for temporary file storage and that temporary file became too large aborting the COPY Either increase the VDK size or remove the temporary SRT name from your VDK_INI file Using extended collating sequence A message to say that an 8 bit collating sequence has been found in your job s active language definition file That sequence will be used to order data in the file Warning A null byte was encountered in the inpu
478. necessary when SET NOREDIRECTION is in effect otherwise the redirection symbols work with most AMOS commands REDIR is useful in command files when it is not known if redirection is on or off REDIR spawns a slave job to assist with redirection Therefore you may need to increase the JOB settings in your system initialization command file For general characteristics of I O redirection whether you are using the REDIR command or not see Chapter 5 REDIR does not work with all AMOS software Any program that doesn t allow switches before the file specifications will not work with REDIR If you use redirection and the AMOS line editor your TRMDEF statement cannot have buffers larger than 200 bytes or a line editor setting over 20 FORMAT REDIR AMOS command redirection specification AMOS command is an AMOS level command or a CMD or DO file and redirection specification is a directional symbol combined with a destination file specification The directional symbols are gt Send output to the following file gt gt Append output to the end of the following file lt Input the contents of the following file into the AMOS command l Place the output of the following file into the input of the AMOS command Removes terminal dependent escape sequences from the redirected data Must be the first symbol following REDIR on the line Quotes the character following it so it is not interpreted as a command System Commands
479. needed If form is not on notifies operator job File switch HEADER Print a page header at top of each page File switch NOHEADER No page headers Default file switch KILL Stop file from printing Operation switch LPP n Maximum lines per page File switch QUERY Confirm before printing killing a file File switch NOQUERY No confirmation Default file switch WAIT Wait to print if queue is full Ties up terminal Operation switch WIDTH n Page width 1 132 characters File switch OPERATION To find out what is in the print queue PRINT This command lists the contents of the queue for all of the printers defined on the system If you wish to see the contents for a single printer enter PRINT followed by the name of the printer whose queue you want to see and an equal sign The display you see tells you what files are waiting to be printed what form type they are to be printed on how many blocks total are in the queue how many blocks remain for each file how many copies of each file are to be printed and which file is currently being printed It also displays which options have been selected for each file If there are no print requests in the queue you do not see any files listed To send files to the printer with the least number of blocks in its queue or to the default printer set by the System Operator simply enter PRINT followed by the specifications of the files you want to print For example PRINT LST
480. nexistent device Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system Program restricted to use on local system only You can t MOUNT devices on another system over a network Contact someone on the other system to mount the device System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MOUNT Page 4 Unable to load BADBLK SYS from unit DSKO WARNING BADBLK SYS has a bad hash total You tried to mount a Winchester technology drive before mounting DSKO BADBLK SYS is reported to have a bad hash total because the hash total looked at is not from the BADBLK file on DSKO and is thus invalid Mount DSKO and try again 2 WARNING BADBLK SYS has a bad hash total When reading in the alternate track information for a device using alternate tracks MOUNT found the BADBLK SYS file is damaged and doesn t have the correct hash total See your System Operator for help WARNING There are active jobs logged in on the device being mounted Enter a Y when it is OK to mount the device The disk has active users on it Such jobs may include the spooler task manager or other jobs processing background tasks When you are sure none of the jobs are really active users type Y to continue If you don t type Y MOUNT will not mount the disk System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MTBOOT FUNCTION Creates a bootable magnetic tape for use by 1 2 magnetic tape drives CHARACTERISTICS MTBOOT is re entrant and re usable
481. ng devn The device driver for the device you entered does not allow you to set the penalty values You cannot use SETPEN with devices which use this driver System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 SHELL FUNCTION Executes AlphaMENU menu programs Calls up a compiled menu to the screen x For complete information about AlphaMENU please refer to the AlphaMENU User s N gt Manual DSS 10044 00 CHARACTERISTICS SHELL is re entrant and re usable You must have at least 32K of memory in your memory partition to use SHELL Do not try to use SHELL with any file that is not a SHELL command file or you may lock up your terminal FORMAT SHELL filename filename is the specification of the file that contains the menu definition code DEFAULTS The default file specification is DSKO AMOSL CMN 7 11 default extension is CMN OPERATION CALLING THE MENU To bring a menu to the terminal screen log into the account containing the menu and enter the name of the menu you want to use For example SHELL DOC WHAT YOU SEE You will see six boxes some or all containing numbered choices You may depending on what kind of terminal you have see an area highlighted in reverse video display if so this is called the selection marker You will see a question displayed at the bottom of the screen followed by a number System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SHELL Page 2 MAKING A SELECTION There are two differ
482. ng Modifying the bad block list destroys all the data on the physical disk When you add a block to the defect list for a SCSI or AM 520 or AM 522 controlled drive BADBLK tries to salvage the data in the bad block However if the block is unreadable the data will be lost and you must restore the file from a backup After backing up the physical disk if necessary enter the BADBLK command as described above and use the A option In our example using the track cylinder and head numbers A 3 2 EUW System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 BADBLK If you don t have a SCSI AM 520 or AM 522 controlled device you see SWarning This command will destroy all data on disk SType Y if you wish to proceed Proceed Y I When adding or deleting a bad block be sure you enter the block number in the correct Ss radix either octal or hex If you want to delete a bad block follow the same procedure but use the D command You cannot use the D command with a SCSI disk When you use the M command BADBLK reads the disk and creates a BADBLK SYS 1 2 file on it or tells you if one already exists The M command does not work on AM 415 AM 515 AM 520 522 or AM 1000 controlled devices or SCSI disks which maintain the bad block list internally To leave BADBLK type E and press RETURN MESSAGES 2 BADBLK SYS 1 2 does not exist Use the DIR command to search for the file If the file has truly been lost you have to
483. nnot specify MEM as the output device Choose another device and re enter an amended command line Cannot output to device being analyzed Make sure the output file is on another disk Checking disk cache for locked blocks status DSKANA is looking for statically locked blocks in disk cache Status may be e Done DSKANA has saved all statically locked blocks for the device e No disk cache Disk cache does not exist e Error Not enough space to store all locked buffers DSKANA could not save all locked blocks for the device Check the cache manually after DSKANA finishes Device write protected Please unprotect for retry type RETURN when ready Write enable your disk and press RETURN Error reading directory structure A UFD is damaged in some way The analysis will be incomplete Memory allocation failed Analysis terminated Your memory partition is too small for DSKANA to save and restore the disk cache Either run DSKANA from a job with more memory or use the B switch to continue analysis without restoring the cache Memory allocation failed Continuing with analysis Disk cache will not be preserved Same as previous message except you used the B switch DSKANA continues to analyze the disk but any statically locked blocks for the device being analyzed are not restored to the disk cache Memory allocation failed xxx bytes more are needed to analyze device Your job does not have enough memory to stor
484. nsion that many or fewer characters can match the symbols otherwise the number of characters matching these wildcard symbols exactly equals the number of 2s Matches all device names on the system Matches all devices of the same name For example DSK would represent DSK1 DSK2 etc Matches all accounts on the specified device System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Chapter 5 Input Output Redirection Any command in AMOS that allows switches before the file specification can use Input Output Redirection This lets you redirect the input and or output of an AMOS command take input from or send output to a file or another program rather than your terminal In order to use redirection redirection must be on for your job this is the default condition If you use redirection and it does not work use the SET REDIRECTION command see the SET reference sheet You can also use the REDIR command as mentioned below If you use I O redirection with the AMOS line editor your TRMDEF statement cannot have buffers larger than 200 bytes or a line editor setting of more than 20 REDIRECTION SYMBOLS gt Send output to the following file gt gt Append output to the end of the following file lt Input the contents of the following file into the AMOS command l Place the output of the following file into the input of the AMOS command Removes terminal dependent escape sequences from the redirected data Must be the
485. nt and re usable To run FMSFLP you must be logged into the System Operator s Account w To run FMSFLP your computer must support the AM 212 20 floppy disk drive You must have a SCSI dispatcher installed and have an AM 212 20 diskette drive attached to the SCSI bus contained in your computer FMSFLP supports narrow and wide SCSI interfaces The AM SCSI and traditional AMOS format is supported but PC formats are not supported and must be pre formatted on a PC FORMAT FMSFLP If you use the format or initialize option FMSFLP destroys all data on all logical devices on the diskette OPERATION FMSFLP runs in interactive mode FMSFLP displays a list of the removable media SCSI drives on your computer Select the drive you want to use and press RETURN The FMSFLP menu then displays as shown System Commands Reference Manual Rev 09 FMSFLP Page 2 Alpha Micro SCSI Floppy Media Format Utility FMSFLP Version 1 0 100 Selected SCSI ID 05 Vendor TEAC Model FC 1 11 Rev RV J Functions Select Drive Reassign Blocks Rewrite Hidden Sector Format Drive Info List Defects Initialize Drive Mode Sense Logical Format Parameters Media Format AM SCSI HD Directory Type Traditional Usable Capacity Optimize for Capacity Logical Drive Size Number of Logicals Drive Utilization Bitmap S126 oe cs ee tidene eea Select logical drive parameters and press Return to continue or press ESCape to abort
486. nt to see a list of all the files on a tape enter MTUDIR ALL To create a disk file containing the directory display specify a listfile For example MTUDIR ALL DAT MESSAGES All date and time switches must be in absolute format Specify dates and times in absolute not relative format 2A date or a time switch must be specified for all date and time switches MTUDIR could not understand the format of the AFTER or BEFORE switch you entered System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 MTUDIR Bypassing bad directory block MTUDIR did not find the block it expected to during a search The bad block is bypassed and MTUDIR continues to look for a directory block Both the preceding file and the current file are probably corrupt and cannot be successfully restored to disk This is most often caused by backing up a disk which has file errors on it use DSKANA before backing up Cannot read device name explanation MTUDIR is not able to read from the tape unit for the reason given Make sure you specified the correct tape drive and the correct tape is mounted Drive is not on line and at load point Please correct then press RETURN when ready Correct the problem and continue End of reel please mount next tape in save set and press RETURN to continue or press Control C to cancel directory Remove the tape and mount the next reel in the save set More than one output specific
487. nual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 14 Incident Mode Abort Where JOBERR OPT Text Acc Note not supported Tape spanning allowed and T Yes T L S D EFUL needed Tape spanning allowed and 1 C No T 1 needed Tape is not part of save set No T 1 Tape is not part of save set C Yes T L JE MSC 1 4 Tape reel number not in No T 1 sequence Tape reel number not in C Yes T L JE MSC 1 4 sequence Verification Incidents Notes 1 The incident is displayed on the screen and the user resolves it manually 2 The file is checked further MTUSAV does not bypass the rest of the file 3 This setting can also adjust the resulting severity for a verification error 4 This error cannot occur when under the Task Manager 5 Not processed as an incident for files listed in MTUSAV INF still reported 6 This incident is overridden by a directory date changed incident Incident Mode Abort Where JOBERR OPT Text Note CPU exceptions All Yes T S Varies 1 Control C abort during All Yes TL JE CTC Bkup user abort 2 backup Control C abort during All No TL JE CTC Date update user abort directory update Control C abort during All Yes T L JE CTC Verif user abort 2 verification Error writing LOG file All No T JE WRN Error writing LOG General Incidents Notes 1 CPU exceptions address error bus error etc cannot be handled cleanly At best JOBERR is set a message is displayed on the screen and a SYSLOG entry made The system or the job may crash MTUSAV may not re
488. o abort verify A multi reel set was created during the backup The verification phase is starting and you need to load the first reel into the drive System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 25 MTUSAV Reading record without regard to locking which may compromise file integrity While reading a contiguous random file a block was locked by another user MTUSAV saves the block by bypassing the record lock However if the other user was modifying the file this may compromise the data integrity of the tape file Tape contains partially copied files Either an error occurred or you aborted the program with a C while the backup phase was in progress The tape does not contain all the files that match the command line specification The last file transferred to tape may be incomplete Tape directory block not found where expected During verification there is a problem with the file format on the tape At what should have been the directory block for a file on the tape MTUSAV found a different type of block probably a data block At a minimum the previous file is corrupt and possibly the rest of the tape is corrupted as well Verification continues from the start of the next properly detected tape file If you receive this error we strongly recommend you check the disk file structure using DSKANA and clean the tape drive heads The tape may be damaged and need replacing The backup may need to be performed again
489. o need to modify the ISAM statements for AMOS 2 2 unless you want to upgrade to ISAM PLUS as well To convert AlphaBASIC 1 3 files to AlphaBASIC PLUS under 2 0 or 2 1 use the default no switches To go to AMOS 2 2 use the default or KI if old style XLOCK FLOCK file locking exists in the 1 3 program MESSAGES Cannot access input file Check your syntax or use DIR to locate the file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 BASIC FUNCTION Allows you to use the AlphaBASIC language processor in interactive mode CHARACTERISTICS BASIC is re entrant and re usable AlphaBASIC is an easy to learn programming language The BASIC command puts your terminal in AlphaBASIC interactive mode Once in AlphaBASIC you may use the interactive mode commands to load create save and run AlphaBASIC programs For information on writing AlphaBASIC programs or on using either the compiler COMPIL LIT or the runtime package RUN LIT portions of AlphaBASIC separately see your AlphaBASIC User s Manual To exit from AlphaBASIC enter BYE To interrupt the execution of a program press CTALVC OPTIONS A Increases memory allowing larger files to be worked on OPERATION Enter BASIC at AMOS command level BASIC You see a version number and READY which tells you BASIC is working You can either load in a BASIC program for example LOAD PAYROL BAS or begin to create a new program by typing in the progr
490. obname selects the job you want to try to interrupt OPERATION Enter KILL and the name of the job whose program you want to try to stop For example KILL JOB4 MESSAGES No terminal attached to job The job you tried to KILL does not have a terminal attached and so KILL cannot work on it 2Nonexistent job You entered an invalid job name Check your spelling or use the TRMDEF command to see a list of the valid jobs on the system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 LABEL FUNCTION Assigns a descriptive label to a logical unit of a disk and displays disk labels Can also correct a damaged label block CHARACTERISTICS LABEL is re entrant and re usable To create or change a label or correct a damaged label block you must be logged into an operator s account 1 2 You cannot run LABEL across a network The disk you are accessing the label for cannot be on a remote system Changing a logical device s directory format can damage its file structure You should uv use the E and S switches only on a logical device which has had its block 0 label damaged in some way To change the directory structure of a disk you should back up the entire disk use SYSACT to re initialize the disk this erases all data on the disk then restore the files from the backup Disk labels are stored in block zero of the logical device and are used both to allow the operator to easily determine what disk is mounted
491. obytes and megabytes and command is one or more optional commands FORCEd to the job These could be any AMOS command a command file to be executed etc OPERATION Enter SETJOB and the parameters for the job For example SETJOB MARK GOLDEN 150K TIME My The AMOS command s at the end of the SETJOB line cannot include any commas If S they do SETJOB interprets each comma as the end of one command and the beginning of a new one For example do not include an account number in the command since SETJOB interprets the comma between the project and programmer numbers as the end of the command System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SETJOB Page 2 MESSAGES Account not found on login disk for specified job You attempted to attach a terminal to a job logged into an account which no longer exists on the device specified or the default device See what can be done to log the job into another account Bad password You did not specify the correct password Check your spelling and try again Command is not in proper format Correct format is SETJOB jobname terminal memory command command where command is optional SETJOB cannot understand the command line you entered Re enter the command ensuring you have entered the command in the correct format especially the commas Setjob Logged in but Port is Busy Last forced command did not execute For some reason the job you were setting up could not respond to all
492. ocated to it or you will run into the same kind of problem FORMAT MEMORY memory allocation K M memory allocation is the amount of memory in bytes you want to allocate to your job If you include a K after the amount MEMORY will multiply the amount specified by 1024 1 Kilobyte If you include an M after the amount MEMORY will multiply the amount by 1048576 1 Megabyte If you use both K and M on the same command line MEMORY will use whichever comes first and ignore the other OPERATION To see how much memory has been allocated to your job enter MEMORY at AMOS command level For example MEMORY Current memory is 231148 bytes To allocate memory to your job enter MEMORY followed by the amount of memory you want to allocate to yourself For example MEMORY 32K 32768 bytes assigned You may not increase your memory allocation beyond its current amount unless you first use the MEMORY 0 command If you allocate MEMORY 0 to your job AMOS will re assign as much System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MEMORY Page 2 free memory to you as it has available for user partitions as soon as you run a command or program MESSAGES Insufficient memory for program load The memory assigned to your job is not enough to load the program you tried to run If you have enough memory to run MEMORY try to add more memory to your job If you do not have enough memory to run MEMORY you will have to re boot your system The
493. oes not exist The system does not understand your device specification Check your spelling and try again Cannot open filespec disk not mounted Use the MOUNT command to mount the device and try again Cannot open filespec file not found Check your syntax or use DIR to find the file Cannot open filespec invalid filename Check your syntax and try again Cannot perform specified operation device is not file structured The device you specified is not a file structured device Choose another device name and re enter an amended command line Command format error Make sure you have followed the proper DUMP format for what you wanted to do File specification error Check the FORMAT section above for information on the valid formats of the DUMP command and try again PPN does not exist DUMP was not able to find the account on the device you specified ina DUMP UFD command Make sure the account exists on that device and check your syntax System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DVD FUNCTION Makes the logical devices on an AMOS DVD accessible without being defined in a DEVTBL statement in your system initialization command file CHARACTERISTICS DVD is re entrant and re usable For more information about using AlphaDVD see the Alpha DVD RAM Installation Instructions which comes with AlphaDVD FORMAT DVD Options OPTIONS HELP Display HELP Same as HELP IV Display version information
494. of memory for each statically locked block in cache regardless of its device If you do not have enough memory in your partition you will receive an error message as listed below and DSKANA will terminate If you use the B switch running out of memory for the cache will still display an error message but DSKANA will continue Any statically locked blocks for the device you re analyzing will not be restored to the cache MESSAGES Besides the errors listed below you may see the standard system error messages dealing with invalid device specifications Allocating memory for cached disk blocks status DSKANA is storing statically locked disk blocks Status may be e xxx bytes xxx is the number of bytes used to store the cached blocks e No disk cache Disk cache doesn t exist e Insufficient memory Your job doesn t have enough memory to store the cache Increase memory and try again BITMAP on disk had a bad hash total The bitmap DSKANA just calculated disagreed with the system bitmap Unless you used C DSKANA re writes the corrected bitmap anyway so this is usually not a problem If this occurs frequently it could indicate a disk problem Bitmap size is 0 not mounted or driver not in RES Either the device could not be mounted or the disk driver is not loaded into system memory Correct the error and retry System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DSKANA Page 4 Cannot output list file to memory You ca
495. of the high data density of the disks that run with the AM 410 Phoenix disks media flaws are a more likely possibility than on more conventional drives for example Winchester disks Therefore you must run CRT410 on each logical device of every disk controlled by an AM 410 before using that device CRT410 runs only under the AMOS L operating system You may use it ONLY on devices o controlled by an AM 410 CRT410 communicates directly with the AM 410 without going through the 410DVR DVR driver program Therefore you MUST NOT run CRT410 at the same time as other programs that access devices under control of the AM 410 CRT410 will also lock up or severly slow down all other users on your system warn them before using this command CRT410 formats and certifies a logical device by writing and verifying data in every block of the device so make sure you back up any data you need on that device before you certify it Because CRT410 destroys any data on the disk it is certifying CRT410 requires you be logged into the System Operator s account DSKO 1 2 before certifying a disk CRT410 creates account 1 2 on the disk you are certifying Then it creates a file BADBLK SYS 1 2 containing a list of all bad disk tracks on the certified device CRT410 assigns alternate tracks for these bad tracks thereby making the fact some tracks are bad completely transparent to the user of the device For more information see the BADBLK reference sheet
496. of the program you patched MESSAGES Assembly errors exist in patch file The patch file contained errors If you typed in the patch file from a written record make sure you entered the patch information correctly If the patch file came from Alpha Micro see your representative for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 PATCH Page 2 Bad object format The data in the patch object OBJ file has been damaged Make sure you entered the patch information correctly in the patch file Expression error in patch file The patch file contains errors Make sure you entered the patch file correctly Your patch file may have tried to reference an external symbol within an expression Fatal error Overlays of code are not permitted The changes within a patch file must occur in sequential order make sure you entered the patch information correctly in the patch file File being patched has wrong hash code The file you want to patch doesn t have the same hash total the patch program was designed for see if you are patching the correct file there may be another version of the program on your system elsewhere or see your Alpha Micro representative to get the proper patch version File being patched has wrong version The file you want to patch doesn t have the same hash total the patch program was designed for see if you are patching the correct file there may be another version of the program on your system elsewhere
497. of valid devices and try again Cannot READ device name device is not mounted Mount your device and try again FILTAP does not support extended directories use MTUSAV instead Move the required files to a logical drive with a traditional format directory structure or use the MTUSAV program No file oriented device corresponding to device name is mounted Check your syntax and try again or mount the device System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 FILTAP Program is not supported FILTAP will not work under this version of AMOS Tape is full please mount another tape then type RETURN to continue or type Control C to abort copy There is no more room on the current reel of tape Mount another reel and press to continue the backup process or press CTRLYC to abort the backup System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIX FUNCTION Executes and symbolically debugs an assembly language program and data structures in a controlled manner CHARACTERISTICS FIX is a screen oriented debugger similar in operation to AlphaVUE It has two modes Display Mode and Command Mode In Display Mode you can examine your program and data areas and you may single step through portions of the program In Command Mode you may examine and modify registers examine data structures and set up the debugging environment You may switch between the two FIX modes by pressing ESC Both input and output values may be eith
498. oks first in DSKO 1 4 if the file is not there it looks next in the device and account you are logged into CRT620 then asks you for information it will place in the cassette label Volume name maximum of 40 characters Volume ID maximum of ten characters Installation maximum of 30 characters System maximum of 30 characters and Creator maximum of 30 characters The streamer is activated and the file transfer occurs Use CRT620 C to check the tape Perform a test warm boot to make sure it works write protect the tape label it and return it to its storage location HOW TO VERIFY A CARTRIDGE V Load a blank or scratch cartridge into your streamer unit Type CRT620 v RETURN CRT620 rewinds the tape and then erases it The writing of data to the tape will take a few minutes During the operation CRT620 prints statistics on the screen and updates them every 1024 blocks CRT620 then rewinds the cartridge and begins reading the tape and prints the statistics on the screen System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 CRT620 Blocks Read is the number of unique blocks of data read from the tape Soft Errors is the number of times a block had to be re read Hard Errors is the number of data blocks which could not be read after 16 tries A non zero number of hard errors is unacceptable because it means you have lost data Although soft errors do not necessarily mean trouble a large number of soft errors per number of b
499. omma introduces a pause into the dialing and a W causes the dialing to wait for a second dialtone before proceeding Common values for this argument are 9 and 9W MESSAGES Busy The Observatory clock is busy Try again later No answer The Observatory clock did not answer the phone Make sure you have specified any necessary outside line access prefixes or try again later No carrier The Observatory clock answered the phone but did not handshake with your modem Make sure you have specified any necessary outside line access prefixes or try again later No dialtone The modem could not get a dialtone on your phone line Make sure you have specified any necessary outside line access prefixes System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VCRDIR FUNCTION Displays a list of the files on a video tape cassette Can also create a disk file containing the video tape directory CHARACTERISTICS VCRDIR is re entrant and re usable The video tape read by VCRDIR must previously have been written by VCRSAV Used in combination with VCRSAV to write files to video cassette tape and VCRRES to copy files from video cassette to disk This program is provided for compatibility for tapes created by VCRSAV If your VCR tape was created using the BACKUP program use BAKDIR to see a directory If your system contains both traditional format and extended disks you must be logged onto the same type of disk when you use VCRDIR that you were when
500. on That reference sheet also includes a list of messages you may get when using redirection The REDIR command forces redirection if NOREDIRECTION has been set for your job w System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Chapter 6 System Commands List by Function The rest of this manual consists of reference sheets explaining the use of each system command We have organized these sheets alphabetically to help you find them quickly Below is an alphabetically ordered list of all AMOS commands We also provide a functional summary of the AMOS commands so if you are not familiar with the name of a specific command but know its function you will be able to find it AlphaTCP commands do not have reference sheets in this manual and are not included in the lists in this chapter For information on AlphaTCP commands please see the AlphaTCP User s Guide and the AlphaTCP Administrator s Guide Commands marked with an asterisk in the list are included for compatibility with older software only we recommend you do NOT use them ALPHABETIC LIST OF AMOS COMMANDS ACD ADJIT AGREP AMSCFG APPEND ASCDMP ATTACH BACKUP BADBLK BAKDIR BASBP BASIC BASICP BASICX BATCH BAUD BDRES BITMAP CACHE CAL100 CBDS CBEN CDIR CLEAR CMP COMPAT COMPIL COMPLP CONT COPY CPMCPY CPMDIR CREATE CRT410 CRT415 CRT420 CRT520 CRT610 CRT620 CTYPE DATE DB DBD DEL DEVTBL DING DIR DIRBD DIRSEQ DO DOSDEL DOSDR DOSEXP DOSIMP DOSMKD DOSRMD DOSTYP DSKANA DSKCPY DSKDDT
501. onto the video cassette and switch is an option request DEFAULTS The default file specification is and the account and device you are logged into Default switches are NOQUERY and NOHASH If you do not use COPIES VCRSAV makes five copies of each data block OPTIONS All switches can be abbreviated to any unique letter combination BOOT Create a warm boot cassette operation switch COPIES n Copy n extra copies of each data block Default is 0 operation switch If you use C with T n must be 20 or more HASH Calculate a hash total file switch NOHASH Don t calculate hash default file switch QUERY Confirm before selecting files file switch NOQUERY Don t confirm copy default file switch SUPPRESS Suppresses the listing of the files selected TRANSFER Copy without locking users out Operation switch Saves 20 copies unless C used WAIT nn nn AM PM Gives time for backup to begin standard or military format Locks up terminal until specified time Using TRANSFER means you share CPU time with other users while backing up files If your system is heavily used while you are creating a backup tape this could affect your ability to restore the files from the tape later What constitutes heavy use depends on the particular system OPERATION Enter VCRSAV and the files you want to save For example VCRSAV MEMO TXT SCHDLE TXT 310 2 or using WAIT VCRSAV W 2 08 AM MEMO TXT SCHDLE TXT 310
502. oose the device you wish to use for recording Scanning the SCSI bus will find CDROM devices as well as CD recording devices ww System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MAKACD Page 4 After entering the MAKACD command the following will be displayed MAKACD Version X X xxx Copyright C 1999 Alpha Microsystems Inc Initializing SCSI CD Recorder If MAKACD finds multiple possible CD recorders including CDROM drives while scanning the SCSI bus the following message will be displayed to allow you to select the drive to use Found the following possible CD Recorders ID Description al nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX 2 nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX Select one of the above devices Additional information about the CD recorder driver and media is then displayed Using Generic SCSI MMC CDR driver CDRMMC CD Recorder located at SCSI id 5 A blank CD is in the CD Recorder MAKACD then asks for an optional title for the CD The title may be up to 60 characters long You may enter an optional title for the CD or press RETURN for none Title Next MAKACD asks for the AMOS logical drives to copy to the CD as follows Enter the list of disk devices to transfer onto the CD Recordable disk Devices may be entered as a range ex dev0 20 for dev0 through dev20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line Enter the logical drives to be copied and then just a retur
503. open files v If your System Disk DSKO is a Winchester technology disk you must never use You cannot use MOUNT across a network to mount or unmount a disk on a remote system System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MOUNT Page 2 FORMAT MOUNT devn switch devn is the specification of the device you want to mount and switch is an option If you don t include a device specification MOUNT displays a list of all of the disks mounted on the system OPTIONS The switches are operation switches and may be abbreviated BUFFEREDWRITES Mounts an AMS format diskette with buffered writes enabled UNMOUNT Unmounts and sequences down the specified disk WAIT Waits until the device is ready before mounting OPERATION To mount a disk enter MOUNT followed by a device specification For example MOUNT DSK1 If the disk has a label MOUNT lists the Volume Name and Volume ID of the disk mounted so you can verify you have mounted the proper disk If you want to mount a disk but you know the device containing the disk is not yet ready use the W switch This ties up your terminal until the device is ready To mount all the logical devices of a physical disk use the three letter name of the drive as the device name without a unit number For example MOUNT DSK This mounts all logical devices on the DSK physical device You can use this format only with SCSI drives If you want to unmount a disk enter MOUNT the dev
504. oppy disk whether or not the account is within the project you are logged into WINFLP does not transfer any account password FORMAT WINFLP filespec switch filespec s switch filespec is a file you want to copy to a floppy disk and switch is an option request The default file specification is and the account and device you are logged into The default floppy drive device specification is DDAO OPTIONS All switches are file switches and may be abbreviated Placing NO before a switch turns it off APPEND Append files at end of existing files Default QUERY Confirm before copying files File switch OPERATION Enter WINFLP and the files you need For example WINFLP MEMO TXT SCHDLE TXT 310 2 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 WINFLP Page 2 WINFLP asks you to enter the backup device enter the device code and unit number of the floppy disk drive When you use Q WINFLP asks you to confirm the files before the transfer Enter Y for yes or N for no You do not need to press RETURN For example WINFLP Q BAS Enter backup device DDAO LSTSQR BAS to DDAO LSTSQR BAS Y NEW BAS to DDAO NEW BAS N You may press CTRLYC at any time to prevent further transfers MESSAGES Cannot find DSKO SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS WINEFLP needs this file to process wildcards in file specifications Use DIR to find the file or get help from your System Operator
505. or control file MTUSAV aborts the entire command or control file and writes the reason to the LOG file the screen for command files and usually SYSLOG SYS If a condition requires user interaction such as changing a tape a control file aborts while a command file waits forever for the action In either of these situations any actions after the MTUSAV are not performed SOFTABORT and TIMEOUT let you change this behavior to give both MTUSAV and the other procedures in your command or control file a better chance of completing successfully e The SOFTABORT switch prevents an error from aborting MTUSAV Instead MTUSAV shuts down cleanly including swallowing any unused command lines for tape unit number device name and tape label information signals the error via reports and JOBERR and continues with the rest of the file If the error occurs during a backup and a verification was requested the verification is not performed e The TIMEOUT n switch causes MTUSAV to wait n minutes for user response if a situation occurs which needs it For example in a command file changing tapes or correcting a tape drive condition requires an action then an entry from the keyboard System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 7 MTUSAV Without TIMEOUT MTUSAV waits forever for this keyboard entry If you use TIMEOUT MTUSAV waits for the time you specify then if there has been no response MTUSAV aborts and if you ve used the SOF
506. or example DOSRMD LFDO DBASE TUTORIAL DOSRMD then removes the directory MESSAGES Directory not empty Remove or re locate the files and try again Directory not found Check your syntax and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DOSRMD Page 2 Invalid directory name Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again Invalid path specified Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again This is not a supported MS DOS format Sorry but can t be decoded Your floppy diskette is in a format DOSRMD can t read System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DOSTYP FUNCTION Types a file from an MS DOS formatted diskette on your terminal screen CHARACTERISTICS DOSTYP is re entrant re usable and works with these diskette formats 5 4 360K 3 1 44M To use this command you must have a proper disk driver program for your computer s type of floppy disk and defined as MS DOS format when created by FIXFLP The device must be defined in BITMAP and DEVTBL statements in your system initialization command file you may want to load the driver into system memory See your system operator for help FORMAT DOSTYP devn DOS filespec devn is the diskette device and DOS filespec is the file you want to display OPERATION Enter DOSTYP and the device file specification you want For example DOSTYP LFDO DBASE TUTORIAL READ ME DOSTYP then display
507. or the job name the file ID and the record number Unlock a Stream for a User Unlocks a specific stream ina USAM file LOKUTL asks you the job name the file ID the starting byte position the stream length and whether or not it is locked exclusively List data base sorted by User ID Displays the currently active jobs on your system and the files they are using This display is the same as when you use LOKUTL from normal accounts System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 LOKUTL W Wake up a user Wakes up a job waiting for a file or record Can also wake up a job trapped in a deadlock X Enable Diagnostic Messages Causes diagnostic messages to appear on your terminal whenever a program tries to execute a conflicting instruction The messages are 3File not OPEN and File already OPEN You probably want to use these two messages only when debugging a program Y Disable Diagnostic Messages Turns off the diagnostic messages MESSAGES File in use Try again later File not found Use DIR to list files and try again File specification error Check your syntax or use DIR to see files and try again Insufficient queue blocks See your System Operator about increasing system queue blocks Invalid argument Check your syntax and try again Invalid job name Use SYSTAT to see the jobnames on your system and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MAKACD FUNCTION Copies one or more AM
508. ory entry as correct A file that is too short is padded to the correct size on the tape with null bytes at the end A file that is too long is truncated on the tape In both cases the disk files and directory entries are not altered Data integrity has been compromised and remedial disk management work is required 10 The incident is displayed on the screen and the user resolves it manually 11 Not processed as an incident for files listed in MTUSAV INF still reported Incident Mode Abort Where JOBERR OPT Text Acc Note Tape file does not match All No TLS Seq file verif error disk file Contig file verif error Yes 5 6 Error reading or writing All No TL Error reading VER VER file Error writing VER Tape label not found All Yes T L S JE MSC Tape label found in wrong All Yes T L S JE MSC place Tape directory block not All No TLS Tape dir block not Yes found found Sequence number error All No T L S JE MSC Sequential file no longer All No T L S Verif seq file not Yes 5 exists found Contiguous file no longer All No T L S Verif contig file not Yes 5 exists found Sequential file in use All No T L S Verif seq file in use Yes 5 Error reading disk file All No T L S Verif seq file read error Verif contig file read error Yes File protection changed All No T L S Verif file protection Yes 2 changed Directory dates changed All No T L S Verif dir date changed 3 Tape spanning needed but A Yes T L S JE MSC System Commands Reference Ma
509. ot support this feature Initialize Drive Same as the format option described above except that it doesn t format the drive before writing the logical drive information If the drive s formatting is OK use this option instead of format This will save you time System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 FMTDVD Page 4 Mode Sense Retrieves mode sense information from the drive You can view these values e Current Values control the current operation of the drive e Changeable Values indicate which bytes bits are changeable e Saved Values control the current operation of the drive unless they are changed by a Mode Selected command e Default Values used by the drive if current values have not been set or the drive is unable to access its saved values The information you requested is displayed within a scrollable window Use LU and WJ to view the information Press when you are done ERROR MESSAGES Can t specify bitmap size with optimization enabled Don t specify a bitmap size or turn optimization OFF Logical format exceeds usable drive capacity You specified a logical drive count and bitmap size that exceeds the capacity of the drive Specify a smaller number of logical drives and or bitmap size Logical format MUST be completely specified When optimization is disabled you must specify both the number of logical drives to create and the bitmap size Program requires AMOS 32 execution FMT
510. otup time and by other products as they initialize AMSCFG sends a report of the system configuration either to the screen or a disk file You can control the level of detail in the report by using command line switches The disk file is a standard ASCII sequential file which you can view by using programs such as TYPE VUE or XED AMSCFG is an unsupported product from Alpha Microsystems It is supplied as is without any warranty FORMAT AMSCFG switch switch switch is an option request DEFAULTS AMSCFG defaults to continuous screen output and summary information on each section reported with no system resident or installed program information OPTIONS A D DS DF DL F fname H text Report on AlphaBASE job usage if any Display disk information Same as DF Do not report on each logical unit individually Summarize information by physical unit only Output full device information per logical unit together with a summary per physical unit Output disk label information as well Forces DF Output the report to a file named fname Unless you also use the K switch if the file already exists it is not overwitten and the program aborts Default extension is CFG Output text as a header at the top of each printed page Ignored for screen output System Commands Reference Manual Rev 06 AMSCFG H IDV I fname IP fname J K Lin Page 2 Prompt for the printed page header sepa
511. ou must be logged into an operator s account 1 2 to run SYSACT If a disk has never been used before you may need to prepare it before you can use SYSACT on that disk All disks received from Alpha Micro are pre certified for you w See your System Operator s Guide for information on what type of disks should be formatted or certified and for instructions on when and how to certify a disk Always use SYSACT to initialize a disk after you format it Initializing a disk erases all data on it Certified disks do not need to be initialized however if you want to delete all data from a logical device of a disk that has been certified you may do so by initializing the device Initializing a floppy diskette disables buffered writes if the diskette was mounted with B see the MOUNT reference sheet SYSACT does not erase the BADBLK SYS file from the first logical device of any physical drive This file contains the bad block information for the entire physical drive SYSACT erases BADBLK SYS from logical devices which are not the first device on their physical drive After the device has been formatted and initialized or certified use SYSACT to add accounts to the disk When adding accounts remember the project programmer numbers are in octal the project number may range from 1 to 377 the programmer number may range from 0 to 377 You cannot use account 377 377 it is reserved for special use The numbers are separated by a comma
512. our CP M Installation Instruction and User s Guide and the CP M Operating System Manual FORMAT CPMCPY AMOS file CPM file switch AMOS file is the AMOS file you want to create and CPM file is the CP M file you want to copy A switch is an option request The default extension for the AMOS file is CPM OPTIONS B Use if the file being copied contains binary data OPERATION Enter CPMCPY the AMOS file an equal sign and the CP M file For example CPMCPY DSK1 FORMS CPM A FORMS ASM System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CPMCPY Page 2 MESSAGES Account does not exist x x Check your syntax find the correct account or create the account you need Cannot DELETE filename file may not be deleted You cannot copy over the filename in memory because it is locked by the system Use the LOKUTL program to erase the old module and add the new file Cannot find DSKO CMDLIN SYS 1 4 The program needs this file to process wildcard symbols Make sure CMDLIN SYS is in DSKO 1 4 f it is you did not have enough memory to load it in your partition If so DELete unneeded files to increase your memory CPM file not found in directory search Check your syntax and or use CPMDIR to locate the file then try again Device Error The device driver for the device you specified as a peripheral is not loaded into system memory so AMOS can t access it See your System Operator about defining the device to th
513. ous filename of the file on which it is reporting If non Alpha Microsystems products are used in the running system AMSCFG may not report correct information Alpha Microsystems does not support AMSCFG in such circumstances MESSAGES Bad include filename or out of memory AMSCFG could not read the include file specified by the I or IP command Either the file does not exist or you do not have enough memory in your partition Cannot find file lt name gt AMSCFG cannot locate a file you requested be appended to the report with the I or IP switch Re enter the command line System Commands Reference Manual Rev 06 Page 5 AMSCFG Cannot INIT buffer cannot read file AMSCFG cannot process a file Try increasing your memory allocation and rerunning AMSCFG Cannot read file any further AMSCFG had a problem reading a file Usually this means there is a device error on the disk Contact your System Operator Could not hash file AMSCFG could not produce a hash total for this file Either you have run out of memory or there is a problem reading the file from the disk Contact your System Operator for assistance filename is a contiguous file Cannot include AMSCFG can print only sequential files Illegal switch settings One of the switches you used had an invalid option setting Check the command line and try again Illegal value in date format setting The LDF n value is invalid Enter a value of 0 2
514. owing message will be displayed to allow you to select the drive to use Found the following possible DBD Recorders ID Description Tes nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX Bs nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX Select one of the above devices More information about the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive driver and media contents is displayed DVD RAM BLU RAY drive found at SCSI id 4 Logical Type S Standard E Extended SSteses SESER B L 0 C K 4 4 BITMAP SECTOR OFFSET DEV D SAU MS oS Total lt Used Free words BOLE Sei SOLS SPEC gt a oE A a a n a io E eoar a aO i DBD000 307200 20929 286272 9200 0 0 blk REX000 E AM 8000 8 0 Release amp Static Files DBDOO1 307200 216928 90272 9200 1470 3 blk REX001 E AM 8000 8 0 Build amp Source Files DBDO02 307200 2617 304583 9200 E849 2 blk REX002 E AM 8000 EAMOS Release 20205 DBDO03 307200 36155 271045 9200 EAD8 2 blk REX003 E CD AMOS Release 01 31 2006 DBD004 307200 63972 243228 9200 10E28 0 blk REX004 E AlphaTCP 1 5A Source amp Release DBDOOS5 307200 7085 300115 9200 14CA1 3 blk REX005 E AlphaNET 2 4 159 4 Rel amp Src DBDO06 307200 57016 250184 9200 1538D 3 blk REX006 E AlphaFAX 2 1 100 1 Rel amp Src DBD007 307200 17996 289204 9200 18B3C 2 blk REX007 E MULTI 2 1 192 10 rEL amp SRC DBD008 307200 40664 266536 9200 19CDO 1 blk REX008
515. p pn Lat TEXT KEY CTRL o Chapter One MEANING Device Name The dev is the three letter physical device code and the n is the logical unit number Examples of device names are DSKO DSK5 WIN1 and MTUO0 Usually device names indicate disk drives but they can also refer to magnetic tape drives and video cassette recorders File Specification A file specification identifies a specific file within an account A complete filespec is made up of the devn the filename the file extension and the project programmer number For example devn filename ext p pn or DSKO SYSTEM INI 1 4 This abbreviation represents an account on a disk you can store files and data in An actual disk account number looks like this 100 2 or 1 4 Disk account specifications are sometimes referred to as Project programmer numbers Braces are used in some examples to indicate optional elements of a command line In the example DIR switch the braces tell you switch is not a required portion of the DIR command line The slash symbol precedes a command line switch or option request For example DIR WIDE 3 This command requests a directory display of the disk account you are currently logged into The switch WIDE 3 indicates you want the display to be three columns wide Bold text in an example of user computer communication represents the characters you type Text like this in
516. partition MEM 6 Look for RECALL CMD in DSKO 2 2 7 Look for RECALL LIT in current account 8 Look for RECALL CMD in current account 9 Look for RECALL LIT in user s project library account 10 Look for RECALL CMD in user s project library account 11 Look for RECALL DO in user s memory partition MEM 12 Look for RECALL DO in current account 13 Look for RECALL DO in user s project library account 14 Look for RECALL DO in DSKO 2 2 At the end of its search if it still has not found the file AMOS echoes the command back to you enclosed in question marks System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 2 2 Chapter 2 COMMANDS TO BE USED WITH CAUTION This section is a quick reference to those commands you should use with caution Some of these commands can destroy the contents of your disk if used improperly Others can bring other users on your system to a halt or must only be used under certain conditions See the particular reference sheet for more information Commands That Can Destroy Disk Contents The following commands may wipe out some or all of your data if used improperly BADBLK BDRESCLEAR CRT415 CRT420 DSKANA DSKCPY DVDRES FIXLOG FMTFLP FMTSCZ FMTFLP FMTSCZ QDT RESTOR CLEAR CRT410 CRT520 DIRSEQ DSKDDT DSKPAK FMSFLP FMTDVD FMTS2 FMT210 MOUNT FMTS2 FMT210 MOUNT SYSACT VCRRES XMOUNT System Operator Commands You must be logged into the System Operator s account DSKO 1 2 to run the
517. pe had been erased by the time MTUSAV tried to verify it from tape Verif contig file not exist Warning A contiguous file that was present when the backup 7 was made and copied to tape had been erased by the time MTUSAV tried to verify it from tape Verif seq file in use Note A sequential file present and copied to tape was in 7 use when MTUSAV tried to verify it The file cannot be checked Verif seq file read error Error MTUSAV could not read a disk block from a sequential file The file cannot be verified further Remedial disk housekeeping is necessary Verif contig file read error Error MTUSAV could not read a disk block from a contiguous file The file cannot be verified further Remedial disk housekeeping is necessary Verif file protection changed Note AMOS 2 x only The file protection for the disk file has 8 changed since the backup was made Verif dir date changed Note The date of creation or last modification has changed 9 between the time of backing up the disk file to the time of verifying the file Verif file known Note The file is listed in MTUSAV INF If the incident is one of those listed for MTUSAV INF use this severity Problem During Directory Date Updating Dir date update failed Warning The date of last update in all the files listed in the MTUSAV TOC file could not be updated Accumulation of Errors Max read errors 5 Maximum number of disk read incidents before triggering an error Max bum block count count 2
518. pe devices you want to use must also be in system memory Enter only one program name at a time To stop loading press only For example Program to load VCR DVR 1 6 Program to load CMDLIN SYS Program to load MTURES Program to load SYSMSG USA Program to load You may enter only the program name if you wish The rest of the program specification defaults to DSKO filename LIT 1 4 Alpha Micro systems prior to AM 1500 series systems may have a size limit of 64K for a warm boot monitor Consider this when defining programs if you have such a system Now you will be asked to enter the names of the programs to be pre loaded into the User Partition As before enter only one program name at a time and enter a blank line to stop The same defaults apply System Commands Reference Manual Rev 09 WRMGEN Page 4 After you have transferred the warm boot monitor file to your backup media remember to label the container with the various programs you included in the monitor file so you will know which programs you can use when you perform a warm boot MESSAGES Cannot open filespec file not found Check your syntax or use DIR to locate the file and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 09 XED FUNCTION Creates and edits text files especially program files CHARACTERISTICS AlphaXED is re entrant and re usable AlphaXED is a screen oriented text editor designed especially for writing program code You s
519. phanumeric characters You can change a password to no password by pressing in response to the new password question Deletes account p pn You can t delete an account with files in it Returns you to AMOS command level You may also exit by pressing CTRLYC Displays a list of all SYSACT commands Initializes the entire disk Erases all data on the disk by zeroing out the MFD It also initializes the bitmap It saves the BADBLK SYS file if that file exists SYSACT asks you to confirm this command before it initializes the disk If you enter Y SYSACT continues On AMOS 2 0 and later systems SYSACT prompts Create extended directory structure If you want the disk to use extended directories and larger files enter Y If you don t enter N If you just press RETURN it defaults to extended directories Displays a list of all of the accounts in the MFD and any associated passwords For example L T2 SYSOP 200 1 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 SYSACT MESSAGES Account already exists Use the L command to see what accounts are on the disk Account does not exist You tried to change the password of an account or tried to delete a non existent account Use the L command to see a list of all accounts on the disk Account has files on it If you want to delete the account exit SYSACT log into the account you want to delete and move or erase all files Run SYSACT again to delete the account Damaged MFD The
520. port any error and under AMOS 2 x may leave a zero block MTUSAV LOG file on disk Other temporary files may also be present 2 A Control C while MTUSAV is listing the TOC or VER file is handled separately outside the scope of user defined severity Such a Control C stops further listing of the file and continues processing A Control C at other times follows the severity procedures outlined earlier System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 15 MTUSAV Omitting Files from Error Checking the MTUSAV INF File Under previous versions of MTUSAV backing up certain files would always or almost always cause errors Examples include the MAL QUE files that AlphaMAIL always has open and NETLOG LST that AlphaTCP always keeps open This complicated meaningful error reporting and handling MTUSAV now lets you list files for which certain incidents should not be considered problems The incidents are still reported to the screen and MTUSAV LOG but they are not considered for JOBERR processing and do not contribute toward any incident accumulation as discussed below To enable this special handling you create a file called MTUSAV_INF listing the files to be ignored by the error handler If MTUSAV encounters one of the incidents listed below while processing a file listed in MTUSAV INF it assigns the incident the severity given in the Bkup file known or Verif file known entry in MTUSAV OPT or a Note severity if
521. procedure but enter this command FWUPD DVR TSCZ1 MESSAGES Can t locate specified firmware file Check to make sure you typed the firmware file name correctly and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FWUPD Page 2 2FWUPD is for use with non disk devices only Check your device specification you cannot use FWUPD on a disk device Invalid device specification The device you entered does not exist Check your spelling and try again Privileged program must be logged into OPR You must be logged into the System Operator s account DSKO 1 2 to use FWUPD System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 GETVER FUNCTION Extracts version data from AlphaBASIC AlphaBASIC PLUS AlphaC and M68 program source files CHARACTERISTICS GETVER is an OS Exec program that may be used as an AMOS command Multiple files may be processed using the Get Source Version function of OS Exec If the source file does not have a recognizable extension the file is processed as if it were an M68 file FORMAT GETVER filespec switches GETVER assumes an extension of M68 OPTIONS Ln Specifies the number of lines to search in the source file for the version information default is 500 OPERATION Enter GETVER and by the specification of the file For example GETVER TRANS M68 GETVER then displays the current version data from the source file For example 4 3 453 MESSAGES Invalid switch ignored
522. process FIX420 asks you to specify the subsystem Enter the AM 1001 controller address 1 2 or 3 for the subsystem you wish to create a driver for FIX420 continues by asking for the new driver name Each driver must have a unique three character name After you have finished entering the information above FIX420 configures the driver and displays the bitmap size Write this number down you will need it when you modify your system initialization command file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 FIX 420 Page 2 Although the new driver is in memory it is not yet a file on the disk Save it to the disk by using the SAVE command For example SAVE PLD DVR RETUAN If you are adding a new device to the system remember to modify the system initialization command file to change the system device table and bitmap areas See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File MESSAGES Could not find filename FIX420 couldn t find the necessary file You must have the proper driver program in DSKO 1 6 Use DIR to see what drivers are available in 1 6 and see your Alpha Micro representative if you need one you don t have Invalid device You have a bad version of your driver program in DSKO 1 6 See your Alpha Micro representative for help Invalid response Check your typing and enter a valid response You must be logged into PPN 1 6 to modify the driver Log into DSKO 1 6
523. quence the directories for all accounts on that disk by using wildcards You may also specify accounts or use ersatz names For example DIRSEQ DSK2 DIRSEQ DSK2 12 35 DIRSEQ BAS If there is an error during sequencing the erroneous PPN is skipped and sequencing continues When all PPNs are done those PPNs not sequenced are listed MESSAGES Cannot INIT device device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of the valid system devices Cannot READ device disk is not mounted Use the MOUNT command to mount the logical device and try again Command error To use DIRSEQ enter Your command syntax was in error Re enter using the guidelines given File in use A file is being used by another job and will not be sequenced though other files will be sequenced as normal Insufficient free memory to sequence PPN There is not enough room in your memory partition to sort all the files in the account Either increase the size of your memory partition or divide the files among two or more accounts You must be logged into PPN 1 2 to sequence other directories Log into 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 DO FUNCTION Executes DO files CHARACTERISTICS DO is re entrant and re usable A DO file is a special extended type of command file For information on command and DO files see your Command File User s Manual Briefly a command file is a text file conta
524. queue block entries allocated by the QUEUE command in your system initialization file and reboot the system Using AM PC CD ROM interface ACD found and is using an ACD line in the AMPC_INI file You must install a SCSI dispatcher prior to using this program If your system uses the SCSI 2 or Wide SCSI 2 bus you must install a SCSI dispatcher to use ACD System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 ADJIT FUNCTION Displays and changes the values in the dynamic job scheduling priority table CHARACTERISTICS When dynamic job scheduling is on the length of the time slice given to each job varies continually based on the number of jobs currently in the run queue The dynamic job scheduling priority table sets the length of the time slice each job receives depending on the number of jobs in the queue ADJIT displays the priority table and lets you change the time slice length for any queue size The priority values take effect only when dynamic job scheduling is on You can turn dynamic job scheduling on and off using the SET command OPERATION To see the dynamic job scheduling priority table type ADJIT This shows in columns the current time slice settings for each queue size Generally the settings for smaller size queues are higher than for larger queues the fewer jobs that are waiting for attention the more time each job gets The maximum setting is 40 To change a setting type the queue size you want to change th
525. r format and then run MFDSEQ on the floppy disk The floppy can then be read by a pre 2 0 AMOS system For example LOG OPR MOUNT FLPO COPY FLP0 DSK1 2 2 FIL DSK1 1 4 FIL MFDSEQ FLPO MOUNT FLPO U System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MFDSEQ Page 2 MESSAGES Program for Traditionally Formatted Disks Only Cannot Continue You cannot run MFDSEQ on this disk 2No PPNs found on this Traditional Logical Cannot Continue No disk accounts have been allocated on this logical device so there are no entries to sort System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MK FUNCTION Provides a method of compiling and linking a group of files on extended directory disks so only the files that have been recently changed are actually assembled CHARACTERISTICS MK is re entrant and re usable MK is a tool that helps you automate the re compilation and or re linking of program modules in an application when one or more of the modules has been modified Because MK compares the file s last modification date and time to decide whether it should rebuild the file the file should reside on an extended directory format device If a file is on a traditional directory it is considered as very old defeating the update detection and forcing the file to be recompiled MK assumes you provide a description of the structure of your application in a file called a makefile The makefile provides information about the modules that make up the
526. r of Rx packets with frames larger than standard MII Error Report is total number of MII errors encountered Receive Watchdog is total number of watchdogs encountered Dribbling Bit is total number of dribbling bits encountered FIFO Overflow is total number of FIFO overflows encountered Fatal Bus Error is total number of fatal bus errors encountered Tx Status Tx Error Summary is the total of Tx Status Errors Loss of carrier is total number of times carrier was lost No Carrier is total number of times no carrier was encountered Late Collision is number of late collisions encountered Excessive Collisions is number of excessive collisions encountered Link Fail Report is number of link failures reported Underflow Error is number of underflow errors encountered Jabber Timeout is number of jabber timeouts encountered Heartbeat Fail is number of heartbeat failures encountered Deferred is the number of Tx packet that were not sent out directly Illegal Descriptor is number of illegal descriptors encountered PAGE III Clearing Accumulated Totals All totals are cleared and a new accumulation summary starts System Commands Reference Manual Rev 14 ESNIC Page 4 MESSAGES ERROR This program is for an AM 450 only This program is only for an AM 450 Ethernet controller ERROR invalid switch The switch you specified is invalid ERROR invalid impure index The PCI impure index has changed PCI memory has been corrupted ERROR PCIPBR
527. r terminal driver the program that takes care of the screen positioning functions of your terminal must allow use of TCRT screen calls XY can perform any TCRT function your terminal supports See your AMOS Terminal Programmer s Manual for a complete list of TCRT calls XY can be used at AMOS command level directly or within a command file You will probably find this command most useful within a command file you can use XY to help you position and control the display of your command file messages FORMAT XY row number column number or XY screen function or XY negative number positive number The first format is for positioning the cursor on the screen row number is the horizontal position and column number is the vertical position The row number may be between 1 and the length of your screen usually 24 The column number may be between 1 and the width of your screen usually 80 The second format is for special screen function calls TCRT 1 n The third format called direct format lets you enter any TCRT command including foreground and background color changes OPERATION TO POSITION THE CURSOR Type XY followed by the numbers of the screen row and column where you want the cursor to be For example XY 12 40 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 XY Page 2 This positions the cursor to the 12th line on the screen and the 40 character position about the middle of the screen on most terminals Yo
528. rack n of the diskette For information on the error codes see the hardware documentation that came with your disk device Invalid device The device you specified is not a floppy disk device or is not compatible with the AM 212 or AM 214 Floppy Disk Controller board No interrupt received after WRITE TRACK May indicate there is no diskette in the drive or the door of the drive is not completely closed If these are not the case it indicates either a bad drive or a bad controller board See your Alpha Micro representative for help Privileged program must be logged into OPR Log into DSKO 1 2 and try again Sector not found MINO block0 This message is displayed when mounting an unformatted diskette if this is the case it may be ignored If it occurs at any other time it indicates a problem with the diskette see your System Operator System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 FMTFLP Unit number for 5 1 4 inch floppies must be 0 or 1 Try again specifying 0 or 1 Unit number must be 0 3 Re enter specifying a unit number of 0 1 2 or 3 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FMTSCZ FUNCTION Formats SCSI Small Computer Systems Interface disk drives displays the drive status lists defects for the drive re assigns defective blocks initializes a drive or reformats the hidden sector As of March 1997 FMTSCZ has been superseded by FMTS2 for all 68020 and later systems Use FMTSCZ only o
529. racters in JOBPRM OPERATION To see the current settings enter SET For example SET Current settings are System Commands Reference Manual Rev 10 Page 5 SET HEX ECHO DSKERR NOVERIFY GUARD CTRLC REDIRECTION LOCK ELOCK Ay All non locking jobs are displayed If the job has locking off for both traditional and Yy extended devices there is an asterisk before the job name To change the SET options enter SET followed by an option For example SET HEX SET FORMS QUME CHECKS SET BPI MTU1 800 SET TERMINAL FCOLOR 4 SET LANGUAGE GERMAN SET PROMPT WELCOME SET LOCK SET TDV MYDRIV SET ELOCK MESSAGES File in use The file is locked by another user Try again later Filespec within SET INI is too long The filename you entered into SET INI is invalid Edit SET INI and try again The format for the command is SET BPI MTUn XX Where n tape drive number in the range 0 through 7 and XX is the desired density Make sure you designated the magnetic tape unit correctly and you have specified a BPI of 800 1600 3200 or 6250 For a list of valid MTUs enter SET The format for the command is SET TERMINAL DRIVER driver Where driver is the desired new terminal driver Your current terminal driver is driver Available terminal drivers are list Make sure you have specified the correct disk and account for the driver check your spelling etc and try again Insufficient
530. raditional and Optimize to Yes FMSFLP calculates both bitmap size and number of logical devices For extended directories using the entire drive set Directory Type to Extended and Optimize to Yes Enter the number of logical devices you want FMSFLP calculates the best bitmap size For any other removable media configuration you can set Optimize to No and enter the Directory Type Bitmap Size and Number of Logicals you want The number of logicals must be one 1 for AMOS format media Although AM SCSI format media will support multiple logical devices one 1 logical is recommended for these diskettes The type of media in the drive is not detected prior to formatting so the configuration defaults to high density AM SCSI After choosing a configuration press RETURN to continue If you decide you don t want to format the drive select Cancel and press RETURN Otherwise the drive begins formatting when you make your selection Drive Info Displays the following information about the currently selected media if available List Defects Usable capacity Block size Format status Formatted capacity amount of space being used for logical drives Number of logicals Size of each logical drive Bitmap size Cylinders heads and sectors per track These are calculated values they don t reflect the physical structure of the drive AMOS formatted media does not have the information available to display the logic
531. rately Ignored for screen output Output details on used DVs Include a printout of the contents of the file named fname at the end of the report As I fname but starting each file at the top of a new page Output detailed job table information Used with the F fname option If the file named fname already exists delete it without further ado Output printed lines per page Ignored for screen output see the P option A The defaults for the LL LR LDP LTS LDF and LTF switches are those defined in gt the job s active language definition file LL c LR c LDP c LTS c LDF n LTF n IN INOA NODL NOF NOJ NON NOR NOT NOTDV NOX P R IS IT TDV ps n Set the left PPN symbol to c Set the right PPN symbol to c Set the decimal point character to c Set the thousands separator to c Set the date format 0 MDY 1 DMY 2 YMD Set the time format 0 12 hour clock 1 24 hour clock Output detailed AlphaNET node and AlphaTCP information Suppress AlphaBASE job totals Suppress disk label information Suppress FOLDERS device information Suppress job detail Suppress network detail Suppres system memory content detail Suppress terminal detail Suppress terminal driver information Suppress installed program information Pause at the end of each screenful of information and wait for a key to be pressed Screen length is determined by the terminal s TRMCHR settings Igno
532. rdware interface it controls some interfaces can be re addressed to allow multiple interfaces on the system Driver Status These fields let you monitor the activity level of the network connection and its quality The individual fields are Packets Transmitted Number of packets transmitted by this interface Packets Received Number of packets received that were specifically addressed to this interface This does not include broadcast packets Broadcasts Received Packets received with a broadcast destination address Broadcast packets are typically used for network management functions Some broadcast packets are normal a high rate of broadcast packets may indicate a network problem System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 LDVSTS Transmissions Pending Receptions Pending Protocols Registered Failed Transmissions CRC Errors Framing Errors Collision Lost Packets Rx Resources Exhausted Page 2 Packets the driver has received for transmission from upper level network software This is normally zero but can briefly become non zero if the system or network is exceptionally busy Packets the driver is holding waiting to be retrieved by upper level network software This is normally zero but can briefly become non zero if the system or network is exceptionally busy The number of network protocols registered with the driver Protocols must register their type with the driver in order for the driver to receiv
533. red for file output use the L n option to specify the number of lines per page for printed output Output information on system resident modules Output details on information held in the System Communications Area and certain details on hardware settings Output information on terminal definitions Output full information on used terminal drivers Report details on certain installed programs Output the fullest possible report Can be used with the NOxxx options Output a brief help screen System Commands Reference Manual Rev 06 Page 3 AMSCFG OPERATION Enter AMSCFG followed by the option switches you want For example 1 To output full information to a file called SYSTEM CFG erasing any existing SYSTEM CFG file with a header of Joe s system AMSCFG F SYSTEM K H Joe s System 2 Same as above but ignore terminal driver and FOLDERS information AMSCFG F SYSTEM CFG K H Joe s System NOTDV NOF 3 Output the same detail to the screen pausing between screenfuls AMSCFG P NOTDV NOF 4 Output the same detail to a file called SYSTEM CFG entering a page header separately AMSCFG NOTDV NOF F SYSTEM CFG H AMSCFG will then prompt you for the header Enter header AMSCFG does most of its work by scanning tables set up by system or application software The only hardware scanning is for SSDs boot PROM revisions CPU settings and devices connected to the SCSI bus If a device has not been set
534. red information e g protection creation date etc aren t reported as different by FILCOM See the SRCCOM reference sheet SRCCOM is slower than FILCOM but better for variable length ASCII records of less than 511 characters that end with a carriage return line feed FORMAT FILCOM filespecl filespec2 switches filespecs specify the sequential files you want to compare SWITCHES IA Output in ASCII instead of hex octal Non printable characters shown as B Minimum length sequence to resume matching Default is 6 IC Compare contiguous files E Maximum errors to report before terminating Default is to report to end of file A zero reports file match no match only F fspec Optional output file Default is on terminal P Starting byte offset in first file Default is 0 Q Starting byte offset in second file Default is 0 S If a mismatch string is gt n end compare Default is 128 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 FILCOM Page 2 OPERATION Enter FILCOM and the files you want to compare For example FILCOM DSKRED 1 4 DSKRED 100 3 You see a display listing like this mismatch 1 length 5 5 0104 43 20 50 4F 57 0104 42 4E 4D 4A 4B The first line of the display above gives the number of the mismatch and the length of the strings involved Then you see the byte offset of the string within the file 0104 and the contents of the data
535. registered trademark of Digital Research In order to use CP M on an Alpha S Micro computer system you must purchase the Alpha Micro implementation of CP M and your computer must be equipped with the correct Communication Controller For information on using CP M on an Alpha Micro computer system see your CP M Installation Instruction and User s Guide and your CP M Operating System Manual FORMAT CPMDIR devn devn is the CP M format specification of the CP M diskette OPERATION Enter CPMDIR and the device name For example CPMDIR B You then see a directory display for that CP M device MESSAGES Cannot READ IMGx device does not exist Make sure IMG is defined as a valid device on your system and the IMG DVR program exists in account DSKO 1 6 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CPMDIR Page 2 Cannot READ IMGx device not mounted Use the MOUNT command to mount the diskette and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CREATE FUNCTION Creates a random file of specified size CHARACTERISTICS CREATE is re entrant and re usable A random or contiguous file is one in which the blocks making up the file are next to each other on the disk as opposed to a sequential file in which the disk blocks may be scattered across the disk Since random files may not be expanded once they are allocated on the disk programs that increase the size of files such
536. ress or CTRLYC You will then see the next highest level of menu If you are using the standard AMOS menu typing 55 as the selection number when you at the main menu will bring you out of the menu and back to AMOS command level other menus may have such a selection also MESSAGES File not found filename Check your syntax or use the DIR command to locate the file and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SI FUNCTION Analyzes and reports on system configuration and speed CHARACTERISTICS SI is neither re entrant nor re usable It scans the system hardware and software to report on the computer CPU math coprocessor and memory management unit type AMOS and boot PROM revision levels number of SSDs total memory and system memory sizes It then derives some speed indexes for the system FORMAT SI disk disk is the name of the logical unit on which to conduct a disk index DEFAULTS SI defaults to not reporting a disk speed index OPERATION Enter SI followed by the options you want For example SI SI SUBO SI does a set of operations that measure CPU power and floating point speed A disk speed benchmark is optional The results give a rough guide for the relative power of AMOS equipped systems You cannot use this test to compare AMOS and non AMOS systems SI should be run with no other active users or background jobs on the system Results for a given system should be within
537. riting in TEST mode This message is shown if the TEST or TESTFIRST switches are included in the command line e OK for 2x recording The disk is too slow for 4 speed recording so 2 speed recording will be used for the entire CD e Quick erase CD MAKACD will erase just enough information to make the rewritable CD look like a blank CD This normally takes less than 5 minutes to complete Do not use this switch if the rewritable CD contains more than one session e This operation may take over 30 minutes to complete This just warns that the erase operation requested will take a long time to complete Nothing will be shown on the terminal screen until the erase operation completes e Transferring DSKO in test mode Test mode does everything but turn on the recording laser e Using Generic SCSI MMC CDR driver CDRMMC This message shows the CDR driver name and description being used e Waiting for CD recorder to finish writing Completed The memory data buffers and the CD Recorder s cache buffers are being recorded on the CDR media e Writing filler This message is shown if filler is required before recording the AlphaCD special sector e Writing Table Of Contents All data has been recorded and the Table of Contents is being recorded on the CDR media e nn complete buffer nn This message shows percentage of the recording process already completed and how full the CD recorder s cache buffer is This message appears on the terminal s s
538. rminal Since I O redirection does not provide such responses these programs will hang You can free it at least until the next time it asks for a response by using CTRLYF ACK If a program is run with the option and that program requests the number of rows and columns on the terminal it receives a value of zero for both This is technically correct but it causes some programs to lock up With redirection you can use piping redirecting the output of one program into the input of another For example REDIR ERSATZ TYPE P This command takes the output of the ERSATZ program typically a very long list and feeds it to the TYPE command which because of P lets you see a paginated display on your terminal This example PROCES gt OUTPUT LST runs the command file PROCES and sends the output minus terminal dependent escape sequences to OUTPUT LST In another example REMOVE lt THE MEMO gt gt OUTPUT LST the phrase lt THE MEMO gt is an argument for the REMOVE DO file If you left out the before the lt and gt brackets needed to indicate to the DO file that THE MEMO is one argument not two the command would try to find a file called THE to get input for REMOVE DO The above command calls REMOVE DO with THE MEMO as an argument and puts the results in OUTPUT LST REDIR is useful in command files when it is not known if redirection is on or off See the REDIR reference sheet for more informati
539. rminal definitions to the file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TXTFMT FUNCTION Formats text file s to produce a printer ready list file The format of the list file is based on TXTFMT commands embedded in the files CHARACTERISTICS TXTFMT is re usable but is not re entrant The formatted file has the same name as the first file specified on the TXTFMT command line but with a LST extension For more on using TXTEMT and on the TXTFMT commands see your TXTFMT User s Manual FORMAT TXTFMT filespec filespec filespec is a file specification for a file you want to format DEFAULTS The default file extension is TXT The default device and account specification is the account you are logged into OPERATION Enter TXTFMT followed by the one or more file specifications that select the text files you want to format For example TXTFMT HEADER COPYRT TITLE PRFACE MAIN This formats HEADER TXT COPYRT TXT TITLE TXT PRFACE TXT and MAIN TXT into the single file HEADER LST To see your formatted file you can either print it using the PRINT or PRNT command or display it on the monitor screen using the TYPE command PRNT PRINT and TYPE use the default file extension of LST MESSAGES Cannot open filespec file not found Check your spelling or use DIR to find the file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 TXTFMT Page 2 Illegal command command TXTFMT did no
540. rocess It tells you what errors occurred how large your program is whether it is copying from any copy files and if any symbols have been automatically EXTERNed M68 produces a OBJ file of the same name as the file you specified on the M68 command line If M68 does not automatically call Phase 4 to create an executable LIT file you must use the linkage editor LNKLIT or SYMLIT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 3 M68 MESSAGES You can see these errors in your assembly listing Branch address was out of the 127 byte range Boundary error a word operand was on an odd byte address Conditional statement syntax error Duplicate user symbol defined more than once User generated error Illegal character in source line Missing term or operator in operand or expression Numeric error a digit out of the current radix range The specific operand is illegal when used with this instruction HU en ia Mee tt hs ye p An expression which had to be resolvable on the first pass of the assembly could not be resolved Questionable syntax A general catch all error code A register expression not in the range of 0 7 Indicates offset requiring more than 16 bits must use M20 switch Source line or operand terminated improperly Undefined user symbol during Pass 2 Absolute parameter value out of its defined range x lt CHnrPRLH Assembler system error please notify Alpha Micro You
541. rom that account unless you do not intend to continue the command file Each use of a PAUSE command erases any current CNT CMD file and creates a new one OPERATION Enter CONT at AMOS command level CONT After CONT loads CNT CMD into memory and processes it CONT erases the CNT CMD file from the disk You may also include CONT within another command file which then resumes execution of the first command file MESSAGES CAN T CONTINUE No CNT CMD file exists in the account you are logged into Make sure you are logged into the correct account Use DIR to locate the CNT CMD file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 COPY FUNCTION Copies one or more files You can copy within an account between accounts and between disks Also copies files across AlphaNET networks Can also copy files to a terminal or to and from user memory CHARACTERISTICS COPY is re entrant and re usable You may use the ersatz names defined for your system You may not copy to an account if it is not in the project you are logged into unless you are logged into an operator s account 1 2 You may copy files into your account from any other account regardless of project number COPY ignores files without any contents You must have the correct driver program loaded into system memory if you wish to COPY from a peripheral device COPY is a wildcard file command See your AMOS User s Guide for more information on wildcarding The file BADBLK SY
542. rompted for it The system doesn t display your password on the terminal as you type it this prevents other users from seeing your password If AMOS recognizes the password it logs you into the system Once you have logged onto the system LOG displays a message telling you which device and account you ve logged into If any other users are logged into the same account LOG warns you certain AMOS programs should not be run if other people are active in your account and or logged into the same disk al The first time a user logs on to a computer the first line of the file DSKO MAIL JNK 7 2 gt gt is displayed if that file exists If you are already logged into an account enter LOG to find out which account and device you are logged in under Once you are logged into the system you can use LOG to transfer to other accounts Enter LOG followed by the device and account to which you wish to transfer For example LOG DSK4 123 5 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 LOG If you are in a project and you wish to move to another account in the same project you can abbreviate the LOG command because of the defaults For example LOG 5 RETURN MESSAGES Account number invalid Make sure you gave the correct device and the account number is in the proper form and try again Already logged in as user name Please use LOGOFF then try again You tried to log to another account using a different user name
543. ry time the system comes up but if you change a hard disk cartridge or a floppy disk or bring up a drive after the system is up and running you still must explicitly mount it using the MOUNT command Do not mount or unmount a tape drive or any other device that is not file structured v Trying to do so may render your tape or device unreadable and result in partial or complete data loss Using MOUNT tells the system you are changing a disk or adding a new disk and the system must therefore look at the new disk to fetch the appropriate bitmap A disk bitmap is a map of the disk it tells the system which disk blocks are free and which are used If the disk is a Winchester technology disk drive MOUNT mounts and sequences up the drive for you If you don t sequence up the drive you cannot access the disk at all MOUNT can also be used to sequence down a Winchester technology drive system writes to the new disk as if it had the same free and used locations as the old disk It is likely data will be overwritten Also NEVER mount or unmount a disk while someone is accessing it this can severely damage the file structure of that disk o If you don t mount a disk after you change it when it comes time to transfer data the MOUNT to sequence down the System Disk before sequencing down other Winchester technology disks on the system MOUNT checks to see if any active jobs are logged into the device you want to mount but does not check if there are
544. s NOBUFWRT devn Disables buffered writes on AM 520 disks System Commands Reference Manual Rev 10 SET CACHE dskn NOCACHE dskn CTRLC NOCTRLC DSKERR NODSKERR DYN DYNNO DYNYES NODYNAMIC DYNJOBNO job DYNJOBYES job ECHO NOECHO ELOCK job NOELOCK job FORMS GUARD NOGUARD HCACHE devn NOHCACHE devn HEX LANGUAGE LINK cpuid NOLINK cpuid LOCK job NOLOCK job NDV cpuid NONDV cpuid OCTAL PFK Page 2 Turns on disk cache for disk n Turns off disk cache for disk n Enables CTRLY C user interrupt command Disables CTRLY C Reports soft disk errors and retries Does not report soft disk errors and retries Turns dynamic job scheduling on or off Turns dynamic job scheduling off for the system Turns dynamic job scheduling on for the system Turns dynamic job scheduling off for this job only You can then set priority for this job using JOBPRI Other jobs continue to have their time slice dynamically Turns dynamic job scheduling off for this job Turns dynamic job scheduling on for this job Displays terminal input Silences terminal input Enables file locking for job for extended devices Disables file locking for job for extended devices Assigns a form to a printer Must be in OPR to set Task Manager spooler forms Prevents SENDs and FORCEs to your terminal Allows SEND and FORCE Enables on board caching for the specified device controlled by a Herbie dis
545. s If the user has a privilege MUSER displays it in bright text otherwise MUSER displays it in dim text On the basis of privilege certain programs will deny the user access to certain functions To change the setting of a privilege bit move the cursor to the setting you wish to change by using the arrow keys Pressing the SPACE BAR toggles the privilege from one state to the other Class is a value in the range of 0 to 100 It indicates what kind of access the user has where they can log into and what they can do see your System Operator s Guide for more information For example a system programmer might belong in class 100 a clerical worker in 20 A value in the range 0 to 100 defines the amount of experience a user has with the system A long time user of the system might be assigned 95 or 100 a novice the value 10 This value determines how much prompting and help information is given to the user Several statistics are maintained on each user by the system These are displayed by the MUSER program and are intended to be used by billing or charge back systems for the purpose of monitoring system use on a user by user basis These statistics include the total CPU time used the total connect time the total number of disk reads and writes and the total number of pages printed Priorities range from 1 lowest to 127 highest Default is 13 Sets the default File Protection level for newly created files See
546. s and the filespec s are the files you want to merge DEFAULTS Assumes the account and device you are currently logged into and a null file extension i e a no character extension for the new file specification Assumes the extension of the new file specification for the first file specification and then assumes for each subsequent file specification the actual or assumed extension of the previous file specification OPERATION Enter APPEND and the specification of the new file an equal sign and one or more specifications of files you want to merge For example APPEND ASMBLR M68 PARSE M68 SCAN TABLE CNVRT When APPEND has written the combined contents of the old files into the new file you are returned to AMOS System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 APPEND Page 2 EXAMPLES If you enter APPEND ASMBLR M68 PARSE SCAN TABLE CNVRT APPEND assumes the default extension of M68 for each of the files PARSE SCAN TABLE and CNVRT because that is the extension of the new file ASMBLR If you enter APPEND ASMBLR PARSE SCAN TABLE CNVRT APPEND assumes that the extension of the file ASMBLER is a null extension ASMBLR an extension having no characters APPEND assumes by default that the extensions of PARSE SCAN TABLE and CNVRT are also null extensions If you enter APPEND EXAMPL TXT INTRO SAMPL1 BAS SAMPL2 CLOSE TXT APPEND creates the new file EXAMPL TXT to include INTRO TXT the extension is assumed to
547. s where module begins Size in decimal bytes Extension Module name The hash total is an identifying code unique to that module The last line of the display tells you how many bytes are free in your memory partition and gives the octal memory address of the first free memory location To see information about a particular memory module include a filespec on the MAP command line For example MAP LOG RETURN LOG LIT 1016 30522 432 672 122 411 To see information about modules in system memory enter MAP RSHMF RETURN TRM DVR 252 552 107 745 717 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MEMORY FUNCTION Allocates memory to your job or displays the size of your memory partition CHARACTERISTICS MEMORY is re entrant and re usable You can t increase your memory allocation if other users on the system have already been allocated the rest of memory If there is not enough free memory to fill your entire request MEMORY allocates as much memory as it can If you try to allocate a very small non zero amount of memory to your job you may not have room to load and execute programs or files you may not even have enough memory to load the MEMORY command back into your partition to change that allocation So be careful to check your MEMORY command line to make sure you have made no mistakes Also be careful when attaching your terminal to another job make sure the job has some memory all
548. s Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 COMPAT FUNCTION Allows you to list programs to be run with the instruction cache on a 68030 or later CPU disabled Some programs which use self modifying code will not run properly with the on chip instruction cache enabled CHARACTERISTICS COMPAT is re entrant and re usable It lets you run some programs with instruction cache disabled while all other programs run with the cache on The programs to run with the cache disabled are listed in a text file in SYS named COMPAT DAT The proper way to solve the problem of self modifying code and the instruction cache is to modify the program so it either doesn t use self modifying code or it disables and enables the instruction cache You should use COMPAT only when you have programs which for some reason cannot be properly modified You can include COMPAT in your system initialization file so the listed programs are never run with the cache enabled COMPAT checks the name of the current program held in the JOBPRG field in the job s v job control block against the COMPAT database If a program modifies the JOBPRG field it will be incorrectly run with the instruction cache enabled Also if there are two programs of the same name located on different devices and or accounts both are affected by the entry into the COMPAT database you cannot differentiate one from the other without renaming one The external on board cache controlled by
549. s Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 MONGEN System disk driver is too large The disk driver is too large to be embedded into the monitor Choose another smaller driver System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MONHSH FUNCTION Lets you check the hash totals of AMOS monitors regardless of which disk driver has been inserted into the monitor by the MONGEN program CHARACTERISTICS sl MONHSH calculates hash totals only for monitor files It can t be used on any other type P gt of file Monitor patches published by Alpha Micro include the monitor hash after you make a monitor patch use MONHSH to make sure the patch was made correctly To check the version number of your monitor use the DIR V command FORMAT MONHSH monitor name monitor name is the name of the monitor file DEFAULTS MONHSH assumes account 1 4 on the device you are currently logged into OPERATION Enter MONHSH and the name of the monitor at AMOS command level For example MONHSH AMOSL MON If you leave out the monitor name MONHSH prompts you for it When MONHSH is finished it displays the hash total MESSAGES Cannot hash monitorname reason Be sure you ve spelled the name correctly and that it is a monitor file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 MONHSH Page 2 File specification error Try again and specify a correct monitor name System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91
550. s if you want to do reblocking Reblocking consists of specifying the number of file data records to place in each tape block If you say no to this question TAPE assumes each data record is 512 bytes long and the blocking factor is 1 that is you want to write one disk block of 512 bytes into one tape block If you tell TAPE you want to do reblocking it asks you the size of the data records in the file in bytes including record delimiters and the blocking factor the number of data records in each tape block TAPE now displays a message telling you how many characters will be written in each tape block If this number is not satisfactory for example if it is zero you have made a mistake in answering the TAPE questions Press CTRLYC to return to AMOS and try again Now TAPE is ready to write to the tape It asks you to press if the tape is properly loaded Make sure the tape has been physically loaded on the tape drive and it is at load point the metallic film at the start of the tape is positioned at the read heads Press when you are ready TAPE now asks you to confirm the drive is on line When the drive is ready press RETURN TAPE transfers your file to the tape When it is finished you see a message tells you how many blocks were written and how many errors were found System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 TAPE Copying Tape Files to Disk TAPE asks for a file specification give the AMOS specification of the fi
551. s no CD ROM installed in the CD ROM drive and exits If the CD ROM disk driver ACD DVR has been loaded into system memory by the SYSTEM command in the system initialization command file the AlphaCD is accessible to all users after ACD has exited successfully Otherwise the AlphaCD is available only to the user entering the ACD command In the latter case ACD displays SWARNING ACD DVR is not loaded in system memory therefore this job will be the only one able to access AlphacD If you want to detach the CD ROM drive or switch to another CD use the U switch ACD U To remove the CD ROM from the computer after you have finished using it remove the media from the CD ROM Then make sure you power down the computer before unplugging it from the SCSI bus MESSAGES AlphaCD is already installed You ve used the ACD command but the CD ROM drive is already installed on the SCSI bus ACD has no effect CD ROM drive found at SCSI id lt gt ACD is confirming the SCSI ID of the CD ROM it is about to use CD ROM is not an AlphaCD insert an AlphaCD and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 Page 3 ACD ACD cannot read AMOS device information from the CD ROM disk Remove the CD disk from the drive and make sure it is an AlphaCD clean and not scratched Re insert the disk and try ACD again If the problem still occurs either the disk is unreadable it does not contain AMOS information or the CD ROM dr
552. s occurred Code provides additional SCSI error sense information SCSI error SCSI status nn sense key xx sssssssssssssss Add Sense Code Qualifier Code ac qc nn SCSI Status Code XX SCSI Sense Key code ssss Interpreted sense key code if known ac SCSI Additional Sense Code qc SCSI Qualifier Code Example DVDRES noe ject DVDRES Version 8 0 101 4 Copyright C 2001 Alpha Micro Products Initializing SCSI DVD RAM Recorder Found the following possible DVD Recorders ID Description Ez 6 HL DT STDVDRAM GSA 4082B Deis 5 SAMSUNG SCR 1231 REV1 01 Select one of the above devices 1 Using Generic SCSI DVD RAM driver DVDRAM DVD RAM Recorder located at SCSI id 6 You may enter an optional title for the DVD or press RETURN for none Title AlphaDVD backup A Enter list of disk devices to transfer onto the DVD media Devices may be entered as a range ex dev0 20 for dev0 through dev20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line dsk0 6 DSKO 131072 blocks DSK1 131072 blocks DSK2 131072 blocks DSK3 131072 blocks DSK4 131072 blocks DSK5 131072 blocks DSK6 131072 blocks The DVD logical unit size is greater than 64K blocks which could mean compatibility problems on AMOS 1 x systems Press RETURN to continue or C to abort DVDRES Calculating space requirements AMOS partition requires 229376 sectors 2007327 unused
553. s the current number of logical devices You then are asked to enter the new number of logical devices The number may range from 1 to 65535 After you answer the above question FIXLOG asks you to confirm you really want to change the number of devices If you answer N FIXLOG returns you to AMOS without making any changes If you answer Y FIXLOG changes the number of logical devices and displays device name has been changed to number logical drives New bitmap size is size words Write down the bitmap size given in this message you may need this number in the next step DO NOT reboot your system or mount the drive you just changed until you are told to below If necessary update your system initialization command file to change the bitmap size and define the new number of logical devices You may not need to do this if you are using self configuring BITMAP and or DEVTBL statements See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for more information about changing the system initialization command file Back up the entire system You need this backup in addition to the one you made before starting this procedure because this one includes the changes you ve made up to this point You will use this backup tape later in the procedure The previous backup is a failsafe so you can return to your previous configuration if something goes wrong Create a warm boot tape that reflects the NEW number of log
554. s the file on your terminal screen You can stop the display at any time by pressing NO SCRL or CTRLI S and resume it again by pressing NO SCRLJ or CTRLVQ You can end the display by pressing CANCEL or using CTRLI C MESSAGES File not found Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again Invalid file type You can t display this type of file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DOSTYP Page 2 Invalid path specified Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again This is not a supported MS DOS format Sorry but can t be decoded Your floppy diskette is in a format DOSTYP can t read System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DSKANA FUNCTION Analyzes the data on a disk tracks lost disk blocks and optionally recreates the disk bitmap Reports file errors inconsistent block counts and bad bitmap hash totals CHARACTERISTICS DSKANA is re entrant and re usable DSKANA reads every block on the disk It keeps track of what the bitmap should be and compares that to what it actually is DSKANA should be run on a regular basis since it reclaims temporarily allocated disk blocks DSKANA also tells you if more than one file claims the same disk block if there are illegal block links in a file and if your bitmap has a bad hash total Unless you specify otherwise DSKANA updates and rewrites the bitmap based on its analysis To see a summary of DSKANA switches
555. sage Unable to continue writing to tape explanation Correct the problem and continue See your System Operator for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 27 MTUSAV Unable to open disk file During verification a file on the tape either no longer exists on the disk or there is a problem opening it Verification continues from the start of the next tape file See your System Operator the number of jobs in the JOBS statement probably needs to be increased to be two or three more than the number of job names listed in the JOBALC statement s Unable to spawn slave task Unit number must be between 0 and 7 Re enter a correct number Updating backup time and date in disk directory Press control C to skip The backup has completed and MTUSAV is now writing the backup time and date to the file directory on an extended disk This can take quite some time for large backups You can press CTRLYC to abort the process Your backup is complete However the last backed up date and time for these files will not reflect this backup You ended MTUSAV by pressing C The backup and verification procedure if any will abort before completion The tape may contain partially copied files User aborted execution at reel changeover You ended MTUSAV when it asked you to mount a new tape The backup and verification procedure if any will abort before completion The tape may contain User aborted execution with
556. sage of the TRANSFER switch You don t have twenty copies of the files on your tape to use T If you continue you may lose files You may want to restore without T You are not logged in under 1 2 can t create p pn Job aborted You can t copy to a nonexistent account unless you are logged into an operator s account 1 2 If you copy to a nonexistent account while logged into 1 2 VCRRES creates the account The job aborts Any files selected prior to this error have been erased from the destination accounts System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VCRSAV FUNCTION Writes copies of disk files to video tape cassettes CHARACTERISTICS VCRSAV is re entrant and re usable Included on the tape are the device and account specifications of the files and the date and time of the backup Used in combination with VCRRES to transfer files from video tape cassettes to disk and VCRDIR to list a directory of files on a cassette The VCR software is included for compatibility with older software While VCRSAV may work on extended disks of less than 32Mb we strongly recommend you use BACKUP to save files from extended disks VCRSAV will not work on extended directories over 32MB in size VCRSAV is a wildcard file command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on wildcard specifications VCRSAYV locks out other users on your system unless you specify the T option You P gt should check with other users on your system
557. scanning the SCSI bus if ID is not specified If more than one DVD RAM or Blu ray type device is found when scanning the SCSI bus you will be asked to choose the device you wish to use for recording After entering the MAKBD command the following will be displayed MAKBD Version X X xxx Copyright 2007 Alpha Microsystems Initializing SCSI DVD RAM or Blu ray Recorder If MAKBD finds multiple DVD RAM or Blu ray drives the following message will be displayed to allow you to select the drive to use Found the following possible DVD RAM or BD RE Recorders ID Description 1 nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 3 2 nn XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX Select one of the above devices MAKBD Additional information about the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive driver and media is then displayed Using Generic SCSI DVD RAM or BD RE driver DVDBD DVD RAM or BD RE Recorder located at SCSI id 4 MAKBD then asks for an optional title for the DVD or Blu ray drive The title may be up to 60 characters long You may enter an optional title for the DVD or press R none Title END OF MONTH BACKUP ETURN for Next MAKBD asks for the AMOS logical drives to copy to the DVD or BD RE as follows media Devices may be entered as a range e g DEVO terminated with a blank line Enter list of disk devices to transfer onto the DVD or Blu ray 20 for
558. se commands CLEAR CRT415 FMTDVD FMTFLP MONTST MUSER You must be logged into 1 2 to run ASCDMP DSKPAK DSKANA FIXCRC Access Limitations These commands lock up all other users on the system while they are running FMTDVD STRSAV FMTFLP CRT420 CRT520 FMSFLP FMTSCZ FMTS2 FMT210 QDT DSKCPY DSKDDT DSKDMP HASHER SYSACT FMT210 MONTST System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Introduction to AMOS Commands Page 2 3 These commands may only be used when no other user is accessing the affected logical disk or disk controller ACD CRT415 DIRSEQ FMSFLP MAKBD SYSACT BACKUP CRT420 DSKCPY FMTDVD MAKDVD VCRDIR BAKDIR CRT520 DSKPAK FMTSCZ MFDSEQ VCRRES BDRES DBD DVD FMTS2 MOUNT VCRSAV DVDRES MAKACD RESTOR XMOUNT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Chapter 3 File Specifications For more information on any AMOS system concepts discussed in this chapter see your AMOS User s Guide Most AMOS commands ask you for one or more file specifications on a command line The file specification identifies a file to AMOS and takes this form devn filename extension p pn devn filename extension p pn Three letters and a number that select a logical unit of a physical device This specification tells AMOS the device the specified file resides on The device specification and the filename are separated by a colon devn usually identifies a disk e g DSKO the System
559. sectors remain Note that once started the recording operation can be stopped by pressing C Press RETURN to start recording or C to abort System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 DVDRES Page 8 Errors Transferring DSKO SCSI error SCSI status 1 sense key 03 medium error Add Sense Code Qualifier Code 32 00 Error Unable to write to the DVD No defect spare location available concerning the AMOS DVD data structure e Error Disk geometry calculation was incorrect The AMOS hidden sector parameters calculated are invalid e Error memory previously calculated as available isn t Memory required for data buffers has disappeared e Error Unable to calculate AMOS disk geometry The AMOS hidden sector parameters could not be calculated e Error unable to get AMOS data buffer The system was unable to acquire memory for data buffers e Error Unable to remove DVD Recorder data buffer from memory e Error Source Bitmap Words could not be calculated For DVDs created before MAKDVD amp 0 101 4 this error may exist This error appears when DVDRES tries to calculate the Bitmap Words for a specific logical The last block of the bitmap area following the hash value has garbage following it This needs to be cleared for DVDRES 8 0 101 5 to calculate the logical bitmap words The logical will be ignored and you must use the COPY command to restore that logical e Error zero UFD link 0
560. sed e Completely erase entire CD MAKACD will erase all data from the rewritable CD This writes to the entire CD and can take 30 minutes or longer e DSKO 64660 blocks Transfer rate 1273K per second ok The disk transfer rates are being tested e Erase last session on CD MAKACD will erase the last session on the rewritable CD This overwrites the entire last session on the CD and can take 30 minutes or longer depending on the size of the session e not calculated disk is too small The specified disk is too small for speed testing The disk will be copied to the CD e Note that once started the recording operation can be stopped by pressing C which will render the CD R disk unusable Warning The CD Recorder must receive data constantly Other users on the system could delay data transfers and render the CD R disk unusable e Press RETURN to start recording or C to abort This is the final prompt before recording begins You may abort by pressing control C or Start the recording process by pressing RETURN e NOTE Disk will be recorded as a multi session recording System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MAKACD Page 10 Disk currently has nnnnn free sectors CD contains tracks 1 through 10 If the CDR media is not blank this message shows how much space is available and what CDR tracks are currently recorded Recording new information on this CDR will make the previously recorded data inaccessible by the ACD program e NOTE W
561. see MOUNT If the device is not mounted FMTFLP mounts it but without buffered writes enabled After formatting the diskette you may want to remount it to enable buffered writes After formatting a diskette use the SYSACT I command to initialize it unless you are going to use DSKCPY to make a literal image of another diskette on the newly formatted one FORMAT FMTFLP devn D devn specifies the device holding the diskette you want to format D is an option which causes FMTFLP to display diagnostic information as it formats the diskette OPERATION Enter FMTFLP and the device that holds the diskette you want to format For example FMTFLP DDAL System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FMTFLP Page 2 This tells FMTFLP to format the diskette in drive one of the floppy device using the DDA driver program MESSAGES Cannot format diskette write protected Remove the write protection tab from the diskette and try again Device does not exist The device you specified is not defined Check your spelling or use DEVTBL to see a list of currently defined devices Device being mounted without buffered writes You may want to remount the device after formatting The device you are formatting was not mounted so FMTFLP mounted it for you To use buffered writes after formatting you must remount the device See the MOUNT reference sheet Error code x on track n A media drive or controller error occurred at t
562. spec filespec s switch filespec is the specification of a file you want to link and switch is an option request You may not specify an overlay or library file as the first filespec on the command line If you have too many filespecs to fit on one screen line you may continue the LNKLIT command line by ending it with acomma LNKLIT accepts as many lines of filespecs as you wish as long as you end the preceding line with a comma If a switch appears in front of a filespec e g LNKLIT MATH O NUM SUB that option request becomes the default for the rest of the command line If a switch follows a filespec e g LNKLIT MATH NUM O SUB it affects only that filespec Certain switches identified in the discussions below as operation switches affect all filespecs on the command line no matter how they are placed System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 LNKLIT DEFAULTS Page 2 LNKLIT uses the default extension of OBJ unless you are specifying a library file in which case LNKLIT uses the default extension of LIB If your filespec does not contain an account and device specification LNKLIT assumes the file is in the account and device you are logged into Next it looks in your project library account P 0 Finally it looks in the System M68 account DSKO 7 7 The default switches are P and R OPTIONS B D O22 F P R S U IX OPERATION Doesn t force word alignment of
563. splay If the cassette contains a warm boot monitor the display notes the backup media is BOOTable meaning a warm boot monitor is the first file on the cassette even though it may not appear on the directory listing you just requested If your printer has been defined on your system as a terminal you may send the display directly to the printer by using an output specification of TRM printer name System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 VCRDIR MESSAGES Cannot find DSKO SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS VCRDIR needs this file to be able to process wildcard symbols This message can indicate SCNWLD SYS does not exist or you don t have enough memory to load the file into your partition Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of device for your system Cannot READ device name device error VCRDIR found something wrong with the tape Be sure the cassette is loaded properly and the internal mechanism of the VCR unit is clean Try again If the problem persists see your System Operator Cannot READ device name device is not mounted MOUNT the device and try again More than one output specification Try again using only one output specification No such files VCRDIR could not find any files matching your input specification Try VCRDIR ALL to see a list of all files on the tape Tape is not file structured The header of the VCR tape c
564. ssing BADBLK SYS 1 2 BADBLK SYS exists to prevent bad blocks ona device from being allocated and should never be directly accessed You cannot copy the BADBLK SYS 1 2 file System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 FLPWIN Cannot find DSKO SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS FLPWIN needs this file to be able to process wildcard symbols in your file specifications This message can mean SCNWLD SYS does not exist is not in the proper account or you do not have enough memory to load it into your partition See your System Operator for help Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system and try again Cannot OPEN device name protection violation Either log into 1 2 or the account you want to write to and try again Cannot READ device name device is not mounted Mount the device and try again Cannot restore 1 3 files to a 1 4 disk You cannot restore the files to a logical disk with an extended directory structure Choose another output device Device full There is no more room on the disk See if you can clear some memory space on the disk by erasing old files BAK files etc Device is not properly file structured The floppy disk you are trying to read was not written by WINFLP Make sure you mounted the correct floppy disk File unsplit mismatch error You tried to restore a split file but the next disk entered con
565. st Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system and try again Cannot READ device name device is not mounted Mount the device and try again Device full See your System Operator about clearing room on the disk and try again Device is not properly file structured The floppy disk was not written by WINFLP Make sure you mounted the correct floppy disk DSK is not a valid backup device You could not have used DSK the system disk as a backup drive Choose another device More than one output specification Try again entering only one listfilespec No file oriented device corresponding to device name is mounted FLPDIR can t find a logical unit matching your specification Check your syntax or try mounting the device System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 FLPDIR No such files FLPDIR couldn t find any files matching your input specification Check your spelling or use a more general specification System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FLPWIN FUNCTION Copies files from a floppy disk to a Winchester disk CHARACTERISTICS This program is provided for compatibility purposes You normally should use the RESTOR program FLPWIN does not work with extended format disks FLPWIN is re entrant and re usable FLPWIN may not be used to transfer data between Alpha Micro and non Alpha Micro computers Used in combination with WINFLP to write disk files to the floppy disk
566. st be reduced A fixed number of blocks are allocated for bad blocking for each drive type This number has been exceeded by adding bad blocks See your System Operator or contact your Alpha Micro reseller or service representative Error Initializing Disk After formatting when creating account 1 2 and writing BADBLK SYS an error was encountered which prevented proper operation This error generally appears with another system error message which indicates the actual error condition The most common cause is incorrect bitmap size in a BITMAP statement which causes a Bitmap Kaput error during initialization System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 Page 5 CRT520 Formatting Operation Aborted You pressed CTRLYC during the formatting operation This message confirms the format has been stopped Illegal Input Format try again Illegal Input Line Format See the format above and re enter Insufficient memory to run CRT520 Allocate more memory to your job Privileged program must be logged into OPR Log into DSKO 1 2 and try again Unable to format error n During the formatting operation the AM 520 experienced a hard error at the physical drive level n is the specific error code in the current output radix returned by the hardware This generally indicates the disk drive is not functioning properly or is not cabled properly The bit positions are 0 1 an BW N
567. sure it is an AlphaDVD Re insert the media and try DVD again If the problem still occurs either it does not contain AMOS information or the DVD drive needs maintenance There is no media installed in the DVD RAM drive Insert a DVD media into the drive Unable to find a DVD RAM Recorder No device that looks like a DVD recorder was found You must install a SCSI dispatcher prior to using this program A SCSI dispatcher is required to use DVD System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 DVDRES FUNCTION Copies one or more AMOS logical disks from a recordable DVD RAM media in a supported DVD RAM drive to AMOS logical disks The logical disk s being copied to must be the same bitmap word size as the AMOS logical disk being copied from n DVDRES is only supported on AM8000 Eagle 800 and AMPC 7 0 Systems CHARACTERISTICS DVDRES copies logical AMOS disk s from a DVD RAM media to an AMOS disk drive The DVD RAM media AMOS disk and the AMOS disk being copied to must be the same bitmap word size The MAKDVD software will create logical drives of differing sizes by padding the smaller logicals DVDRES will not allow for differing bitmap size logicals to be copied If an unequal bitmap word size is tried DVDRES will ignore the request and continue with the restoring FORMAT DVDRES switches OPTIONS HELP Display the available options and exits n Same as HELP DEV xxx Uses device and driver named xxx instead of the d
568. swers the question Can the severity of this incident be changed through accumulation For some incidents you can set in MTUSAV OPT a number of occurrences after which the incident s severity increases This column appears only in some tables e Note Further details are found in the Notes section following each table System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 11 Incident Insufficient memory Bad version 1 x version under AMOS 2 x Cannot locate load or initialize CMDLIN SYS Bad command line switches Invalid line in MTUSAV OPT Error reading MTUSAV OPT Invalid line in MTUSAV INF Error reading MTUSAV INF Cannot spawn slave task Cannot execute TAPSER on slave task Notes Mode Abort Where JOBERR All Yes T JE MSC All Yes T JE MSC All Yes T JE MSC All Yes T JE CLS All No T L All No T L S All No T L b All No T L S ii All Yes __ TL JE MSC All Yes TL JE MSC Initialization Incidents MTUSAV OPT Text Note 3 MTUSAV OPT invalid line 4 MTUSAV OPT read error MTUSAV INF invalid line MTUSAV INF read error 1 This refers only to an insufficient memory condition that exists after MTUSAV LIT has been loaded and starts to execute 2 Only triggered if you run the latest AMOS 1 x version of MTUSAV under AMOS 2 x 3 Some command line switches are automatically adjusted if bad values or incompatible options are selected in which case no error is reported but the adjustments are displayed
569. switches may be abbreviated to any unique characters BATCH Suppresses most screen display output Especially for use with Task Manager to reduce unnecessary screen output to the LOG files BIN Used with binary and data files Carriage returns and nulls are transparent NOJOURNAL Turn journaling off NODISPLAY Turns off display of changes during a journal file recovery NOYANK Opens a file without putting any text into memory Useful for YANKing data into the front of a file too large for your memory READ Opens a file in another account for Read only access Lets you see a file in a protected account You can only exit with Q any changes to the file are not kept SUBROUTINE Executes XED as if it were being called as a subroutine from another program Suppresses most interactive input and output TRACE Displays each line of the XED INI file as it processes OPERATION Enter XED followed by the specification of the file you want to edit For example XED INVEN M68 If the file you specify does not yet exist you are asked if you want to create it Enter for Yes or N for No If you enter N AlphaXED returns you to AMOS command level When you enter a file you see either text or a screen full of lines of asterisks if the file is empty or new Now you can enter or edit your text If the WRAP feature is set to OFF in your XED INI file you must press at the end of each line to begin a new line If the WRAP feature is O
570. system LOKUTL also allows the System Operator when logged into OPR to display the current file lock status and monitor its operation CHARACTERISTICS LOKUTL is re entrant and re usable When you use LOKUTL from OPR LOKUTL enters a privileged mode and allows you to execute a variety of functions When you use LOKUTL from any other account LOKUTL displays the current status of the file locking data base OPERATION FROM STANDARD SYSTEM ACCOUNTS Enter LOKUTL LOKUTL The program displays data on which files and records are currently locked on your system LOKUTL then lists each job currently active The Job ID is shown on the same line as its first file specification Under each job ID LOKUTL lists the files the job is currently using The word Exclusive indicates the file is locked exclusively and the word Writer indicates the file is open for output If it s a random file LOKUTL then lists the records locked by this job If a file is locked exclusively LOKSER doesn t need to lock individual records FROM THE SYSTEM OPERATOR S ACCOUNT Enter LOKUTL as above LOKUTL displays an asterisk prompt to indicate LOKUTL is waiting for a command COMMAND SUMMARY A Abort a User from the Data Base Cancels the program being run by a particular job and releases all of its locked files and records LOKUTL asks you the name of the job and processes the job as if it EXITed The job is not aborted and the files are not CLOSEd as far as
571. system memory The specified LDV was not found in system memory Since LDVs must be in system memory to be used LDVSTS only looks there for them Retrieving driver statistics failed LDVSTS cannot retrieve all the information the driver can provide or the format of the information has changed Contact Alpha Micro for an updated version of LDVSTS System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 Page 3 LDVSTS Usage LDVSTS driver name You must specify the name of the LDV you want LDVSTS to display information for System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 LIBLIT FUNCTION LIBLIT is an object file library generator It combines separate OBJ files into one library LIB file You may also use LIBLIT to update an existing LIB file CHARACTERISTICS LIBLIT is re entrant and re usable A library file gives you a way to make available to all programmers on the system a standardized set of machine language routines It also keeps you from having to rewrite the same utility routines again and again for multiple programs At the time you link your object files into an executable program using LNKLIT or SYMLIT you may include the specification of a library file on the command line If the other files specified on the command line make use of a symbol defined in the library file LNKLIT or SYMLIT will process the routine within the library file that defines that symbol linking it into your program file Each object file placed into the
572. t AlphaBASIC may be unable to read the mag tape data you have written into the file As another example the screen oriented text editor AlphaVUE requires each line end with a carriage return linefeed pair and the line be 510 or less characters For such reasons TAPE optionally appends a carriage return linefeed character pair to the end of every record as it transfers the records from tape to an AMOS disk Beyond converting data from EBCDIC to ASCII or vice versa and optionally appending carriage return linefeed pairs the task of modifying data so it is compatible with AMOS is up to you MTSTAT SYS must be in system memory on older Alpha Micro systems If you have an S 100 Bus system or any non VME system see your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Command File for information about adding it to system memory TAPE only works with sequential disk files containing fixed length data records It does not support any random access file format on the tape Before you use TAPE use the SET BPI command to set the recording density of your tape Remember to note the size of the data records you write to the tape and the number of records you write per tape block when you read the data back to a disk file you will need that information You can read one file after another on the magnetic tape by using TAPE several times in a row without rewinding the tape You can also use the SKIP command to skip over files Some tapes contain
573. t backup Operation switch System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 3 MTUSAV OPTLIST Display the default error severity settings or with LOG output them to MTUSAV LOG file Does not perform a backup All other switches are ignored Operation switch NOOPTLIST Do not display error severity settings Default operation switch OPT2LIST Same as OPTLIST except settings are written to MTUSAV LOG in format usable for MTUSAV OPT file as described below Operation switch NOOPT2LIST Do not display error severity settings Default operation switch QUERY Confirm before selecting files NOQUERY Do not confirm files Default SOFTABORT Allow rest of command or control file to execute if MTUSAV detects an incident with an Error severity Otherwise command and control files are aborted Operation switch NOSOFTABORT Abort command or control file after MTUSAV error Default operation switch SUPPRESS Don t list file names or account numbers on terminal as they are backed up May speed up backup NOSUPPRESS List files on the terminal Default SYSFILES Look for MTUSAV INF and MTUSAV OPT only in OPR instead of normal search path 1 login account 2 P 0 3 OPR Operation switch NOSYSFILES Use normal search path for MTUSAV INF and MTUSAV OPT Default operation switch TIMEOUT n Number of minutes for a command file to wait for terminal input or a control file to wait for an error condition
574. t file Nulls are discarded and not rewritten to the sorted file resulting in lost data You may press C at this time to terminate the sort and leave your data intact or press RETURN to continue There is at least one non ASCII character in the file you are sorting System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SRCCOM FUNCTION Compares two sequential files and lists the differences between them CHARACTERISTICS SRCCOM is re entrant and re usable and is useful for distinguishing between two versions of the same file so you can determine what changes have been made FORMAT SRCCOM listfilespec filespec filespec switch The filespecs select the files you want to compare listfilespec is a disk file to hold the comparison and switch is an option request DEFAULTS SRCCOM assumes a file extension of M68 for the filespecs and LST for the listfilespec If no listfilespec is specified the listing is displayed on the terminal OPTIONS The switches may be abbreviated QUICK List only differences BRIEF List only differences without line numbers OPERATION Enter SRCCOM and optionally the specification of the file you want to create to hold the file comparison Then type an equal sign and the two files you want to compare If you want a brief or quick listing use the B or Q option For example SRCCOM CMPARE CTLOG1 TXT CTLOG2 TXT Now you can edit print or display the list file Here is an example of the
575. t recognize a command you had in the text file TXTFMT inserts the illegal command into your LST file so you can find the problem Line too long remainder of line ignored TXTFMT found a line in your text file of more than 300 characters It ignored everything past the 300th character There are other less commonly seen messages see your TXTFMT User s Manual System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 TYPE FUNCTION Displays a text file on your terminal screen CHARACTERISTICS TYPE is re entrant and re usable TYPE works only on sequential files containing ASCII characters FORMAT TYPE switch filespec switch filespec selects the file you want to see and switch is an option request The default file extension is LST OPTIONS P Display one screen of text at a time Operation switch S n Display at slower speed n selects how slow the higher the number the slower the display File switch OPERATION Enter TYPE and the file you want to display For example TYPE MEMO TXT You now see the file displayed on your terminal screen If the file display covers more than one screen page and you haven t used the P option you can halt the display by pressing the key or by pressing CTRLYS When you want to continue press the key again or press CTRL Q You can press CTRLYC at any time to stop the display If you use P pressing RETURN the down arrow key or the space bar brings up the
576. t reel of tape TAPFIL cannot restore files to extended directories TAPFIL can only be used on traditional format logical devices Use DEVTBL to identify such a device You are not logged in under 1 2 can t create p pn Log into 1 2 and try again Unit number must be between 0 and 7 The unit number you entered is invalid Enter a number between 0 and 7 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TAPLOG FUNCTION Checks quality of tape by reading statistics from certain tapes used by certain SCSI based tape drives CHARACTERISTICS TAPLOG is re entrant and re usable Many newer tape drives particularly DAT drives record Statistics about tape operation in a special area of the tape called the log page TAPLOG uses the LOGSNS command to read and display these statistics It works only with the SCSI dispatcher and only with tape drives that support the LOGSNS command fr The system must be running a SCSI dispatcher in order to run TAPLOG The LOGSNS command is an internal SCSI command that the tape drive must be able to understand LOGSNS is NOT an AMOS command FORMAT TAPLOG devn C devn is the name of the tape device containing the tape you want to check The C switch clears the log page of the tape after reading it OPERATION Mount the tape you want statistics about and type the TAPLOG command For example TAPLOG DATO C This displays the statistics recorded on the tape in the DATO device and c
577. t specified on the command line Try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SET FUNCTION Sets or displays various system and terminal options CHARACTERISTICS SET is re entrant and re usable SET lets you define your own SET verbs If you have a SET INI file in your current account your library account or DSKO 1 4 SET reads the INI file when SET is used The format for an entry in a SET INI file is verb filespec For example GRAPH DSKO GRAPHC LIT 1 4 If you had such a line in a SET INI file entering SET GRAPH at AMOS command level would execute the file DSKO GRAPHC LIT 1 4 When a file is called by SET the register A2 points to the remainder of the SET command line allowing you to add arguments to the keyword FORMAT nN ET option specifications DEFAULTS The system comes up with these options as defaults CTRLC ECHO LOCK ELOCK OCTAL NODSKERR NOGUARD NOREDIRECTION and NOVERIFY The default form type for a specific printer is set by the printer initialization file for that printer The initial tape density at the time of system start up is 1600 BPI OPTIONS ACCESS Turns on access to a network for the device NOACCESS Turns off network access for the device BPI Sets magnetic tape bits per inch rate BROADCAST cpuid Turns on AlphaNET broadcasting Must be in OPR NOBROADCAST cpuid Turns off AlphaNET broadcasting Must be in OPR BUFWRT devn Enables buffered writes on AM 520 disk
578. t the clock calendar by using the TIME and DATE commands OPERATION Enter CAL100 at AMOS command level CAL100 Adjust the trimmer capacitor to exactly 1024 Hz at the calibration test point When you have completed the calibration procedure press CTRL C to exit CAL100 MESSAGES This program is not supported You cannot use CAL100 on this computer System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 CBDS FUNCTION Disables the cache for certain high performance Alpha Micro Central Processing Unit CPU boards such as those using the 68030 68040 or 68060 CPU CHARACTERISTICS CBDS is re entrant and re usable If the cache is already disabled or if there is no on board memory cache on your system CBDS has no effect The on board memory cache controlled by CBEN CBDS should not be confused with the memory cache contained on the CPU chip itself The on chip cache is an instruction cache only The on board cache is a combined instruction and data cache that is transparent to users and programmers in everyday use Both the on chip and on board caches are enabled at bootup time automatically The on chip cache is turned on and off by executing a sequence of program instructions see the AMOS Monitor Calls Manual for details whiile the on board cache is turned off by the CBDS command and re enabled by the CBEN command The on board cache is not affected by the COMPAT database Self modifying code does not have to deal with the on
579. t the interface you want FMTS2 displays a list of the SCSI drives on your computer Select the drive you want to affect and press RETURN The FMTS2 menu then displays as shown on the next page System Commands Reference Manual Rev 15 Page 3 FMTS2 Alpha Micro SCSI Drive Format Utility FMTS2 Version 1 0 101 Selected SCSI ID 00 Vendor QUANTUM Model FIREBALL540S Rev 1009 Functions Select Drive Reassign Blocks Rewrite Hidden Sector Format Drive Info List Defects Initialize Drive Mode Sense To navigate the menus use and WJ To invoke a highlighted function press RETURN To abort menu functions and return to the AMOS prompt press or C To return to menu functions from submenus press ESC You can do any of the following in interactive mode Select Drive Selects drive to use in the operations listed below Reassign Blocks Allows you to add one or more blocks to the drive s grown defect list Enter the number of the physical block to reassign in hex or octal depending on the job s current radix setting Rewrite Hidden Sector Re initializes the drive s hidden sector If the hidden sector becomes corrupted you may use this command to restore it without destroying any user data assuming the hidden sector is initialized as it was before it became corrupted AE Whenever the hidden sector is written the diagnostic cylinder is also re initialized This P gt is necessary since the diagnostic
580. tained a new file Make sure you have the correct disk Files may not be transferred to RES You may only add programs to system memory by using the SYSTEM command in your system INI file Change your output specification to restore the files to the disk Missing output specification You left out the equal sign in the FLPWIN command line FLPWIN couldn t tell which information was your input specification and which was your output specification Try again with an equal sign System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FLPWIN Page 4 More than one output specification Try again with one output specification No file oriented device corresponding to device name is mounted You specified a device but left off the unit number FLPWIN tried to find a logical device that matched the device code you specified but failed to do so Check your syntax or try mounting the device Not copied Destination file already exists You tried to copy to an existing file while the NOD option was in effect Either specify D or move rename or erase the file now on the disk You are not logged in under 1 2 can t create p pn Either log into 1 2 and try again or change your output specification to an existing account System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FMSFLP FUNCTION Formats diskettes using the AM 212 20 SCSI diskette drive initializes diskettes or rewrites the hidden sector CHARACTERISTICS FMSFLP is re entra
581. tal Used Free words SOLS S SOL SPEC T s 234454 5 MA B Bahesssarseacesa a TOTAL 4915200 905417 4009783 edia Label MONTHLY BACKUP megabytes 2400 000 442 098 1957 901 gigabytes 2 3438 0 4317 1 9120 The program has completed REQUIREMENTS AND SETUP DBD requires the following AMOS AM 8000 Eagle 800 or AMPC 7 X based systems 8 1 or later A supported DVD RAM or Blu ray drive DIRBD is only supported on AM 8000 Eagle 800 and AMPC 7 X systems The DBD package contains the following required files DBD LIT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 Page 3 DIRBD e The device driver DBD DVR for the DVD RAM amp Blu ray disc drive in system memory e The SSD overlay file DVD000 OVR e MAKBD LIT e DIRBD LIT e BDRES LIT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 18 DIRSEQ FUNCTION Atranges the entries in the directory of a disk account in alphabetical order All directories may be arranged from account 1 2 CHARACTERISTICS DIRSEQ is re entrant and re usable If you are not in 1 2 you may only sequence the account you are in Arranges the directory based on the RAD50 value of the file names This means names beginning with numbers come after names beginning with letters Do NOT use DIRSEQ while other jobs are accessing the logical disk containing the o account you are sequencing The BADBLK SYS file is always the first file in its account The number o
582. tape it displays a message telling you how many tape blocks were read and how many errors were found MESSAGES Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax and use DEVTBL to see a list of devices on your system You are writing 0 characters in a tape block This message indicates you made an error in entering values to the TAPE questions asking for blocking information Press CTRLVC to exit and try again Tape is not loaded or is not ready press RETURN when it is TAPE cannot read or write to the tape unit you specified Check the unit s status and correct the problem then press RETURN System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TAPFIL FUNCTION Writes files from magnetic tape to disk CHARACTERISTICS TAPFIL is re entrant and re usable and a wildcard file command See your AMOS User s Guide for information on using wildcard commands Used in combination with FILTAP to write disk files to the tape and TAPDIR to see a list of files on magnetic tape This program is included for compatibility purposes for those who have existing tapes fr created by FILTAP MTUSAV and MTURES are the preferred backup methods for magnetic tape see those reference sheets TAPFIL does not work with extended format disks Only reads tapes written by FILTAP Not for transferring data between Alpha Micro and non Alpha Micro computers use TAPE for that Use a separate TAPFIL command for each magnetic tape reel FIL
583. tatus line System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MAKBD FUNCTION Copies one or more AMOS logical disks to a recordable DVD RAM or Blu ray disc BD RE in a supported DVD RAM or Blu ray drive DVDs and BD REs created with MAKBD can be used for system backups DVDs and BD REs created with MAKBD can be easily read with the DIRBD or BDRES programs hh rnovo is NOT compatible with AlphaDBD AlphaDVD supports DVD RAM media ackups AlphaDBD supports DVD RAM and BD RE media The two packages have different formats AlphaDVD copies an entire logical but AlphaDBD copies only used logical blocks AlphaDVD can not read AlphaDBD media and AlphaDBD cannot read AlphaDVD media CHARACTERISTICS MAKBD copies used blocks from logical AMOS disk drives onto a DVD or BD RE in a format that is compatible with the DBD program A DVD can contain up to approximately 4 7 gigabytes of data and a BD RE contains up to 23 gigabytes of data MAKBD creates a drive structure on the DVD or BD RE that is supported by the DBD program Only used blocks are copied to the DVD RAM or BD RE media DVD RAM or BD RE media may be reused MAKBD will start recording at the beginning of the DVD or BD RE and use only as much space as required to hold the used data blocks MAKBD uses the available user memory for data buffers in order to continue supplying data to the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive while other system or multi user activity occurs FORMAT MAKBD switches OPTI
584. tches your terminal to 132 column display and shows this information for each job Name Program being executed How many times the job has run How many times the job has been placed next in the run queue How many times the job has acted as a preemptor job How many times the job has been preempted by another job How many times the job has been placed at the end of the job queue CPU time used Job status bits Number of cached disk reads and writes Total disk reads and writes Percentage of reads and writes that were cached Job priority setting If your terminal is not capable of 132 column display the disk read write and cache information and the job priority do not display The bottom of the screen shows the original uptime the uptime since you last cleared values see below total CPU time used by all jobs the number of jobs in the run queue and the number of jobs in a wait state OPERATION Enter STAT1 at AMOS command level The display is continuously updated If you want to reset it you can type C This clears all fields except the job status and priority and the original uptime System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 STAT1 Page 2 If there are more jobs than fit on your screen you can use the up and down arrows to scroll the list or CTRLYT and CTRLYR to go forward and back When you want to leave the display press ESC Type Q to exit or R to return to the STATI screen System Commands Reference Manual
585. ted by CA This table allows the remote controlled VCR to operate the fast forward ability of your VCR for faster RESTOR operations TO ADJUST THE TRACKING OF YOUR VCR Enter CRT610 TRACK A screen appears displaying information and giving you directions for adjusting your VCR to best match the tape This may improve your chances of restoring data from a tape made on another machine MESSAGES Cannot assign VCRO device in use Turn off your AlphaNET network using the SET NOLINK command remember to inform other users and try again Cannot record tape Cannot write VCRO The VCR tape you are using is write protected the write enable tab has been removed If you do want to write over the data on the tape place a piece of tape over the write enable hole and re insert the tape If you have the wrong tape insert the correct tape or to halt the CRT610 program re insert the tape and use CTRLC Cannot rewind tape The tape may already be rewound or there may be a problem with your VCR check it and try again Illegal cassette size You entered an invalid number of hours in response to the CRT610 V cassette size question You may only enter from 1 to 6 Start over again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 Page 5 CRT610 Illegal number of copies When you are verifying a cassette you must enter from 4 to 255 Start over Record ID error detected while building remote VCR tables The tape you used was not lon
586. tely necessary Use the MTUxxx commands for all tape backup and CRT620 to create warm boot tapes CHARACTERISTICS RESTOR is re entrant re usable and a wildcard command Files can be transferred into the disk account you are logged into from another account on the backup medium regardless of project number However files can t be transferred to a disk account if they are not in the same project number you are logged into unless you re logged into the operator s account 1 2 RESTOR is used with BACKUP which transfers files from the disk to the specified backup medium and BAKDIR which gives a directory of files from the backup medium RESTOR works on both traditional and extended format disks Unless you are using a VCR and T RESTOR locks up all other users on your system Inform other users before using RESTOR RESTOR can be set up to use a default backup device This is useful if you normally use one device for most or all of your backups When this default is in effect you don t have to tell RESTOR what device you wish to use thus saving a step in the backup process To set up a device as the default define an ersatz name called BACKUP in your ERSATZ INI file For example BACKUP VCRO Define the device you want as your default backup device after the name If you want to use another device after the default device has been set up you can specify the OVERRIDE switch and you are prompted for the name of the device yo
587. ter CRT610 C CRT610 c If you have a manually operated recorder follow CRT610 s instructions CRT610 reads each block of the tape and checks it for accuracy This takes as long as it did to originally record the tape As it reads CRT610 displays statistics about the tape If all totals are zero either the tape is completely bad or the VCR unit is not connected to the system properly Total Blocks Read is the number of unique blocks on the tape Total Copies Read is the actual number of blocks read Total CRC Errors is the number of bad blocks read that could be recovered Total Hard Errors is the number of unrecoverable bad blocks Reliability Ratio is the number of blocks read per CRC soft error You should write these totals on the case of the cassette to give you an idea of how the tape is wearing A low Reliability Ratio may indicate hard errors can occur unless you increase the number of extra copies the next time you record on the tape CRC errors are acceptable as long as the Reliability Ratio is greater than 100 1 If you get a hard error check to see if you have equipment problems If that is not the case re run CRT610 using C and H and CRT610 will try four times to recover the hard error If the data System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 Page 3 CRT610 still cannot be recovered CRT610 aborts this means the tape is bad and no data past the hard error can be recovered Recover what you can off the tape and disc
588. the AM 415 controller board without going through the disk driver program Therefore you MUST NOT run CRT415 at the same time as other programs that access devices that run under control of the AM 415 CRT415 destroys all data that may currently exist on the device it certifies Therefore you must make backup copies of all your files before you use CRT415 You must be logged into the System Operator s account DSKO 1 2 to run CRT415 The file BADBLK SYS 1 2 contains a list of all bad disk blocks on the certi fied device For information on the program you can use to display the BADBLK SYS file see the BADBLK reference sheet Multiple logical devices on the same Winchester technology physical unit share the same BADBLK SYS file FORMAT CRT415 devn switch devn is the specification of the device you want to certify and switch is an option OPTIONS IZ Initialize the disk by writing data to every block on the disk in addition to certifying the contents of BADBLK SYS This takes longer than regular certifying System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 CRT415 Page 2 OPERATION Log into OPR and enter CRT415 and the device you want to certify For example LOG OPR CRT415 DSKO CRT415 warns you the program will destroy all the data on your disk Make sure you have backed up any data on the disk you may need You can interrupt the program at this point by pressing CTRLYC If you continue CRT415 creates
589. the cartridge and scans it to select which files to restore This allows STRRES to stop looking when it locates the files without scanning the whole cartridge Use Q to ask for confirmation before each selection Enter a Y for Yes or an N for No after each STRRES prompt You don t need to RETURN For example STRRES OLD DSK3 BAS 10 QUERY STRO DSK3 B32 BAS 10 4 to DSK2 B32 OLD 10 4 STRO DSK3 SCRTCH BAS 10 6 to DSK2 SCRTCH OLD Y 0 10 6 N You may press CTRLVC at any time to stop the transfer When STRRES has located each file in the directory it begins transferring them to the disk and accounts you have specified When it is finished STRRES tells you how many files were transferred System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 Page 3 STRRES MESSAGES Bypassing BADBLK SYS 1 2 BADBLK SYS exists to prevent bad blocks ona device from being allocated and should never be directly accessed An informative message Bypassing STRTOC IPF 1 2 STRTOC IPF is the name of Table of contents file from tape cannot be destination file name An informative message Cannot find DSKO SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS STRRES needs this file to process wildcard symbols in your file specifications This message can mean SCNWLD SYS does not exist or you do not have enough memory to load the file into your partition Cannot INIT device name device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEV
590. the command line than DIR could handle Break your command into smaller commands 2MEM or RES specified on network You cannot access MEM or RES over the network More than one output specification Try again with only one listfile specification No such files DIR couldn t find any files matching your file specifications Check your entry or specify DIR to see what files are in the account Specification error Your command line isn t in the proper format The symbol points to the error Wildcard device or unit specified on network You cannot use wildcard symbols over the network Type in the full specification for the files you want to see System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DIRBD FUNCTION Produces a directory listing of the AMOS logicals on the media in the selected DVD RAM or Blu ray device DBD o DIRBD is only supported on AM 8000 Eagle 800 and AMPC 7 X systems CHARACTERISTICS DIRBD reads the selected media and displays the AMOS logicals FORMAT DIRBD OPTIONS None OPERATION o DIRBD works best on a job with 132 columns set as the terminal width Before starting the program place the DVD or BD RE media in the DVD RAM or Blu ray drive Type DIRBD from the AMOS prompt DIRBD DIRBD will attempt to find a DVD RAM or Blu ray drive by defaulting to DBD The driver DBD DVR must be loaded in system memory If more than one DVD RAM or Blu ray type device is found when scanning the
591. the commands It has been allocated memory and logged in but one or more commands failed to process You must specify a memory size of at least 512 bytes SETJOB can only allocate a job more than 512 bytes of memory Re enter the command line with a larger memory allocation Unable to locate job with specified name You tried to attach a terminal to a job not defined in the JOBS command in your system initialization command file Use SYSTAT to see a list of the jobs defined on the system Unable to locate terminal with specified name You tried to attach a job to a terminal not defined in a TRMDEF command in your system initialization command file Use TRMDEF to see a complete list of all of the terminals defined on your computer System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 SETPEN FUNCTION Lets you set read write penalties for disk activity CHARACTERISTICS SETPEN lets you set the read write penalty values for a particular logical disk The read write penalty value affects the amount of time a job is charged for performing disk activity With intelligent disk controllers a disk read or write requested by a job can continue into another job s time slice effectively reducing the amount of time the following job receives Changing the penalty setting can have two advantages it can prevent jobs performing heavy disk access from excessively slowing other jobs on the system and it causes the amount of CPU time being used by each job
592. then displayed DVD RAM drive found at SCSI id x BITMAP CD title XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX WORDS DVD RAM contains x logical units DVDO XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX XXX mounted xXxXxxx DVD1 XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX XXX mounted xXxxxx DVD2 XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX XXX mounted xXxxxx DVD3 XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX XXX mounted xXxxxx DVD4 XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX ERROR zero UFD link 0 DVD5 XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX XXX mounted xXxxxx Blank logical with no data DVDRES then asks for the DVD Logical s that you wish to copy Which DVD Logical s would you like to restore System Commands Reference Manual Rev 17 Page 3 DVDRES Enter list of disk logicals to be transferred Disk logicals may be entered as a range ex Dev0 20 for devO thru dev20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line Enter the logical drives to be copied from DVDO 4 DVDRES then asks for the AMOS Disk Logical s that you wish to copy to Which Disk Logical s would you like to restore to Enter list of disk Logicals to be transferred Disk Logicals may be entered as a range ex Dev0 20 for dev0 thru dev20 or may be comma separated The list is terminated with a blank line Enter the logical drives to be copied to AGBO 4 The copying process then begins As it progresses status messages are displayed The following is a sample of a DVDRE
593. these incidents aren t listed in that file MTUSAV searches for MTUSAV INF using the following search path 1 Login account of the MTUSAV job 2 P 0 account of the MTUSAV job 3 DSKO 1 2 If MTUSAV INF is not found MTUSAV assumes all files are handled through its standard incident handling scheme If you use the SYSFILES switch MTUSAV looks for MTUSAV INF only in DSKO 1 2 MTUSAV INF is an ASCII sequential file Each line contains a single unambiguous file specification Wildcarding is not supported and a full device drive filename ppn specification is strongly recommended If any part of the full file specification is missing MTUSAV defaults that part of the specification to the current login device and or account This can cause a problem as MTUSAV will behave differently if you run it from different accounts Blank lines text after a semicolon or hash character and tabs or spaces before or after a file specification are all ignored letting you format and comment the file for best readability These incidents are affected by MTUSAV INF e During backup phase sequential file in use contiguous file in use contiguous file hijacked contiguous file record in use e During verification phase tape file does not match disk file file not found sequential file in use All other incidents such as disk errors are always treated and reported as errors even for files listed in MTUSAV INF System Commands Reference Manual
594. tialization file The available CD recorder device driver files are supplied either with the MAKACD package or with the Alpha Micro CD recorder you purchased The device driver must be installed in DSKO 1 6 and given the same name as the CD recorder device in the DEVTBL statement For example using the supplied CDRMMC DVR device driver and the device name CDR you would have DEVTBL CDRO in the system initialization file Then copy the supplied device driver as follows LOG DSKO 1 6 COPY CDR DVR CDRMMC DVR If desired you may load the device driver into system memory during system initialization by adding the following statement in you system initialization file SYSTEM DSKO CDR DVR 1 6 This statement should be added in the same area of the initialization file that is currently loading other system device drivers The CDR DEV device information file must be installed in DSKO 1 4 This file is supplied with the MAKACD package or with the Alpha Micro CD recorder If you received more than one copy of the file you should use the newer one You must enter the Product Installation Code PIC to actuate MAKACD Contact your dealer for the PIC for your computer system The first time you attempt to use MAKACD you will be asked to enter the PIC After entering the correct PIC MAKACD is ready to use MESSAGES Command line syntax messages e Error Cannot have EJECT TOC NOTOC together e Error Cannot have TE
595. time zone This is necessary so UTC can convert the time as received from the Observatory to your local time The time zone can be specified using one of the three character time zone names shown below or for those users outside of North America can be specified as the number of hours difference between your local time zone and Universal Time Coordinated UTC also known as Greenwich Mean Time GMT or Zulu Time Z The difference is negative for time zones west of Greenwich and positive for those located east For example Pacific Standard Time can be given as either PST or 8 The symbolic time zones the UTC program understands are AST Atlantic Standard Time ADT Atlantic Daylight Time EST Eastern Standard Time EDT Eastern Daylight Time CST Central Standard Time CDT Central Daylight Time MST Mountain Standard Time MDT Mountain Daylight Time PST Pacific Standard Time PDT Pacific Daylight Time YST Yukon Standard Time YDT Yukon Daylight Time HST Hawaii Alaska Standard Time HDT Hawaii Alaska Daylight Time NST Nome Standard Time NDT Nome Daylight Time System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 UTC The optional dial prefix argument lets you specify any special dialing information that must precede the main telephone number such as digits to access an outside phone line to select a long distance carrier or to specify necessary country codes In addition to the digits 1 9 you may also use the and characters A c
596. to add to the bad block list is already listed Make sure you entered the block numbers correctly Error sending REQUEST SENSE command The SCSI drive returned an error condition when the list of defects were read The drive is not usable in its current state Invalid command The command you entered is not allowed Check your entry or use the help option to see the proper commands and formats Illegal disk address The block or track and head number you specified is outside the valid range for the device Check your entry and or the specifications for the device Make sure you entered the block in the correct radix M command not allowed on device name You cannot use the M command with the specified device S command not allowed on SCSI drives You cannot change the serial number of a SCSI disk device using BADBLK SCSI error code type n code n BADBLK had difficulty with the SCSI device See the System Operator s Guide for an explanation of the error code and type System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 5 BADBLK Unable to delete or add entry If deleting the block you specified was not listed If adding this appears after the Duplicate entry message if the block is already listed Unable to read Bad Block Map insufficient memory There is not enough free memory in your memory partition to read in the bad block map from the disk Delete unwanted memory modules or increase the size of your partition with
597. to an operator s account 1 2 or the command must appear in your system initialization command file before the final SYSTEM command You cannot use JOBPRI to change any job s priority if dynamic job priority scheduling is active You turn dynamic scheduling on and off using the SET command you can adjust the values in the dynamic scheduling priority table using the ADJIT command FORMAT JOBPRI jobname priority Jobname is the name of the job whose priority you want to change and priority is the number of clock ticks you want the job to have OPERATION To find out your job s priority enter JOBPRI JOBPRI Current priority is 13 System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 JOBPRI Page 2 To find out another job s priority enter JOBPRI and the name of the job For example JOBPRI MELVIN Current priority is 15 To change your job s priority enter JOBPRI and a priority number For example JOBPRI 50 To change the priority of another user s job log into 1 2 enter JOBPRI the name of the job and a priority number For example LOG 1 2 JOBPRI MELVIN 50 MESSAGES Dynamic job priority scheduling is active Request is denied You cannot change any job s priority while dynamic job priority scheduling is active You can turn dynamic scheduling on and off using the SET command Illegal job priority level You specified a number less than 1 or greater than 254 Re enter a valid number Nonexistent
598. to certify CRT520 PLDO Make sure you have backed up any data you need from the disk CRT520 destroys all data on the disk You can stop CRT520 at this point by pressing CTRLYC CRT520 displays a menu of supported drive types Select the type of drive you want to format The program then asks you for the drive serial number Enter the number up to 20 characters CRT520 then asks if you want to format using a bad block map or a defect list The next two sections describe the procedures Alpha Micro recommends you use After that is a discussion of the other methods available If the drive has not been formatted on an AM 520 before Choose option 2 format using a defect list Then CRT520 asks if you want the formatting data from a file from the drive or from the keyboard Select 2 again to take the bad block information directly from the manufacturer s defect list built into the drive You then have the option of saving the media defect list and the bad block map in files These files are created in the account you re currently logged into not on the drive you re formatting We strongly recommend you create these two files e The defect list default name DEFECT DEF is an ASCII file containing all the media defect information from the drive e The bad block map default name DEFECT MAP is a binary file an exact copy of the bad block map CRT520 writes to the hidden area of the drive during formatting CRT520 now writes the format
599. to change the protection level of files as you rename them Each file on an extended disk has a protection level controlling who can access and modify that file The default is 0505051717 For more about protection see your System Operator s Guide For example RENAME MYTEXT P 0505051210 If you use Q RENAME asks you to confirm the renamings For example RENAME Q BASTXT WRKFIL WRKTXT WRKFIL BAS to BASTXT BAS Y WRKTXT TXT to BASTXT TXT N You may press TRLYC to stop further renamings MESSAGES Account does not exist x x Check your syntax find the correct account using PPN or create the account you need and try again Bypassing BADBLK SYS 1 2 BADBLK SYS exists to prevent bad blocks on a device from being allocated and should never be directly accessed No files transferred You can t rname BADBLK SYS 1 2 Cannot find DSKO CMDLIN SYS 1 4 The RENAME program needs this file to be able to process wildcard symbols See if CMDLIN SYS exists in DSKO 1 4 if it does it means you didn t have enough memory to load it into your partition If so try to increase your memory by erasing unnecessary files See your System Operator for further help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 RENAME Cannot RENAME filename file already exists You tried to rename a file but a file of that name already exists If you want RENAME to overwrite the existing file use the D option
600. to copy disk files to magnetic tape and TAPFIL to copy files from tape to disk The tape you read with TAPDIR must have been written by FILTAP TAPDIR is a wildcard command The account and device portions of the specifications refer to the disk account and device the files were backed up from See your AMOS User s Guide for information on wildcards TAPDIR only works under AMOS 32 and AMOS L versions of the operating system This program is included for compatibility purposes for those who have existing tapes created by FILTAP MTUSAV and MTURES are the preferred backup methods for magnetic tape see those reference sheets TAPDIR does not work with extended format disks FORMAT TAPDIR switch listfilespec filespec filespec switch is an option request and the filespec s specify the files on the tape whose directory listing you want to see The optional listfilespec specifies a disk file to contain the tape directory display DEFAULTS The default listfilespec is DIRECT LST in the account and device you are logged into The listfilespec extension default is LST The default filespec is and the account and device you are logged into The default magnetic tape drive device specification is MTU OPTIONS KILL or K Overwrites matching listfiles Operation switch OPERATION Enter TAPDIR and the files you need For example TAPDIR ALL System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TAPDIR Page 2 TAPDIR
601. totals and a new accumulation summary starts PAGE III OPERATION ESNIC returns the following information from the PCI hardware PAGE I Static Page BASE 10 24 is PCI base address amp memory requirements RDA is Rx descriptor starting amp ending address TDA is Tx descriptor starting amp ending address RBA is Rx buffer area MBADDR is the next available PCI memory address MEMEND is the system end of memory address CBMAR is the starting address for the PCI port 0 card PCIPBR BUF is the address of the PCI informational memory module System Commands Reference Manual Rev 14 ESNIC Page 2 PCI IMPURE is the address of the PCI impure area PCI FLAGS is the general flags PCI P0 FLAGS is the Port 0 flags PCI P1 FLAGS is the Port 1 flags RDA count is the number of Rx descriptors TDA count is the number of Tx descriptors PAGE Il Rx amp Tx Status Page Broadcast Ours is the count of broadcast packets sent by us Broadcast All is the count of all broadcast packets Interrupts Total is the count of all interrupts Rx Interrupts All is the count of all Rx interrupts Tx Interrupts All is the count of all Tx interrupts Both Rx amp Tx Int is the count of all interrupts with Rx amp Tx bits set RDA Last amp First is the count of Rx packets with the last amp first segment bit set Tx Collision count is the total Tx collision counts returned from the chip Unregistered Type is the total count of unidentifiable
602. ts terminal characteristics see below Sets the system into test mode by setting a bit in the SYSTEM longword in the monitor See Appendix C of the AMOS Monitor Calls Manual for details Sets the system out of test mode by clearing a bit in the SYSTEM longword in the monitor See Appendix C of the AMOS Monitor Calls Manual for details Verifies each write operation by re reading data Does NOT compare written data with data in memory Does not verify write operations Clears the ignore IS ABT flag processing Except for those options which include an optional jobname these options are only set for the job that used SET With the SET TERMINAL option you have a number of added commands Enter WIDTH SCROLL HEIGHT n FCOLOR foreground BCOLOR background or DRIVER then a setting or a driver name If TERMINAL alone is specified SET displays settings The WIDTH can be 80 or 132 colors can be 0 Black 1 White 2 Blue 3 Magenta 4 Red 5 Yellow 6 Green 7 Cyan Scrolling can be 0 Jump 1 Fastest smooth 2 Fast smooth 3 Medium smooth 4 Slow smooth The SET TERMINAL commands can be abbreviated to any unique name i e SET TERMINAL DRIVER filespec could be SET TDV filespec SET TERMINAL HEIGHT lets you define the number of lines on your terminal screen if your terminal supports this feature With SET PROMPT you can enter the actual string you want or one or more codes from this list
603. tte See the CRT610 reference sheet for more information MESSAGES Cannot find DSKO SCNWLD SYS 1 4 or MEM SCNWLD SYS VCRSAV needs this file to be able to process wildcard symbols in your file specifications This can mean SCNWLD SYS does not exist or you do not have enough memory to load the file into your partition Cannot save File beyond 32mb boundary Use BACKUP command One of the files you ve specified is past the 32Mb boundary of an extended disk You must use BACKUP to save these files Discrepancy in file block count for filename Process suspended while saving filename The transfer is now complete Job aborted This message is given if the actual number of blocks in a file does not equal the count in the table of contents VCRSAV aborts the job and marks the tape with an end of tape marker at the point before the bad file All files prior to that point can be restored This indicates your disk has an error Run DSKANA to correct the file error then re run VCRSAV again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VCRSAV Page 4 Field size exceeded Re enter While entering the label information you tried to put more data into a field than it could hold Check the maximum field length and try again File read error detected while saving filename Process suspended while saving filename The transfer is now complete Job aborted This message appears if a disk error occurred VCRSAV aborts the job and m
604. tten out to the disk FORMAT MTURES outfilespec filespec filespec switch outfilespec specifies the files to be created on the disk the filespec s specify the files to be transferred from the magnetic tape and switch is an option request DEFAULTS The input specification defaults to the device and account you are logged into The output specification defaults to the input specification in the case of the filename and extension and to the account and device you are currently logged into Therefore if you do not specify a device everything on the tape will be written to the device you are logged into For example if you are logged into DSKO everything on the tape will be written onto DSKO even if the files were originally backed up from other disks Be careful to specify an output specification if the files on the tape came from more than one disk unless you do intend to transfer them all onto one disk System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MTURES Page 2 If you are logged into the System Operator s account DSKO 1 2 the default output specification is all accounts This means files will be restored to their original accounts the ones from which they were backed up If an account does not exist on the disk MTURES creates it If you are logged into account 1 2 on any other disk the output specification is all accounts on that logical disk OPTIONS The switches are file switches an
605. ty MTUSAV tracks all incidents it encounters and reports them along the way as detailed below Just before it finishes MTUSAV sets JOBERR to an appropriate value Because JOBERR can only hold one value and any number of incidents can occur during MTUSAYV it is important to understand MTUSAV s concept of Incident Severity and Incident Priority System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 9 MTUSAV With the exception of a few extremely serious incidents and a Control C user abort MTUSAV classifies all incidents into three severity levels Severity Role Symbol Note Least severe will not set JOBERR on exit lt N gt Warning More severe will set JOBERR to JESWRN on exit lt W gt Fatal Most severe will set JOBERR to JE MSC or other value lt E gt shown in the error tables on exit All incidents are preset to one of these severities For some incidents the severity cannot be changed for others you can override the default severity by making an entry in the MTUSAV OPT file You can also use MTUSAV OPT to have MTUSAV accumulate a number of less severe incidents into one more more severe one This lets you tailor MTUSAV s operation for an individual system environment For example on some systems having a sequential file open during a backup could be classified as an error while on other systems it may be worth only a note Or while any single open file could be a note ten or more should be treated as a warning Using M
606. u are debugging was not found in the same directory as the file being debugged FIX will continue but it can only display numeric information and offsets rather than symbolic literals and labels What AlphaFIX does not recognize your command System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIXCRC FUNCTION Reads and re writes a disk block to try to correct a bad Cyclic Redundancy Checksum CRC CHARACTERISTICS FIXCRC is re entrant and re usable You must be logged into an operator s account 1 2 to use FIXCRC You cannot use FIXCRC over a network The data written back to the specified disk block may not be correct but at least you will be able to access that block You should check the contents of the block for accuracy using DUMP after using FIXCRC FORMAT FIXCRC devn block devn is the disk device and block is the number of the block you wish to try to correct The default device is DSKO and the block number defaults to block zero OPERATION Log into 1 2 Enter FIXCRC and the device and or block number For example LOG 1 2 FIXCRC DSK1 512 The block number is in either octal or hex depending on your job s current setting If the block can t be corrected an error message will be displayed Sometimes the block can be read from the disk seemingly successfully especially if the CRC error is in a non data part of the disk sector However some drives or controllers return a block filled with zeroes if a
607. u can also use the row column format to perform TCRT functions by subtracting the first number of the TCRT call from 256 For example an AlphaBASIC TAB 5 42 would be XY 251 42 TO SELECT A SCREEN FUNCTION TCRT 1 n Enter XY an equal sign and the number of the screen function you want to perform For example XY 0 RETURN XY 32 RETURN The first command clears your screen The second turns on reverse video so characters are displayed the opposite way they normally are i e if your screen normally displays green letters on a black background you would see black letters on a green background USING DIRECT FORMAT To use any TCRT function enter XY and the TCRT codes For example XY 2 1 This sets the foreground color to color number 1 You can use any of the three formats to perform a TCRT 1 n function For example each of these commands clears the screen xy 0 Screen function format xy 255 0 Row column format xy 1 0 Direct format System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 640INI FUNCTION Loads the AM 515 controller with AM 640 mag tape interface microcode Use after warm booting from a mag tape attached to the AM 640 paddle card to provide file structured access to tapes created with MTUSAV or another file structured tape utility CHARACTERISTICS 640INI is re entrant and re usable It works only if you have an AM 515 10 in your VME system If not your job may lock up if you try to run 640INI 6
608. u may have mistyped the name See your Alpha Micro representative if you need help restoring the driver to the proper account DSKO 1 6 Could not load driver name AMOS error message The driver could not be loaded for the reason given You may not be logged into DSKO 1 6 or you may have typed the name incorrectly Try to correct the situation or see your Alpha Micro representative for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 5 FIXLOG Invalid device driver The device driver for your drive is incorrect See your Alpha Micro representative for help Invalid entry Must be between x and y You entered an invalid number Check the choices allowed and re enter System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 FIXTRN FUNCTION Lets you create and edit function key translation files CHARACTERISTICS FIXTRN is re entrant and re usable Creates a file on the disk with a default extension of XLT which can then be loaded into user or system memory as needed You must be on the same type of terminal as the one the XLT file will be used on You will get unpredictable results if you use FIXTRN on a file that is not a function key translation table FORMAT FIXTRN translation table nam OPERATION Enter FIXTRN and the translation table name For example FIXTRN KEYS If the file does not exist you are asked if you want to create it FIXTRN then asks Enter the unique character to termi
609. u originally created the file did not match the data in the data file the record size in the data file is not the same as the size you specified to ISMBLD Illegal device specification Use DEVTBL to see a list of legal devices and try again Invalid record size Make sure all your records are less than 513 bytes Invalid number Check the proper range of numbers for the question and try again ISBAFL Data file full You did not specify enough records when you built the ISAM file When you loaded the ISAM file the data file was not large enough to hold all of the data ISBXFL Index file full You did not specify enough additional index blocks when you built the ISAM file When you loaded the ISAM file with data the index was not large enough to hold the necessary entries System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 ISMBLD Page 4 Key must be within record You entered an incorrect number for the record or key size Check the size limits and try again Key size causes entries per index block to be 2 or less Key size must be reduced Try again with a smaller key size System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 ISMDMP FUNCTION ISMDMP writes the contents of an ISAM data file to a sequential file or displays the structure of an index file on your terminal CHARACTERISTICS ISAM Indexed Sequential Access Method is a method of organizing and accessing data An ISAM file is a data fil
610. u wish to use If you don t have a default device and if you don t use OVERRIDE RESTOR presents a menu of available devices to select from System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 RESTOR FORMAT Page 2 RESTOR switch outfspec fspec fspec switch switch is an option request The fspecs define files to be restored You must use the exact file specification as it was written onto the backup medium by BACKUP The outfspec defines which device and account the backed up files are written to on the disk It also allows you to rename the files as they are copied onto the disk DEFAULTS The default fspec is the device and account you are logged into and is equivalent to entering RESTOR outspec RETURN The outfilespec defaults to the filename of fspec and the device and account you are logged into If you are logged into the System Operator s account DSKO 1 2 the default outfspec is all accounts If you are logged into account 1 2 on any other disk the default is all accounts on that disk OPTIONS Placing NO before the switch turns it off The default switches are D NOH NOQ NOS and NOT AFTER date time BEFORE date time DELETE HASH OVERRIDE QUERY SUPPRESS TRANSFER Restore only files that were last updated after the specified date and or time Operation switch Restore only files that were last updated before the specified date and or time Operation switch
611. ucer SCI 232 154 9A Single Character Introducer Cc CSI 233 155 9B Control Sequence Introducer Cc ST 234 156 9C String Terminator Cc OSC 235 157 9D Operating System Command Cc PM 236 158 9E Privacy Message Cc APC 237 159 OF Application Program Cc Command NBSP 240 160 AO No Break Space Zs i 241 161 Al Inverted Exclamation Mark Po 242 162 A2 Cent Sign Sc 243 163 A3 Pound Sign Sc x 244 164 A4 Currency Sign Sc 245 165 A5 Yen Sign Sc i 246 166 A6 Broken Bar So 247 167 A7 Section Sign So 250 168 A8 Diaeresis Lm 251 169 A9 Copyright Sign So 252 170 AA Feminine Ordinal Indicator So 253 171 AB Left Pointing Double Angle Ps Quotation Mark i 254 172 AC Not Sign Sm 255 173 AD Soft Hyphen Po 256 174 AE Registered Sign So 257 175 AF Macron Lm 260 176 BO Degree Sign So 261 177 Bl Plus Minus Sign Sm 2 262 178 B2 Superscript Two So 2 263 179 B3 Superscript Three So 264 180 B4 Acute Accent Lm u 265 181 B5 Micro Sign So q 266 182 B6 Pilcrow Sign So 267 183 B7 Middle Dot Po f 270 184 B8 Cedilla Lm 1 271 185 B9 Superscript One So 2 272 186 BA Masculine Ordinal Indicator So 273 187 BB Right Pointing Double Angle Pe Quotation Mark 14 274 188 BC Vulgar Fraction One Quarter So YW 275 189 BD Vulgar Fraction One Half So 34 276 190 BE Vulgar Fraction Three So Quarters 277 191 BF Inverted Question Mark Po A 300 192 co Latin Capital Letter A With Lu Grave 301 193 Cl Latin Capital Letter A With Lu Acute A 302 194
612. uld be re assembled or the library file rebuilt using a current version of the software Fatal error Insufficient memory See your System Operator about increasing the size of your memory partition System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 LNKLIT Page 4 Fatal error Overlays of code are not permitted Next expected address is address Overlay code address is address Your program is trying to overlay previous code Check your M68 programs to make sure your overlay references are correct Fatal error Overlay symbol symbol in segment segment name was not defined in a previous input segment You may not reference an undefined overlay In other words LNKLIT is trying to process a supposed overlay file but has seen no references to the overlay in a previous file Without such a reference LNKLIT cannot construct the overlay so it aborts and returns you to AMOS command level Fatal error Overwriting of impure zone not permitted Next expected address is xxxx Overwriting address is yyyy You backstepped the DSECT location counter overwriting previously allocated storage in a DSECT area symbol undefined An external symbol is undefined This is a very common error You have referenced a symbol which has not previously been defined Make sure an EXTERNed symbol in one segment is defined by an INTERN statement in another segment Undefined switch switch ignored Try again using a valid s
613. um of four times if a hard error is found remote control VCRs only TRACK Lets you adjust the tracking of your VCR to optimize a restore VERIFY Writes data to cassette reads it back and prints statistics Destroys all data on the tape System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 CRT610 Page 2 OPERATION TO CREATE A WARM BOOT MONITOR TAPE Create a warm boot monitor disk file using WRMGEN Load a blank cassette into your VCR and enter CRT610 followed by the optional file specification of the warm boot monitor For example CRT610 SPECAL WRM If you enter just a file name and extension CRT610 looks first in DSKO 1 4 if the file is not there it searches the device and account you are in It then asks you for information to put in the cassette label Volume name maximum of 40 characters Volume ID maximum of ten characters Installation maximum of 30 characters System maximum of 30 characters and Creator maximum of 30 characters The video recorder is activated and file transfer occurs If the recorder you are using is not a remote controlled VIDEOTRAX Video Tape Recorder VTR CRT610 steps you through operating the VCR rewinding the cassette recording the boot monitor onto the cassette and stopping the VCR Use CRT610 C to check the cassette is good Label the cassette container and return it to its storage location TO CHECK A PREVIOUSLY RECORDED CASSETTE Load the cassette you want to check into the VCR En
614. umber of Tx packet that were not sent out directly Illegal Descriptor is number of illegal descriptors encountered PAGE III Clearing Accumulated Totals All totals are cleared and a new accumulation summary starts MESSAGES ERROR This program is for an AM 7000 only This program is only for an AM 7000 Ethernet controller ERROR invalid switch The switch you specified is invalid ERROR invalid impure index The PCI impure index has changed PCI memory has been corrupted ERROR PCIPBR BUF not found in system memory The PCI bus was not properly initialized System Commands Reference Manual Rev 14 ESNIC FUNCTION Displays Ethernet statistical information accumulated by the PCI LAN driver LDV for use only with the Eagle 450 computer system LDVs are similar to NDVs The most notable difference is that LDVs are hardware S drivers only They do not perform any network protocol specific functions Use this command only on the Eagle 450 CHARACTERISTICS ESNIC is re entrant and re usable It displays Ethernet statistical information retrieved from a central depository The LDV updates the central depository continuously You can press CTRL C at any time to exit the program FORMAT ESNIC S C B If no switch is provided a usage prompt is displayed OPTIONS IS Retrieves PCI static page PAGE D IC Retrieves PCI Rx and Tx status page PAGE ID IE Clears accumulated
615. und The file was not found on the MS DOS diskette Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again Invalid file type Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again Invalid path specified Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again This is not a supported MS DOS format Sorry but can t be decoded Your floppy diskette is in a format DOSIMP can t read Unable to open filespec DOSIMP couldn t open the file on the AMOS side Check your AMOS directory and syntax System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DOSMKD FUNCTION Creates a subdirectory on an MS DOS formatted diskette under the specified directory CHARACTERISTICS DOSMKD is re entrant re usable and works with these diskette formats 5 4 360K 3 1 44M To use this command you must have a proper disk driver program for your computer s type of floppy disk and defined as MS DOS format when created by FIXFLP The device must be defined in BITMAP and DEVTBL statements in your system initialization command file you may want to load the driver into system memory See your system operator for help FORMAT DOSMKD devn path devn is the name of the diskette device and path is the route to the directory including the new directory name If you specify only the new directory name it is created under the root directory OPERATION Enter DOSMKD the device specification you want to create a directory on and the path
616. up media and RESTOR which copies files from backup media to a hard disk AE When you are using a VCR except with the TRANSFER option BACKUP locks up all SS other users on your system Notify other users before using BACKUP BACKUP can be set up to use a default backup device This is useful if you normally use one device for most or all of your backups When this default is in effect you don t have to tell BACKUP what device you wish to use thus saving a step in the backup process To set a device as the default define an ersatz device called BACKUP in your ERSATZ INI file For example BACKUP MTUO Define the device you want as your default backup device after the name If you want to use another device after the default device has been set you can use the OVERRIDE switch to be prompted for the device name If you don t have a default device and you don t use OVERRIDE BACKUP presents a menu of available devices to select from FORMAT BACKUP switch filespec filespec s switch switch is an option request and filespec s specify the files to be transferred System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 BACKUP DEFAULTS Page 2 The default filespec is and the device and account you are logged into For video tape backup the default number of copies is 5 OPTIONS All switches may be abbreviated to any unique characters Placing NO before a switch turns that switch off The default switches are
617. up by software usually in the system initialization file AMSCFG will generally not report the presence of the device AMSCFG only detects Herbie controllers AM 515 AM 520 and AM 522s by looking at DVR files and comparing fields with standard Alpha Micro defined IO memory space locations DVRs using non standard locations or third party drivers that occupy that address space may be misreported Settings descriptions are taken from the appropriate manuals In particular the message May be on VME bus is particularly unreliable as the software setting more accurately reflects the use of particular hardware components on the CPU motherboard Reported sizes are rounded to the nearest whole number or nearest tenth if a decimal point is displayed In some circumstances adding individual items may not equal the displayed total due to rounding errors The total figure is more accurate than the sum of the items as it is based on the sum of individual byte or block counts not on the accumulation of rounded values Certain early versions of the monitor especially prior to AMOS 1 3D may not report certain fields fully or properly AMSCFG knows about the following third party products in their released versions of October 1995 Earlier or later versions of these products may produce incompatibilities with AMSCFG System Commands Reference Manual Rev 06 AMSCFG Page 4 Alpha Microsystems does not support AMSCFG handling of other software
618. ur file specification and which was your output specification Try again Not selected Source file does not have a calculated HASH total You specified H but the cassette doesn t have a HASH total to compare H was not used when the tape was created Run VCRRES without H System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VCRRES Page 6 Table of Contents out of sequence An error occurred when VCRRES was searching through the tape s table of contents Try again and see your System Operator if it occurs again Tape has passed specified location Press REWIND to back up and try again In a SEARCH operation you went past the location of the file you specified Rewind the tape and continue searching Unable to load Disk Driver Usually this means you don t have enough memory available in your partition Increase your memory and try again Unable to rehash bitmap run DSKANA immediately Due to I O errors the software is unable to read in the bitmap and write out a new hash for it To correct any invalid bitmap condition run DSKANA right away VCR blocks not in sync with VCRTOC IPF file The number of blocks in a file on the tape is not equal to the number of blocks the table of contents says are on the tape This tape cannot be restored To prevent this occurrence run DSKANA and correct all file errors before using VCRSAV to create the tape WARNING Extra copies count on backup media is below the minimum level for u
619. ur printer and network specification and try again Destination socket is full The destination system cannot accept your print request at this time Try again later If the problem persists see your System Operator Ersatz name not allowed when killing a file on remote spoolers You may not specify an ersatz name in association with the file name if the filename is being printed on a remote printer The ersatz name is translated by the local system which may not be what is desired Re enter the command using the full file name Insufficient Message Blocks You do not have a MSGINI nK command in your system INI file or your MSGINI command does not specify enough memory See your System Operator about changing the system INI file to correct this problem Message length greater than destination s specified maximum An internal network error has occurred This error may indicate that there are incompatible versions of network and spooler software installed on the local and remote systems Check with your System Operator Message system not supported No messages are pending receipt No socket has been established Not enough memory to perform KILL or LIST option There is not enough free memory in your job s partition to carry out the command Use DEL to remove files loaded into your partition or see your System Operator No files in print request no files updated PRNT was not able to find the files you specified Check the
620. utes a bitmap hash total based on the blocks it has processed If this value does not match the official bitmap hash total you see a message Whether the previous official bitmap hash total was correct or not DSKANA rewrites the bitmap unless you use C The last line of data in the terminal display tells you how many file errors were detected The messages listed in MESSAGES below tell you what kinds of file errors occurred Frequent file errors can indicate hardware or software problems If you want to see more information about how DSKANA is progressing as it analyzes your disk or if DSKANA has reported file errors on your disk and you want to find out where the errors occurred use L or E If DSKANA finds an error you see where on the disk it occurred For example Block 1703 block creates endless loop in file MDO LIT System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 DSKANA If you want to place the DSKANA output into a file include a file specification and an equal sign on the DSKANA command line For example DSKANA DSKO ERROR TXT DSK1 L If the specified file already exists DSKANA deletes it before beginning the disk analysis The first line of the file includes the date of the analysis Remember the output file must not be on the device you are analyzing If you use disk cache you will see this message DSKANA DSK5 Allocating memory for cached disk blocks 10540 bytes DSKANA needs four bytes
621. v 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 DOSDEL FUNCTION Deletes a file from an MS DOS formatted diskette CHARACTERISTICS DOSDEL accepts wildcards for the DOS file s It is re entrant re usable and works with these diskette formats 5 4 360K 3 1 44M DOSDEL understands only directory and file names that conform to the MS DOS 8 3 convention It does not understand Windows 95 long file names To use this command you must have a proper disk driver program for your computer s type of floppy disk and defined as MS DOS format when created by FIXFLP The device must be defined in BITMAP and DEVTBL statements in your system initialization command file you may want to load the driver into system memory See your system operator for help FORMAT DOSDEL devn DOS filespec devn is the AMOS device name for the diskette drive and DOS filespec is the complete specification of the file you want to delete There are no defaults OPERATION Enter DOSDEL and the file specification for the file you want to delete For example DOSDEL LFDO DBASE TUTORIAL READ ME DOSDEL then deletes the file from the diskette MESSAGES Invalid path specified Check your directory lists or your syntax and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DOSDEL Page 2 This is not a supported MS DOS format Sorry but can t be decoded Your floppy diskette is in a format DOSDEL can t read System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DOS
622. vel Because they are such common typing mistakes LOG treats the characters m and as commas However if the comma comes right after the word LOG a mistake is not translated because LOG doesn t know if you made a typing mistake or mis entered a user name For example LOG 100m5 works LOG m5 doesn t If an account is password protected LOG checks your password entry before logging you into that account It also validates your user name and user password before logging you in LOG also sets your job s file locking status according to the Lock Nolock and Elock Noelock options set up by MUSER If the status is changed the event is recorded in the system log file if event logging is active If you have a command file in your account named START CMD LOG automatically runs that file after it logs you in unless you specify N This command file can contain AMOS system commands program invocations the names of other command files etc If you have a MAIL JNK file in DSKO 7 2 LOG displays the first line of that file whenever a user logs into the system FORMAT LOG switch devn p pn user name switch is an option devn is the device name p is the project number and pn is the programmer number If you are already logged into an account you may be able to abbreviate the account number depending on where you want to LOG to see OPERATION below The user name is required if you are not logged in and you have a us
623. viously made in the VDK INI file CHARACTERISTICS VDKUTL is re entrant and re usable When you use VDKUTL from OPR or SYS VDKUTL enters a privileged mode and allows you to execute a variety of functions When you use VDKUTL from any other account it displays the current VDK statistics The virtual disk must be set up as either a traditional or extended format disk and can then only transfer files from the same type of disk If you have a system with both traditional and extended format disks on it you have to choose which type of disk you wish to use with the virtual disk o VDK transfers a file into memory only if it meets these requirements the file must use a default specification neither a device nor an account may be included with the file name and the default specification must match a specification in the VDK INI file Keep this in mind when looking at the VDKUTL display See the System Operator s Guide for more information about the virtual disk cache system OPERATION Enter VDKUTL VDKUTL The program displays data on how efficiently the virtual disk system is working If you are in OPR or SYS you see an asterisk prompt and can then enter the commands below COMMAND SUMMARY E Exit VDKUTL Returns you to AMOS command level H HELP List VDKUTL commands System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VDKUTL Page 2 I Initialize Make effective any changes that have been made to VDK INI since the computer
624. want to write into and try again Cannot perform special function device name device does not exist You tried to copy to or from a device not listed in the DEVTBL command in your system INI file does not have a driver in account 1 6 of the System Disk or is not file structured Fix the condition and try again Cannot READ device name device is not mounted Mount your device and try again Cannot read file mark reason A tape error has been encountered Device full See your System Operator about erasing unneeded files or otherwise making more room on your disk Files may not be transferred to RES Try again and transfer the file s to the disk You can then if you wish add them to resident memory in your system INI file Missing output specification You left out the equal sign in the TAPFIL command line TAPFIL couldn t tell which information was your file specification and which was your output specification Try again More than one output specification Try again using only one output specification No file oriented device corresponding to devn is mounted Check your syntax or mount the device Not copied Destination file already exists If you want to copy over the existing file try again without using NOD System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 TAPFIL Page 4 Tape is not file structured The tape you are trying to read was not written by FILTAP Make sure you have mounted the correc
625. what devices have been defined on your system and some information about them A line from the display might be DSKO sharable alternate physical unit 0 logical unit 0 sharable means the device can be accessed by more than one user at a time Non sharable devices are those devices only one user can access at a time such as a printer alternate means an alternate track table has been assigned Certain disk devices such as Winchester technology devices use an alternate track table to handle media flaws Sharable devices can be assigned to a particular job for exclusive use a You may also see no network access which tells you the device is not connected to a network or extended directory or other informative messages The physical and logical unit numbers tell you if the device has multiple logical devices All logical devices on a single physical unit share the same alternate track table if there is one which is stored on the first logical device If a device is listed as assigned to a job it is a non sharable device currently being used by that job System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DEVTBL Page 2 MESSAGES No device table allocated Your system does not have a device table See your System Operator for help System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 DING FUNCTION Rings the terminal bell CHARACTERISTICS DING is re entrant and re usable Useful in a command file to tell the user input
626. will save the file but its data may not be consistent as the other job s may be writing to the file while it is being saved to tape Bkup error contig file open Error MTUSAV could not open the contiguous file for any reason other than another job had the file opened for exclusive use MTUSAV will save the file but its data may not be consistent as the other job may be writing to the file while it is being saved to tape Bkup record in use Warning MTUSAV tried to read a block from a contiguous file 6 on disk but LOKSER reported that the block or part of it was locked by another job MTUSAV will read the block anyway but the data in the file may not be consistent Bkup contig file hijacked Warning Another job opened a contiguous file for exclusive use 6 while MTUSAV was copying it to tape MTUSAV will continue to save the file to tape and will read subsequent blocks regardless of locking The data in the tape file may not be consistent Bkup seq file padded Warning The number of blocks in a sequential file that can be read from the disk by following the internal forward pointers was fewer than the number of blocks indicated in the disk file s directory entry The file system is corrupt MTUSAV will save the entire file but will append null blocks to the tape file to pad its length out to the number of blocks specified in the directory entry The file is corrupt Bkup seq file truncated Error The number of blocks in a sequential fil
627. witch System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 LOAD FUNCTION Loads disk files into your memory partition as memory modules CHARACTERISTICS LOAD is re entrant and re usable You may use LOAD to load memory modules only in your own memory partition You cannot load a file from a remote system over a network LOAD does not understand wildcard symbols but it does understand ersatz names If you specify an ersatz name but omit a file extension LOAD uses the default extension for that ersatz name For example the default extension for the BAS account is SBR The ersatz device default extensions are Ersatz Device Extension Ersatz Device Extension BAS SBR BOX BOX CMD CMD DVR DVR HLP HLP LIB LIT SYS LIT MAC M68 OPR LIT PAS PSB FORMAT LOAD filespec filespec selects the disk file you want to load OPERATION Enter LOAD and the specification of the file you want to load into your memory partition For example LOAD DSKO ISAM SYS 1 4 If you see the AMOS prompt symbol and you don t see an error message you know the program you requested is now loaded into memory You can verify this by using the DIR MEM or MAP command System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 LOAD Page 2 MESSAGES Cannot DELETE filespec file may not be deleted A file of the same name as the one you tried to LOAD already exists in memory normally LOAD would write your new file over the old but th
628. witches you must specify dates and times in the following format switch month day year hour minute AM PM System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 Page 3 BACKUP You must specify either a date a time or both Specifying a time without a date defaults to the current date while a date without a time defaults to zero time midnight The argument for WAIT must be a relative number of hours and minutes from the current time WAIT hours minutes OPERATION Enter BACKUP followed by the desired file specifications For example BACKUP DSKO MEMO TXT 150 0 DSK1 TEST M68 100 3 BACKUP responds with a menu of the available backup devices After you make your selection BACKUP asks you to confirm that the device specification is correct If it is press RETURN If not enter the correct specification BACKUP then gives you step by step instructions for completing the backup These instructions vary according to the type of backup device you are using MESSAGES All date and time switches must be in absolute format See the rules above for specifying dates and times and try again Attempt to initiate device handler failed error code n Check to see if the number of jobs defined in your system initialization file is enough to include one for the device handler task The error codes are 1 Job table is full 4 SHNDLR task already exists If you see 1 add more jobs in the JOBS command in your system initializatio
629. xample SHELL MYMENU Account DSKO 7 11 is the menu library account if you place a menu in this account it can be called from any account on the system See the SHELL reference sheet for more information about using menus System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MENU Page 2 MESSAGES Syntax error number errors detected Your MNU file has an error check the file and correct it then try again Out of memory Increase the free memory in your job s partition before trying again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 MFDSEQ FUNCTION Sorts the accounts within a traditional logical disk unit into ascending order CHARACTERISTICS MFDSEQ is re entrant and re usable Used primarily as a tool for producing floppy disks on an AMOS 2 0 or later system which can be read on a pre 2 0 version of AMOS MEDSEQ does not work on extended disks You cannot run MFDSEQ on a remote disk across a network n Do NOT use MFDSEQ while other jobs are accessing the logical disk you are sequencing FORMAT MFDSEQ devn devn specifies the logical unit you want to arrange OPERATION Enter MFDSEQ and the logical unit For example MFDSEQ DSK1 MFDSEQ puts the directories of the logical device in ascending order An appropriate use of MFDSEQ is to copy one or more files to a floppy disk which has been SYSACTed as a traditional format disk from either an extended or traditional logical unit that is in AMOS 2 0 or late
630. xtended directory structure records the time and date of the last backup of each file You aborted this update process but any transfer to tape and verification prior to the abort is complete Cannot ASSIGN devn reason Cannot DEASGN devn reason MTUSAV could not get exclusive use of the tape unit Someone else has been assigned exclusive use Try using MTUSAV later You can find out which job has the tape assigned by using the DEVTBL command Cannot locate TAPSER LIT in spawned task s partition The background task launched by MTUSAV could not load and launch TAPSER LIT The backup will be aborted Cannot use filename reason MTUSAV encountered an error while accessing one of its work files If filename is a TOC table of contents or VER file the backup and verification proceed and the number of verification errors encountered will be correct but details on all the errors will not be available If filename is a LOG file further log details are not recorded in the Backup date update aborted by C LOG file but still display on the screen System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 MTUSAV Page 22 Data verification failure in file fspec The block by block comparison of a file on tape against its corresponding image on disk failed The file on tape is not identical to the now current contents of the file on disk Verification continues from the start of the next tape file Drive is not on line and at load po
631. y 4 W Modify full words Place counter changes by 2 Display current word as two octal bytes Puts contents of current location at next address Cancels current command number n Moves to n octal location n Stores n at current location nLINEFEED Stores n at current location and adds to counter A Stores n at current location and decrements counter MESSAGES Any command not in the list above will be echoed back with a question mark Privileged program must be logged into OPR Log into DSKO 1 2 and try again System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 QUEUE FUNCTION Displays the number of monitor queue blocks available for use CHARACTERISTICS QUEUE is re entrant and re usable Various portions of the system for example the line printer spooler use the monitor queue system The monitor queue is also available for use by user programs see your Monitor Calls Manual for information on the monitor queue system The initial size of the queue is 80 blocks The number of queue blocks you need depends on the tasks you need to perform Each queue block defined uses a certain amount of memory in the monitor so don t define many more queue blocks than you need or you will waste monitor memory and possibly slow down your system QUEUE is also used in the system initialization command file to allocate the number of queue blocks for the system See your System Operator s Guide to the System Initialization Co
632. y account HELP uses a function key translation file for your terminal if it finds one with the name driver name AMX in system or user memory or in DSKO 7 0 FORMAT HELP topic If you do not specify a topic HELP displays the HELP HLP file which contains a list of help topics or which may be modified to include whatever helpful information you wish You can insert TCRT codes for terminal attributes 1 x in a help file by entering an ESCAPE character followed by the decimal value of the code for the required attribute See Chapter 7 of the AMOS Monitor Calls Manual for the values for each attribute Terminate the codes with a non numeric character or a trailing ESCAPE character A FORMFEED character in a help file displays Press any key to continue and pauses for keyboard input before clearing the screen and displaying the rest of the file You can also design help files that call other help files in response to user input This allows you to have multi level help files that cover broad areas of information and allowing users to see only the information pertinent to their needs You do this by associating help file specifications with numbers A left brace begins the definitions and a right brace ends the definitions the text of which is not displayed on the screen For example System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 HELP Page 2 TAX HLP FILE HLP INVEN HLP KWo oe Al When the file above
633. y not displaying your old or new password PASS cannot change the password of an account on a write protected disk so make sure the correct device is write enabled A password must be six characters or less in length PASS doesn t check the length of the password you enter but cuts it off at the sixth character FORMAT PASS devn devn is the specification of the logical device containing an account with the same PPN as you are logged into DEFAULTS PASS won t allow any other account except the one you are logged into The devn defaults to the device you are logged into OPERATION Enter PASS optionally followed by a device name For example PASS DSK1 PASS asks you for your old password if one exists and your new password Then it asks you to verify your new password in other words to type your new password again PASS then changes your password MESSAGES Account number invalid Check your syntax and remember you can t password an account you are not logged into System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 PASS Page 2 Bad password You entered your old password incorrectly or made a typing mistake PASS did not change your old password Try again Cannot write device name write protected Remove the write protection and try again PPN has been deleted While you were running PASS someone deleted the account you are logged into See your System Operator about re creating your
634. you created the backup using VCRSAV While VCRSAV does work with extended disks in some situations we strongly suggest you use BACKUP to back up extended disks VCRDIR can be run with or without locking the others users out of the system even if the tape was created without using T You probably don t want to lock other users out unless having them on the system interferes with VCRDIR If you are going to lock other users out you should check with them before proceeding with VCRDIR f another user is reading from or writing to the disk that you are on when you use VCRDIR you both could be locked up VCRDIR accepts full wildcard specifications which select the files to be listed in the directory The account and device portions of the specification refer to the disk account and device from which the files were originally backed up See your AMOS User s Guide for information on wildcard file specifications FORMAT VCRDIR switch listfilespec filespec filespec s switch is an option request The listfilespec specifies a disk file to contain the tape directory display The filespecs are the files on the tape whose directory listing you want to see If you want a list of all the files on the tape enter VCRDIR ALL System Commands Reference Manual Rev 07 VCRDIR Page 2 DEFAULTS The default listfilespec is DIRECT LST in the account and device you are logged into The default filespec is and the account an
635. your boot drive is not SCSI ID 0 you XJ should use a disk driver created by FIXLOG for the correct SCSI ID If you use a generic disk driver which doesn t have the SCSI ID embedded you will not be able to MONTST with this monitor Next you are asked for the language definition table name If you just press RETURN MONGEN selects the default language file ENGLSH LDF MONGEN then asks for a name to be given to the new monitor Enter a one to six character name the default extension is MON This name is now the name of the new monitor You can now test the new monitor by using the MONTST program or you can save the monitor as a disk file by using the SAVE command For example SAVE TRISYS MON Remember MONGEN does not affect the running monitor either in memory or on the System Disk Nor does MONGEN test the new monitor it merely builds a new monitor as a module in your memory partition MESSAGES Cannot INIT filespec device does not exist Check your syntax or use DEVTBL to see a list of current devices and try again Cannot READ filespec disk not mounted Mount the specified device and try again Disk driver filespec not found Check your syntax if there is no mistake use the DIR command to search for the file it may be in the wrong account Input monitor filespec not found Check your syntax if there is no mistake use the DIR command to search for the file it may be in the wrong account System Command
636. your syntax or use DIR to locate the file and try again Insufficient memory to load program filename Use MEMORY to check your memory partition size You may need to increase it See your System Operator for help You may also see any of the standard AlphaBASIC error messages if your program has an error in it see your AlphaBASIC User s Manual System Commands Reference Manual Rev 03 AMOS 2 2 4 91 RUNP FUNCTION Runs a previously compiled AlphaBASIC PLUS program CHARACTERISTICS RUMP is re entrant and re usable See the AlphaBASIC PLUS User s Manual for information about the AlphaBASIC PLUS programming language System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 RUNX FUNCTION Runs a previously compiled AlphaBASIC program using the integral math coprocessor on a 68040 CPU chip CHARACTERISTICS RUNX is re entrant and re usable It functions only on a computer with a 68040 CPU with an integral math coprocessor Except for using the math functions of the 68040 to increase performance it works exactly like the RUN command See the AlphaBASIC User s Manual for information about the AlphaBASIC programming language System Commands Reference Manual Rev 04 SAVE FUNCTION Saves memory modules as disk files CHARACTERISTICS SAVE is re entrant and re usable and understands the wildcard symbols and SAVE will not save modules as disk files in accounts other than the one into which you are currently logged M
637. ystem was unable to find a buffer size that allows the AlphaCD special sector to properly recorded e Error Unable to calculate AMOS disk geometry System Commands Reference Manual Rev 11 Page 9 MAKACD The AMOS hidden sector parameters could not be calculated e Error Unable to remove CD Recorder data buffer from memory e Error Unable to write AlphaCD special sector An error was received while trying to record the AlphaCD special sector e Unable to continue due to one or more errors shown above Testing of logical disk drive transfer rates resulted in the errors listed above Normal informational messages e A blank CD is in the CD Recorder The CD media in the CD Recorder is blank and unused A blank CD does not require filler and an AlphaCD special sector e AlphaCD test complete The test recording is done e AlphaCD creation complete The recording of data on the CDR media is done e Are you sure you want to erase data from this CD Y N If you really want to erase the CD type Y RETURN The CD will be erased as requested If this was a mistake type N and the program will exit without erasing the CD e Calculating space requirements AMOS partition requires 16165 sectors Filler requires 38127 sectors Calculated starting AMOS sector is 251608 This shows information about where data will be recorded on the CD and how much space it consumes e CD Recorder located at SCSI id n This shows the SCSI id of the CD Recorder being u

Download Pdf Manuals

image

Related Search

Related Contents

D-Link DWA-566  Ethernet over VDSL2 Converter VC-201A / VC  SafeFile Backup Client User Manual Professional Edition  Embedded Systems Lecture #1  Silenciadores de Escape en Plástico Poroso Series M/S  小出しガン・小出しF ・セッ ト取扱説明書  Minka Lavery 4179-84 Instructions / Assembly    LN 51, Spécial - Portail de l`Agriculture wallonne  I TI UAL  

Copyright © All rights reserved.
Failed to retrieve file